HiPath 3000 V1.2 3.0 Service Manual
HiPath 3000 V1.2 3.0 Service Manual
HiPath 3000 V1.2 3.0 Service Manual
Version 1.2-3.0
Service Manual
*1PP31003-H1030-S403-6-7620*
1P P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620
This device has been manufactured in accordance with our certified environmental management system (ISO 14001). This process ensures that
energy consumption and the use of primary raw materials are kept to a minimum, thus reducing waste production.
Siemens AG 2004
Information and Communication Networks,
Hofmannstrae 51, D-81359 Mnchen, Germany
Reference No.: P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620 Printed in the Federal Republic of Germany.
Subject to availability. Right of modification reserved.
>
Unless otherwise indicated, the new features listed below are available in Version
3.0.
HiPath 3000 V3.0 is the IP convergence platform for small and medium-sized
business. The new version optimizes the use in IP environments and its expansion capabilities increase the range of possible uses.
Starting with Version 3.0, all models in the HiPath 3000 system family (not HiPath
3250 and HiPath 3150) can be operated either as conventional telecommunications systems (TC systems) or as IP systems only. In this case, the IP station connects directly to the HiPath HG 1500 boards. Table 2-6 on page 2-19 lists the resulting capacity limits.
New boards
HiPath
3750
HiPath
3700
HiPath
3550
HiPath
3350
HiPath
3500
HiPath
3300
HiPath
3250
HiPath
3150
ANI4R1
HXGM32
HXGS32
HXGR32
IVMP8
IVMP8R
TMGL4R1
TST11
SLC16N3
1 for selected countries only
2 V3.0 SMR-11 or later
3 SLC16N can be used in conjunction with special SMRs for V1.2 and V3.0. Please refer to the respective
sales release documentation for further details.
Call Management: The number of possible call destination lists has been increased (Section 7.4.4 on page 7-65):
The maximum number of Team/Top configurations for HiPath 3750 and HiPath
3700 has been increased from 150 to 500 (see Section 7.13.14 on page 7-394).
SMR-3 or later: New telephone family optiPoint 500 with new adapters and addon devices (see Section 9.2 on page 9-3).
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
New-1
Convergence telephone optiPoint 600 office with UP0/E and IP interfaces (see
Section 9.3 on page 9-34).
optiPoint 600 office can be used in conjunction with special SMRs for V1.2 and
V3.0. Please refer to the respective sales release documentation for further details.
SMR-6 or later: New IP telephone optiPoint 400 economy (see Section 9.6.3 on
page 9-43).
IP payload switching optimizes communication between LAN-based IP Workpoint Clients ( Section 9.6.5.1 on page 9-49).
Information about the calculation of the required HiPath HG1500 V2.0 and HiPath HG1500 V3.0 boards (Section 9.6.5.2 on page 9-51).
New-2
Information on configuring the plus product DoorCom Analog (not for U.S.)
(Section 10.5.1.1 on page 10-11).
New features:
Collect call barring for ISDN trunks (Section 7.16.24 on page 7-553)
SMR-6 or later: Every entry in a call data record in compressed format (via
V.24 and TFTP) and long format can be provided with a consecutive number
from 0000 to 9999 (see Section 7.15.8 on page 7-494).
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
New-3
New Features for U.S. Only (Already Introduced in Other Countries with Version 1.2)
New-4
To allow more application capabilities, additional housing designs were developed that are optimized for installation in 19 cabinets:
New 19 expansion cabinet rack ECR (not for U.S. and Canada) (Section 6.4 on
page 6-5), which can be equipped with
a battery pack (HiPath 3700, HiPath 3500, and HiPath 3300) and / or
an external power supply unit (EPSU2-R) for HiPath 3500 and HiPath 3300.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
New Features for U.S. Only (Already Introduced in Other Countries with Version 1.2)
New boards
HiPath
3750
HiPath
3700
HiPath
3550
HiPath
3350
HiPath
3500
HiPath
3300
HiPath
3250
HiPath
3150
CBCPR
CBCC
CBRC
SBSCO SBSCS
CMA
CMS
CUCR
CUPR
IMODC
LIM
MMC
IVML8
IVML24
TMCAS
UPSC-D
UPSC-DR
IVMS8
HXGSR
TMAMF
IVMS8R
SLU8R
STLS4R
TLA4R
TS2R
8SLAR
EXMR
OPALR
STRBR
UAMR
IVML8 and IVML24 for HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 (Section 3.3.5 on page
3-110)
IVMS8 for HiPath 3550, HiPath 3350 and IVMS8R for HiPath 3500, HiPath
3300 (Section 3.3.7 on page 3-118).
HiPath Cordless Office can be used for all systems in the product line (Chapter
11):
Direct connection to the UP0/E interfaces in the central control boards for HiPath 3550, HiPath 3350, HiPath 3250, HiPath 3150, HiPath 3500 and HiPath
3300.
Connection to the UP0/E interfaces in the SLC16 boards for HiPath 3750, HiPath 3550 and HiPath 3700. In HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700, up to four
SLC16 boards can be used.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
New-5
New Features for U.S. Only (Already Introduced in Other Countries with Version 1.2)
New-6
New features
Silent Monitoring: It is possible for all stations in the system to use Silent
Monitoring, not only for one (Section 7.4.14 on page 7-123).
Storing account codes ACCT in the redial memory (Section 7.8.1 on page
7-229)
E911 Emergency Call Service for the USA (Section 7.8.19 on page 7-277)
Relocate: It is possible to change the assignment between the physical telephone port and the logical station data (user profile) (Section 7.13.11 on
page 7-385).
Call detail recording central CDRC: Call data records from external calls that
were not completed can be recorded (Section 7.15.8 on page 7-494).
Controlled release of remote connections (using an analog or digital modem) between HiPath 3000 and HiPath 3000 Manager E (Section 12.9.4 on page 12-35).
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
New Features for U.S. Only (Already Introduced in Other Countries with Version 1.2)
Remote administration of the HiPath 3000 using PPP (Section 13.9 on page
13-13)
Using PPP (Point to Point Protocol), HiPath 3000 systems can be centrally administered from a service center.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
New-7
New Features for U.S. Only (Already Introduced in Other Countries with Version 1.2)
New-8
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Contents
Contents
1-17
1-17
1-18
1-18
1-18
1-18
1-19
1-20
1-20
1-20
1-21
1-22
1-23
1-23
1-24
1-24
1-25
1-32
1-32
1-32
0-1
Contents
0-2
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Contents
0-3
Contents
3-260
3-262
3-264
3-265
3-267
3-269
3-271
3-274
3-280
3-281
3-286
3-288
3-289
4 Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1
4.1 Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1
4.2 HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-2
4.2.1 Installation Prerequisites . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-2
4.2.2 Installation Procedure. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-3
4.2.3 HiPath 3750 Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-4
4.2.3.1 Selecting the Installation Site. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-5
4.2.3.1.1 AC Power (for U.S. Only) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-6
4.2.3.2 Unpacking the Components. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-7
4.2.3.3 Mounting the Main Distribution Frame (MDFU or MDFU-E) (Not for U.S.) . . . 4-7
4.2.3.4 Setting up the System Cabinets. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-8
4.2.3.4.1 Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-8
4.2.3.4.2 Removing the Cabinet Covers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-9
4.2.3.4.3 Setting Up a One-Cabinet System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-10
4.2.3.4.4 Setting Up a Stacked Two-Cabinet System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-13
4.2.3.4.5 Setting Up a Two-Cabinet System Side by Side . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-19
4.2.3.4.6 Setting Up a Stacked Three-Cabinet System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-20
4.2.3.4.7 Installing the Seismic Anchors (for U.S. Only) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-22
4.2.3.5 Grounding the System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-24
4.2.3.5.1 Not for U.S.: Grounding the System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-24
4.2.3.5.2 For U.S. Only: Grounding the System. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-27
4.2.3.6 Checking the Protective Grounding . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-29
4.2.3.7 Connecting the Cables to the Backplane. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-30
4.2.3.7.1 Backplanes of the 8-Slot Cabinets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-30
4.2.3.7.2 Connection Between the MDFU or MDFU-E and Backplane . . . . . . . . . 4-35
4.2.3.8 Laying the Line Network and Setting Jumpers on the MDFU or MDFU-E. . . 4-40
4.2.4 HiPath 3700 Installation (19-Inch Cabinet). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-45
4.2.4.1 Selecting the Installation Site. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-46
4.2.4.1.1 AC Power (for U.S. Only) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-46
4.2.4.2 Unpacking the Components. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-46
4.2.4.3 Mounting the System Cabinet in the 19-Inch Cabinet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-47
0-4
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Contents
0-5
Contents
4-113
4-114
4-117
4-117
4-117
4-118
4-118
4-118
4-119
4-120
4-123
5 Startup. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-1
5.1 Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-1
5.2 HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 Startup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-2
5.2.1 Overview. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-2
5.2.2 Startup Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-2
5.2.3 Supplying the System With Power . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-3
5.2.3.1 Assigning Station Numbers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-4
5.2.4 Carrying Out a System Reload. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-5
5.2.5 Carrying Out the Country Initialization and Selecting the Password Type . . . . . . . 5-6
5.2.6 Entering the System Number (Not for U.S.) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-8
5.2.7 Conducting Customer-Specific Programming . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-9
5.2.8 Carrying out a System Check. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-10
5.3 HiPath 3550, HiPath 3350, HiPath 3250, HiPath 3150, HiPath 3500 and
HiPath 3300 Startup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-11
5.3.1 Overview. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-11
5.3.2 Startup Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-11
5.3.3 Carrying Out a System Reload. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-12
5.3.4 Carrying Out the Country Initialization and Selecting the Password Type . . . . . . 5-13
5.3.5 Entering the System Number (Not for U.S.) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-15
5.3.6 Conducting Customer-Specific Programming . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-16
5.3.7 Carrying out a System Check. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-17
5.3.8 Station and Line Number Assignment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-18
5.3.9 Connecting ISDN (S0) interfaces (Not for U.S.) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-20
5.3.9.1 Connecting an ISDN Trunk (Not for U.S.) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-20
5.3.9.2 Networking Connection (HiPath 4000 CorNet-N) (Not for U.S.) . . . . . . . . . . 5-20
5.3.9.3 Connecting ISDN Terminals (Not for U.S.) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-20
5.3.9.4 Station Numbers for Internal S0 Stations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-23
5.3.9.5 Multi-Device Connection (for Germany Only) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-23
6 Expanding and Upgrading the System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.1 Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.2 Replacing Peripheral Boards for HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.3 Connecting a Printer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
0-6
6-1
6-1
6-2
6-4
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Contents
6.4 Installing an ECR with HiPath 3700, HiPath 3500, HiPath 3300 (not for U.S. and
Canada) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-5
6.4.1 ECR Control, Display, and Connecting Elements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-6
6.4.2 Components . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-9
6.4.3 Installation Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-9
6.4.4 Expansion Cabinet Rack (ECR) With Batteries. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-10
6.4.4.1 Installing Batteries . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-12
6.4.5 Expansion Cabinet Rack (ECR) With Batteries and EPSU2-R . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-15
6.4.5.1 Connect Fan (if needed) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-17
6.5 Upgrade System to HW V1.2 and SW V1.2/V3.0 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-20
7 Implementing Features. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-1
7.1 Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-1
7.2 Starting System Administration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-19
7.2.1 Accessing Manager T . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-19
7.2.2 Accessing HiPath 3000 Manager E. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-19
7.3 Features for All Traffic Types. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-20
7.3.1 Call Hold . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-20
7.3.2 Call Park . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-23
7.3.3 Toggle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-25
7.3.4 Unscreened Transfer. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-27
7.3.5 Screened Transfer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-30
7.3.6 Conference . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-32
7.3.7 Music on Hold (Internal or External Source) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-35
7.3.8 Announcements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-38
7.3.9 Consultation Hold . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-41
7.3.10 Recall . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-44
7.3.11 Setting the Signaling Method for Analog Stations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-47
7.3.12 optiPoint Attendant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-49
7.3.13 Busy Override . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-52
7.3.14 Overload Indication . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-55
7.3.15 Shared Transfer Switch (Not for U.S.). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-57
7.4 Features for General Incoming Traffic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-58
7.4.1 ANI (for Selected Countries Only) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-58
7.4.2 Distinctive Ringing. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-59
7.4.3 Call Waiting Tone/Call Waiting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-62
7.4.4 Call Management (CM) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-65
7.4.5 Call Forwarding - No Answer (CFNA) With a Timeout . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-71
7.4.6 Call Forwarding (CF) - Busy and No Answer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-75
7.4.7 Call Forwarding (CF) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-78
7.4.8 Subscriber Groups . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-82
7.4.9 Group Call . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-84
7.4.10 Group Call with Busy Signaling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-87
7.4.11 Hunt Group . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-89
7.4.12 Leave Group Call/Hunt Group (Stop Hunt) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-93
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
0-7
Contents
0-8
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Contents
7-193
7-198
7-201
7-204
7-206
7-210
7-214
7-217
7-219
7-221
7-223
7-226
7-229
7-229
7-233
7-237
7-240
7-243
7-246
7-248
7-251
7-253
7-255
7-259
7-262
7-264
7-267
7-269
7-271
7-273
7-274
7-277
7-280
7-281
7-284
7-285
7-285
7-286
7-287
7-288
7-288
7-289
7-297
0-9
Contents
7.10.1 Introduction. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.10.2 Carrier Types . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.10.3 Using Alternate Carriers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.10.3.1 Carrier Access Methods Supported . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.10.4 LCR Time of Day Evaluation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.10.5 LCR Outdial Rules . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.10.6 Expensive Route Identification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.10.7 Overflow Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.10.8 LCR Class of Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.10.9 Carrier-Select Override . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.10.10 Handling of Numbers and Destinations and Trunk Group Access Codes . . .
7.10.11 Correlation With Other Features. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.10.11.1 Station-Related Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.10.11.2 Trunk-Related Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.10.12 Routing Tables . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.10.13 LCR Dial Plan . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.10.13.1 Rules for Creating LCR Dial Plan Entries . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.10.14 Route Table . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.10.15 Time Table . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.10.16 Outdial Rule Table . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.10.17 Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.11 Features for Internal Traffic. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.11.1 Internal Traffic. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.11.2 Direct Station Selection (DSS)/Repertory Dial Key . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.11.3 Names . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.11.4 Automatic Callback When Free or Busy. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.11.5 Entrance Telephone/Door Opener . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.11.6 Speaker Call/Handsfree Answerback/Internal Paging (OptiPage) . . . . . . . . . .
7.11.7 Transfer from Announcement. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.11.8 Radio Paging Equipment (PSE) (Not for U.S.) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.11.8.1 Simple Radio Paging Equipment/Simple PSE (Not for U.S.). . . . . . . . . . .
7.11.8.2 Radio Paging Equipment via ESPA/Enhanced Radio Paging
Equipment (Not for U.S.) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.11.9 Message Texts/Mailboxes/Message Waiting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.11.10 Advisory Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.11.11 Internal Directory . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.11.12 Room Monitor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.11.13 Editing the Telephone Number. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.12 Tenant Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.12.1 Tenant Service Configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.13 Other Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.13.1 Voice Channel Signaling Security . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.13.2 Date and Time Display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.13.3 Relays. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
0-10
7-297
7-299
7-300
7-300
7-301
7-301
7-302
7-302
7-302
7-302
7-302
7-302
7-303
7-303
7-304
7-304
7-305
7-306
7-307
7-307
7-310
7-312
7-312
7-314
7-317
7-320
7-323
7-326
7-329
7-331
7-331
7-333
7-335
7-340
7-343
7-346
7-349
7-351
7-352
7-357
7-357
7-359
7-362
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Contents
7.13.4 Sensors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.13.5 Multilingual Text Output. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.13.6 Associated Dialing. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.13.7 Associated Services . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.13.8 Display Number of Stations with Direct Trunk Access (for Austria Only) . . . .
7.13.9 Services in the Talk State . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.13.10 Reset Activated Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.13.11 Relocate (Hoteling) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.13.12 Automatic Wake-up System/Timed Reminders. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.13.13 Delete All Station Numbers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.13.14 Team/Top . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.13.14.1 Team Configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.13.14.2 Top Configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.13.14.3 MULAP Groups . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.13.15 Storing Procedures on Procedure Keys . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.13.16 Customer-Specific Display (V3.0 or Later) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.14 Networking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.14.1 Satellite CS Capability. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.14.2 Tie Trunk Via TIEL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.14.3 Numbering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.14.4 Toll Restriction with CorNet-N . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.14.5 Call Detail Recording With Networking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.14.6 Incoming Call . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.14.7 Consultation Hold/Transfer/Pickup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.14.8 Recall . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.14.9 Call Waiting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.14.10 Distinctive Ringing in the Network. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.14.11 Callback on Free/Busy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.14.12 Station Number/Name Display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.14.13 Call Forwarding With Rerouting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.14.14 Toggle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.14.15 Conference . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.14.16 Central Attendant Console . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.14.17 Network-Wide Busy Signaling on the optiClient Attendant . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.14.18 Sharing System Speed Dialing in a Gateway System. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.14.19 Sharing a Central Voice Mail Server . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.14.20 QSig . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.14.20.1 Basic Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.14.20.2 Central Attendant Position/Attendant Console . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.14.20.3 Intercept . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.14.20.4 Originator of the Intercept . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.14.20.5 Busy Override . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.14.20.6 Recall . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.14.20.7 Message Waiting Indication (MWI) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-367
7-370
7-373
7-376
7-379
7-381
7-382
7-385
7-390
7-392
7-394
7-394
7-401
7-410
7-422
7-427
7-429
7-433
7-436
7-437
7-439
7-442
7-444
7-445
7-447
7-448
7-449
7-450
7-451
7-453
7-455
7-456
7-458
7-459
7-462
7-463
7-465
7-466
7-467
7-467
7-467
7-468
7-468
7-468
0-11
Contents
0-12
7-469
7-469
7-470
7-472
7-472
7-474
7-477
7-479
7-482
7-486
7-489
7-494
7-516
7-518
7-520
7-523
7-524
7-525
7-526
7-528
7-529
7-531
7-532
7-533
7-534
7-536
7-538
7-539
7-540
7-542
7-543
7-544
7-545
7-546
7-547
7-548
7-549
7-550
7-552
7-553
7-555
7-556
7-561
7-564
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Contents
7-564
7-566
7-567
7-568
7-569
7-570
7-571
7-572
7-573
7-574
7-576
7-577
7-578
7-579
7-580
7-581
7-582
7-583
7-584
7-585
7-586
7-587
7-588
7-589
7-590
7-591
7-592
7-593
7-594
7-595
7-596
0-13
Contents
0-14
9-13
9-14
9-15
9-15
9-16
9-17
9-18
9-19
9-20
9-21
9-22
9-24
9-27
9-28
9-29
9-30
9-30
9-31
9-32
9-34
9-37
9-38
9-39
9-39
9-41
9-43
9-44
9-46
9-49
9-51
9-55
9-55
9-56
9-59
9-59
9-60
9-61
9-62
9-64
9-66
9-67
9-67
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Contents
9.8.7.2 Log On the Mobile Telephone (for Gigaset 3000 Comfort, 3000 Micro). . . .
9.8.7.3 Log On the Mobile Telephone (for Gigaset 4000 Comfort, 4000 Micro). . . .
9.8.7.4 Check the Login Status of the Mobile Telephones . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
9.8.7.5 Replace, Lock, and Log Off a Mobile Telephone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
9.9 Analog Telephones . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
9.10 ISDN Terminals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
9.10.1 General S0 Wiring (for U.S. Only) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
9.10.1.1 Specific S0 Wiring Configurations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
9-68
9-69
9-70
9-70
9-71
9-72
9-73
9-74
0-15
Contents
12-13
12-13
12-14
12-14
12-16
12-17
12-18
12-19
12-20
12-20
12-20
12-21
12-29
12-29
12-29
12-30
12-31
12-33
12-33
12-34
12-35
12-35
12-35
12-36
12-36
12-36
12-36
12-37
12-37
12-40
12-42
12-44
12-45
12-45
12-45
12-48
0-16
13-1
13-1
13-2
13-3
13-3
13-3
13-5
13-6
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Contents
0-17
Contents
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .W-1
Tables . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . X-1
Abbreviations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Y-1
Index . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Z-1
0-18
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Important Information
Overview
1 Important Information
Service Manual HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0: P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
1.1 Overview
Chapter Contents
This chapter discusses the following topics:
Topic
Structure of This Service Manual, page 1-2
Connection area, page 1-4
Safety Information, page 1-5
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
1-1
Important Information
Structure of This Service Manual
Warning
Only authorized service personnel are permitted to work on the system.
The information provided in this document contains merely general descriptions or
characteristics of performance which in case of actual use do not always apply as described or which may change as a result of further development of the products. An
obligation to provide the respective characteristics shall only exist if expressly agreed
in the terms of contract.
1-2
Chapter 2, System Data provides information on the current HiPath 3000 version and associated systems (characteristics, construction, system environment,
capacity limits, technical data).
Chapter 3, Boards describes all of the boards used for HiPath 3000. The
hardware information (such as connection cables and NT connections) is presented for each board.
The actions necessary for the standard installation (part of a standard system) of
the different HiPath 3000 systems are described in Chapter 4, Installation.
The procedures for the startup of the individual HiPath 3000 components are described in Chapter 5, Startup.
Chapter 9, Workpoint Clients contains the description of the workpoint clients and adapters supported.
Basic information about the operation of the HiPath Cordless Office are part of
Chapter 11, HiPath Cordless Office.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Important Information
Structure of This Service Manual
Chapter 12, Service describes the optional service and maintenance tasks
and provides support for error detection and troubleshooting.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
1-3
Important Information
Connection area
This device has been manufactured in accordance with our certified environmental management system (ISO 14001). This process ensures that
energy consumption and the use of primary raw materials are kept to a minimum, thus reducing waste production.
1-4
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Important Information
Safety Information
Danger
This symbol warns that a situation may cause death or serious injury.
Warning
This symbol indicates hazard which may lead to serious injury.
Caution
This symbol indicates a risk of damage to hardware or software.
>
Electricity
Weight
Heat
Fire
Chemicals
ESD*
Laser
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
1-5
Important Information
Safety Information
Replace any damaged safety equipment (covers, labels and protective cables)
immediately.
Accessories
Use only original accessories or components approved for the system. Failure to observe these instructions may damage the equipment or even violate safety and EMC
regulations.
System Shut-Down During Maintenance Work
Procedures to be observed are described in the relevant chapters.
1-6
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Important Information
Safety Information
Work on low voltage electrical networks (100 to 240 Vac) must only be carried
out by qualified personnel or authorized electrical engineers.
Do not work alone. Work with another person who knows the locations of the
power-off switches.
Never assume that the power is turned off. Always test to ensure that a circuit
does not have power.
Use caution when installing or modifying telephone lines. Never install telephone
wiring during an electrical storm.
When performing work on an open system, ensure that it is never left unsupervised.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
1-7
Important Information
Safety Information
Do not wear loose clothing; tie back your hair while working on machines.
Be sure to remove rings, watches, and other jewelry when working with electrical
circuits and components.
Wear eye protection when you are working in any conditions that might be hazardous to your eyes.
Always wear a hard hat where there is a risk of injury from falling objects.
General Safety
1-8
The surface of a mirror is conductive. Do not touch powered circuits with a mirror.
To do so can cause personal injury and machine damage.
Disconnect all power before working near power supplies unless otherwise instructed by a maintenance procedure.
Do not attempt to lift objects that you think are too heavy for you; use a hand truck
or get help.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Important Information
Safety Information
Check the nominal voltage set for the equipment (operating instructions and type
plate).
High voltages capable of causing shock are used in this equipment. Be extremely
careful when measuring high voltages and when servicing cards, panels, and
boards while the system is powered on.
Damage
Only use tools and equipment which are in perfect condition. Do use equipment with
visible damage.
Protecting Electrostatically Sensitive Devices (ESD)
To protect electrostatically sensitive devices (ESD):
Wear a wristband before carrying out any work on PC boards and modules. Connect the alligator clip at the end of the electrostatic wristband wire to a grounded
object.
Laying Cables
Lay cables so as to prevent any risk of them being damaged or causing accidents,
such as tripping.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
1-9
Important Information
Safety Information
All cables and lines leaving a system cabinet must be shielded between the connection point in the cabinet and, at the very least, the point at which they leave
the cabinet. Use a clip and pressure screw to contact all braided shields to the
cabinet outlet. This also applies to continuously connected service equipment
1-10
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Important Information
Safety Information
Flammable Materials
Do not store documents, descriptions, operating instructions, and similar flammable materials in the cabinet.
Workplace Hazards
Battery Disposal
Batteries are also included with the telephones and the equipment. Do not dispose of old or defective batteries along with normal household refuse. Instead, drop them off at special sites intended for battery disposal. Observe country-specific regulations.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
1-11
Important Information
Safety Information
1.4.5 Emergencies
Actions in Emergencies
Use caution if an accident occurs. Disconnect the power before touching the victim.
If you do not know how to disconnect the power, use a nonconducting object,
such as a wooden rod, to push or pull the victim away from electrical contact.
Be familiar with first aid for electrical shock. This includes resuscitation methods,
heartbeat restoration, and burn treatment.
If you are trained and certified, administer cardiac compression if the heart is not
beating.
First Aid
What happened?
Be prepared to assist the emergency services with any supplementary information they may require.
1-12
Report to your manager all accidents, near accidents, and possible hazards to
ensure their causes are resolved as soon as possible.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Important Information
Safety Information
Music on Hold and paging devices must be connected to the HiPath 3000 via an
ACA approved Line Isolation Unit.
HiPath 3550, HiPath 3350 and HiPath 3250 must be installed near the mains
socket-outlet, which is powering the system. The mains socket shall be readily
accessible. Integrity of the main socket earth must be assured.
The HiPath 3000 communications servers must only be installed and maintained
by service personnel.
HiPath 3550, HiPath 3350 and HiPath 3250 must be earthed with a separate
bonding earth, if the systems are powered by a UPS.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
1-13
Important Information
Privacy and Data Security
1-14
Use the password features of the system with no exceptions. Never give passwords to an unauthorized person orally or in writing.
Ensure that no unauthorized person can ever process (store, modify, transmit,
disable or delete) or use customer data.
Prevent unauthorized persons from gaining access to data media (such as backup diskettes or log printouts. This applies to service calls as well as storage and
transport.
Ensure that data media that are no longer needed are completely destroyed and
that documents are not stored or left in places which are accessible to the public.
Work closely with your customer contact; this promotes trust and reduces
your workload.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Important Information
Related Documents
Intranet: http://c4bs.spls.de/
Internet: http://www.click4business-supplies.de/
Table 1-1
Order number
Medium:
P31003 = elec. doc.
A31003 = paper doc.
Language:
xx = language code
(e. g. 74 for German/English, 76 for English ...)
P31003-H1030-S403-*-6Z20
P31003-M1550-X403-*-6Z20
A31003-M1550-X-*-xx20
P31003-H1030-X100-*-7418
A31003-M1522-C101-*-xx20
A31003-S2510-A400-*-xxA9
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
1-15
Important Information
Related Documents
1-16
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
1-17
1.2 Safety
The following information is included in this publication for the use and safety of installation and maintenance personnel.
Do not attempt to lift objects that you think are too heavy for you; use a hand truck
or get help.
Do not wear loose clothing; tie back your hair while working on machines.
Wear eye protection when you are working in any conditions that might be hazardous to your eyes.
After maintenance, reinstall all safety devices such as shields, guards, labels,
and ground wires. Replace worn safety devices.
If you feel any action is unsafe, notify your manager before proceeding.
Do not use a telephone to report a gas leak while in the vicinity of the leak.
Ensure you are familiar with the site safety procedures of the location where you
are performing installation or maintenance.
DANGER
Do not take chances with your life. Follow these safety guidelines carefully.
Observe all safety regulations and read the warnings, cautions, and notes posted
on the equipment.
Find the switch to power off the cabinet. Read the posted instructions.
1-18
Never assume that the power is turned off. Always test to ensure that a circuit
does not have power.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Do not work alone. Work with another person who knows the locations of the
power-off switches.
Follow the instructions in the manual carefully, especially when working with circuits that are powered. Disconnect power when instructed to do so in the procedures.
Disconnect all power before working near power supplies unless otherwise instructed by a maintenance procedure.
Disconnect all power before installing changes in machine circuits unless otherwise instructed by a maintenance procedure.
High voltages capable of causing shock are used in this equipment. Be extremely
careful when measuring high voltages and when servicing cards, panels, and
boards while the system is powered on.
Be sure to remove rings, watches, and other jewelry when working with electrical
circuits and components.
Use caution when installing or modifying telephone lines. Never install telephone
wiring during an electrical storm.
Never install a telephone jack where it can get wet unless the jack is specifically
designed for wet conditions.
Never touch uninsulated telephone wires or terminals unless the telephone line
has been disconnected at the network interface.
Avoid using a telephone (other than the cordless type) during an electrical storm
due to the remote risk of shock from lightning.
Look for hazards in your area and eliminate them. Examples are moist floors, ungrounded power extension cables, power surges, and missing safety grounds.
Rubber electrostatic mats will not protect you from electrical shock. Do not use
them for this purpose. Stand on suitable rubber mats to insulate you from
grounds such as metal floor strips and machine frames.
Use only tools and testers suitable for the job, approved by Siemens Communications. Do not use worn or broken tools or testers; inspect them regularly.
Set controls on testers correctly and use approved probe leads and accessories
intended for that tester.
The surface of a mirror is conductive. Do not touch powered circuits with a mirror.
To do so can cause personal injury and machine damage.
Do not store combustible gases or flammable materials in cabinets near the site.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
1-19
1.2.2.3 Emergencies
Ensure you are familiar with the site emergency procedures of the location where
you are performing installation or maintenance.
Be familiar with first aid for electrical shock. This includes resuscitation methods,
heartbeat restoration, and burn treatment.
Use caution if an accident occurs. Disconnect the power before touching the victim.
If you do not know how to disconnect the power, use a nonconductive object,
such as a wooden rod, to push or pull the victim away from electrical contact.
If you are trained and certified, administer cardiac compression if the heart is not
beating.
Report to your manager all accidents, near accidents, and possible hazards to
ensure their causes are resolved as soon as possible.
1-20
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Danger
This symbol warns that a situation may cause death or serious injury.
Warning
This symbol indicates hazard which may lead to serious injury.
Caution
This symbol indicates a risk of damage to hardware or software.
>
Electricity
Weight
Heat
Fire
Chemicals
ESD*
Laser
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
1-21
1-22
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
1-23
1-24
Connect the equipment into an outlet on a circuit different from that to which the
receiver is connected.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
1-25
1-26
Each Siemens system discussed in this section returns proper answer supervision to the public switched telephone network (PSTN) when DID calls are:
Each Siemens system discussed in this section returns proper answer supervision on all DID calls forwarded to the PSTN. Permissible exceptions are when:
A call is unanswered
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
1-27
This table lists the network trunk interfaces for loop-start and ground-start services.
Facility Interface
REN
Network
Jacks
02LS2
TMGL8
1.2B
RJ21X
02GS2
TMGL8
1.2B
RJ21X
02RV2-T
TMDID8
0.0
RJ21X
This table lists the station interfaces for analog private line (PL) services.
Analog PL Facility
Interface
Network Jacks
OL13B
SLA16 (OPS)
9.0F
RJ21X
OL13B
SLA24N (OPS)
9.0F
RJ21X
TL11M
TIEL4
9.0F
RJ2EX
TL11E
TIEL4
9.0F
RJ2FX
TL12M
TIEL4
9.0F
RJ2GX
TL12E
TIEL4
9.0F
RJ2HX
TL31M
TIEL4
9.0F
RJ2EX
TL31E
TIEL4
9.0F
RJ2FX
TL31M
TIEL4
9.0F
RJ2GX
TL31E
TIEL4
9.0F
RJ2HX
This table lists the network digital trunk interfaces for digital services.
Network
Jacks
04DU9-BN
TMST1
6.0P
Refer to note
04DU9-DN
TMST1
6.0P
Refer to note
04DU9-1KN
TMST1
6.0P
Refer to note
04DU9-1SN
TMST1
6.0P
Refer to note
Note: Always use this product with network channel terminating equipment that specifies the jack to use.
1-28
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
This table lists the answer supervision codes for network DID interfaces.
Network
Jacks
02RV-T
TMDID
AS.2
RJ21X
04DU9-BN
TMST1
AS.2
Refer to note
04DU9-DN
TMST1
AS.2
Refer to note
04DU9-1KN
TMST1
AS.2
Refer to note
04DU9-1SN
TMST1
AS.2
Refer to note
Note: Always use this product with network channel terminating equipment that specifies the jack to use.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
1-29
This table lists the network trunk interfaces for loop-start and ground-start services.
Facility Interface
REN
Network
Jacks
02LS2
TMGL4
0.4B
RJ21X
02GS2
TMGL4
0.4B
RJ21X
This table lists the station interfaces for analog private line (PL) services.
Analog PL Facility
Interface
Network Jacks
OL13B
8SLA (OPS)
9.0 F
RJ21X
OL13B
4SLA (OPS)
9.0 F
RJ2GX
OL13B
SLA24N (OPS)
9.0 F
RJ21X
This table lists the network digital trunk interfaces for digital services.
Network
Jacks
02IS5
TMQ4 board
6.0 Y
RJ49
04DU9-BN
TST1
6.0 P
Refer to note
04DU9-DN
TST1
6.0 P
Refer to note
04DU9-1KN
TST1
6.0 P
Refer to note
04DU9-1SN
TST1
6.0 P
Refer to note
Note: Always use this product with network channel terminating equipment that specifies the jack to use.
1-30
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
This table lists the network trunk interfaces for loop-start and ground-start services.
Facility Interface
REN
Network
Jacks
02LS2
TMGL4
0.4B
RJ21X
02GS2
TMGL4
0.4B
RJ21X
This table lists the station interfaces for analog private line (PL) services.
Analog PL Facility
Interface
Network Jacks
OL13B
8SLA (OPS)
9.0 F
RJ21X
OL13B
4SLA (OPS)
9.0 F
RJ2GX
This table lists the network digital trunk interfaces for digital services.
Network
Jacks
02IS5
TMQ4 board
RJ49
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
6.0 Y
1-31
1-32
DANGER
Users should not attempt to make such connections themselves, but should contact
the appropriate electric inspection authority, or electrician, as appropriate
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
System Data
Overview
2 System Data
2.1 Overview
Chapter Contents
This chapter discusses the following topics:
Topic
Introduction to HiPath 3000, page 2-2
Design and Dimensions, page 2-3
Design and Dimensions of the HiPath 3250 and the HiPath 3150 (Not for U.S.),
page 2-7
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
2-1
System Data
Introduction to HiPath 3000
>
HiPath 3000 V3.0 is the IP convergence platform for small and medium-sized business. The new version optimizes the use in IP environments and its expansion capabilities increase the range of possible uses.
Starting with Version 3.0, all models in the HiPath 3000 system family (not HiPath
3250 and HiPath 3150) can be operated either as conventional telecommunications
systems (TC systems) or as IP systems only. In this case, the IP station connects
directly to the HiPath HG 1500 boards. Table 2-6 on page 2-19 lists the resulting capacity limits.
Systems for free-standing installation (HiPath 3750 only) and wall mounting
HiPath 3750
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3250
HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3300
Refer to Table 2-6 for information on the capacity limits of the different HiPath 3000
systems.
2-2
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
System Data
Design and Dimensions
Design
The HiPath 3750 uses 8-slot cabinets, where expansion cabinet 1 (EC1) and expansion cabinet 2 (EC2) are identical in design.
The BC has seven slots available for peripheral boards and each expansion cabinet
has 8 slots. The UPSM power supply (in all cabinets) and the CPCPR central board
(only in the BC) have fixed positions.
Up to two cabinets can be stacked.
A main distribution frame unit (MDFU/MDFU-E) is needed to complete the communication system.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
2-3
System Data
Design and Dimensions
Dimensions
MDFU
ca.328 mm
MDFU-E
ca.370 mm
ca.670 mm
EC1
MDFU
MDFU
EC2
BC
Cable duct
Figure 2-1
2-4
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
System Data
Design and Dimensions
Mounting
surface
200 mm (8 in.)
Figure 2-2
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
2-5
System Data
Design and Dimensions
Mounting
surface
128 mm (5 in.)
Figure 2-3
2-6
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
System Data
Design and Dimensions
2.3.4 Design and Dimensions of the HiPath 3250 and the HiPath 3150 (Not
for U.S.)
Design
HiPath 3250 and HiPath 3150 are one-cabinet systems for wall mounting. The housing contains a single-board system and connections for the trunks and stations.
The cables to the peripherals (such as telephones and trunks) connect directly to the
board.
Dimensions
Mounting
surface
365 mm
293 mm
67 mm
Figure 2-4
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
2-7
System Data
Design and Dimensions
a three-cabinet system (BC + EC1 + EC2), only when the 19 cabinets are next
to one another and are accessible from the back.
EC1
EC2
approx. 980 mm
approx. 410 mm
BC
Figure 2-5
2-8
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
System Data
Design and Dimensions
Slot levels 1-3: slide-in shelves for peripheral boards (2 boards can be plugged
in on each level)
440 mm
155 mm
380 mm
Necessary height units for 19 cabinet assembly: 4
(one height unit corresponds to approx. 1.7 = 43 mm)
Figure 2-6
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
2-9
System Data
Design and Dimensions
440 mm
88 mm
380 mm
Necessary height units for 19 cabinet assembly: 2
(one height unit corresponds to approx. 1.7 = 43 mm)
Figure 2-7
2-10
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
System Data
System Environment
U.S.
Central Boards
and Options
ROW
U.S.
Trunk Boards
ROW
U.S.
IVML8
CBCPR
HXGM2
IVML24
CMS
HXGM3
SLA8N
CR8N
STMD8
TMGL8
SLA16N
IMODC
TIEL
SLA24N
LIM
TML8W
TMDID
SLC16
MMC
TMOM
TMST1
SLC16N
UPSM
TMS2
TMAMF2
SLMO8
SLMO24
GEE8
STMD8
MPPI
TMCAS3
PFT1/PFT4
REAL
1 ROW = rest of world
2 For Brazil, India, Malaysia, Singapore, and ATEA countries only
3 For selected countries only
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
2-11
System Data
System Environment
U.S.
IVMS8
LAN Bridge
SLA8N
SLA16N
SLA24N
SLC16
SLC16N
SLMO24
Central Boards
and Options
ROW
U.S.
CBCC
CMA
CMS
CUC
IMODC
LIM
MMC
UPSC-D
SLU8
STLS2
STLS4
4SLA
8SLA
16SLA
1
2
3
4
2-12
ALUM4
ANI43
EXM
GEE12
GEE16
GEE50
UAM
MPPI
OPAL
PDM1
4
STBG4
STRB
V24/1
Trunk Boards
ROW
U.S.
HXGS2
HXGS3
STLS2
STLS4
TLA2
TMGL4
TLA4
TMQ4
TLA8
TST1
2
TMAMF
TMCAS3
TS2
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
System Data
System Environment
U.S.
IVMP8
IVMS8
LAN Bridge
SLU8
STLS2
STLS4
4SLA
8SLA
16SLA
Central Boards
and Options
ROW
U.S.
CBCC
CMA
CMS
CUP
IMODC
LIM
MMC
PSUP
UPSC-D
Trunk Boards
ROW
U.S.
HXGS2
HXGS3
STLS2
STLS4
TLA2
TMGL4
TLA4
TMQ4
TLA8
ALUM4
ANI42
EXM
GEE12
GEE16
GEE50
UAM
MPPI
OPAL
PDM1
STBG43
STRB
V24/1
1 ROW = rest of world
2 For selected countries only
3 For France only
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
2-13
System Data
System Environment
S0
option 1
S0 (1)
Digital trunk
Euro ISDN
S0 (2)
Digital trunk
Euro ISDN
S0 (1)
Digital trunk
Euro ISDN
S0 (2)
CorNet slave
S0 (2)
CorNet slave
S0 (2)
Digital trunk
Euro ISDN
10BaseT
LAN
V.24
Service PC
Printer
or
S0
option 2
or
S0
terminal
S0 (1)
S0
option 3
or
S0
terminal
S0 (1)
Analog
terminals
a/b
optiPoint 500 U
P0/E
optiset E
BS3/1 / BS3/S Cornet TS
Euro ISDN
S0
option 4
4 x a/b
4 x UP0/E
SBSCO
Adapter
Figure 2-8
2-14
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
System Data
System Environment
Option 2:
Option 3:
Option 4:
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
2-15
System Data
System Environment
S0
terminal
S0 (2)
Analog
terminals
a/b
optiPoint 500 U
P0/E
optiset E
Cornet TS
BS3/S
Euro ISDN
2 x S0
S0 (1)
Digital trunk
Euro ISDN
10BaseT
LAN
V.24
Service PC
Printer
4 x a/b
2 x UP0/E
SBSCS
Adapter
Figure 2-9
2-16
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
System Data
System Environment
Central Boards
and Options
ROW
U.S.
CBRC
CMA
CMS
CUCR
IMODC
LIM
MMC
UPSC-DR
Trunk Boards
ROW
U.S.
HXGR3
HXGSR2
STLS4R
TS2R
TMGL4R
TLA4R
TST1
ANI4R2
EXMR
MPPI
OPALR
PDM1
STRBR
UAMR
1 ROW = rest of world
2 For selected countries only
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
2-17
System Data
System Environment
Central Boards
and Options
ROW
U.S.
CBRC
CMA
CMS
CUPR
IMODC
LIM
MMC
UPSC-DR
Trunk Boards
ROW
U.S.
HXGR3
HXGSR2
STLS4R
TLA4R
TMGL4R
ANI4R2
EXMR
MPPI
OPALR
PDM1
STRBR
UAMR
1 ROW = rest of world
2 For selected countries only
2-18
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
System Data
System-Related Capacity Limits
>
Table 2-6
System
HiPath
3750
HiPath
3550
Total stations
TDM1 + IP
384
116 (1642)
with
SLC16/
SLC16N
or
84 (1562)
44 (602)
13
13
384
84
44
5003
192
96
5003
192
96
44 (1084) 5 20 (362)
256
(3842)
44 5
20
48 (722) 5
24
3846
48 5
24
24
116
48
24
Stations analog
Stations digital
256
(3842)
3846
48
(722)
116
Stations IP
5003
192
96
5003
192
96
Stations cordless
250
64 (BS on
SLC16/
SLC16N)
or
32 (BS on
CBCC)
16
250
32
16
100
100
30
2 per
phone
2 per
phone
100
100
30
optiPoint BLFs
127
127
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
2-19
System Data
System-Related Capacity Limits
Table 2-6
System
HiPath
3550
50
48
50
48
50
48
16
50
48
16
384
48
24
384
48
24
(32)
64
on max.
4 SLC16
/SLC16N
optiClient Attendants
64
on max.
4 SLC16
/SLC16N
16 on
SLC16/
SLC16N
or
7 on
CBCC
1203
60
16
1203
60
16
1203
60
16
1203
60
16
Total network
trunks CorNet-IP
1203
32
16
1203
32
16
16
16
16
16
16
16
2
(1 x 9pin, 1 x
25-pin)
2
(1 x 9-pin,
1 x 25-pin)
2
(1 x 9pin, 1 x
25-pin)
1
(9-pin)
1
(9-pin)
2
(1 x 9pin, 1 x
25-pin)
1
(9-pin)
1
(9-pin)
Trunks
Base stations
V.24 interfaces
1 Including slave phones via phone adapter, analog phones via analog adapter and mobile phones (cordless)
2 Country specific configuration
3 To ensure that the dynamic capacity limit of HiPath 3750 or HiPath 3700 is not exceeded, the configuration can be tested
using the project planning tool.
4 Country specific configuration: 108 analog stations = 1xSLA24N + 5x16SLA + 4xa/b on CBCC
5 One slot reserved for trunk board
6 Max. 144 digital stations per cabinet with UPSM, max. 120 digital stations per cabinet with PSUI
7 Connection to a maximum of 6 optiPoint 500 phones
8 optiset E control adapters which are not used for CSTA applications do not count as data terminal equipment.
2-20
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
System Data
Technical Specifications
Technical Specifications
HiPath
3750
HiPath
3550
HiPath
3350
HiPath
3250
HiPath
3150
HiPath
3700
HiPath
3500
HiPath
3300
60 W
25 W
25 W
430 W
180 W
90 W
430 W
180 W
90 W
Line voltage
100 240 VAC (not for U.S); 120 VAC (for U.S. only)
AC line frequency
Weight
8 kg
0,7 kg
22 kg
6 kg
(1.54 lb.) (48.46 lb.) (17.62 lb.) (13.22 lb.)
(per fully
equipped
cabinet)
Expansion cabinet ECR (not for
U.S. and Canada):
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
2-21
System Data
Technical Specifications
SLA16 or
SLA24
Communications
server
Measurement points
>
2-22
All values are approximate and should be viewed as such under operating conditions. Always allow a tolerance range with technical equipment.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
System Data
Interface-to-Interface Ranges
Telephone Interfaces
Range in m
Loop Resistance in
Ohms
ISDN-S0 point-to-point
< 600
156
ISDN-S0 point-to-multipoint
< 150
39
< 10
Analog users
< 2000
520
< 1000
230
< 100
23
S2M
Diameter
Attenuation
per km
Max. Cable
Length
ICCS cable
J-2Y(ST)Y4x2x0,51 LG
ICCS Data5
0.51 mm
7.5 dB
at 96 kHz
800 m
Installation cable
J-2Y(ST)Y 10x2x0,6 ST
III BD
0.6 mm
6.0 dB
at 96 kHz
1000 m
A-2Y0F(L)2Y 10x2x0,6
(full PE insulation, filled)
0.6 mm
17 dB
at 1 MHz
350 m
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
2-23
System Data
Numbering Plan
Type of Numbers
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3250
HiPath 3150
HiPath 3300
100-349
500-749
100-278
500-687
11-30
51-70
100-349
500-749
100-278
500-687
11-30
51-70
Trunk numbers
7801-7920
7801-7920
801-816
0 = ROW1
9 = U.S.
0 = ROW
9 = U.S.
0 = ROW
9 = U.S.
80-84
850-859
80-84
850-859
82-88
891
891
891
890
890
890
Digital modem
Internal & DID
879
879
879
Group numbers
Internal & DID
350-499
8600-8749
350-499
31-50
9 = ROW
0 = U.S.
9 = ROW
0 = U.S.
9 = ROW
0 = U.S.
0 = ROW
9 = U.S.
0 = ROW
9 = U.S.
0 = ROW
9 = U.S.
75
75
75
76
76
76
*xxx
#xxx
*xxx
#xxx
*xxx
#xxx
Service codes
1 ROW = rest of world
2-24
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
System Data
Compliance
2.9 Compliance
2.9.1 CE Compliance (Not for U.S.)
The systems conform to the following guidelines and standards:
Guideline
R&TTE-Directive 1999/5/EC
Standard
Category
Electrical compliance
HiPath 3750
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3350
UL 60950
CSA C22.2
No. 60950-00
UL 60950
CSA C22.2
No. 60950-00
AY3USA-33046-MF-E
AY3USA-33047-KF-E
AY3USA25214MFE
AY3USA25215KFE
Industry Canada
CS03 certification
267 9147A
267 8782A
Ringer equivalency
number (REN)
1.2
0.4
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
2-25
System Data
Compliance
Operating limits
Room temperature: + 5 to + 40 C (+ 41 to + 104 F)
Absolute humidity: 2 to 25 g H2O/m3
Relative humidity: 5 to 80 %
Caution
Avoid exposing the system to direct sunlight and heaters (excessive heat may damage the system).
If condensation has formed on a system, do not start up the system until the it has
thoroughly dried.
2-26
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Overview
3 Boards
7
WARNING
The system must be powered down and de-energized before removing or inserting
all boards in the HiPath 3550, HiPath 3350, HiPath 3500, HiPath 3300 and before
removing or inserting the central boards of the HiPath 3750, HiPath 3700.
3.1 Overview
Functional Overview of all Boards and Components Used
Table 3-1
Board or
Component
Model
Central Boards
CBCC
S30810-Q2935-A201
CBCP
S30810-Q2935-B201
CBRC
S30810-K2935-Z
CBCPR
S30810-Q2936-X
CMA
S30807-Q6931-X
CMS
S30807-Q6928-X
HiPath 3000
CR8N
S30810-Q2513-X100
CUC
S30777-Q750-X
HiPath 3550
CUCR
S30777-Q750-Z
HiPath 3500
CUP
S30777-Q751-X
HiPath 3350
CUPR
S30777-Q751-Z
HiPath 3300
IMODC
S30807-Q6932-X
LIM
S30807-Q6930-X
HiPath 3000
MMC16
S30122-X7424-X
HiPath 3000
PSU One
S30122-K5837-M
S30122-K5837-S
PSUP
S30122-K5658-M
HiPath 3350
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-1
Boards
Overview
Table 3-1
Board or
Component
Model
SBSCO
S30810-Q2937-A201
SBSCS
S30810-Q2937-B201
UPSC-D
S30122-K5660-M300
UPSC-DR
S30122-K7373-M900
UPSM
S30122-K5950-A100
S30122-K5950-S100
3-2
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Overview
Table 3-1
Board or
Component
Model
Peripheral Boards
Caution: The HiPath 3550, HiPath 3350, HiPath 3500, and HiPath 3300 peripheral boards
must be firmly inserted into their slots; otherwise contact problems can cause board failure.
HXGM
S30810-Q2930-X
S30810-Q2930-X100
HXGM2
S30810-Q2940-X
S30810-Q2940-X10
S30810-Q2940-X100
S30810-Q2940-X110
HXGM3
S30810-Q2942-X
HXGR3
S30810-K2943-Z
HXGS
S30810-Q2931-X
S30810-Q2931-X100
HXGS2
S30810-Q2939-X
S30810-Q2939-X10
S30810-Q2939-X100
S30810-Q2939-X110
HXGS3
S30810-Q2943-X
HXGSR
S30810-K2931-Z
S30810-K2931-Z100
HXGSR2
S30810-K2939-Z
S30810-K2939-Z10
S30810-K2939-Z100
S30810-K2939-Z110
IVML8
S30122-X7380-X100
IVML24
S30122-X7380-X
IVMP8
S30122-Q7379-X100
HiPath 3350
IVMP8R
S30122-K7379-Z100
HiPath 3300
IVMS8
S30122-Q7379-X
IVMS8R
S30122-K7379-Z
LAN Bridge
S30817-Q955-Axxx
SLA8N
S30810-Q2929-X200
SLA16N
S30810-Q2929-X100
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-3
Boards
Overview
Table 3-1
Board or
Component
Model
SLA24N
S30810-Q2929-X
SLC16
S30810-Q2922-X
SLC16N
S30810-Q2193-X100
SLMO8
S30810-Q2901-X100
SLMO24
S30810-Q2901-X
SLU8
S30817-Q922-A301
SLU8R
S30817-K922-Z301
STLS2
S30817-Q924-B313
STLS4
S30817-Q924-A313
STLS4R
S30817-K924-Z313
STMD8
S30810-Q2558-X200
TIEL
S30810-Q2520-X
TLA2
S30817-Q923-Bxxx
TLA4
S30817-Q923-Axxx
TLA8
S30817-Q926-Axxx
TLA4R
S30817-Q923-Zxxx
TMAMF
S30810-Q2587-A200
S30810-Q2587-A400
TMCAS
S30810-Q2938-X
TMDID
S30810-Q2507-X
TMGL4
S30810-Q2918-X
TMGL4R
S30810-K2918-Z
TMGL8
S30810-Q2703-X
TML8W
S30817-Q626-Axxx/
Bxxx
TMOM
S30810-Q2535-X
TMQ4
S30810-Q2917-X
TMST1
S30810-Q2920-X
3-4
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Overview
Table 3-1
Board or
Component
Part Number
Model
TMS2
S30810-Q2915-X
TST1
S30810-Q2919-X
S30810-K2919-Z
TS2
S30810-Q2913-X100
TS2R
S30810-K2913-Z100
4SLA
S30810-Q2923-X200
8SLA
S30810-Q2923-X100
8SLAR
S30810-K2925-Z
16SLA
S30810-Q2923-X
SLA16
SLA16N
SLA24N
TMDID8
TMGL8
TIEL4*
TMST1**
TST1**
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-5
Boards
Overview
Table 3-1
Board or
Component
Model
Options
ALUM4
S30817-Q935-A
AM
S30122-X7217-X100
ANI4
S30807-Q6917-A103
ANI4R
S30807-Q6917-Z103
EXM
S30817-Q902-B401
EXMNA
S30817-Q6923-X
EXMR
S30122-K7403-Z
GEE8
S30817-Q664-xxxx
GEE12
S30817-Q951-Axxx
GEE16
S30817-Q951-Axxx
GEE50
S30817-Q951-Axxx
HOPE board
S30122-Q7078-X
HOPE board
S30122-Q7079-X
MPPI
S30122-K5380-X200
MPPI
S30122-X7275-X
HiPath 3000
OPAL
C39195-A7001-B130
OPALR
C39195-A7001-B142
PDM1
S30807-Q5692-X100
PFT1/PFT4
S30777-Q539-X
S30777-Q540-X
REAL
S30807-Q5913-X
STBG4
S30817-Q934-A
STRB
S30817-Q932-A
STRBR
S30817-Q932-Z
UAM
S30122-X7217-X
UAMR
S30122-X7402-Z
3-6
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Overview
Table 3-1
Board or
Component
V24/1
Part Number
S30807-Q6916-X100
Model
HiPath 3550/HiPath 3350 (not for U.S.)
HiPath 3000
Basic cabinet
S30777-U757-X103
Expansion cabinet
S30777-U708-X103
Backplane basic
cabinet
S30777-Q757-X
Cabinet
S30777-U711-A103
HiPath 3550
Cabinet
S30777-U712-A103
HiPath 3350
Cabinet
S30777-U711-A903
HiPath 3500
Cabinet
S30777-U712-A903
HiPath 3300
MDF cables
S30267-Z320-A4
MDF cables
S30267-Z321-A4
Inter-cabinet cable
S30267-Z178-A13
Cable TST1 to
CSU
S30269-27256-A
HiPath 3750
HiPath 3750
HiPath 3750
S30777-D40-X
ALUM4 adapter
cable
C39195-A7001-B105
Ribbon cable
ANI4 to TMGL4
C39195-A7001-B87-1
Cable ANI4R to
TMGL4R
C39195-A7001-C69
Cable TST1 to
CSU
S30122-K7031-X
HiPath 3550
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-7
Boards
Overview
Table 3-1
Board or
Component
RS-232 administration cable for
LAN Bridge
3-8
Model
HiPath 3550/HiPath 3350
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Overview
Function
S30810-Q2936-X
Central board
CMS
S30807-Q6928-X
Central board
CR8N
S30810-Q2513-X100
Central board
GEE8
S30817-Q664-xxxx
HXGM
S30810-Q2930-X
S30810-Q2930-X100
Peripheral board
Peripheral board
HXGM2
S30810-Q2940-X
S30810-Q2940-X10
S30810-Q2940-X100
S30810-Q2940-X110
Peripheral board
Peripheral board
Peripheral board
Peripheral board
HXGM3
S30810-Q2942-X
Peripheral board
IMODC
S30807-Q6932-X
Central board
IVML8
S30122-X7380-X100
Peripheral board
IVML24
S30122-X7380-X
Peripheral board
LIM
S30807-Q6930-X
Central board
MMC16
S30122-X7424-X
Central board
MPPI
S30122-X7275-X
Option
PFT1/PFT4
S30777-Q539-X
S30777-Q540-X
REAL
S30807-Q5913-X
Option
SLA8N
S30810-Q2929-X200
SLA16N
S30810-Q2929-X100
Peripheral board
SLA24N
S30810-Q2929-X
Peripheral board
SLC16
S30810-Q2922-X
SLC16N
S30810-Q2193-X100
Peripheral board
SLMO8
S30810-Q2901-X100
SLMO24
S30810-Q2901-X
Peripheral board
STMD8
S30810-Q2558-X200
Peripheral board
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-9
Boards
Overview
Table 3-2
Board or
Component
Part Number
Function
TIEL
S30810-Q2520-X
Peripheral board
TMAMF
S30810-Q2587-A200
TMCAS
S30810-Q2938-X
TMDID
S30810-Q2507-X
TMGL8
S30810-Q2703-X
TML8W
S30817-Q626-Axxx/
Bxxx
Peripheral board
TMOM
S30810-Q2535-X
TMST1
S30810-Q2920-X
TMS2
S30810-Q2915-X
UPSM
S30122-K5950-A100
S30122-K5950-S100
Power supply
For U.S. Only: Other Field-Replaceable Units for HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700
RS-232 cable
Cable
Basic cabinet
S30777-U757-X103
Cabinet
Cabinet
Backplane basic
cabinet
Backplane
S30777-Q757-X
Backplane
Cable
Cable TST1 to
CSU
Cable
S30269-27256-A
Anchors
Bracket
3-10
S30777-D40-X
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Overview
Table 3-2
Board or
Component
Part Number
SLA16
SLA16N
SLA24N
TMDID8
Function
TMGL8
TIEL4*
TMST1**
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-11
Boards
Overview
Table 3-2
Board or
Component
Function
HiPath 3550
Caution: The HiPath 3550, HiPath 3350, HiPath 3500 and HiPath 3300 peripheral boards
must be firmly inserted into their slots; otherwise contact problems can cause board failure.
ALUM4
S30817-Q935-A
Option
ANI4
S30807-Q6917-A103
CBCC
S30810-Q2935-A201
Central board
CMA
S30807-Q6931-X
Central board
CMS
S30807-Q6928-X
Central board
CUC
S30777-Q750-X
Central board
EXM
S30817-Q902-B401
EXMNA
S30817-Q6923-X
GEE12
S30817-Q951-Axxx
GEE16
S30817-Q951-Axxx
GEE50
S30817-Q951-Axxx
HOPE board
S30122-Q7078-X
HOPE board
S30122-Q7079-X
HXGS
S30810-Q2931-X
S30810-Q2931-X100
Peripheral board
Peripheral board
HXGS2
S30810-Q2939-X
S30810-Q2939-X10
S30810-Q2939-X100
S30810-Q2939-X110
Peripheral board
Peripheral board
Peripheral board
Peripheral board
HXGS3
S30810-Q2943-X
Peripheral board
IMODC
S30807-Q6932-X
Central board
IVMS8
S30122-Q7379-X
Peripheral board
LIM
S30807-Q6930-X
Central board
MMC16
S30122-X7424-X
Central board
LAN Bridge
S30817-Q955-Axxx
Peripheral board
MPPI
S30122-K5380-X200
S30122-X7275-X
Option
OPAL
C39195-A7001-B130
Cable
3-12
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Overview
Table 3-2
Board or
Component
Function
PDM1
S30807-Q5692-X100
Option
SLA8N
S30810-Q2929-X200
SLA16N
S30810-Q2929-X100
Peripheral board
SLA24N
S30810-Q2929-X
Peripheral board
SLC16
S30810-Q2922-X
SLC16N
S30810-Q2193-X100
Peripheral board
SLMO24
S30810-Q2901-X
Peripheral board
SLU8
S30817-Q922-A301
Peripheral board
STBG4
S30817-Q934-A
STLS2
S30817-Q924-B313
STLS4
S30817-Q924-A313
Peripheral board
STRB
S30817-Q932-A
Option
TLA2
S30817-Q923-Bxxx
TLA4
S30817-Q923-Axxx
TLA8
S30817-Q926-Axxx
TMAMF
S30810-Q2587-A400
TMCAS
S30810-Q2938-X
TMGL4
S30810-Q2918-X
TMQ4
S30810-Q2917-X
TST1
S30810-Q2919-X
TS2
S30810-Q2913-X100
UAM
S30122-X7217-X
Option
UPSC-D
S30122-K5660-M300
Central board
V24/1
S30807-Q6916-X100
4SLA
S30810-Q2923-X200
8SLA
S30810-Q2923-X100
Peripheral board
16SLA
S30810-Q2923-X
Peripheral board
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-13
Boards
Overview
Table 3-2
Board or
Component
Part Number
Function
Cable
Cabinet
S30777-U711-A103
Cabinet
MDF cables
S30267-Z320-A4
Cable
MDF cables
S30267-Z321-A4
Cable
Cord
ALUM4 adapter
cable
Cable
C39195-A7001-B105
Cable
Cable TST1 to
CSU
S30122-K7031-X
Cable
S30122-X5468-X
Cable
CBCC
SLU8
8SLA
SLA16N
SLA24N
STLS4
TST1*
*When this module is connected to the public network, secondary protection must be provided by the CSU.
3-14
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Overview
Table 3-2
Board or
Component
Function
HiPath 3350
Caution: The HiPath 3550, HiPath 3350, HiPath 3500 and HiPath 3300 peripheral boards
must be firmly inserted into their slots; otherwise contact problems can cause board failure.
ALUM4
S30817-Q935-A
Option
ANI4
S30807-Q6917-A103
CBCC
S30810-Q2935-A201
Central board
CBCP
S30810-Q2935-B201
Central board
CMA
S30807-Q6931-X
Central board
CMS
S30807-Q6928-X
Central board
CUP
S30777-Q751-X
Central board
EXM
S30817-Q902-B401
EXMNA
S30817-Q6923-X
GEE12
S30817-Q951-Axxx
GEE16
S30817-Q951-Axxx
GEE50
S30817-Q951-Axxx
HOPE board
S30122-Q7078-X
HOPE board
S30122-Q7079-X
HXGS
S30810-Q2931-X
S30810-Q2931-X100
Peripheral board
Peripheral board
HXGS2
S30810-Q2939-X
S30810-Q2939-X10
S30810-Q2939-X100
S30810-Q2939-X110
Peripheral board
Peripheral board
Peripheral board
Peripheral board
HXGS3
S30810-Q2943-X
Peripheral board
IMODC
S30807-Q6932-X
Central board
IVMP8
S30122-Q7379-X100
Peripheral board
IVMS8
S30122-Q7379-X
Peripheral board
LIM
S30807-Q6930-X
Central board
MMC16
S30122-X7424-X
Central board
LAN Bridge
S30817-Q955-Axxx
Peripheral board
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-15
Boards
Overview
Table 3-2
Board or
Component
Part Number
Function
MPPI
S30122-K5380-X200
S30122-X7275-X
Option
OPAL
C39195-A7001-B130
Cable
PDM1
S30807-Q5692-X100
Option
PSUP
S30122-K5658-M
Central board
SLU8
S30817-Q922-A301
Peripheral board
STBG4
S30817-Q934-A
STLS2
S30817-Q924-B313
STLS4
S30817-Q924-A313
Peripheral board
STRB
S30817-Q932-A
Option
TLA2
S30817-Q923-Bxxx
TLA4
S30817-Q923-Axxx
TLA8
S30817-Q926-Axxx
TMGL4
S30810-Q2918-X
TMQ4
S30810-Q2917-X
UAM
S30122-X7217-X
Option
UPSC-D
S30122-K5660-M300
Central board
V24/1
S30807-Q6916-X100
4SLA
S30810-Q2923-X200
8SLA
S30810-Q2923-X100
Peripheral board
16SLA
S30810-Q2923-X
Peripheral board
Cable
Cabinet
S30777-U712-A103
Cabinet
MDF cables
S30267-Z320-A4
Cable
MDF cables
S30267-Z321-A4
Cable
Cord
ALUM4 adapter
cable
Cable
3-16
C39195-A7001-B105
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Overview
Table 3-2
Board or
Component
Function
Cable
Cable TST1 to
CSU
S30122-K7031-X
Cable
S30122-X5468-X
Cable
CBCC
SLU8
8SLA
STLS4
S30122-X7217-X100
Option
CMS
S30807-Q6928-X
Central board
LIM
S30807-Q6930-X
Central board
MMC16
S30122-X7424-X
Central board
MPPI
S30122-X7275-X
Option
PSU One
S30122-K5837-M
S30122-K5837-S
Central board
SBSCO
S30810-Q2937-A201
Central board
S30122-X7217-X100
Option
CMS
S30807-Q6928-X
Central board
LIM
S30807-Q6930-X
Central board
MMC16
S30122-X7424-X
Central board
MPPI
S30122-X7275-X
Option
PSU One
S30122-K5837-M
S30122-K5837-S
Central board
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-17
Boards
Overview
Table 3-2
Board or
Component
SBSCS
3-18
Function
Central board
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Overview
Table 3-2
Board or
Component
Function
HiPath 3500
Caution: The HiPath 3550, HiPath 3350, HiPath 3500 and HiPath 3300 peripheral boards
must be firmly inserted into their slots; otherwise contact problems can cause board failure.
ANI4R
S30807-Q6917-Z103
CBRC
S30810-K2935-Z
Central board
CMA
S30807-Q6931-X
Central board
CMS
S30807-Q6928-X
Central board
CUCR
S30777-Q750-Z
Central board
EXMR
S30122-K7403-Z
Option
HXGR3
S30810-K2943-Z
Peripheral board
HXGSR
S30810-K2931-Z
S30810-K2931-Z100
HXGSR2
S30810-K2939-Z
S30810-K2939-Z10
S30810-K2939-Z100
S30810-K2939-Z110
Peripheral board
Peripheral board
Peripheral board
Peripheral board
IMODC
S30807-Q6932-X
Central board
IVMS8R
S30122-K7379-Z
Peripheral board
LIM
S30807-Q6930-X
Central board
MMC16
S30122-X7424-X
Central board
MPPI
S30122-X7275-X
Option
OPALR
C39195-A7001-B142
Cable
PDM1
S30807-Q5692-X100
Option
SLU8R
S30817-K922-Z301
Peripheral board
STLS4R
S30817-K924-Z313
Peripheral board
STRBR
S30817-Q932-Z
Option
TLA4R
S30817-Q923-Zxxx
Peripheral board
TMGL4R
S30810-K2918-Z
TST1
S30810-K2919-Z
TS2R
S30810-K2913-Z100
Peripheral board
UAMR
S30122-X7402-Z
Option
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-19
Boards
Overview
Table 3-2
Board or
Component
Part Number
Function
UPSC-DR
S30122-K7373-M900
Central board
8SLAR
S30810-K2925-Z
Peripheral board
Cable
Cabinet
S30777-U711-A903
Cabinet
MDF cables
S30267-Z320-A4
Cable
Cable ANI4R to
TMGL4R
C39195-A7001-C69
Cable
3-20
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Overview
Table 3-2
Board or
Component
Function
HiPath 3300
Caution: The HiPath 3550, HiPath 3350, HiPath 3500 and HiPath 3300 peripheral boards
must be firmly inserted into their slots; otherwise contact problems can cause board failure.
ANI4R
S30807-Q6917-Z103
CBRC
S30810-K2935-Z
Central board
CMA
S30807-Q6931-X
Central board
CMS
S30807-Q6928-X
Central board
CUPR
S30777-Q751-Z
Central board
EXMR
S30122-K7403-Z
Option
HXGR3
S30810-K2943-Z
Peripheral board
HXGSR
S30810-K2931-Z
S30810-K2931-Z100
HXGSR2
S30810-K2939-Z
S30810-K2939-Z10
S30810-K2939-Z100
S30810-K2939-Z110
Peripheral board
Peripheral board
Peripheral board
Peripheral board
IMODC
S30807-Q6932-X
Central board
IVMP8R
S30122-K7379-Z100
Peripheral board
IVMS8R
S30122-K7379-Z
Peripheral board
LIM
S30807-Q6930-X
Central board
MMC16
S30122-X7424-X
Central board
MPPI
S30122-X7275-X
Option
OPALR
C39195-A7001-B142
Cable
PDM1
S30807-Q5692-X100
Option
SLU8R
S30817-K922-Z301
Peripheral board
STLS4R
S30817-K924-Z313
Peripheral board
STRBR
S30817-Q932-Z
Option
TLA4R
S30817-Q923-Zxxx
Peripheral board
TMGL4R
S30810-K2918-Z
UAMR
S30122-X7402-Z
Option
UPSC-DR
S30122-K7373-M900
Central board
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-21
Boards
Overview
Table 3-2
Board or
Component
8SLAR
Part Number
S30810-K2925-Z
Function
Peripheral board
Cable
Cabinet
S30777-U712-A903
Cabinet
MDF cables
S30267-Z320-A4
Cable
Cable ANI4R to
TMGL4R
C39195-A7001-C69
Cable
3-22
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Central Boards
CBCC (Central Board with Coldfire Com) S30810-Q2935-A201 (Figure 3-1) - for
use in HiPath 3550 and HiPath 3350 (wall housing)
CBRC (Central Board Rack Com) S30810-K2935-Z (Figure 3-2) - for use in HiPath 3500 and HiPath 3300 (19-inch housing)
Functions
>
Disconnecting the battery buffer by unplugging the X27 jumper is necessary only for
testing (module test at the factory). Disconnection does not necessarily delete the
customer database (CDB). To delete the CDB, use the reset switch.
Interfaces
>
Backplane connection (CUC and CUCR) via slots 1 (X11), 2 (X5) and 3 (X6)
CBCC: please note that you may only connect one MPPI module. In other words,
you can connect either MPPI S30122-K5380-X200 via X4 or MPPI S30122-X7275X via X19/X20.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-23
Boards
Central Boards
V.24 interfaces:
CBCC: two V.24 interfaces. The second interface is implemented with the
V24/1 option.
3-24
Reset/reload switch
Switch pressed > 5 s = Reload activated (RUN LED out indicates that a reload is in progress)
RUN LED
LED status meaning is explained in Table 12-2.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Central Boards
To backplane (CUC)
50
X5
50
X8 options bus
X11
50
X6
26
Batt.
CMA
X7
X27
1
X15
X16
To V.24
module
V24/1
X14
X17
IMODC
CMS
X13
X20
1
X12
MPPI
1
LIM
X1
1
X2
1
8 x UP0/E
X9
X19
MMC
X18
2 x S0
Reset/reload
switch
RUN LED
X4
1
10
X3
1
4 x a/b
MPPI or EXM
V.24 interface,
9-pin SUB-D plug
(service PC or application)
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-25
Boards
Central Boards
To backplane (CUCR)
50
X5
50
X8 options bus
CMA
X11
50
X6
X16
Batt.
X27
1
X15
X14
X17
X13
IMODC
CMS
X20
1
X12
MPPI/
EXMR
1
LIM
X1
X9
8 x UP0/E
2 x S0
MMC
X18
RUN LED
LAN connector, 8pole RJ45 jack
X19
1 X3
4 x T/R
V.24 interface,
9-pin SUB-D plug
(service PC or application)
Reset/reload switch
Figure 3-2
3-26
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Central Boards
Connector X2 Connector X3
UP0/E
Connector X4
a/b
MPPI or EXM
UP0/E port 1b
UP0/E port 5b
a/b port 1a
GND
UP0/E port 1a
UP0/E port 5a
a/b port 1b
Not assigned
UP0/E port 2b
UP0/E port 6b
a/b port 2a
Not assigned
UP0/E port 2a
UP0/E port 6a
a/b port 2b
EXMCLK
(512 kHz data cycle)
UP0/E port 3b
UP0/E port 7b
a/b port 3a
EXMDIR
(8 kHz frame cycle)
UP0/E port 3a
UP0/E port 7a
a/b port 3b
EXMRES
(high-active reset)
UP0/E port 4b
UP0/E port 8b
a/b port 4a
EXMD
(data line)
UP0/E port 4a
UP0/E port 8a
a/b port 4b
EXMDET
(detect signal)
+5 V
10
Not assigned
Table 3-4
Pin
a/b
14
UP0/E port 1a
a/b port 1a
15
UP0/E port 1b
a/b port 1b
24
UP0/E port 2a
a/b port 2a
25
UP0/E port 2b
a/b port 2b
34
UP0/E port 3a
a/b port 3a
35
UP0/E port 3b
a/b port 3b
44
UP0/E port 4a
a/b port 4a
45
UP0/E port 4b
a/b port 4b
54
UP0/E port 5a
55
UP0/E port 5b
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-27
Boards
Central Boards
Table 3-4
Pin
a/b
64
UP0/E port 6a
65
UP0/E port 6b
74
UP0/E port 7a
75
UP0/E port 7b
84
UP0/E port 8a
85
UP0/E port 8b
Table 3-5
Pin
3-28
11
S0 port 1, transmit +
12
S0 port 1, receive +
13
S0 port 1, receive
14
S0 port 1, transmit
21
S0 port 2, transmit +
22
S0 port 2, receive +
23
S0 port 2, receive
24
S0 port 2, transmit
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Central Boards
X18, Pin
Signal
Description
RxD A
TxD A
0V
RTS A
CTS A
Not used
Not used
Ground
Not used
Not used
Pin
Signal
Tx +
Transmit +
Tx
Transmit
Rx +
Receive +
Not used
Not used
Rx
Receive
Not used
Not used
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Description
3-29
Boards
Central Boards
CBCC and CBRC Numbering Plan (HiPath 3550 and HiPath 3500)
Table 3-8
Station
DID no.
Port
UP0/E host
(primary)
100
100
UP0/E 1
101
101
UP0/E 2
102
102
UP0/E 3
103
103
UP0/E 4
104
104
UP0/E 5
105
105
UP0/E 6
106
106
UP0/E 7
107
107
UP0/E 8
500
500
UP0/E 1
501
501
UP0/E 2
502
502
UP0/E 3
503
503
UP0/E 4
504
504
UP0/E 5
505
505
UP0/E 6
506
506
UP0/E 7
507
507
UP0/E 8
108
108
a/b 1
109
109
a/b 2
110
110
a/b 3
111
111
a/b 3
UP0/E client
(secondary)
3-30
Line
Code
Port
S0
CO PP
7801
S0 1-1
7802
S0 1-2
7803
S0 2-1
7804
S0 2-2
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Central Boards
>
Disconnecting the battery buffer by unplugging the X27 jumper is necessary only for
testing (module test at the factory). Disconnection does not necessarily delete the
customer database (CDB). To delete the CDB, use the reset switch.
Interfaces
>
CBCP: please note that only one MPPI module may be connected. In other words,
you can connect either MPPI S30122-K5380-X200 via X4 or MPPI S30122-X7275X via X19/X20.
Two V.24 interfaces, where the second interface is implemented via the V24/1 option.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-31
Boards
Central Boards
Reset/reload switch
Switch pressed > 5 s = Reload activated (RUN LED out indicates that a reload is in progress)
RUN LED
LED status meaning is explained in Table 12-2.
X5
50
X8 options bus
X11
50
X6
26
Batt.
CMA
X7
X27
1
X15
X16
To V.24
module
V24/1
X14
X17
IMODC
CMS
X13
X20
1
X12
MPPI
1
LIM
X1
1
X2
1
8 x UP0/E
X9
X19
MMC
X18
2 x S0
Reset/reload
switch
RUN LED
X4
1
10
X3
1
4 x a/b
MPPI or EXM
V.24 interface,
9-pin SUB-D plug
(service PC or application)
3-32
Boards
Central Boards
Connector X2 Connector X3
UP0/E
Connector X4
a/b
MPPI or EXM
UP0/E port 1b
UP0/E port 5b
a/b port 1a
GND
UP0/E port 1a
UP0/E port 5a
a/b port 1b
Not assigned
UP0/E port 2b
UP0/E port 6b
a/b port 2a
Not assigned
UP0/E port 2a
UP0/E port 6a
a/b port 2b
EXMCLK
(512 kHz data cycle)
UP0/E port 3b
UP0/E port 7b
a/b port 3a
EXMDIR
(8 kHz frame cycle)
UP0/E port 3a
UP0/E port 7a
a/b port 3b
EXMRES
(High-active reset)
UP0/E port 4b
UP0/E port 8b
a/b port 4a
EXMD
(data line)
UP0/E port 4a
UP0/E port 8a
a/b port 4b
EXMDET
(detect signal)
+5 V
10
Not assigned
Table 3-10
Pin
Connector X9
S0
11
S0 port 1, transmit +
12
S0 port 1, receive +
13
S0 port 1, receive
14
S0 port 1, transmit
21
S0 port 2, transmit +
22
S0 port 2, receive +
23
S0 port 2, receive
24
S0 port 2, transmit
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-33
Boards
Central Boards
X18, Pin
Signal
Description
RxD A
TxD A
0V
RTS A
CTS A
Not used
Not used
Ground
Not used
Not used
3-34
Pin
Signal
Description
Tx +
Transmit +
Tx
Transmit
Rx +
Receive +
Not used
Not used
Rx
Receive
Not used
Not used
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Central Boards
Station
DID no.
Port
UP0/E host
(primary)
11
11
UP0/E 1
12
12
UP0/E 2
13
13
UP0/E 3
14
14
UP0/E 4
15
15
UP0/E 5
16
16
UP0/E 6
17
17
UP0/E 7
18
18
UP0/E 8
51
51
UP0/E 1
52
52
UP0/E 2
53
53
UP0/E 3
54
54
UP0/E 4
55
55
UP0/E 5
56
56
UP0/E 6
57
57
UP0/E 7
58
58
UP0/E 8
19
19
a/b 1
20
20
a/b 2
21
21
a/b 3
22
22
a/b 3
UP0/E client
(secondary)
Line
Code
Port
S0
CO PP
801
S0 1-1
802
S0 1-2
803
S0 2-1
804
S0 2-2
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-35
Boards
Central Boards
3.2.3 CBCPR
Introduction
The CBCPR board (shown in Figure 3-4) performs all central control and switching
functions for HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700.
>
Disconnecting the battery buffer by unplugging the X27 jumper is necessary only for
testing (module test at the factory). Disconnection does not necessarily delete the
customer database (CDB). To delete the CDB, use the reset switch.
Subboards
The following subboards can be used depending on the application:
V.24 Interfaces
To connect a service PC, you can access the first V.24 interface (9-pin SUB-D
plug) on the CBCPR from the front of the basic cabinet (after removing the cover). (See Figure 3-4).
You can access the second V.24 interface (25-pin SUB-D plug) via the backplane
of the basic cabinet (X7).
3-36
Reset/reload switch
Switch pressed > 5 s = Reload activated (RUN LED out indicates that a reload is in progress)
RUN LED
Signals the current status of the CBCPR board (see Table 12-2).
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Central Boards
CMA
1
X13
CMS
1
Reset/reload
switch
RUN LED
X14
X27
Batt.
MMC
LAN connector,
8-pole RJ45 jack
IMODC
LIM
X15
X12
V.24 interface,
9-pin SUB-D
plug (service PC or
application)
X18
MPPI
X19
X17
X20
X16
Figure 3-4
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-37
Boards
Central Boards
X18, Pin
Signal
Description
RxD A
TxD A
0V
RTS A
CTS A
Not used
Not used
Ground
Not used
Not used
3-38
Pin
Signal
Description
Tx +
Transmit +
Tx
Transmit
Rx +
Receive +
Not used
Not used
Rx
Receive
Not used
Not used
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Central Boards
3.2.4 CMA
Caution
Place the central control board on a flat surface before inserting the CMA subboard.
The spacing bolts supplied guarantee the correct insertion of the subboard, so you
should always mount them (see Figure 3-5).
Otherwise you may damage the board.
Spacing bolts
Figure 3-5
Introduction
The Clock Module ADPCM CMA (S30807-Q6931-X) is an optional subboard for the
CBCC and CBRC central control boards. It is needed for certain HiPath Cordless Office configurations.
When you insert a CMA board, you have all functions of the Clock Module Small
(CMS).
Refer to page 3-40 for recommendations on the use of the CMA module.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-39
Boards
Central Boards
3.2.5 CMS
Caution
Place the central control board on a flat surface before inserting the CMS subboard.
The spacing bolts supplied guarantee the correct insertion of the subboard, so you
should always mount them (see Figure 3-5).
Otherwise you may damage the board.
Introduction
The Clock Module Small CMS (S30807-Q6928-X) is an optional subboard for the HiPath 3000 central control boards. It guarantees greater clock accuracy.
Recommendations for the use of CMA and CMS
Table 3-16 lists recommendations for the use of the CMA and CMS submodules depending on
The type of networking (ISDN S0, ISDN S2M, or Ethernet/IP (10/100 BaseT))
The existing trunk connection (no trunk or analog trunk, ISDN S0, or ISDN S2M)
and the possible provision of a digital reference clock connected with it.
Trunk connection:
HiPath 3000
System 1
3-40
ISDN S0
ISDN S2M
HiPath 3000
Slave
System(s)
Figure 3-6
Trunk connection:
Networked via:
Ethernet/IP
(10/100
BaseT)
HiPath 3000
System(s)
1+n
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Central Boards
Table 3-16
Trunk
connection
Reference
clock
yes
Trunk
connection
Reference
clock
yes
no trunk
or analog
trunk
SLAVE system(s)
CMS/CMA
(see Table
11-1)
no trunk
or analog
trunk
via
ISDN S0
networking line
CMA2
ISDN S0
(not always active)
via
CMS1
ISDN S0
trunk connection (if
active)
CMS/CMA
(see Table
11-1)
ISDN S0
(not always active)
via
ISDN S0
networking line
CMA2
ISDN S0
(always
active)
via
CMS1
ISDN S0
trunk connection
CMA2
ISDN S0
(always
active)
via
ISDN S0
trunk connection
CMA2
ISDN
S2M
CMS1
via
ISDN S2M
trunk connection
CMA2
ISDN S2M
via
ISDN S2M
trunk connection
CMA2
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-41
Boards
Central Boards
Table 3-16
Trunk
connection
Reference
clock
yes
Trunk
connection
Reference
clock
yes
no trunk
or analog
trunk
SLAVE system(s)
CMS/CMA
(see Table
11-1)
no trunk
or analog
trunk
via
ISDN S2M
networking line
CMA2
ISDN S0
(not always active)
via
CMS1
ISDN S0
trunk connection (if
active)
CMS/CMA
(see Table
11-1)
ISDN S0
(not always active)
via
ISDN S2M
networking line
CMA2
ISDN S0
(always
active)
via
CMS1
ISDN S0
trunk connection
CMA2
ISDN S0
(always
active)
via
ISDN S0
trunk connection
CMA2
ISDN
S2M
via
CMS1
ISDN S2M
trunk connection
CMA2
ISDN S2M
via
ISDN S2M
trunk connection
CMA2
3-42
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Central Boards
Table 3-16
Trunk
connection
Reference
clock
yes
Trunk
connection
Reference
clock
yes
System(s) 1 + n
CMS3
CMS/CMA
(see Table
11-1)
no trunk
or analog
trunk
ISDN S0
(not always active)
via
CMS3
ISDN S0
trunk connection
(if active)
CMS/CMA
(see Table
11-1)
ISDN S0
(always
active)
via
ISDN S0
trunk connection
ISDN
S2M
via
ISDN S2M
trunk connection
no trunk
or analog
trunk
CMS3
CMS/CMA
(see Table
11-1)
ISDN S0
(not always active)
via
CMS3
ISDN S0
trunk connection (if
active)
CMS/CMA
(see Table
11-1)
CMA2
ISDN S0
(always
active)
via
ISDN S0
trunk connection
CMA2
CMA2
ISDN S2M
via
ISDN S2M
trunk connection
CMA2
1 CMS is not required if the reference clock supplied by the trunk is always available via the networking lines (no transparent
clock).
2 CMA is not required if no ADPCM conversion is needed for HiPath Cordless Office (see Table 11-1).
3 CMS is not required but is recommended for the following reason: although the Ethernet link is an asynchronous connection,
transmission errors can occur because of buffer overflow or underflow. To prevent this, the clock difference between the primary and secondary systems must be as small as possible so that receiving and sending buffers on both sides are read and
written at the same speed. The more accurate the clock source of the systems involved, the few errors.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-43
Boards
Central Boards
3.2.6 CR8N
Introduction
The CR8N (Code Receiver) board is an optional plug-in module and can be used in
any slot in all HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 cabinets.
The CR8N board is required for:
A high outgoing traffic load and a large number of analog subscribers exist.
A Hicom Phonemail system with more than six ports and the automatic attendant
function is connected.
An external automatic attendant is being used as a virtual attendant and the system has a large number of analog trunks.
In these cases, the six code receivers (for tone dialing on analog telephones) that are
already present in the system on the CBCPR are not sufficient. Adding a CR8N board
provides another eight code receivers and eight code transmitters. Up to two CR8Ns
can be installed in each system. A CR8N board and a CR8 board (S30810-Q2513X) cannot be used in the same system simultaneously.
You can also install or remove a CR8N board during operation. If you remove it while
the system is in the operating state, you risk interrupting DTMF signal processing. It
is always recommended that you remove or install the board only while the system is
switched off.
Note the following recommendations for using the CR8N board if a Hicom Phonemail
system, voice mail system, or automatic attendant is connected:
These are general recommendations only. In some cases, a CR8N board may already be required for six ports under extreme load conditions.
3-44
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Central Boards
H1 (red)
LEDs
H2 (green)
Figure 3-7
CR8N (S30810-Q2513-X100)
Red LED
Green
LED
Status
Action
Off
Off
On
Off
Wait
Replace board
Flashing
Off
Loadware is loading.
On
On
Off
On
Off
Flashing
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Replace board
Board ready.
3-45
Boards
Central Boards
CUC (Connection Unit Com) S30777-Q750-X (Figure 3-8) - for use in HiPath
3550 (wall housing)
CUCR (Connection Unit Com Rack) S30777-Q750-Z (Figure 3-9) - for use in HiPath 3500 (19-inch housing)
Reserve
Slot 10 (X10)
Slot 2 (8 x UP0/E)
Slot 6 (X40)
Slot 1 (2 x S0)
CUC
Slot 8 (X60)
Slot 3 (4 x a/b)
CBCC
Slot 7 (X50)
Peripheral board
Slot 9 (X70)
Peripheral board
Peripheral board
Slot 4 (X20)
Figure 3-8
PSU/UPS (X1)
Slot 5 (X30)
Slot 2 (8 x UP0/E)
Slot 6 (X40)
Slot 1 (2 x S0)
CUCR
Slot 8 (X60)
Slot 4 (X20)
Figure 3-9
3-46
PSU/UPS (X1)
Slot 3 (4 x a/b)
CBRC
Slot 7 (X50)
Peripheral board
Slot 9 (X70)
Peripheral board
Slot 5 (X30)
Peripheral board
Boards
Central Boards
CUP (Connection Unit Point) S30777-Q751-X (Figure 3-10) - for use in HiPath
3350 (wall housing)
CUPR (Connection Unit Point Rack) S30777-Q751-Z (Figure 3-11) - for use in
HiPath 3300 (19-inch housing)
Slot 2 (8 x UP0/E)
Slot 4 (X20)
Slot 1 (2 x S0)
Slot 3 (4 x a/b)
CBCC
PSU/UPS (X1)
Slot 5 (X30)
Peripheral board
CUP
Figure 3-10
Slot 2 (8 x UP0/E)
Slot 4 (X20)
Slot 1 (2 x S0)
Slot 3 (4 x a/b)
CBRC
PSU/UPS (X1)
Slot 5 (X30)
Peripheral board
CUPR
Figure 3-11
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-47
Boards
Central Boards
3.2.9 IMODC
Caution
Place the central control board on a flat surface before inserting the IMODC subboard.
The spacing bolts supplied guarantee the correct insertion of the subboard, so you
should always mount them (see Figure 3-5).
Otherwise you may damage the board.
Introduction
The Integrated Modem Card Columbus IMODC (S30807-Q6932-X) is an optional
subboard for the HiPath 3000 central control boards.
This board cannot be used with the HiPath 3250 and HiPath 3150 control boards.
It permits the use of remote service (analog mode up to 14.4 kbit/s) without an external modem.
3-48
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Central Boards
3.2.10 LIM
Caution
The LAN interface module must not be plugged in or out when the system is energized.
Place the central control board on a flat surface before inserting the LIM subboard.
The spacing bolts supplied guarantee the correct insertion of the subboard, so you
should always mount them (see Figure 3-5).
Otherwise you may damage the board.
Interface
The LAN interface module (LIM - S30807-Q6930-X) is an optional plug-in card for all
HiPath 3000 central control boards.
The board provides an Ethernet (10BaseT/10 Mb) LAN connection via an 8-pole
RJ45 jack.
You cannot operate the LIM module and a HiPath HG1500 board simultaneously in a
HiPath 3000.
RJ45 Jack Assignment
Table 3-18
Pin
Signal
Tx +
Transmit +
Tx
Transmit
Rx +
Receive +
Not used
Not used
Rx
Receive
Not used
Not used
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Description
3-49
Boards
Central Boards
For shielding reasons, the stripped part of the cable must be fastened to the grill of the HiPath
3750-/HiPath 3700 backplane with cable straps.
X18
to LAN
C39195-Z7213-A1
adapter cable
(see Figure 3-13)
3-50
approx. 300 mm
stripped length
approx. 60 mm
Figure 3-12
LIM in HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 - Procedure for LAN Connection
Figure 3-13
Boards
Central Boards
Figure 3-14
LIM in HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 - Attachment of the Patch Cable to the Backplane Grill
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-51
Boards
Central Boards
3.2.11 MMC16
Introduction
The multimedia card (MMC) is a plug-in memory card for the central control boards
and contains the CDB backup and the country-specific and release-specific application processor software (APS).
Please note that the MMC may only be replaced by a multimedia card released by
Siemens AG. Cards that have not been released may have a different internal structure, which affects temporal access and some features (for example CDB backup and
APS transfer).
HiPath 3250
HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3300
with CBRC
Country
HiPath 3350
Part Number
HiPath 3550
MMC
Table 3-19
S30122-X7424-X
(= empty basic MMC)
World
P30370-P855-A610
P30370-P856-A610
X
X
P30370-P857-A610
X
X
X
X
X
X
S30122-X7424-X
(= empty basic MMC)
P30370-P1031-A816
P30370-P1032-A816
P30370-P1033-A816
3-52
World
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Central Boards
Warning
HiPath 3250 and HiPath 3150 can only be activated or deactivated by connecting or
disconnecting the mains cable.
The SDRAM cannot be initialized correctly by clearing down and then setting up the
connection between PSU One and the system if the affected power supply is in operation. Firmware and APS startup is also impossible in this case.
Introduction
The two following PSU types are used for HiPath 3250 and HiPath 3150:
S30122-K5837-M
S30122-K5837-S
Nominal frequency: 50 Hz - 60 Hz
Power consumption: 25 W
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-53
Boards
Central Boards
Diagram
Line cord to the PSU input on the HiPath 3250 and HiPath 3150
3-54
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Central Boards
3.2.13 PSUP
Introduction
The PSUP S30122-K5658-M power supply (Figure 3-16) is used in HiPath 3350 (wall
housing). The device plugs into a special slot and is secured by screws. It connects
to the power system with a modular power cord.
A monitoring LED indicates the presence of the 5 V output voltage.
Technical Specifications
Nominal frequency: 50 Hz - 60 Hz
Power consumption: 70 W
Caution
System voltage can only be switched on or off by plugging in or out the power cord.
25 Hz
50 Hz
20 Hz
1
To CUP
X1
25 Hz = Germany + international
50 Hz = France
20 Hz = U.S.
50
Power plug
Figure 3-16
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-55
Boards
Central Boards
>
Disconnecting the battery buffer by unplugging the X27 jumper is necessary only for
testing (module test at the factory). Disconnection does not necessarily delete the
customer database (CDB). To delete the CDB, use the reset switch.
Interfaces
3-56
V.24 interface
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Central Boards
Reset/reload switch
Switch pressed > 5 s = Reload activated (RUN LED out indicates that a reload is in progress)
RUN LED
LED status meaning is explained in Table 12-2.
CMA
1
X14
Batt.
X27
MPPI
CMS
X13
X19
X20
AM
X12
LIM
X1
1
X21
1
MMC
X9
X3
4 x UP0/E 2 x S0
Reset/reload
switch
RUN LED
X18
PSU 4 x a/b
V.24 interface,
9-pin SUB-D plug
(service PC or application)
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-57
Boards
Central Boards
Pin
Connector X1
UP0/E
Connector X3
ab
UP0/E port 1b
a1 port 1a
UP0/E port 1a
b1 port 1b
UP0/E port 2b
a2 port 2a
UP0/E port 2a
b2 port 2b
UP0/E port 3b
a3 port 3a
UP0/E port 3a
b3 port 3b
UP0/E port 4b
a4 port 4a
UP0/E port 4a
b4 port 4b
Table 3-21
Pin
3-58
11
S0 port 1, transmit +
12
S0 port 1, receive +
13
S0 port 1, receive
14
S0 port 1, transmit
21
S0 port 2, transmit +
22
S0 port 2, receive +
23
S0 port 2, receive
24
S0 port 2, transmit
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Central Boards
Table 3-22
Pin
Connector X19
Connector X20
Connector X21
+5 V
0V
0V
0V
0V
0V
+5 V
+5 V
X18, Pin
Signal
RxD A
TxD A
0V
RTS A
CTS A
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Description
Not used
Not used
Ground
Not used
Not used
3-59
Boards
Central Boards
3-60
Pin
Signal
Description
Tx +
Transmit +
Tx
Transmit
Rx +
Receive +
Not used
Not used
Rx
Receive
Not used
Not used
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Central Boards
Station
DID no.
Port
UP0/E host
(primary)
11
11
UP0/E 1
12
12
UP0/E 2
13
13
UP0/E 3
14
14
UP0/E 4
51
51
UP0/E 1
52
52
UP0/E 2
53
53
UP0/E 3
54
54
UP0/E 4
15
15
a/b 1
16
16
a/b 2
17
17
a/b 3
18
18
a/b 4
UP0/E client
(secondary)
Line
Code
Port
S0
CO PP
801
S0 1-1
802
S0 1-2
803
S0 2-1
804
S0 2-2
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-61
Boards
Central Boards
>
Disconnecting the battery buffer by unplugging the X27 jumper is necessary only for
testing (module test at the factory). Disconnection does not necessarily delete the
customer database (CDB). To delete the CDB, use the reset switch.
Interfaces
V.24 interface
3-62
Reset/reload switches
Switch pressed > 5 s = Reload activated (RUN LED out indicates that a reload is in progress)
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Central Boards
RUN LED
LED status meaning is explained in Table 12-2.
CMA
1
X14
Batt.
X27
MPPI
CMS
X13
X19
X20
AM
X12
LIM
X1
1
X21
X9
X3
2 x UP0/E
MMC
1
2 x S0
Reset/reload
switch
RUN LED
X18
PSU 4 x a/b
V.24 interface,
9-pin SUB-D plug
(service PC or application)
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-63
Boards
Central Boards
Pin
Connector X1
UP0/E
Connector X3
ab
UP0/E port 1b
a1 port 1a
UP0/E port 1a
b1 port 1b
UP0/E port 2b
a2 port 2a
UP0/E port 2a
b2 port 2b
a3 port 3a
b3 port 3b
a4 port 4a
b4 port 4b
Table 3-27
Pin
3-64
11
S0 port 1, transmit +
12
S0 port 1, receive +
13
S0 port 1, receive
14
S0 port 1, transmit
21
S0 port 2, transmit +
22
S0 port 2, receive +
23
S0 port 2, receive
24
S0 port 2, transmit
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Central Boards
Table 3-28
Pin
Connector X19
Connector X20
Connector X21
+5 V
0V
0V
0V
0V
0V
+5 V
+5 V
X18, Pin
Signal
RxD A
TxD A
0V
RTS A
CTS A
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Description
Not used
Not used
Ground
Not used
Not used
3-65
Boards
Central Boards
Pin
Signal
Description
Tx +
Transmit +
Tx
Transmit
Rx +
Receive +
Not used
Not used
Rx
Receive
Not used
Not used
DID no.
Port
UP0/E host
(primary)
11
11
UP0/E 1
12
12
UP0/E 2
13
13
a/b 1
14
14
a/b 2
15
15
a/b 3
16
16
a/b 4
17
17
S0 2
S0 bus
3-66
Line
Code
Port
S0
CO PP
801
S0 1-1
802
S0 1-2
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Central Boards
3.2.16 UPSC-D
Introduction
The UPSC-D S30122-K5660-M300 board (Figure 3-19) is used in HiPath 3550 and
HiPath 3350 (wall housing).
The module integrates the power supply and battery manager functions. No other
components are required if operating as a power supply. To maintain short-term battery emergency operation after a power failure, that is, to use uninterruptible power
supply functions, you must also connect a battery pack.
If the power supplied by the UPSC-D is insufficient, an external EPSU2 power supply
can be installed to provide additional power. To do this, connect the DC port on the
EPSU2 to the special 48 Vdc input on the UPSC-D. The UPSC-D internal 48 V output is deactivated when the external power supply is connected.
Allowed battery pack
S30122-K5928-X (48 V (4 x 12 V)/1.2 Ah battery pack)
Only this battery pack is released for connection to the UPSC-D.
Danger
It is forbidden to operate a 24 V battery pack (S30122-K5403-X) on the UPSC-D,
because if the battery is overloaded, an explosive gas (hydrogen and oxygen) escapes.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-67
Boards
Central Boards
Technical Specifications
Nominal frequency: 50 Hz - 60 Hz
Bridging times
Table 3-32 gives the maximum possible bridging times (battery operation in case
of power failure) for the S30122-K5928-X (48 V/1.2 Ah) battery pack, depending
on the system.
Table 3-32
System
Load levels
Maximum
bridging time
19 min
6 min
15 min
17 min
Measurement conditions:
All measurements were performed at a room temperature of approximately
23C (73,4F).
The batteries were fully charged when the measurement was started.
3-68
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Central Boards
Diagram of UPSC-D
LED, yellow
Figure 3-19
UPSC-D (S30122-K5660-M300)
LED,
green
1
to
CUC/
CUP
LED, yellow
X1
50
ck
pa
t
tle
ou
U2
r
we
Po
S
EP
ry
tte
Ba
Figure 3-20
UPSC-D (S30122-K5660-M300)
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-69
Boards
Central Boards
Caution
System voltage can only be switched on or off by plugging in or unplugging the power plug. If using an uninterruptible power supply, switch off the battery voltage first.
LED, yellow: 48 V output voltage is supplied by the external EPSU2 power supply.
Slide switch for activating and deactivating the battery voltage (battery pack):
Slide switch for activating and deactivating the battery voltage (battery
pack)
LED, green: +5 V output voltage is
available
3-70
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Central Boards
Connectors
Figure 3-22
UPSC-D - Connectors
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-71
Boards
Central Boards
3.2.17 UPSC-DR
Introduction
The UPSC-DR S30122-K7373-M900 board (Figure 3-23) is used in HiPath 3500 and
HiPath 3300 (19-inch housing).
The module integrates the power supply and battery manager functions. No other
components are required if operating as a power supply. To maintain short-term battery emergency operation after a power failure, that is, to use uninterruptible power
supply functions, you must also connect a battery pack (see Section 6.4).
DANGER
The UPSC-DR board is not insulated.
Consequently, a system using a UPSC-DR may only be operated with a closed
housing.
Before opening the housing, make sure that the system is de-energized as follows:
Switch off the battery voltage and line voltage of any expansion cabinet that
may be connected (see Section 6.4.1, ECR Control, Display, and Connecting
Elements).
Disconnect the line cord on any battery that may be connected (installed in the
expansion cabinet) (see Section 6.4.4, Expansion Cabinet Rack (ECR) With
Batteries).
Disconnect the line cord on any EPSU2-R that may be connected (installed in
the ECR) (see Section 6.4.5, Expansion Cabinet Rack (ECR) With Batteries
and EPSU2-R).
Allowed batteries
4 x V39113-W5123-E891 (4 x 12 V/7 Ah battery packs)
Only these batteries are released for connection to the UPSC-DR and assembly in
the expansion cabinet.
3-72
Danger
It is forbidden to operate a 24 V battery pack (S30122-K5403-X) on the UPSC-DR,
because if the battery is overloaded, an explosive gas (hydrogen and oxygen) escapes.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Central Boards
Technical Specifications
Nominal frequency: 50 Hz - 60 Hz
Bridging times
Table 3-33 gives the maximum possible bridging times (emergency battery operation in case of power failure) for the four V39113-W5123-E891 batteries (4 x
12 V/7 Ah-batteries), depending on the system.
Table 3-33
System
Load levels
Maximum
bridging time
HiPath
3300
UPSC-DR
7 h 30 min
HiPath
3500
UPSC-DR
1 h 30 min
HiPath
3500
UPSC-DR
2 h 20 min
HiPath
3500
UPSC-DR
with
EPSU2-R
1 h 30 min
HiPath
3500
UPSC-DR
with
EPSU2-R
2 h 40 min
Measurement conditions:
The batteries were fully charged when the measurement was started.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-73
Boards
Central Boards
Diagram of UPSC-DR
LED, green
LED, yellow
Figure 3-23
3-74
UPSC-DR (S30122-K7373-M900)
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Central Boards
25 Hz
20 Hz
50 Hz
1
To
CUCR/
CUPR
X1
50
LED, yellow
Connector
for batteries
and EPSU2-R
(installed in expansion cabinet)
Power plug
UPSC-DR (S30122-K7373-M900)
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-75
Boards
Central Boards
Caution
System voltage can only be switched on or off by plugging in or unplugging the power plug. If using an uninterruptible power supply, switch off the battery voltage first.
Slide switch for activating and deactivating the battery voltage (batteries):
Slide switch for activating and deactivating the battery voltage (batteries)
Figure 3-25
3-76
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Central Boards
Connectors
Power plug
UPSC-DR - Connectors
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-77
Boards
Central Boards
3.2.18 UPSM
Introduction
Each cabinet in HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 requires one UPSM (uninterruptible
power supply modular). This board integrates the power supply and battery management functions. No other components are required if operated as a power supply.
To maintain short-term battery emergency operation after a power failure, that is, to
use uninterruptible power supply functions, you must also connect one of the following to the UPSM:
>
Each connection must have a ferrite bead provided between the UPSM and battery
pack, battery cabinet or 48 V dc network. Insert the ferrite bead (Wrth 742 7113 or
C39022-Z7000-C7) with two windings into the connecting cable at the UPSM output.
You do not need a ferrite assembly when using the BSG 48/38 battery cabinet in
version 2 or later as the ferrite beads were integrated in the battery cabinet.
If the UPSM is operated without an additional 48 Vdc interface connection, that is,
only in 110/220 Vac operation, you may use both UPSM and PSUI in one system.
You may not mix them in systems that have an USVI uninterruptible power supply because of the different battery interface connections. You are not allowed to use UPSM
in these systems.
The UPSM is used in models for all countries. You can adjust the ring frequency of
the modular ring generator to meet your functional needs (country-specific). For production-related reasons there are two different UPSM models with the same function.
Technically identical, the two models have minor mechanical differences and are fully
compatible with each other.
UPSM model S30122-K5950-S121 is an exception. It supplies a ring frequency of
60 Veff and is used only in the Republic of South Africa.
>
3-78
Basic cabinet
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Central Boards
Caution
When mounting the UPSM on the cabinet frame, be careful to prevent screws from
falling into the power supply unit through the ring generator opening. If a screw falls
inside the UPSM, remove the screw before starting up the unit.
LED, Switches
An LED lights up to indicate that the UPSM is in operation. The UPSM must be replaced when defective (LED does not light up).
Caution
For maintenance work that requires that the system be de-energized (for example,
replacing central boards), you must turn all UPSM switches into the Off position to
switch off the secondary operating voltage (system supply voltages).
Part Numbers
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-79
Boards
Central Boards
Technical Specifications
Nominal frequency: 50 Hz - 60 Hz
Bridging times
Table 3-34 lists the maximum possible bridging times (battery emergency operation in case of power failure) for the S30122-K5950-Y200 (48 V/7 Ah) battery
pack.
Table 3-34
UPSM - Bridging Times With S30122-K5950-Y200 (48 V/7 Ah) Battery Pack
System
Power supply
Load levels
HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
UPSM
1h
HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
UPSM
60 % nominal load
1 h 40 min
Measurement conditions:
All measurements were performed with the batteries at a room temperature of
approximately 22C (71,6F).
The batteries were new and fully charged when the measurement was started.
3-80
Nominal output voltage: 75 Vact (60 Veff with the UPSM model for RSA)
Output power
continuous: 4.0 VA
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Central Boards
Modular
ring generator
REAR
VIEW
LED
OFF
ON
ON/OFF switch
for secondary
voltages (system
supply voltages)
FRONT
VIEW
Warning:
High Voltage
25 Hz
48 V
50 Hz
UPSMres 1)
UPSMres 1)
1) Contact (max. 100 mA) closes when battery
mode is activated. A relay connected in series can
be used for signaling purposes, for example.
Figure 3-27
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-81
Boards
Central Boards
FRONT
VIEW
REAR
VIEW
LED
OFF
ON
1
2
3
4
ON/OFF switch
for secondary
voltages (system
supply voltages)
Modular
ring generator
Warning:
High Voltage
Off
On
Figure 3-28
3-82
DIP switches
(e.g. 25 Hz)
Frequency
On Off Off
20 Hz
Off On Off
25 Hz
Off Off On
50 Hz
Boards
Central Boards
BSG 48/38
You can use a BSG 48/38 battery cabinet instead of the battery pack or a 48 V direct
current supply to extend the bridging time in the event of a power failure. The BSG
48/38 battery cabinet (S30122-K5950-F300) consists of
an upright housing
a charging rectifier
The battery cabinet is designed for direct connection to the HiPath 3750 and HiPath
3700 communication system. The DC power cable (S30122-X5950-F310) provided
lets you connect any UPSM to the battery cabinet (do not connect to extension cables). Figure 3-30 offers a schematic representation of the connections between the
BSG 48/38 battery cabinet and HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 (UPSM).
>
For detailed information about safety precautions as well as using and connecting
the battery cabinet, refer to the installation and startup instructions that came with
the cabinet.
DC output 2:
48 V special
outputs
BSG 48/38
DC Power System, 48 V
AC input,
230 V
Figure 3-29
DC output 1:
48 V to HiPath
3750 and HiPath
3700
1
2
3
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-83
UPSM
Boards
Central Boards
DC power cable
DCOutput 1,
48 V
UPSM
AC power
DC power cable
AC power
DC power cable
Expansion cabinet 1
USVI (battery cabinet)
UPSM
AC input
BSG 48/38
with battery
set 38 Ah/48 V
Basic cabinet
Expansion cabinet 2
USVI (battery cabinet)
AC power
to BSG 48/38
(For clarity, the cabinets are displayed separately and without protective grounding).
DC power cable
(S30122-X5950-F310)
to UPSM
Lamp-wire connector (UPSMres)
Contact (maximum load of 100 mA), which is closed during battery operation. Signaling equipment can be driven using a series-connected relay, for
example.
Figure 3-30
3-84
Connections Between BSG 48/38 Battery Cabinet and UPSM (HiPath 3750/HiPath 3700)
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Peripheral Boards
>
Do not install an HXGM or HXGM2 in board slot 2 on the HiPath 3750 or HiPath
3700.
A maximum of six HXGM or HXGM2 boards may be inserted in a HiPath 3750 or
HiPath 3700 cabinet.
It is not possible to operate an HXGM or HXGM2 and an LIM module simultaneously
in a HiPath 3750 or HiPath 3700.
For information on startup and configuration, refer to the HiPath HG1500 V2.0 service
manua.
Board Versions
Table 3-35
Board Version
Services
DSPs
Board Name
Data only
HXGM
HXGM
HXGM2
HXGM2
S30810-Q2940-X110
HXGM2
S30810-Q2940-X10
HXGM2
S30810-Q2930-X100
S30810-Q2930-X
S30810-Q2940-X100
S30810-Q2940-X
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-85
Boards
Peripheral Boards
Two simultaneous Voice-over-IP connections are possible per DSP (digital signal processor).
Interfaces and Connectors
LED H2 (green)
LED H1 (red)
Backplane
Figure 3-31
3-86
V.24
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Peripheral Boards
H1 (Red)
H2 (Green)
Meaning
Flashing
Off
On
Off
On -> off
Off
Off
Off -> on
Off
On
On
On
Board has reached idle state after startup (router number logon)
V.24 Interface
You can update the software over the 6-pin MiniDin jack X2, which can also be used
to configure the board and debug the software.
Make the connection using the serial interface cable SIC (S30122-K5468-X3). The
SIC converts the level of the TTL signals (HXGM2) to V.24 (9-pin Sub-D socket). Depending on the SIC, the maximum permissible transmission rate of the V.24 interface
is 19.2 Kbps. The interface supports only asynchronous transmission.
Table 3-37
Pin
Signal
GND
TXD
Transmit Data
CTS
Clear to Send
RXD
Receive Data
RTS
Request to Send
+5V
(7)
GND
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
I/O
Function
3-87
Boards
Peripheral Boards
LAN Interfaces
Table 3-38
Function
Transmit: + wire
Transmit: wire
Receive: + wire
Receive: wirer
4+5+7+8
4+5+7+8
not used
Note
Direct connection of Ethernet twisted pair to the HiPath HG1500.
The RJ45 cable must be cross-connected as follows:
1 <> 3
3-88
2 <> 6
3 <> 1
6 <> 2
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Peripheral Boards
SIPAC 1 SU
socket
(Backplane
Xx8 or Xx9)
RJ45 socket
(to the LAN)
Figure 3-32
Table 3-39
SIPAC 1 SU socket
RJ45 socket
Signal
B1
C2
B3
C4
B5
C6
B7
C8
Signals TT1/2 and RT1/2 are not needed for transmitting data. They represent a
signal termination of 100 Ohm (so-called Bob Smith termination) for the two unused
wire pairs of a 4-pair twisted pair cable.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-89
Boards
Peripheral Boards
CHAMP (Backplane)
3-90
Figure 3-33
HXGM and HXGM2 LAN Adapter Cable for Backplane (for U.S.
only)
Table 3-40
HXGM and HXGM2 LAN Adapter Cable Assignments (for U.S. only)
CHAMP connector
RJ45 socket
Signal
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
25, 50
Housing
LAN connection
LAN 2
LAN 1
Shield
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Peripheral Boards
Connection of a local LAN to the HiPath 3000 and connection with external LANs
via the ISDN and DSL interfaces of HiPath 3000.
Support for the conventional functions of an ISDN and DSL router with the additional functionality of a media gateway for the transfer of voice, fax and data.
With HiPath HG1500 V3.0 or later, an HTML-supported tool is used instead of HiPath
3000 Manager I for configuration. This web-based management (WBM) allows administration of HiPath HG1500 without special software.
>
A combination of up to eight HXGM3 boards can be used per system, but the following restrictions must be observed:
A maximum of four HXGM3 boards may be inserted per HiPath 3750 or HiPath
3700 cabinet.
To allow for future expansion of the channels with extension modules, the slot
between two HXGM3 boards should remain free.
Board Versions
Table 3-41
Board
HXGM3
S30810-Q2942-X
Services
Voice and Data
DSPs
B Channels
16
16
Two simultaneous Voice-over-IP connections are possible per DSP (Digital Signal
Processor).
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-91
Boards
Peripheral Boards
Extension Modules
The HXGM3 board has three HGA (HiPath Gateway Accelerator) slots, which can be
used to connect the extension modules.
At the moment no extension modules are available
Figure 3-34
3-92
HXGM3 (S30810-Q2942-X)
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Peripheral Boards
Interfaces/Connections
The HXGM3 board provides the following connections:
HGA slot 2
Backplane
LED H0 (red)
LED H1 (green)
HGA slot 0
HGA slot 1
LAN connections
via LAN adapter
connector:
LAN 2 (SU Xx8)
Figure 3-35
HXGM3 Interfaces
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-93
Boards
Peripheral Boards
Meaning
On
H1(Green)
Flashing
On
H0 (Red)
Error
Flashing
V.24interface
The V.24 cable C30267-Z355-A25 is used for connecting the service PC.
The following settings must be chosen for a terminal or PC connected to the V.24 interface:
Transmission rate
19,200
Data bits
Parity bit
None
Stop bits
None
I/O
RXD
TXD
DTR
0V
DSR
RTS
CTS
Remark
1
Internal pull-up resistor in level switch (MAX211E)
Ground
Internal pull-up resistor in level switch (MAX211E)
Internal pull-up resistor in level switch (MAX211E)
3-94
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Peripheral Boards
SIPAC 1 SU
socket
(Backplane
Xx8 or Xx9)
RJ45 Jack
(to the LAN)
Figure 3-36
Table 3-44
SIPAC 1 SU jack
RJ45 Jack
Signal
B1
C2
B3
C4
B5
C6
B7
C8
Signals TT1/2 and RT1/2 are not needed for transmitting data. They represent a signal termination of 100 Ohm (so-called Bob Smith termination) for the two unused
wire pairs of a 4-pair twisted pair cable.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-95
Boards
Peripheral Boards
CHAMP (Backplane)
3-96
Figure 3-37
Table 3-45
CHAMP
connector
RJ45 Jack
Signal
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
25, 50
Housing
LAN
connection
LAN 2
LAN 1
Shield
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Peripheral Boards
HXGS and HXGS2 - for use in HiPath 3550 and HiPath 3350 (wall housing)
HXGSR and HXGSR2 - for use in HiPath 3500 and HiPath 3300 (19-inch housing)
You can use up to four boards in HiPath 3550 and HiPath 3500; these boards may be
operated simultaneously. You may use a maximum of two boards in HiPath 3350 and
HiPath 3300.
Information about the calculation of the required HiPath HG1500 V2.0 boards can be
found in Section 9.6.5.2 on Page 9-51.
>
Board Versions
Table 3-46
Board version
Services
DSPs
Board name
Data only
HXGS
HXGS
Data only
HXGS2
HXGS2
S30810-Q2939-X110
Data only
HXGS2
S30810-Q2939-X10
HXGS2
S30810-K2931-Z100
Data only
HXGSR
HXGSR
Data only
HXGSR2
HXGSR2
S30810-Q2931-X100
S30810-Q2931-X
S30810-Q2939-X100
S30810-Q2939-X
S30810-K2931-Z
S30810-K2939-Z100
S30810-K2939-Z
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-97
Boards
Peripheral Boards
Table 3-46
Board version
Services
DSPs
Board name
S30810-K2939-Z110
Data only
HXGSR2
S30810-K2939-Z10
HXGSR2
Two simultaneous Voice-over-IP connections are possible per DSP (digital signal processor).
3-98
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Peripheral Boards
X4: 8-pin RJ45 socket for LAN 10 BaseT (only for HXGS2 and HXGSR2)
HXGS/HXGSR
50
X2 V.24
LAN
connection
X1
To
CUC/CUCR/
CUP/
CUPR
X3 10/100 BaseT
2
Figure 3-38
HXGS2/HXGSR2
50
X2 V.24
LAN
connection
X4 10 BaseT
X1
To
CUC/CUCR/
CUP/
CUPR
X3 10/100 BaseT
2
Figure 3-39
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-99
Boards
Peripheral Boards
V.24 Interface
You can update software over the 6-pin MiniDin jack X2, which can also be used to
configure the board and debug the software.
Make the connection using the serial interface cable SIC (S30122-K5468-X3). The
SIC converts the level of the TTL signals (HXGS2 and HXGSR2) to V.24 (9-pin SubD socket). Depending on the SIC, the maximum permissible transmission rate of the
V.24 interface is 19.2 Kbps. Only asynchronous transmission is supported.
Table 3-47
Pin
Signal
I/O
Function
GND
TXD
Transmit Data
CTS
Clear to Send
RXD
Receive Data
RTS
Request to Send
+5V
(7)
GND
LAN Interfaces
Table 3-48
X3 (10/100 BaseT)
X4 (10 BaseT)
only for HXGS2 and HXGSR2
Transmit: + wire
Transmit: wire
Receive: + wire
Receive: wire
4+5+7+8
4+5+7+8
Function
not used
Note
Direct connection of Ethernet twisted pair to the HiPath HG1500.
The RJ45 cable must be cross-connected as follows:.
1 <> 3
2 <> 6
3 <> 1
6 <> 2
A ferrite bead must be attached to both the LAN 1 and LAN 2 lines on the RJ45 cable.
3-100
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Peripheral Boards
Connection of a local LAN to the HiPath 3000 and connection with external LANs
via the ISDN and DSL interfaces of HiPath 3000.
Support for the conventional functions of an ISDN and DSL router with the additional functionality of a media gateway for the transfer of voice, fax and data.
With HiPath HG1500 V3.0 or later, a HTML-supported tool is used instead of HiPath
3000 Manager I for configuration. This web-based management (WBM) allows administration of HiPath HG1500 without special software.
>
Up to three boards can be used in HiPath 3550 and HiPath 3500. To support this
maximum configuration, slot 10 (board in HiPath 3750 format) must remain free.
A maximum of one board is permitted in HiPath 3350 and HiPath 3300.
When using an HXGS3 in HiPath 3350, power supply unit PSUP must be replaced
with UPSC-D.
It is not possible to operate an HXGS3 or HXGR3 and an LIM module simultaneously in one system.
Refer to the HiPath HG1500 V3.0 Installation Manual and the HiPath HG1500 V3.0
Configuration Manual for information on the startup and configuration.
Warning
When using an HXGS3 board in a HiPath 3550 or HiPath 3350, fan kit C39165A7021-D3 must be installed for thermal reasons (see page 3-107).
The boards HXGS3 and HXGR3 are compatible with HiPath HG1500 V2.0 boards
HXGS2 and HXGSR2. A combined installation in a system is possible.
Information about the calculation of the required HiPath HG1500 V3.0 boards can be
found in Section 9.6.5.2 on Page 9-51.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-101
Boards
Peripheral Boards
Board Versions
Table 3-49
Board
Part Number
Services
DSPs
B Channels
HXGS3
S30810-Q2943-X
HXGR3
S30810-K2943-Z
Two simultaneous Voice-over-IP connections are possible per DSP (Digital Signal
Processor).
>
If extension module PDM1 is used, the number of DSP channels for boards HXGS3
and HXGR3 can be expanded by eight in each case.
Extension modules
The HXGS3 and HXGR3 boards each have two HGA (HiPath Gateway Accelerator)
slots, which can be used to connect extension modules.
Table 3-50
Extension
module
PDM1
(PMC DSP
modules)
3-102
S30807-Q5692X100
Function
Notes
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Peripheral Boards
Figure 3-40
HXGS3 (S30810-Q2943-X)
Figure 3-41
HXGR3 (S30810-K2943-Z)
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-103
Boards
Peripheral Boards
Interfaces/connections
The HXGS3 and HXGR3 boards provide the following connections:
LAN connections:
LAN 1 (X2)
50
HGA slot 1
HGA slot 0
LAN 2 (X3)
X1
to
CUC/
CUCR /
CUP/
CUPR
2
V.24 interface X4
Figure 3-42
3-104
HXGS3/HXGR3 Interfaces
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Peripheral Boards
LAN Interfaces
Table 3-51
Pin on
HXGS3/HXGR3
(X2 and X3)
Signal
Signals TT1/2 and RT1/2 are not needed for transmitting data. They represent a signal termination of 100 Ohm (so-called Bob Smith termination) for the two unused
wire pairs of a 4-pair twisted pair cable.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-105
Boards
Peripheral Boards
V.24interface
The V.24 cable C30267-Z355-A25 is used for connecting the service PC.
The following settings must be chosen for a terminal or PC connected to the V.24 interface:
Transmission rate
19.200
data bits
Parity bit
None
Stop bits
None
I/O
RXD
TXD
DTR
0V
DSR
RTS
CTS
Remark
1
Internal pull-up resistor in level switch (MAX211E)
Ground
Internal pull-up resistor in level switch (MAX211E)
Internal pull-up resistor in level switch (MAX211E)
3-106
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Peripheral Boards
Installing the Fan Kit for HXGS3 in HiPath 3550 or HiPath 3350
Warning
If an HXGS3 board is used in a HiPath 3550 or HiPath 3350, one fan kit C39165A7021-D3 must be installed for thermal reasons.
When installing and connecting the fan kit, proceed as follows:
Step
Activity
1.
2.
3.
Place fan kit [A] on the system shelf [B] as shown in Figure 3-43.
4.
Push the two supplied securing clips over positions [C] illustrated in Figure 3-44 to attach the fan kit to the shelf.
5.
Insert the connector of the fan kit cable into the port provided for it on
an HXGS3 board as illustrated in Figure 3-45.
6.
7.
Start the system by plugging in the power plug. In the case of an uninterruptible power supply, the battery must then be switched on.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-107
Boards
Peripheral Boards
[A]
[B]
Figure 3-43
3-108
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Peripheral Boards
[C]
Figure 3-44
[D]
Figure 3-45
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-109
Boards
Peripheral Boards
>
A maximum of one IVML8 or IVML24 is permitted for each HiPath 3750 and HiPath
3700. This board may only be inserted into the slot beside the power supply in the
basic cabinet or in the expansion cabinets. Furthermore, the ferrite bead (C39022Z7000-C7) included with the board must be mounted on the CABLU of the board
that is inserted to the immediate left of the IVML8 or IVML24.
The rules provided under Distribution of the PCM Segments on page 4-74 for population with boards must be observed to ensure the non-blocking operation of the
system.
For detailed information on HiPath Xpressions Compact, startup and administration,
see the manual for the product (see list of documentation).
Figure 3-46
3-110
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Peripheral Boards
Lockout switch
(setting = free, default)
LED (green)
LED (yellow)
Figure 3-47
Up = free (default)
Down = locked: existing connections remain active, new connections are locked.
The yellow LED lights up when all connections are ended and the board is
effectively locked.
The yellow LED flashes when a lockout request is entered (via lockout switch
or software) but at least one call is still active.
To reset the board to the default state, activate the lockout switch twice within the first
10 s of board startup.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-111
Boards
Peripheral Boards
Yellow
LED
Table 3-53
Green
LED
Meaning
Action
Off
On
On
On
Off
blocked = On
free = Off
Flashing
(500/
500 ms)
Off
Hard disk test, start of the application (depending on hard disk status, lasts approx.
3 - 8 minutes)
Off
On
On
Off
Off
During Operation
Off
Off
On
3-112
Off
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Peripheral Boards
LAN Adapter
The Ethernet LAN interface is accessed via the LAN adapter shown in Figure 3-48
(part no. C39228-A7195-A10), which is connected on the backplanes (Xx9) SIPAC 1
SU connector. Only shielded cables may be used for the LAN connector (RJ45 jack).
SIPAC 1 SU
jack (Xx9
backplane)
RJ45
jack
(LAN)
Figure 3-48
Table 3-54
SIPAC 1 SU Jack
RJ45 Jack
Signal
B1
C2
B3
C4
B5
C6
B7
C8
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-113
Boards
Peripheral Boards
IVMP8 (Integrated Voice Mail Point) S30122-Q7379-X100 - for HiPath 3350 (wall
housing)
In addition, the boards have an Ethernet (10/100BaseT) interface which can be used
for HiPath Xpressions Compact administration (fast APS transfer, backup and restore
activities).
>
Figure 3-49
3-114
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Peripheral Boards
X4
50
10
X3 = LAN
connector,
8-pole RJ45
jack
Lockout switch
LED (green)
LED (yellow)
X1
X1 = connection to
CUP/
CUPR
X3
2
X2
10
Figure 3-50
Not pressed = locked: existing connections remain active, new connections are
locked.
The yellow LED lights up when all connections are ended and the board is
effectively locked.
The yellow LED flashes when a lockout request is entered (via lockout switch
or software) but at least one call is still active.
To reset the board to the default state, activate the lockout switch twice within the first
10 s of board startup.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-115
Boards
Peripheral Boards
3-116
RJ45 Jack X3
Pin
Signal
Description
Printed Circuit
Connector X2
Pin
Tx +
Transmit +
Tx
Transmit
Rx +
Receive +
Not used
Not used
Rx
Receive
Not used
Not used
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Peripheral Boards
Green
LED
Meaning
Action
Off
On
On
On
Off
blocked = On
free = Off
Flashing
(500/
500 ms)
Off
Hard disk test, start of the application (depending on hard disk status, lasts approx.
3 - 8 minutes)
Off
On
On
Off
Off
During Operation
Off
Off
On
Off
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-117
Boards
Peripheral Boards
IVMS8 (Integrated Voice Mail Small) S30122-Q7379-X - for HiPath 3550 and HiPath 3350 (wall housing)
IVMS8R (Integrated Voice Mail Small Rack) S30122-K7379-Z - for HiPath 3500
and HiPath 3300 (19-inch housing)
In addition, the boards have an Ethernet (10/100BaseT) interface which can be used
for HiPath Xpressions Compact administration (fast APS transfer, backup and restore
activities).
>
Figure 3-51
3-118
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Peripheral Boards
X4
50
10
X3 = LAN
connector,
8-pole RJ45
jack
Lockout switch
LED (green)
LED (yellow)
X1
X3
2
X2
X1 = connection to
CUC/
CUCR/
CUP/
CUPR
10
Figure 3-52
Not pressed = locked: existing connections remain active, new connections are
locked.
The yellow LED lights up when all connections are ended and the board is
effectively locked.
The yellow LED flashes when a lockout request is entered (via lockout switch
or software) but at least one call is still active.
To reset the board to the default state, activate the lockout switch twice within the first
10 s of board startup.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-119
Boards
Peripheral Boards
3-120
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Peripheral Boards
RJ45 Jack X3
Pin
Signal
Tx +
Transmit +
Tx
Transmit
Rx +
Receive +
Not used
Not used
Rx
Receive
Not used
Not used
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Description
Printed Circuit
Connector X2
Pin
3-121
Boards
Peripheral Boards
Green
LED
Meaning
Action
Off
On
On
On
Off
blocked = On
free = Off
Flashing
(500/
500 ms)
Off
Hard disk test, start of the application (depending on hard disk status, lasts approx.
3 - 8 minutes)
Off
On
On
Off
Off
During Operation
Off
Off
On
3-122
Off
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Peripheral Boards
>
Only one board can be installed in an HiPath 3550 or HiPath 3350 system.
Do not install the board in slot 5.
Board Slot
Interfaces
X3: LAN port, 10-pin shielded, coded RJ45 jack for LAN 10Base-5, Not for U.S.:
AUI (15-pin Cannon connector via cable adapter)
X4: LAN port, 8-pin RJ45 jack for LAN 10Base-T (twisted pair)
LAN Bridge
X2
V.24 (RS-232)
X3
10Base-5
X4
10Base-T
LAN
port
50
X1
to
CUC/
CUP
2
Figure 3-54
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-123
Boards
Peripheral Boards
Table 3-59
X3
10-Pin
RJ45 Jack
15-Pin
SUB-D Jack
(not for U.S.)
12
Receive: - wire
Receive: + wire
5+6
1+4+8+11+14
10
Transmit: - wire
Transmit: + wire
GND(AUI)
10
13
(11+12)
Shielding
Table 3-60
GND(AUI)
GND(AUI)
X4: 8-Pin
RJ45 Jack
Function
Transmit: + wire
Transmit: - wire
Receive: + wire
Receive: - wire
4+5+7+8
3-124
Function
Not used
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Peripheral Boards
SLA8N (subscriber line module analog with 8 analog interfaces; not for U.S.)
H1 (green)
LEDs
H2 (red)
Lockout switch S1
up = in service (factory default)
Figure 3-55
The operating mode (short or long line with the appropriate flash times) can be set up
for each subscriber line interface with HiPath 3000 Manager E (the menu Settings:
Set up station > Station > Parameters > Flags).
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-125
Boards
Peripheral Boards
3-126
Red LED
Green
LED
Status
Action
Off
Off
On
Off
Replace board.
Replace board.
Flashing
Off
Off
On
Off
Flashing
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Peripheral Boards
Cable and Connector Assignment (Backplane, MDFU/MDFU-E, Patch Panel) (not for U.S.)
Table 3-62
Color
Group
SU Conn.
Pair
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
Color
Group
Pair
a-Wire
b-Wire
wht/blu
BP: Xx8
19
1a
39
1b
38
2a
ora/wht
48
2b
27
3a
grn/wht
47
3b
16
4a
46
4b
05
5a
45
5b
14
6a
blu/red
44
6b
23
7a
ora/red
43
7b
32
8a
42
8b
11
9a
31
9b
02
10a
gry/red
22
10b
13
11a
blu/blk
33
11b
04
12a
ora/blk
24
12b
15
13a
grn/blk
35
13b
06
14a
brn/blk
26
14b
17
15a
gry/blk
37
15b
08
16a
28
16b
blu/wht
wht/ora
wht/grn
wht/brn
brn/wht
wht/gry
gry/wht
red/blu
red/ora
red/grn
grn/red
red/brn
brn/red
red/gry
blk/blu
blk/ora
blk/grn
blk/brn
blk/gry
yel/blu
blu/yel
SU Conn.
a-Wire
SLA8N, SLA16N,
and SLA24N
b-Wire
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
BP: Xx8
Port 1
Port 2
Port 3
Port 4
Port 5
Port 6
Port 7
Port 8
Port 9
Port 10
Port 11
Port 12
Port 13
Port 14
Port 15
Port 16
SLA8N, SLA16N,
and SLA24N
MDFU/
MDFU-E
Patch
Panel,
MW8 Pin
1a
1b
2a
2b
3a
3b
4a
4b
5a
5b
6a
6b
7a
7b
8a
8b
9a
9b
10a
10b
11a
11b
12a
12b
13a
13b
14a
14b
15a
15b
16a
16b
MDFU/
MDFU-E
Patch
Panel,
MW8 Pin
Notes
not
used
by
SLA8N
Notes
3-127
Boards
Peripheral Boards
Table 3-63
Color
Group
SU Conn.
Pair
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
Color
Group
Pair
3-128
a-Wire
b-Wire
BP: Xx9
SLA8N, SLA16N,
and SLA24N
wht/blu
wht/ora
wht/grn
free
grn/wht
wht/brn
free
brn/wht
wht/gry
free
gry/wht
red/blu
free
blu/red
red/ora
free
ora/red
red/grn
free
grn/red
11
17a
31
17b
02
18a
22
18b
13
19a
33
19b
04
20a
ora/blk
24
20b
15
21a
grn/blk
35
21b
06
22a
26
22b
17
23a
37
23b
08
24a
28
24b
red/gry
gry/red
blk/blu
blu/blk
blk/ora
blk/grn
blk/brn
brn/blk
blk/gry
gry/blk
yel/blu
blu/yel
SU Conn.
a-Wire
b-Wire
Notes
free
ora/wht
brn/red
Patch
Panel,
MW8 Pin
free
blu/wht
red/brn
MDFU/
MDFU-E
BP: Xx9
Port 17
Port 18
Port 19
Port 20
Port 21
Port 22
Port 23
Port 24
SLA8N, SLA16N,
and SLA24N
17a
17b
18a
18b
19a
19b
20a
20b
21a
21b
22a
22b
23a
23b
24a
24b
MDFU/
MDFU-E
Patch
Panel,
MW8 Pin
not
used
by
SLA8N,
SLA16N
Notes
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Peripheral Boards
a-Wire
b-Wire
wht/blu
blu/wht
wht/ora
ora/wht
wht/grn
grn/wht
wht/brn
brn/wht
wht/gry
gry/wht
red/blu
blu/red
red/ora
ora/red
red/grn
grn/red
red/brn
brn/red
red/gry
gry/red
blk/blu
blu/blk
blk/ora
ora/blk
blk/grn
grn/blk
blk/brn
brn/blk
blk/gry
gry/blk
yel/blu
blu/yel
SLA16N and SLA24N - Assignment (SU Xx8, Xx9) (for U.S. only)
SU Conn. Backplane
SLA16N
and SLA24N
19
1a
1 a/Ring
39
1b
26
1 b/Tip
38
2a
2 a/Ring
48
2b
27
2 b/Tip
27
3a
3 a/Ring
47
3b
28
3 b/Tip
16
4a
4 a/Ring
46
4b
29
4 b/Tip
05
5a
5 a/Ring
45
5b
30
5 b/Tip
14
6a
6 a/Ring
44
6b
31
6 b/Tip
23
7a
7 a/Ring
43
7b
32
7 b/Tip
32
8a
8 a/Ring
42
8b
33
8 b/Tip
11
9a
9 a/Ring
31
9b
34
9 b/Tip
02
10a
10
10 a/Ring
22
10b
35
10 b/Tip
13
11a
11
11 a/Ring
33
11b
36
11 b/Tip
04
12a
12
12 a/Ring
24
12b
37
12 b/Tip
15
13a
13
13 a/Ring
35
13b
38
13 b/Tip
06
14a
14
14 a/Ring
26
14b
39
14 b/Tip
17
15a
15
15 a/Ring
37
15b
40
15 b/Tip
08
16a
16
16 a/Ring
28
16b
41
16 b/Tip
Xx8
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Xx9
Port 1
Port 2
Port 3
Port 4
Port 5
Port 6
Port 7
Port 8
Port 9
Port 10
Port 11
Port 12
Port 13
Port 14
Port 15
Port 16
Notes
3-129
Boards
Peripheral Boards
Table 3-64
#
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
3-130
a-Wire
b-Wire
red/brn
brn/red
red/gry
gry/red
blk/blu
blu/blk
blk/ora
ora/blk
blk/grn
grn/blk
blk/brn
brn/blk
blk/gry
gry/blk
yel/blu
blu/yel
SLA16N and SLA24N - Assignment (SU Xx8, Xx9) (for U.S. only)
SU Conn. Backplane
Xx8
Xx9
SLA16N
and SLA24N
11
17a
31
17b
02
18a
22
18b
13
19a
33
19b
04
20a
24
20b
15
21a
35
21b
06
22a
26
22b
17
23a
37
23b
08
24a
28
24b
Port 17
Port 18
Port 19
Port 20
Port 21
Port 22
Port 23
Port 24
9 a/Ring
34
9 b/Tip
10
10 a/Ring
35
10 b/Tip
11
11 a/Ring
36
11 b/Tip
12
12 a/Ring
37
12 b/Tip
13
13 a/Ring
38
13 b/Tip
14
14 a/Ring
39
14 b/Tip
15
15 a/Ring
40
15 b/Tip
16
16 a/Ring
41
16 b/Tip
Notes
not
used
by
SLA16N
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Peripheral Boards
Ring voltage against negative supply voltage (a/b or tip/ring) for a maximum of
two telephones
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-131
Boards
Peripheral Boards
HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 (max. four SLC16s or SLC16Ns per system).
The new SLC16N board is the optimized enhancement of SLC16. Both boards have
the same range of features and are completely compatible technically. Mixed operation of SLC16 and SLC16N boards within one system is supported. SLC16N can be
used in conjunction with special SMRs for V1.2 and V3.0. Please refer to the respective sales release documentation for further details.
Chapter 11 contains basic information on the new options available in HiPath 3000
Version 1.2 or later for the use of HiPath Cordless Office.
>
For initial installation of the HiPath Cordless Office, the HiPath Cordless Office system number (DECT ID) must be ordered together with the SLC16 or SLC16N board.
Replacement boards are always delivered without a HiPath Cordless Office system
number.
Installing SLC16 or SLC16N and entering the HiPath Cordless Office system number releases 16 mobile units for use (PIN numbers are assigned). These mobile
units can then be logged on to the system. Any additional mobile units to be used
must first be released (see Section 9.8.7).
Base stations must be clocked with a high degree of accuracy for HiPath Cordless
Office. Install the plug-in CMS module on the CBCPR board (HiPath 3750 and HiPath
3700) or the plug-in CMA or CMS module on the CBCC board (for HiPath 3550) to
ensure clock accuracy (see Table 11-1).
3-132
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Peripheral Boards
H1 (green)
LEDs
H2 (red)
Lockout switch S1
(position = free,
factory setting)
Figure 3-56
SLC16 (S30810-Q2922-X)
LED (green)
LED (red)
Lockout switch
(up = free,
factory setting)
Figure 3-57
>
SLC16N (S30810-Q2193-X100)
When you activate the lockout switch (SLC16 = flip the switch down, SLC16N =
press the switch), all idle mobile telephones are locked. Active mobile telephones
are not locked until their release keys are pressed.
Before unplugging the SLC16 or SLC16N board, always activate the lockout switch
and wait until the green LED stops flashing. This precaution ensures that none of
the mobile telephones are active.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-133
Boards
Peripheral Boards
3-134
Red LED
Green
LED
Status
Action
Off
Off
On
Off
Replace board.
Replace board.
Flashing
Off
Off
On
Off
Flashing
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Peripheral Boards
Cable and Connector Assignment (Backplane, MDFU/MDFU-E, Patch Panel) (not for U.S.)
Table 3-66
Color
Group
Pair
2
3
4
5
6
7
2
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
4
Color
Group
b-Wire
SU
Conn.
SLC16,
SLC16N
BP: Xx8
1
a-Wire
16
Pair
wht/blu
blu/wht
wht/ora
ora/wht
wht/grn
grn/wht
wht/brn
brn/wht
wht/gry
gry/wht
red/blu
blu/red
red/ora
ora/red
red/grn
grn/red
red/brn
brn/red
1a
39
1b
38
2a
48
2b
27
3a
47
3b
16
4a
46
4b
05
5a
45
5b
14
6a
44
6b
23
7a
43
7b
32
8a
42
8b
11
9a
31
9b
02
10a
22
10b
13
11a
33
11b
04
12a
24
12b
15
13a
35
13b
06
14a
26
14b
17
15a
37
15b
08
16a
blu/yel
28
16b
b-Wire
SU
Conn.
red/gry
gry/red
blk/blu
blu/blk
blk/ora
ora/blk
blk/grn
grn/blk
blk/brn
brn/blk
blk/gry
gry/blk
yel/blu
a-Wire
19
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
BP: Xx8
Access 1
Access 2
Access 3
Access 4
Access 5
Access 6
Access 7
Access 8
Access 9
Access 10
Access 11
Access 12
Access 13
Access 14
Access 15
Access 16
SLC16,
SLC16N
MDFU/
MDFU-E
Patch
Panel,
MW8 Pin
1a
1b
2a
2b
3a
3b
4a
4b
5a
5b
6a
6b
7a
7b
8a
8b
9a
9b
10a
10b
11a
11b
12a
12b
13a
13b
14a
14b
15a
15b
16a
16b
MDFU/
MDFU-E
Patch
Panel,
MW8 Pin
Note
BS 1:
UP0/E port 1
BS x:
UP0/E port x
BS x:
UP0/E port x
BS x:
UP0/E port x
BS x:
UP0/E port x
BS x:
UP0/E port x
BS x:
UP0/E port x
BS x:
UP0/E port x
BS x:
UP0/E port x
BS x:
UP0/E port x
BS x:
UP0/E port x
BS x:
UP0/E port x
BS x:
UP0/E port x
BS x:
UP0/E port x
BS x:
UP0/E port x
BS x:
UP0/E port x
Notes
3-135
Boards
Peripheral Boards
SLC16
SLC16N
BS3/1 to
1 x UP0/E
BS3/S to
1 x UP0/E
BS2/2 to
2/1 x UP0/E
BS3/3 to
3/2 x UP0/E
BS3/1
BS3/S
BS2/2
BS3/3
max. number
of MTs
analog trunk
access for system
V3.0
Table 3-67
CGMC
16
8/16
4/8
12
64
yes
HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
V1.2
System
SW
max.
version number
Simultaneous
calls per BS
12
CMS
16
8/16
4/8
12
64
yes
(X)1
CGM
16
8/16
4/8
12
64
yes
42
CMS
64
32/64 21/32
12
250 (with 4
SLC16s/
SLC16Ns)3
yes
Explanations:
BS3/1 (S30807-H5482-X): this is a base station (Figure 11-1) that supports up to four calls simultaneously.
BS3/1 can also be operated directly at the UP0/E interfaces of the HiPath 3550, HiPath 3350, HiPath 3250,
HiPath 3500, and HiPath 3300 central control boards. For more information, see Chapter 11.
You cannot simultaneously connect BS3/1 base stations to SLC16 or SLC16N and to CBCC in a HiPath
3550 system.
BS3/3 (S30807-H5485-X): this is a base station that can only be operated at SLC16 or SLC16N. Connection via at least two UP0/E interfaces is essential. You can conduct up to twelve calls simultaneously if the
base station is connected via three UP0/E interfaces.
BS3/S (X30807-X5482-X100): the monocell base station BS3/S guarantees the operation of a maximum of
one base station on the UP0/E interfaces of the central control. It is not possible to operate additional base
stations.
1 You can use HiPath Cordless Office on old hardware (Version 1.2 or earlier) when you use V1.2 SMR-G or later.
2 SLC16N can be used in conjunction with special SMRs for V1.2 and V3.0. Please refer to the respective sales release documentation for further details.
3 Maximum of 128 MTs are possible on one SLC16 or SLC16N.
3-136
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Peripheral Boards
SLC16 and SLC16N Board Distribution in HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 Cabinets
You can install up to four SLC16 or SLC16N boards in HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700.
Please note the following when distributing the boards in the individual cabinets:
>
To guarantee uninterrupted operation of HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700, the SLC16
or SLC16N board should not be installed with a second SLC16 or SLC16N, an
SLMO24, or a TS2 on a PCM segment. This requirement must be fulfilled in all cases.
For information on PCM segment distribution, see page 4-74.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-137
Boards
Peripheral Boards
HiPath 3550
Subject to certain prerequisites, the system-internal PSU UPSC-D provides sufficient power for the operation of sixteen BS3/1s (one UP0/E each) or eight BS2/
2s and BS3/3s (two UP0/E each). These prerequisites depend on the
Line length and line type between SLC16 or SLC16N and base station.
The following specifications are based on line lengths of up to 1000 m and a
line type 2x0.6 mm per UP0/E.
Table 3-68
Number of
BS3/1s
at
SLC16 or SLC16N
1-10
11-20
21-30
31-40
41-50
3-138
66
61
57
53
48
44
63
59
54
50
46
41
60
56
52
47
43
39
58
53
49
45
40
36
55
51
47
42
38
33
53
48
44
40
35
31
50
46
41
37
33
28
47
43
39
34
30
26
45
40
36
32
27
23
10
42
38
33
29
25
20
11
40
35
31
27
22
18
12
37
33
28
24
20
15
13
34
30
26
21
17
13
14
32
27
23
19
14
10
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Peripheral Boards
Table 3-68
Number of
BS3/1s
at
SLC16 or SLC16N
1-10
11-20
21-30
31-40
41-50
29
25
20
16
12
16
27
22
18
13
Table 3-69
Number of
BS2/2s
at
SLC16 or SLC16N
1-10
11-20
21-30
31-40
41-50
63
59
54
50
46
41
58
53
49
45
40
36
53
48
44
40
35
31
47
43
39
34
30
26
42
38
33
29
25
20
37
33
28
24
20
15
32
27
23
19
14
10
27
22
18
13
Table 3-70
Number of
BS3/3s
at
SLC16 or SLC16N
1-10
11-20
21-30
31-40
41-50
64
60
56
51
47
42
60
56
52
47
43
39
57
52
48
43
39
35
53
48
44
40
35
31
49
44
40
36
31
27
45
40
36
32
27
23
41
37
32
28
23
19
37
33
28
24
20
15
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-139
Boards
Peripheral Boards
>
For information on connecting the base stations, refer to the HiPath Cordless Office
service manual.
Each base station must be connected to SLC16 or SLC16N via the main distribution
frame (MDFU or MDFU-E).
Always route the UP0/E interfaces on SLC16 or SLC16N via a splitting strip to ensure
that surges due to lightning will be arrested. To do so, insert the polarized surge protectors (supplied) in the plugging locations on the splitting strip.
The following options are available for supplying power to the base stations:
Power supply via three UP0/E interfaces (page 3-143), for BS3/3 only
If the power supplied by the UPSC-D (HiPath 3550) is insufficient, additional power
can be supplied by installing the external power supply EPSU2 (page 3-143).
Signal propagation times differ due to the varying distances between the base stations, the system, and the connecting cables used (refer to the HiPath Cordless Office
service manual). The SLC16 and SLC16N boards automatically equalize these propagation times.
3-140
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Peripheral Boards
HiPath 3750/HiPath
3550/HiPath 3700
SLC16 or
SLC16N
Splitting
strip
1
2
Cablu
UP0/E
a
b
1
MDFU/MDFU-E
Figure 3-58
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-141
Boards
Peripheral Boards
HiPath 3750/HiPath
3550/HiPath 3700
SLC16 or
SLC16N
Splitting
strip
2
3
4
5
Cablu
UP0/E1
UP0/E2
a
b
1
MDFU/MDFU-E
Figure 3-59
3-142
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Peripheral Boards
HiPath 3750/HiPath
3550/HiPath 3700
SLC16 or
SLC16N
Splitting
strip
2
3
4
5
6
7
CABLU
UP0/E1
UP0/E2
UP0/E3
a
b
1
MDFU/MDFU-E
Figure 3-60
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-143
Boards
Peripheral Boards
>
3-144
S30122-K7221-X2 - no batteries are supplied with this model. If you want to use
the uninterruptible power supply function, you must also order and install four
batteries.
Plans call for replacing the S30122-K7221-X1 model with the new EPSU2 S30122K7221-X2 model.
The following description points out differences in the two models where needed.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Peripheral Boards
Housing cover
Battery fuse
LED 1
Fixing screws
LED 2
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-145
Boards
Peripheral Boards
Table 3-71
LED 1
LED 2
(DC Port)
(AC Port)
On
On
Off
On
No DC voltage at output
(rectifier short-circuited).
On
Off
No AC voltage at input
(power outage, circuit-breaker panel receiving battery
power).
Off
Off
Explanation
Ports
Explanation
Battery fuse
AC port (input)
DC port (output)
Items supplied
3-146
EPSU2
S30122-K7221-X2
Boards
Peripheral Boards
Table 3-72
EPSU2
S30122-K7221-X2
Frequency range
47 to 63 Hz
Connected output
200 W
140 W
Mains/nominal voltage
54.2 V
UPS batteries
Battery operation:
Permitted batteries
Manufacturer/type number
Number of batteries
Size (Ah)
Nominal voltage
Overload protection
V39113-W5123-E891
Delivery includes four batteries, already installed.
Nominal current
V39113-W5123-E891
Batteries are not included in
the delivery and must be ordered separately.
Overload protection
Ambient temperature
Humidity
95 %/non-condensing
Cooling
Natural convection
Protection
IP 21 (DIN 40050)
Housing dimensions (W x D
x H in mm)
Weight
Symbol
CE
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-147
Boards
Peripheral Boards
Installation Notes
The unit is suitable only for mounting on the wall (vertically, with AC port on bottom).
Always install the units in a dry, dust-free area where there is no danger of vibrations.
Always make sure there is sufficient air circulation around the units. Do not block
the ventilation holes.
When selecting the location, keep in mind the necessary lengths of the following
cables:
AC cable (protective grounding plug, IEC 320 socket)
DC cable to UPSC-D
Action
1.
Drill two holes for anchors (5 mm in diameter) in the wall, as shown in Figure 3-62.
Depending on the wall materials, you may have to use a different kind of
attachment, such as wooden screws for wooden walls.
2.
Insert the anchors and insert two screws (3.5 mm in diameter), leaving
5 mm projecting from the wall.
3.
Mount the EPSU2 onto the screws and tighten them all the way.
115 mm
102 mm
33 mm
317 mm
Figure 3-62
3-148
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Peripheral Boards
Lockout switch S1
up = in service
(factory default)
H1 (green)
LEDs
H2 (red)
Figure 3-63
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-149
Boards
Peripheral Boards
3-150
Red LED
Green
LED
Status
Action
Off
Off
On
Off
Replace board.
Replace board.
Error detected on board. Board is deactivated (not applicable to errors detected by test loops) or board was deactivated using HiPath 3000
Manager E.
Flashing
Off
Off
On
Off
Flashing
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Peripheral Boards
Cable and Connector Assignment (Backplane, MDFU/MDFU-E, Patch Panel) (Not for U.S.)
Table 3-74
Color
Group
Pair
2
3
4
5
6
7
2
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
4
Color
Group
b-Wire
SU
Conn.
SLMO8,
SLMO24
BP: Xx8
1
a-Wire
SLMO8 and SLMO24 - Cable 1 Assignment (SU Xx8) (Not for U.S.)
16
Pair
wht/blu
blu/wht
wht/ora
ora/wht
wht/grn
grn/wht
wht/brn
brn/wht
wht/gry
gry/wht
red/blu
blu/red
red/ora
ora/red
red/grn
grn/red
red/brn
brn/red
red/gry
gry/red
blk/blu
blu/blk
blk/ora
ora/blk
blk/grn
grn/blk
blk/brn
brn/blk
blk/gry
gry/blk
1a
39
1b
38
2a
48
2b
27
3a
47
3b
16
4a
46
4b
05
5a
45
5b
14
6a
44
6b
23
7a
43
7b
32
8a
42
8b
11
9a
31
9b
02
10a
22
10b
13
11a
33
11b
04
12a
24
12b
15
13a
35
13b
06
14a
26
14b
17
15a
37
15b
08
16a
blu/yel
28
16b
b-Wire
SU
Conn.
yel/blu
a-Wire
19
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
BP: Xx8
Access 1
Access 2
Access 3
Access 4
Access 5
Access 6
Access 7
Access 8
Access 9
Access 10
Access 11
Access 12
Access 13
Access 14
Access 15
Access 16
SLMO8,
SLMO24
MDFU/
MDFU-E
Patch
Panel,
MW8 Pin
1a
1b
2a
2b
3a
3b
4a
4b
5a
5b
6a
6b
7a
7b
8a
8b
9a
9b
10a
10b
11a
11b
12a
12b
13a
13b
14a
14b
15a
15b
16a
16b
MDFU/
MDFU-E
Patch
Panel,
MW8 Pin
Notes
not
used
by
SLMO8
Notes
3-151
Boards
Peripheral Boards
Table 3-75
Color
Group
Pair
2
3
4
5
6
7
2
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
4
Color
Group
3-152
b-Wire
SU
Conn.
SLMO8,
SLMO24
BP: Xx9
1
a-Wire
SLMO8 and SLMO24 - Cable 2 Assignment (SU Xx9) (Not for U.S.)
16
Pair
wht/blu
wht/ora
wht/grn
wht/brn
wht/gry
red/blu
red/ora
red/grn
blk/grn
grn/blk
blk/brn
brn/blk
blk/gry
gry/blk
a-Wire
11
17a
31
17b
02
18a
22
18b
13
19a
33
19b
04
20a
24
20b
15
21a
35
21b
06
22a
26
22b
17
23a
37
23b
08
24a
blu/yel
28
24b
b-Wire
SU
Conn.
yel/blu
19a
free
grn/red
ora/blk
18b
free
ora/red
blu/blk
free
blu/red
blk/ora
18a
free
gry/wht
blk/blu
17b
free
brn/wht
gry/red
free
grn/wht
brn/red
17a
Notes
free
ora/wht
red/gry
Patch
Panel,
MW8 Pin
free
blu/wht
red/brn
MDFU/
MDFU-E
BP: Xx9
Access 17
Access 18
Access 19
Access 20
Access 21
Access 22
Access 23
Access 24
SLMO8,
SLMO24
19b
20a
20b
21a
21b
22a
22b
23a
23b
24a
24b
MDFU/
MDFU-E
Patch
Panel,
MW8 Pin
not
used
by
SLMO8
Notes
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Peripheral Boards
a-Wire
b-Wire
wht/blu
blu/wht
wht/ora
ora/wht
wht/grn
grn/wht
wht/brn
brn/wht
wht/gry
gry/wht
red/blu
blu/red
red/ora
ora/red
red/grn
grn/red
red/brn
brn/red
red/gry
gry/red
blk/blu
blu/blk
blk/ora
ora/blk
blk/grn
grn/blk
blk/brn
brn/blk
blk/gry
gry/blk
yel/blu
blu/yel
SLMO24
Xx9
19
1a
39
1b
38
2a
48
2b
27
3a
47
3b
16
4a
46
4b
05
5a
45
5b
14
6a
44
6b
23
7a
43
7b
32
8a
42
8b
11
9a
31
9b
02
10a
22
10b
13
11a
33
11b
04
12a
24
12b
15
13a
35
13b
06
14a
26
14b
17
15a
37
15b
08
16a
28
16b
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Port 1
Port 2
Port 3
Port 4
Port 5
Port 6
Port 7
Port 8
Port 9
Port 10
Port 11
Port 12
Port 13
Port 14
Port 15
Port 16
1 a/Ring
26
1 b/Tip
2 a/Ring
27
2 b/Tip
3 a/Ring
28
3 b/Tip
4 a/Ring
29
4 b/Tip
5 a/Ring
30
5 b/Tip
6 a/Ring
31
6 b/Tip
7 a/Ring
32
7 b/Tip
8 a/Ring
33
8 b/Tip
9 a/Ring
34
9 b/Tip
10
10 a/Ring
35
10 b/Tip
11
11 a/Ring
36
11 b/Tip
12
12 a/Ring
37
12 b/Tip
13
13 a/Ring
38
13 b/Tip
14
14 a/Ring
39
14 b/Tip
15
15 a/Ring
40
15 b/Tip
16
16 a/Ring
41
16 b/Tip
Notes
3-153
Boards
Peripheral Boards
Table 3-76
#
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
3-154
a-Wire
b-Wire
red/brn
brn/red
red/gry
gry/red
blk/blu
blu/blk
blk/ora
ora/blk
blk/grn
grn/blk
blk/brn
brn/blk
blk/gry
gry/blk
yel/blu
blu/yel
Xx9
SLMO24
11
17a
31
17b
02
18a
22
18b
13
19a
33
19b
04
20a
24
20b
15
21a
35
21b
06
22a
26
22b
17
23a
37
23b
08
24a
28
24b
Port 17
Port 18
Port 19
Port 20
Port 21
Port 22
Port 23
Port 24
9 a/Ring
34
9 b/Tip
10
10 a/Ring
35
10 b/Tip
11
11 a/Ring
36
11 b/Tip
12
12 a/Ring
37
12 b/Tip
13
13 a/Ring
38
13 b/Tip
14
14 a/Ring
39
14 b/Tip
15
15 a/Ring
40
15 b/Tip
16
16 a/Ring
41
16 b/Tip
Notes
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Peripheral Boards
3.3.12 SLU8
Introduction
The SLU8 board provides the HiPath 3550 and HiPath 3350 with 8 digital subscriber
line interfaces, allowing up to 16 digital telephones in host-client operation (primarysecondary operation).
Interfaces
50
1
UP0/E ports
1-4
X2
8
SLU8
1
UP0/E ports
5-8
Figure 3-64
To
X1
CUP/
CUC
X3
8
Caution
After disconnecting the system electrical plug, you must wait a few minutes before
you remove or insert the SLU8. Otherwise, you may damage the CBCC/CBCP.
Table 3-77
Pin
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
X3 (UP0/E Ports 5 to 8)
a5
b5
a6
b6
a7
b7
a8
b8
3-155
Boards
Peripheral Boards
Table 3-78
Pin
X2 (UPo/E ports 1 to 4)
X3 (UP0/E ports 5 to 8)
R1
R5
T1
T5
R2
R6
T2
T6
R3
R7
T3
T7
R4
R8
T4
T8
Note: Pinouts shown are at the board itself. The supplied main distribution frame cable (MDF cable) reverses the signal order before the MDF.
3-156
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Peripheral Boards
3.3.13 SLU8R
Introduction
The SLU8R (subscriber line UP0/E rack) board provides eight ports for the connection
of optiset E and optiPoint 500 Telephones to HiPath 3500 and HiPath 3300 (19-inch
housing).
Interfaces
UP0/E1
11
50
X1
UP0/E ports
18
(8-pole MW8
jacks)
X2
2
To
CUPR
CUCR
88
UP0/E8
Figure 3-65
SLU8R Interfaces(S30817-K922-Z301)
Table 3-79
MW8
Jack
X2, Pin
UP0/E Ports
1-4
MW8
Jack
X2, Pin
UP0/E Ports
5-8
14
Tip/a 1
54
Tip/a 5
15
Ring/b 1
55
Ring/b 5
24
Tip/a 2
64
Tip/a 6
25
Ring/b 2
65
Ring/b 6
34
Tip/a 3
74
Tip/a 7
35
Ring/b 3
75
Ring/b 7
44
Tip/a 4
84
Tip/a 8
45
Ring/b 4
85
Ring/b 8
2
3
4
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
6
7
8
3-157
Boards
Peripheral Boards
>
The STLS2 or STLS4 does not supply terminals with power; power must be supplied locally using an optiset E local power supply or a bus power supply unit.
50
S0 ports
MW6
2
Not with
STLS2
To
CUP/
CUC
X1
X2
4
2
654321
Port example
2 = SX +
3 = SR +
4 = SR 5 = SX -
SX = Signal transmit
SR = Signal receive
Figure 3-66
3-158
Boards
Peripheral Boards
Port
Pin
Signal transmit
Signal receive
Signal receive
Signal transmit
Signal transmit
Signal transmit
Signal transmit
Signal receive
Signal receive
Signal transmit
2
3
4
3
4
5
Port
Assignment
Signal transmit
Signal receive
Signal receive
Signal receive
Signal receive
Signal transmit
Note: The STLS4 Module serves the trunk side in Europe, so the transmit and receive signals must be reversed before the first device on the S0 bus. In contrast, the
optiset E ISDN adapter uses a straight-through connection because it is always a station-only device. See Figure 3-68 on page 3-161 for details.
The ISDN terminals must have their own local power supply. Refer to Section 9.10.1
for information on setting up an S0 bus.
The system assigns the MSN only after the S0 port is configured on the Euro-bus (not
for U.S.) and can be read out via the administration (Manager T: code 20 4 3 S0 bus
MSN).
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-159
Boards
Peripheral Boards
Connect the provided, silver-satin connector cord to each port on the STLS4
Module. Connect the other end to a surface-mounted MW jack, reversing the
transmit and receive wires as shown in Figure 3-68 on page 3-161.
Contact is always established using the center pins of MW jacks. Figure 3-67
shows the pin assignments for jacks of different sizes.
The ISDN terminals must have their own local power supply. Refer to Section
9.10.1 for information on setting up an S0 bus.
Plug the ISDN terminal (connecting cord) into the MW jack. Connecting an ISDN
S0 telephone requires a local power supply (e.g. manufactured by Sedlbauer);
see Figure 9-18 on page 9-31.
6-pin MW6
6
SR SX SX SR
4-pin MW4
3
SR SX SX SR
3-160
SR SX SX SR
SX = signal transmit
SR = signal receive
Figure 3-67
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Peripheral Boards
ISDN adapter in
optiset E telephone
Through-jack on silver-satin
connector cord MW6
(6-pin)
123
456
789
0
ABC
DEF
ABC
DEF
GHI
JKL
MNO
GHIMNO
PQRS
TUV
WXYZ
PQRS
TUV
SX SR SR SX
6
1
SR SX SX SR
Surface-Mounted MW8
jack (8-pin)
Cross the transmit and receive wires from the STLS
port (not required in S0 bus
from ISDN adapter).
Device jack 1
(8-pin MW8)
Device jacks 1 to 7
(8-pin MW8)
Device jack 2
(8-pin MW8)
8
100 /0.25 W
Terminating resistors in
the last jack
Figure 3-68
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-161
Boards
Peripheral Boards
3.3.15 STLS4R
Introduction
The STLS4R (subscriber and trunk line S0 rack) board provides four S0 basic accesses for HiPath 3500 and HiPath 3300 (19-inch housing). These are operated either as
external trunk interfaces in TE (terminal equipment) mode or as internal S0 buses
(bus PMP) in NT (network terminator) mode with cross-connected RX-TX lines.
>
The STLS4R does not supply terminals with power; power must be supplied locally
using an optiset E local power supply or a bus power supply unit.
Interfaces
S0-Port 1
11
4 S0 ports
(MW8 (RJ49)
jacks)
50
X2
S0 port 4
STLS4R
X1
To
CUPR
CUCR
48
Figure 3-69
3-162
...
3 = SX +
4 = SR +
5 = SR
6 = SX
SX = Signal transmit
SR = Signal receive
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Peripheral Boards
Table 3-81
X2, Pin
13
S0 port 1 transmit+
14
S0 port 1 receive+
15
S0 port 1 receive
16
S0 port 1 transmit
23
S0 port 2 transmit+
24
S0 port 2 receive+
25
S0 port 2 receive
26
S0 port 2 transmit
33
S0 port 3 transmit+
34
S0 port 3 receive+
35
S0 port 3 receive
36
S0 port 3 transmit
43
S0 port 4 transmit+
44
S0 port 4 receive+
45
S0 port 4 receive
46
S0 port 4 transmit
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
S0 Ports 1-4
3-163
Boards
Peripheral Boards
3.3.16 STMD8
Introduction
The STMD8 board (subscriber and trunk module digital S0) provides eight S0 ports
in HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700, which can be used
for an S0 Bus for Connecting ISDN Telephones (Not for U.S.) (separate power
supply required)
H300
LEDs
H301
.
.
.
.
H308
Lockout switch
S300
Figure 3-70
3-164
1
:
:
8
On
STMD8 (S30810-Q2558-X200)
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Peripheral Boards
Table 3-82
LED Status
(on/off)
Meaning
Action
Replace board
Flashing
(100/100 ms)
On
Loading in progress
Flashing
(100/100 ms)
Off
Board loaded
Flashing
(500/500 ms)
Replace board
During Operation
On
Flickering
(450/50 ms)
Flashing
(500/500 ms)
Off
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-165
Boards
Peripheral Boards
>
Table 2-8 on page 2-23 lists examples of maximum line lengths for connecting
trunks.
HiPath 3750
Public network
MDFU cable
STMD8
(Cablu)
Figure 3-71
MDFU or
MDFU-E
NT
1TX
1RX
1TX
1RX
NT (network termination):
the connection depends on the
country-specific NT
S0 basic
access 1
Figure 3-72
>
3-166
MDFU or MDFU-E
S0 basic
access 2
......
STMD8
Not for U.S.: When starting up S0 ports during operation with PABXs, it is important
to ensure that the NT switch is in the POINT-TO-POINT position.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Peripheral Boards
Point-to-multipoint connection
You can connect HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 on an ISDN multi-device connection (S0 bus) to the central office, allowing you to use it simultaneously with other
ISDN devices on the same connection.
Note the following:
The phone company assigns an 11-digit DID number (MSN or multiple subscriber number) for telephones to be connected to the S0 bus. There are usually at least three MSNs per basic access.
When setting the system-wide ISDN parameters, select DSS1 trunk PMP
under Port configuration (code 20 4 1) for the port you are using.
Enter the MSN in the table for DID numbers. For each MSN assigned, callers
can directly dial a station, group, or hunt group in the HiPath 3750 and HiPath
3700 system.
Always configure HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 as the last station on the S0
bus because terminating resistors (2 x 100 ) are permanently installed in
the trunk connection of the communications server. Remove any terminating
resistors from the last socket.
Point-to-point connection
Use a point-to-point connection if you have a dedicated line (trunk/tie circuit) or
to extend the range if only one telephone is connected to the S0 bus.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-167
Boards
Peripheral Boards
>
For examples of the maximum cable lengths for direct CorNet-N networking, refer
to Table 2-8 on page 2-23.
HiPath 3000 or
HiPath 4000
HiPath 3750
4
STMD8
MDFU or
MDFU-E
MDFU or
MDFU-E
STMD8
S0
HiPath 3000 or
HiPath 4000
HiPath 3750
2
STMD8
MDFU or
MDFU-E
NT
NT
MDFU or
MDFU-E
STMD8
HiPath 3000 or
HiPath 4000
HiPath 3750
STMD8
MDFU or
MDFU-E
NT
NT
MDFU or
MDFU-E
STMD8
Fixed lines using a public network (NT connection in accordance with Figure 3-72)
MDFU cable (Cablu)
Figure 3-73
3-168
Boards
Peripheral Boards
HiPath 3750
S0 bus
MDFU or
MDFU-E
STMD8
MDFU cable
(Cablu)
Max.10 m
(32 ft.)
ISDN terminal
Maximum of 8 terminals
Max.10 m
(32 ft.)
ISDN terminal
Max.10 m
(32 ft.)
S0 bus to the STMD8 via the MDFU or MDFU-E (Not for U.S.)
ISDN terminal
6-pin MW6
1
SR SX SX SR
SR SX SX SR
4-pin MW4
4
SR SX SX SR
Figure 3-75
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-169
Boards
Peripheral Boards
From MDFU or
patch panel
Wall outlet
8
UAE
connector
SR SX SX SR
6
S0 power
supply unit
(Sedlbauer AG)
4
3
2nd8th MW8
jacks
>
3-170
ISDN boards can also be connected to available optiPoint 500 series telephones
(except for optiPoint 500 entry and optiPoint 500 economy) using an optiPoint ISDN
adapter.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Peripheral Boards
Cable and Connector Assignment (Backplane, MDFU/MDFU-E, Patch Panel) (Not for U.S.)
Table 3-83
Color
Group
SU Conn.
Pair
2
3
4
5
6
7
2
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
Color
Group
a-Wire
b-Wire
STMD8
BP: Xx8
16
wht/blu
blu/wht
wht/ora
ora/wht
wht/grn
grn/wht
wht/brn
brn/wht
wht/gry
gry/wht
red/blu
blu/red
red/ora
ora/red
red/grn
grn/red
red/brn
brn/red
red/gry
gry/red
blk/blu
blu/blk
blk/ora
ora/blk
blk/grn
grn/blk
blk/brn
brn/blk
blk/gry
gry/blk
yel/blu
blu/yel
19
39
38
48
27
47
16
46
05
45
14
44
23
43
32
42
11
31
02
22
13
33
04
24
15
35
06
26
17
37
08
28
1Ea
1Eb
1Sa
1Sb
2Ea
2Eb
2Sa
2Sb
3Ea
3Eb
3Sa
3Sb
4Ea
4Eb
4Sa
4Sb
5Ea
5Eb
5Sa
5Sb
6Ea
6Eb
6Sa
6Sb
7Ea
7Eb
7Sa
7Sb
8Ea
8Eb
8Sa
8Sb
Basic
access 1
Basic
access 2
Basic
access 3
Basic
access 4
Basic
access 5
Basic
access 6
Basic
access 7
Basic
access 8
SU Conn.
Pair
a-Wire
b-Wire
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
STMD8
BP: Xx8
S0 Patch Panel,
MW8 Pin
MDFU/
MDFU-E Subscriber
Trunk
Line
Connection
1a
3
4
1b
6
5
2a
4
3
2b
5
6
3a
3
4
3b
6
5
4a
4
3
4b
5
6
5a
3
4
5b
6
5
6a
4
3
6b
5
6
7a
3
4
7b
6
5
8a
4
3
8b
5
6
9a
3
4
9b
6
5
10a
4
3
10b
5
6
11a
3
4
11b
6
5
12a
4
3
12b
5
6
13a
3
4
13b
6
5
14a
4
3
14b
5
6
15a
3
4
15b
6
5
16a
4
3
16b
5
6
S0 Patch Panel,
MW8 Pin
MDFU/
MDFU-E Subscriber
Trunk
Line
Connection
3-171
Boards
Peripheral Boards
a-Wire
b-Wire
wht/blu
blu/wht
wht/ora
ora/wht
wht/grn
grn/wht
wht/brn
brn/wht
wht/gry
gry/wht
red/blu
blu/red
red/ora
ora/red
red/grn
grn/red
red/brn
brn/red
red/gry
gry/red
blk/blu
blu/blk
blk/ora
ora/blk
blk/grn
grn/blk
blk/brn
brn/blk
blk/gry
gry/blk
yel/blu
blu/yel
STMD8
Xx8
19
1Ra
39
1Rb
38
1Sa
48
1 Receive
26
1 Receive +
1 Transmit
1Sb
27
1 Transmit +
27
2Ra
2 Receive
47
2Rb
28
2 Receive +
16
2Sa
2 Transmit
46
2Sb
29
2 Transmit +
05
3Ra
3 Receive
45
3Rb
30
3 Receive +
14
3Sa
3 Transmit
44
3Sb
31
3 Transmit +
23
4Ra
4 Receive
43
4Rb
32
4 Receive +
32
4Sa
4 Transmit
42
4Sb
33
4 Transmit +
11
5Ra
5 Receive
31
5Rb
34
5 Receive +
02
5Sa
10
5 Transmit
22
5Sb
35
5 Transmit +
13
6Ra
11
6 Receive
33
6Rb
36
6 Receive +
04
6Sa
12
6 Transmit
24
6Sb
37
6 Transmit +
15
7Ra
13
7 Receive
35
7Rb
38
7 Receive +
06
7Sa
14
7 Transmit
26
7Sb
39
7 Transmit +
17
8Ra
15
8 Receive
37
8Rb
40
8 Receive +
08
8Sa
16
8 Transmit
28
8Sb
41
8 Transmit +
Port 1
Port 2
Port 3
Port 4
Port 5
Port 6
Port 7
Port 8
Notes
3-172
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Peripheral Boards
ISDN adapter
in optiset E
telephone
SR
SX
SX
SR
1
2
4
53
6
78
09
ABC
DEF
ABC
DEF
GHI
JKL
MNO
GHI
MNO
PQRS
TUV
WXYZ
PQRS
TUV
1
2
3
4
5
6
STMD8 port on
MDF (port 1 shown)
SX 2
SX 27
SR 1
SR 26
.
.
.
Figure 3-77
MW8 Jack 1
(8-pin)
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
MW8 Jack 2
(8-pin)
100 /0.25 W
Terminating resisMW8 Jacks 2 to 7 tors in the last jack
(8-pin)
MW8 Jack 1
(8-pin)
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
S0 Bus Wiring From STMD8 Port or ISDN adapter (for U.S. Only)
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-173
Boards
Peripheral Boards
3.3.17 TIEL
Introduction
The TIEL board (tie line E & M) provides four analog tie trunk circuits for E&M signaling for HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700. The circuits can be configured for one- or twoway operation. They convert incoming analog signals into PCM (pulse-code modulation) signals and convert outgoing PCM signals into analog signals for tie-trunk traffic.
Speech Paths
The speech paths can be set to four-wire or two-wire mode. Four-wire connections
should be used for high transmission quality on analog networks (this description
deals only with four-wire mode).
The advantage of separate speech paths for the incoming and outgoing directions is
that the stability (echo) of a connection is not adversely affected. In addition, repeaters in the transmission equipment compensate for attenuation loss on the line.
E&M Signaling Paths
The E&M signaling paths carry the signals that control connection setup and cleardown. Various interfaces can be selected, depending on the requirements of the remote system or transmission equipment. These interface types have different numbers of wires and different potentials.
Starting Up a Tie Trunk
Before you can start up a tie trunk, you must determine the type of interface supported by the two systems. Type 2 is preferable because it virtually excludes problems
with longitudinal voltages.
3-174
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Peripheral Boards
>
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-175
Boards
Peripheral Boards
Interface Specifications
Transmit path
Four-wire transmit level
-3.5 dBr
-3.5 dBr
Characteristic impedance
600 ohms
Frequency range
Signaling
Type of E&M interface (programmable)
1, 1A, 1B, 2, 3, 5
Protocols
To ANSI/EIA/TIA-464-A, configurable
Immediate start
Wink signal
Delay signal
Signaling method
DP or DTMF
3-176
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Peripheral Boards
H0
LEDs
H1
H2
H3
Lockout switches:
DIP-FIX switches
(factory default):
S1/1
:
S1/8
S1/1 to 4:
Up = in service
Down = out of service
23
4 2356
S202
S104
23
2356
1 4
S203
v S204
2356
2356
S302
S304
2356
1 4
23
1
2356
1 4
S403
S402
S404
2356
S303
Figure 3-78
S103
S1/5 to 8 = factory
testing
S102
23
2356
TIEL (S30810-Q2520-X)
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-177
Boards
Peripheral Boards
Circuit 2
Circuit 3
Circuit 4
Type 1
(Figure 3-79)
S103
1-2
4-6
1-2
S203
1-3
4-6
1-2
S203
S203
S102
1-3
4-5
1-2
S103
S102
S103
S102
Type 1A
(Figure 3-80)
S103
S102
Type 1B or 5
(Figure 3-81)
Type 2
(Figure 3-82
and
Figure 3-83)
S103
1-2
4-6
1-2
S303
1-3
4-6
1-2
S303
S303
S202
1-3
4-5
1-2
Open
1-2
S203
S202
1-2
4-6
1-3
S203
S202
S202
1-2
4-6
1-2
S403
1-3
4-6
1-2
S403
S403
S302
1-3
4-5
1-2
S402
1-3
4-5
1-2
Open
1-2
S303
S302
Open
1-2
S403
S402
Open
1-2
1-2
4-6
1-3
S303
1-2
4-6
1-3
S403
1-2
4-6
1-3
S302
S302
S402
S402
1-2
4-6
1-2
1-3
4-6
1-2
(factory default)
Type 3
S102
S202
S302
S402
2-wire speech
lines
S104
1-3
4-6
S204
1-3
4-6
S304
1-3
4-6
S404
1-3
4-6
4-wire speech
lines
S104
1-2
4-5
S204
1-2
4-5
S304
1-2
4-5
S404
1-2
4-5
(factory default)
3-178
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Peripheral Boards
>
The following maximum ranges (without converter) must be taken into account:
2-wire speech: 6 km (3.75 miles) with 0.6 mm diameter (22 AWG) wire
TIEL
- 48 V
1E
1E
1M
1M
1ka
1kb
1ga
1gb
1ga
1gb
1ka
1kb
- 48 V
1
2356
CCT 1: S103
CCT 2: S203
CCT 3: S303
CCT 4: S403
23
S102
S202
S302
S402
System A
Figure 3-79
2356
CCT 1: S103
CCT 2: S203
CCT 3: S303
CCT 4: S403
23
S102
S202
S302
S402
System B
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-179
Boards
Peripheral Boards
TIEL
- 48 V
- 48 V
1
2356
CCT 1: S103
CCT 2: S203
CCT 3: S303
CCT 4: S403
Figure 3-80
3-180
23
2356
CCT 1: S103
CCT 2: S203
CCT 3: S303
CCT 4: S403
S102
S202
S302
S402
23
S102
S202
S302
S402
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Peripheral Boards
TIEL
- 48 V
2356
CCT 1: S103
CCT 2: S203
CCT 3: S303
CCT 4: S403
Figure 3-81
- 48 V
23
2356
S102
S202
S302
S402
CCT 1: S103
CCT 2: S203
CCT 3: S303
CCT 4: S403
23
S102
S202
S302
S402
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-181
Boards
Peripheral Boards
TIEL
- 48 V
SG
M
SB
1
2356
CCT 1: S103
CCT 2: S203
CCT 3: S303
CCT 4: S403
Figure 3-82
3-182
- 48 V
SG
M
SB
23
2356
S102
S202
S302
S402
CCT 1: S103
CCT 2: S203
CCT 3: S303
CCT 4: S403
23
S102
S202
S302
S402
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Peripheral Boards
E&M Interface Type 2 Circuit Diagram, MDFU or MDFU-E Numbering (Not for U.S.)
TIEL
Circuit 1, E&M interface type 2
4 speech wires
2
S104
2356
b1
S104
1
1
a2
S104
6
b2
Optocoupler
E
150
- 48 V
1
5
9T
13T
Outgoing
speech
1R
5R
9R
13R
2T
6T
10T 14T
Incoming
speech
2R
6R
10R 14R
3T
7T
11T 15T
Incoming
signaling
SG
3R
7R
11R 15R
4T
8T
12T 16T
3
k101
2
3 S103
Outgoing
signaling
27
SB
5T
120
2.4 k
S102
1T
Notes
4R
8R
12R 16R
PTC
- 48 V
Figure 3-83
E&M Interface Type 2 Circuit Diagram, MDFU or MDFU-E Numbering (Not for U.S.)
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-183
Boards
Peripheral Boards
TIELLED Statuses
LED status
(on/off)
Meaning
Action
Replace board.
Flashing
(100/100 ms)
On
Flashing
(100/100 ms)
Off
Board loaded
Flashing
(500/500 ms)
Replace board.
During Operation
3-184
On
Circuit seized
Flashing in ring
cadence
Flickering
(450/50 ms)
Flashing (500/
500 ms)
Circuit out of service (e.g. S1/ Check whether the circuit was
x in on position)
deactivated with HiPath 3000
Manager E or lockout switch.
Off
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Peripheral Boards
Cable and Connector Assignment (Backplane, MDFU/MDFU-E, Patch Panel) (Not for U.S.)
>
Table 3-87
Color
Group
Pair
a-Wire
blu/wht
wht/ora
ora/wht
wht/grn
grn/wht
wht/brn
brn/wht
wht/gry
gry/wht
red/blu
blu/red
red/ora
TIEL
BP: Xx8
wht/blu
SU
Connector
ora/red
red/grn
grn/red
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
MDFU/
MDFU-E
Patch
Panel,
MW8 Pin
Notes
19
1ka
1a
Ring
39
1kb
1b
Tip
38
1ga
2a
Ring
48
1gb
2b
Tip
27
1E
3a
Ear
47
1SG
3b
System
ground
16
1M
4a
Mouth
46
1SB
4b
System
battery
05
2ka
5a
Ring
45
2kb
5b
Tip
14
2ga
6a
Ring
44
2gb
6b
Tip
23
2E
7a
Ear
43
2SG
7b
System
ground
32
2M
8a
Mouth
42
2SB
8b
System
battery
Port
1
Port
2
Transmit
with 4-wire
speech
Transmit +
receive with
2-wire
speech
Signal wires
Transmit
with 4-wire
speech
Transmit +
receive with
2-wire
speech
Signal wires
3-185
Boards
Peripheral Boards
Table 3-87
Color
Group
Pair
a-Wire
brn/red
10
red/gry
gry/red
blk/blu
11
blu/blk
blk/ora
12
ora/blk
blk/grn
13
14
grn/blk
blk/brn
brn/blk
blk/gry
15
gry/blk
yel/blu
3-186
TIEL
BP: Xx8
red/brn
SU
Connector
16
blu/yel
MDFU/
MDFU-E
Patch
Panel,
MW8 Pin
Notes
11
3ka
9a
Ring
31
3kb
9b
Tip
02
3ga
10a
Ring
22
3gb
10b
Tip
13
3E
11a
Ear
33
3SG
11b
System
ground
04
3M
12a
Mouth
24
3SB
12b
System
battery
15
4ka
13a
Ring
35
4kb
13b
Tip
06
4ga
14a
Ring
26
4gb
14b
Tip
17
4E
15a
Ear
37
4SG
15b
System
ground
08
4M
16a
Mouth
28
4SB
16b
System
battery
Port
3
Port
4
Transmit
with 4-wire
speech
Transmit +
receive with
2-wire
speech
Signal wires
Transmit
with 4-wire
speech
Transmit +
receive with
2-wire
speech
Signal wires
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Peripheral Boards
a-Wire
b-Wire
TIEL
Notes
Xx8
wht/blu
1
2
3
4
blu/wht
wht/ora
ora/wht
wht/grn
grn/wht
wht/brn
brn/wht
wht/gry
6
7
8
gry/wht
red/blu
blu/red
red/ora
ora/red
red/grn
grn/red
red/brn
10
11
12
brn/red
red/gry
gry/red
blk/blu
blu/blk
blk/ora
ora/blk
19
1Ra
Ring
39
1Rb
26
Tip
38
1Sa
Ring 1
48
1Sb
27
Tip 1
27
2Ra
47
2Rb
28
System ground
16
2Sa
46
2Sb
29
System battery
05
3Ra
Ring
45
3Rb
30
Tip
14
3Sa
Ring 1
44
3Sb
31
Tip 1
23
4Ra
43
4Rb
32
System ground
32
4Sa
42
4Sb
33
System battery
11
5Ra
Ring
31
5Rb
34
Tip
02
5Sa
10
Ring 1
22
5Sb
35
Tip 1
13
6Ra
11
33
6Rb
36
System ground
04
6Sa
12
24
6Sb
37
System battery
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Port 1
Port 2
Port 3
Signal wires
Signal wires
Signal wires
3-187
Boards
Peripheral Boards
Table 3-88
#
a-Wire
b-Wire
TIEL
Notes
Xx8
blk/grn
13
14
15
16
grn/blk
blk/brn
brn/blk
blk/gry
gry/blk
yel/blu
blu/yel
15
7Ra
13
Ring
35
7Rb
38
Tip
06
7Sa
14
Ring 1
26
7Sb
39
Tip 1
17
8Ra
15
37
8Rb
40
System ground
08
8Sa
16
28
8Sb
41
System battery
Port 4
Signal wires
3-188
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Peripheral Boards
LS ports
14 to CO
(CO 3, 4
not for
TLA2)
8
1
X2
TLA2/4
50
to
CUP/
CUC
X3 (free)
X1
8
1
to GEE
module
X4
10
Figure 3-84
Table 3-89
Contact
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
Connector X2
a trunk 1
b trunk 1
a trunk 2
b trunk 2
a trunk 3
b trunk 3
a trunk 4
b trunk 4
Connector X4
GND for GEE50 FKR, otherwise free
b trunk 1
a trunk 1
b trunk 2
a trunk 2
b trunk 3
a trunk 3
b trunk 4
a trunk 4
Call charging module assignment (GMZ)
10
for TLA2 trunks 1 and 2 only
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-189
Boards
Peripheral Boards
The loop start board TLA8 connects 8 analog trunks using DP and DTMF signalling
in HiPath 3550 and HiPath 3350.
1
To GEE
module
LS ports
14 to CO
X3
10
1
8
LS ports
58 to CO
50
X2
TLA8
X1
1
X4
2
8
1
to GEE
module
to
CUP/
CUC
X5
10
Figure 3-85
Table 3-90
Contact
Conn. X3
Conn. X2
Conn. X4
Conn. X5
GND
a trunk1
a trunk5
GND
b trunk 1
b trunk 1
b trunk 5
b trunk 5
a trunk 1
a trunk 2
a trunk 6
a trunk 5
b trunk 2
b trunk 2
b trunk 6
b trunk 6
a trunk 2
a trunk 3
a trunk 7
a trunk 6
b trunk 3
b trunk 3
b trunk 7
b trunk 7
a trunk 3
a trunk 4
a trunk 8
a trunk 7
b trunk 4
b trunk 4
b trunk 8
b trunk 8
a trunk 4
a trunk 8
10
GMZ 1
GMZ 2
3-190
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Peripheral Boards
3.3.19 TLA4R
Introduction
The TLA4R (Trunk Line Analog Rack) board provides four ports for the analog trunk
connection (DP and DTMF signaling methods) on HiPath 3500 and HiPath 3300 (19
housing). There are also two ALUM power failure transfers.
The transmission and function-oriented characteristics of the TLA4R are completely
identical to those of the TLA boards that are used in HiPath 3550 and HiPath 3350,
except for
the call metering receiving equipment interface, which is only on the TLA boards.
Interfaces
8 MW8
sockets
Trunk 1
:
:
Trunk 4
50
11
18
21
:
X1
X5
ALUM
to
CUPR
CUCR
1+2
88
Figure 3-86
Table 3-91
MW8 socket
X5, pin
14
a trunk 1
15
b trunk 1
24
a trunk 2
25
b trunk 2
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-191
Boards
Peripheral Boards
Table 3-91
3
34
a trunk 3
35
b trunk 3
44
a trunk 4
45
b trunk 4
MW8 socket
X5, pin
ALUM 1 + 2
54
TB1
55
TA1
64
TB2
65
TA2
74
BE1
75
AE1
84
BE2
85
AE2
6
7
8
3-192
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Peripheral Boards
LEDs
H0 (green)
:
:
:
:
H7
0
:
:
7
H100 (yellow)
On
Lockout switch S501
(factory default)
Figure 3-87
TMAMF (S30810-Q2587-Axxx)
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-193
Boards
Peripheral Boards
Data bits = 8
Stop bit = 1
Parity = none
5 4 3 2 1
6 7 8 9
9 8 7 6
1
2
3
5
Figure 3-88
3-194
1
3
2
5
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Peripheral Boards
Table 3-92
LED Status
(On/Off)
Meaning
Action
Flashing
(250/250 ms)
On
During Operation
Off
Flashing
(250/250 ms)
On
Table 3-93
LED Status
(On/Off)
Meaning
Action
During Operation
Off
On
Flashing
(500/500 ms)
Trunk out of service (e.g. S1/x Check whether the trunk was
closed)
deactivated using HiPath 3000
Manager E or the lockout switch.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-195
Boards
Peripheral Boards
Pair
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
Color
Group
Pair
3-196
a-Wire
wht/blu
blu/wht
wht/ora
ora/wht
wht/grn
grn/wht
wht/brn
brn/wht
wht/gry
gry/wht
red/blu
blu/red
red/ora
ora/red
red/grn
grn/red
red/brn
red/gry
19
1a
39
1b
38
2a
48
2b
27
3a
47
3b
16
4a
46
4b
05
5a
45
5b
14
6a
44
6b
23
7a
43
7b
32
8a
42
8b
31
02
gry/red
blk/blu
22
13
blu/blk
blk/ora
33
04
ora/blk
blk/grn
24
15
grn/blk
blk/brn
35
06
brn/blk
blk/gry
26
17
gry/blk
yel/blu
37
08
blu/yel
b-Wire
TMAMF
BP: Xx8
11
brn/red
a-Wire
SU Connector
28
SU Connector
BP: Xx8
Port 1
Port 2
Port 3
Port 4
Port 5
Port 6
Port 7
Port 8
1b
2a
2b
3a
3b
4a
4b
5a
5b
6a
6b
7a
7b
8a
8b
Notes
free
free
free
free
free
free
free
free
TMAMF
Notes
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Peripheral Boards
Display
25-pin SUB-D socket:
V24 interface for connecting the
service PC with ECGM tool
Lockout switch
(Setting = unlocked, factory default)
H1
X10
Battery
S1
Switch S4
1
Off
= default
Jumper
S2
3 2 1
S3
Figure 3-89
TMCAS (S30810-Q2938-X)
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-197
Boards
Peripheral Boards
Switch settings
S4-1
S4-2
Off
Off
100 ohms
On
Off
75 ohms
Off
On
No function
On
On
Switch
S4-3
S4-4
Off
Off
100 ohms
On
Off
75 ohms
Off
On
No function
On
On
3-198
Switch
Function
S4-5
Reserved
S4-6
S4-7
Reserved
S4-8
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Peripheral Boards
Jumper setting
S2 = 1 - 2, S3 = 1 - 2
S2 = 2 - 3
S3 = 2 - 3
Rx: Ground the cables shield on the side of the connected device (NT, MUX,
modem).
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-199
Boards
Peripheral Boards
Seven-Segment Display H1
The board statuses listed in the following table are displayed on H1.
Table 3-95
Display
3-200
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Peripheral Boards
X90
UPSM
X80
X70
X60
X50
X40
T
M
S
2
T
M
C
A
S
X30
X20
X88
X78
X68
X58
X48
X38
X28
X89
X79
X69
X59
X49
X39
X29
X10
CBCPR
TMCAS cable:
C39195-A9700-B512/B514, length = 10 m
Figure 3-90
Table 3-96
Function
Receive a-wire
Receive b-wire
Transmit a-wire
Transmit b-wire
+5 V for board detection
+5 V (reserved)
GND
page 3-203 has information on the assignments for the two C39195-A9700-B512/B514 TMCAS cables.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-201
Boards
Peripheral Boards
TMCAS
X2
X8, X9
TS2
TMCAS
X2
TS2
PSU/
USV
X8
X9
TMCAS cable:
C39195-A9700B512/-B514, length
= 10 m
Figure 3-91
Table 3-97
TS2
Wieland terminal X2,
pin
1, 2, 3
4
5
6
7
8
Function
TMCAS
SU connector X9,
pin
33
6
26
2
22
page 3-203 has information on the assignments for the two C39195-A9700-B512/B514 TMCAS cables.
3-202
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Peripheral Boards
Assignments for the Two TMCAS Cables for HiPath 3750, HiPath 3700, and HiPath 3550
You can use one of the two following cables to connect Network Terminator NT, Multiplexer MUX, or modem to the TMCAS board:
Table 3-98
Function
Color code
Receive a-wire
grn
22
Receive b-wire
blk
Transmit a-wire
red
26
Transmit b-wire
blk
Table 3-99
Function
Wire
Receive a-wire
22
Receive b-wire
Transmit a-wire
26
Transmit b-wire
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-203
Boards
Peripheral Boards
Action
1.
2.
Insert TMS2 (HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700) or TS2 (HiPath 3550).
3.
HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700: Insert TMCAS next to the TMS2, on the
left.
HiPath 3550 (wall housing): Insert TMCAS in slot 10.
4.
5.
6.
7.
After the system has booted, both boards are entered in the systems database (TMS2 or TS2 and TMCAS).
8.
Possible problems:
TMCAS not entered in HiPath 3000 Manager E
The TMCAS is displayed automatically after the generation/regeneration of the
database in a system with a correctly inserted and connected TMCAS-TMS2/
TS2 combination.
3-204
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Peripheral Boards
Database programming
Trace capability
Procedure
Step
Action
1.
2.
Set up the connection to the download server (the responsible ITSC can
provide you with information) and copy the following files into the directory
c:\ecginst:
v = software version
3.
Execute .exe files. This will extract the following files, for example:
Ecgm.cab (WinZip file)
4.
Execute Setup.exe file. This will create the directory ecgm and extract
various files.
5.
6.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-205
Boards
Peripheral Boards
3-206
Step
Action
7.
File/Options menu: select the service PCs COM interface (for example, COM1)
File/Install Software menu: Select file E1v0xx.pnm (for example, E140ah.pnm) from the directory ecginst.
8.
9.
Enter the COM interface under COMM and the customer name in the
Settings/ECG Name menu. All other windows are updated automatically.
10.
Channel configuration
Define the channel parameters in the View/Database menu (reserve unused channels with Out of Service):
Protocol
11.
Software download
If the seven-segment display H1 on the TMCAS displays H, it is necessary to download the extender software (Download/Extender menu).
Otherwise, continue with the next step.
12.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Peripheral Boards
H1 H2 H3 H4 H5 H6 H7 H8
T4
T3
S2
T8
Figure 3-92
A
Trunk 3
Trunk 4
T2
T7
T1
S1
Trunk 1
Trunk 2
T6
S4
Trunk 7
Trunk 8
A
G
T5
S3
Trunk 5
Trunk 6
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-207
Boards
Peripheral Boards
Switches
Adjust switches S1 to S4 to compensate for trunk loop resistance.
Table 3-100
Trunk
Status of LEDs 18
3-208
Meaning
Off
On
Channel is seized
Flashing
Channel is deactivated
Winking
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Peripheral Boards
a-Wire
b-Wire
TMDID8
Xx8
wht/blu
blu/wht
wht/ora
ora/wht
wht/grn
grn/wht
wht/brn
brn/wht
wht/gry
gry/wht
red/blu
blu/red
red/ora
ora/red
red/grn
grn/red
19
1a
39
1b
38
2a
48
2b
27
3a
47
3b
16
4a
46
4b
05
5a
45
5b
14
6a
44
6b
23
7a
43
7b
32
8a
42
8b
Port 1
Port 2
Port 3
Port 4
Port 5
Port 6
Port 7
Port 8
1 a/Ring
26
1 b/Tip
2 a/Ring
27
2 b/Tip
3 a/Ring
28
3 b/Tip
4 a/Ring
29
4 b/Tip
5 a/Ring
30
5 b/Tip
6 a/Ring
31
6 b/Tip
7 a/Ring
32
7 b/Tip
8 a/Ring
33
8 b/Tip
Notes
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-209
Boards
Peripheral Boards
Caution
You must disconnect the power and remove the slip-on connectors from the TMGL4
Module before removing it from the system.
Do not connect the slip-on connectors to the TMGL4 Module until the board is seated in its slot and the system power is on.
Failure to follow these instructions may severely damage the system.
Interfaces
50
1
X2
To trunks
TMGL4 Module
to
CUP/
CUC
X1
To ANI4
Figure 3-93
3-210
X3
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Peripheral Boards
Interface Assignments
Table 3-103
Pin
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
Connector X2
R trunk 1
T trunk 1
R trunk 2
T trunk 2
R trunk 3
T trunk 3
R trunk 4
T trunk 4
Port
1
2
3
4
Note: Pinouts shown are at the board itself. The supplied main distribution frame cable (MDF cable) reverses the signal order before the MDF.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-211
Boards
Peripheral Boards
To ANI4R
X1
X4 (4 MW4 sockets)
44
To GEE
>
3-212
50
11
To trunk 1
:
:
To trunk 4
Figure 3-94
X5 (MW10 socket)
to
CUPR
CUCR
X3
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Peripheral Boards
Interface Assignments
Table 3-104
Port
1
2
3
4
X3 Pin
(To GEE)
3
2
5
4
7
6
X4 Pin
(To trunks 1-4)
12
13
22
23
32
33
X5 Pin
(To ANI4R)
3
2
5
4
7
6
9
8
10
42
43
9
8
10
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Signal
Ring, trunk 1
Tip, trunk 1
Ring, trunk 2
Tip, trunk 2
Ring, trunk 3
Tip, trunk 3
Ring, trunk 4
Tip, trunk 4
Call charging module assignment
(GMZ)
3-213
Boards
Peripheral Boards
Switches
1
On
8
LEDs
H1
.
.
.
.
H8
Figure 3-95
Switches
The TMGL8 Module has an eight-path microswitch under a flip-up cover. For
each channel:
3-214
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Peripheral Boards
Status of LEDs 18
Meaning
Off
On
Channel is seized
Flashing
Channel is deactivated
Winking
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
a-Wire
b-Wire
TMGL8
Xx8
wht/blu
blu/wht
wht/ora
ora/wht
wht/grn
grn/wht
wht/brn
brn/wht
wht/gry
gry/wht
red/blu
blu/red
red/ora
ora/red
red/grn
grn/red
19
1a
39
1b
38
2a
48
2b
27
3a
47
3b
16
4a
46
4b
05
5a
45
5b
14
6a
44
6b
23
7a
43
7b
32
8a
42
8b
Port 1
Port 2
Port 3
Port 4
Port 5
Port 6
Port 7
Port 8
1 a/Ring
26
1 b/Tip
2 a/Ring
27
2 b/Tip
3 a/Ring
28
3 b/Tip
4 a/Ring
29
4 b/Tip
5 a/Ring
30
5 b/Tip
6 a/Ring
31
6 b/Tip
7 a/Ring
32
7 b/Tip
8 a/Ring
33
8 b/Tip
Notes
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-215
Boards
Peripheral Boards
On
Jumpers Insert(Circuit)
ed
Jumpers
(On specific board
variants
only)
LEDs
W650
W600
:
:
H101 (red)
W700 (1)
W703 (2)
W706 (3)
W709 (4)
W800 (5)
W803 (6)
W806 (7)
W809 (8)
W300
1
:
:
8
Jumpers
W700
W706
W800
W806
Figure 3-96
>
3-216
W703
W709
W803
W809
W650 (8)
W600 (7)
W550 (6)
W500 (5)
W450 (4)
W400 (3)
W350 (2)
W300 (1)
Call Detail
Recording
(GEE8)
Yes
16 kHz/50 Hz
No
12 kHz
Yes
Without
silent
reversal
No
With
silent
reversal
For Austria only: If a FS trunk is connected to the TML8W, remove the jumpers
(W300 to W650) to activate silent reversal.
If silent reversal is inactive, users in the HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 would hear a
busy signal following backward release instead of being released.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Peripheral Boards
Red LED
Green
LED
Status
Off
Off
On
Off
Replace board.
Replace board.
Flashing
Off
Off
On
Off
Flashing
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Action
3-217
Boards
Peripheral Boards
Cable and Connector Assignment (Backplane, MDFU/MDFU-E, Patch Panel) (Not for U.S.)
Table 3-108
Color
Group
Pair
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
Color
Group
Pair
3-218
a-Wire
wht/blu
blu/wht
wht/ora
ora/wht
wht/grn
grn/wht
wht/brn
brn/wht
wht/gry
gry/wht
red/blu
blu/red
red/ora
ora/red
red/grn
grn/red
red/brn
red/gry
19
1a
39
1b
38
2a
48
2b
27
3a
47
3b
16
4a
46
4b
05
5a
45
5b
14
6a
44
6b
23
7a
43
7b
32
8a
42
8b
31
02
gry/red
blk/blu
22
13
blu/blk
blk/ora
33
04
ora/blk
blk/grn
24
15
grn/blk
blk/brn
35
06
brn/blk
blk/gry
26
17
gry/blk
yel/blu
37
08
blu/yel
b-Wire
TML8W
BP: Xx8
11
brn/red
a-Wire
SU Connector
28
SU Connector
BP: Xx8
Port 1
Port 2
Port 3
Port 4
Port 5
Port 6
Port 7
Port 8
1b
2a
2b
3a
3b
4a
4b
5a
5b
6a
6b
7a
7b
8a
8b
Notes
free
free
free
free
free
free
free
free
TML8W
Notes
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Peripheral Boards
HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 may be equipped with a maximum of one TMOM.
Lockout switch S1
DIP-FIX switches S2, S3 for a/b port changeover for split, incoming, and outgoing
traffic with an 8-wire connection in accordance with ESPA 4.4.3.
DIP-FIX switch S4 for potential changeover for KX1 to KX16 relay contacts and
indicators 1 to 4 (not supported).
DIP-FIX switches S9, S10 for potential connection for relay contacts
KX1 to KX16 and indicators 1 to 4 (not supported)
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-219
Boards
Peripheral Boards
Switches on TMOM
LED
Lockout switch S1
up = in service
(factory default)
H1
S1
S2
K1V
K1DC
DIP-FIX switches:
S8 1
S7 1
S6 1
S5 1
Figure 3-97
>
3-220
3
2
K1M
S3
K1UE
K1P
K1I
3
2
Relay:
3 KX5
2
KX1
3 KX6
2
KX2
3
2 KX15
3 KX11
KX13
2 KX16
KX8
KX12
KX4
KX9
KX14
S4
S10
KX10
KX7
KX3
3
2
S9
1
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Peripheral Boards
PSE Interface
The following standards have be implemented for single-call and enhanced radio
paging equipment:
ESPA 4.4.3
a, b, c, d interface
Figure 3-98 shows a simplified representation of the PSE interface with all signals.
The type of signalling depends on the PSE type.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-221
Boards
Peripheral Boards
TMOMPSE Interface
A1 (ring) 1 a
B1 (tip) 1 b
A2 (ring) 5 a
B2 (tip) 5 b
PSE
C1 2 a
t
- 48 V
D1 2 b
0VK
- 48 V
M1H 4 b
0VK
M1L 4 a
0VK
E1H 3 b
0V
- 48 V
E1L 3 a
0VK
Figure 3-98
3-222
Boards
Peripheral Boards
LED State
(On/Off)
Meaning
Action
Replace board
Flashing
(100/100 ms)
On
Flashing
(100/100 ms)
Off
Board loaded
Flashing
(500/500 ms)
Replace board
During Operation
On
Board seized
Flashing in ring
cadence
Flickering
(450/50 ms)
Flashing
(500/500 ms)
Off
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-223
Boards
Peripheral Boards
Cable and Connector Assignment (Backplane, MDFU/MDFU-E, Patch Panel) (Not for U.S.)
Table 3-110
Color
Group
Pair
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
Color
Group
Pair
3-224
a-Wire
wht/blu
blu/wht
ora/wht
wht/grn
grn/wht
wht/brn
brn/wht
wht/gry
gry/wht
red/blu
blu/red
red/ora
ora/red
red/grn
grn/red
red/brn
brn/red
red/gry
gry/red
blk/blu
blu/blk
blk/ora
ora/blk
blk/grn
grn/blk
blk/brn
brn/blk
blk/gry
gry/blk
yel/blu
blu/yel
b-Wire
TMOM
BP: Xx8
19
wht/ora
a-Wire
SU Connector
1a
A1
39
1b
B1
1b
38
2a
C1
2a
48
2b
D1
2b
27
3a
E1L
3a
47
3b
E1H
3b
16
4a
M1L
4a
46
4b
M1H
4b
05
5a
A2
5a
45
5b
B2
5b
14
6a
44
6b
23
7a
43
7b
32
8a
42
8b
11
9a
31
9b
02
10a
22
10b
13
11a
33
11b
04
12a
24
12b
15
13a
35
13b
06
14a
26
14b
17
15a
37
15b
08
16a
28
16b
SU Connector
BP: Xx8
Notes
TMOM to PSE
interface
(see
Figure 3-98)
Relay
contacts
(not
supported)
TMOM
Notes
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Peripheral Boards
Interfaces
50
1
X2
To trunks
TMQ4 Module
To
CUP/
CUC
X1
Figure 3-99
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-225
Boards
Peripheral Boards
Interface Assignments
Table 3-111
Pin
Connector X2
R trunk 1
T trunk 1
R trunk 2
T trunk 2
Port
1
2
Pin
Connector X2
R trunk 3
T trunk 3
R trunk 4
T trunk 4
Port
3
4
Note: Pinouts shown are at the board itself. The supplied main distribution frame cable (MDF cable) reverses the signal order before the MDF.
3-226
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Peripheral Boards
SF
ESF
Service
switch
LEDs
Figure 3-100
Up = in service
Down = out of service
H1
H2
The TMST1 includes a service switch. The switch alerts the system software that the
Module will be removed so that no new calls are routed to the board.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-227
Boards
Peripheral Boards
3-228
Red LED
Green
LED
State
Action
Off
Off
On
Off
Replace board.
Replace board.
Flashing
Off
Off
On
Off
Flashing
On
On
Board error
Replace board.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Peripheral Boards
MW8 (RJ48C)
jack
(to the CSU or
networked
system)
SIPAC 1
SU jack
(Xx9 backplane)
Figure 3-101
Table 3-113
MW8
(RJ48C)
SIPAC 1 SU
jack
SU Connector Backplane
C2
22
Receive ring
E2
Receive tip
C6
26
Transmit ring
E6
Transmit tip
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
TMST1
Xx9
3-229
Boards
Peripheral Boards
S2M Networking
To support country-specific CAS protocols, you can use the Euro-ISDNCAS-Gateway ECG. The ECG cabinet is a protocol converter that converts the Euro-ISDN protocol into the Channel Associated Signaling CAS protocol. Refer to the installation instructions, which are provided with each ECG cabinet, for information on the
connection and power supply.
For HiPath 3000 V1.0 or later, you can also use the new TMCAS board to support
country-specific CAS protocols.
Switches and LEDs
LEDs
Lockout switch S1
up = in service
(factory default)
Jumpers
(setting = symm.
line 120 ohms,
factory default)
Figure 3-102
3-230
H1 (red)
H2 (green)
H3 (red)
S1
X302
1
2
3
X300
1
2
3
X301
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Peripheral Boards
Jumper Settings
The X300 or X302 jumpers are used to set the TMS2 interface for the connection of
this interface to NT1. The following can be set:
Table 3-114
TMS2
Interface
Jumper
X300
Jumper
X301
Jumper
X302
120 ohms =
factory default
2-3
2-3
2-3
75 ohms
1-2
1-2
1-2
SU Connector
Xx8/Xx91
Pin
Function
Cable S30267-Z57-Axxx
Color Code
Up to and Including Status 6
Status 7
or Later
grn
wht/ora
22
blk
ora/wht
red
wht/blu
26
blk
blu/wht
1 SU connector Xx8 is used for board status 4 or earlier, SU connector Xx9 for board status 5 or later
>
Note that the SU connector Xx9 was used in the old TMS2M board.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-231
Boards
Peripheral Boards
Table 3-116
3-232
Red
LED
Green
LED
State
Action
Off
Off
On
Off
Replace board.
Replace board.
Flashing
Off
Off
On
Off
Flashing
H3 LED (see Figure 3-102): Reference clock display (clock is generated if this
feature has been configured using HiPath 3000 Manager E.)
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Peripheral Boards
S30267-Z57-Axxx cable
Public network
NT
Observe the following when connecting NTs using the S30267-Z57-Axxx cable:
Keep the cable from the NT to HiPath 3750 or HiPath 3700 as short as possible
to ensure proper operation.
HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 must always be grounded (whether the line used
by the network provider is copper or optical fiber). (See 1 TR 211 item 2.4, Protective Measures and Grounding.). The diameter of the earth conductor must be
at least 2.5 mm2. Grounding the system using sheath wires is not sufficient. For
operating reasons, keep the ground connection from the NT to the system as
short as possible.
Caution
In order to guarantee successful operation, you must ensure that the NT is grounded on the network provider side.
Power feeding
The NT must be fed over the 48 V (max. 10 W, observe the power requirements
of the NTs) of the UPSM (see Figure 3-104).
The voltage is fed out on backplane connector X06 (pins 17 + 37 = 48 V). Use
the supplied Cablu to connect the system with the MDFU. This places the voltage
on pair no. 15 (= 48 V) of the splitting strip.
The delivery does not include a Cablu if the REAL board has been ordered or is
already being used (the necessary Cablu is included in the delivery of the ALUM
using REAL feature).
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-233
Boards
Peripheral Boards
- 48 V
X06
Cablu
MDFU
0V
- 48 V
Pair no. 15
UPSM
Earth
TMS2
NT
HiPath 3750,
HiPath 3700
Figure 3-104
S2MNT Connection
HiPath 3750 or HiPath 3700 (NT 2)
NT 1
Network
termination:
the connection
depends on
the countryspecific NT.
PE
Earth connection,
min. 2,5 mm2
a
b
Receive direction
Transmit direction
a
b
Shield
Backplane, connection to
Xx8
Xx9 (from board state 5)
Cable S30267-Z57-Axxx
Length: 6 (not in Germany), 10 and 20 m
Color code (see Table 3-115)
The wires in a wire pair may be interchanged.
Figure 3-105
3-234
B
A
C
K
P TMS2
L
A
N
E
Boards
Peripheral Boards
NT 1
NTPMGF
+ (0 V)
1
2
s UBatt
(- 48 V) 3
FPE
4
a
5
b S2M
6
7
s
8
a
b S2M
9
s
10
NTPMKU
Receive
Transmit
s = Shield
+ (0 V)
1
s UBatt
2
(- 48 V) 3
PE
4
a
5
b S2M
6
7
s
a
8
b S2M
9
10
s
11
s
12
a UK2
b
13
14
s
15
a UK2
16
b
Feeding
Earth connection,
min. 2,5 mm2
Receive direction
Transmit direction
Shield
Backplane, connection to
Xx8
Xx9 (from board state 5)
Cable S30267-Z57-Axxx
Length: 6 (not in Germany), 10 and 20 m
Color code (see Table 3-115)
The wires in a wire pair may be interchanged.
Figure 3-106
B
A
C
K
P TMS2
L
A
N
E
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-235
Boards
Peripheral Boards
S2M Networking
For examples of the maximum cable lengths for direct CorNet-N networking, refer to
Table 2-9 on page 2-23.
TMS2
HiPath 3000 or
HiPath 4000
NT
NT
TMS2
Fixed connection
(cabling must be approved
by NT supplier)
Cable S30267-Z57-Axxx
6 m (not in Germany), 10 m and 20 m
HiPath 3000 or
HiPath 4000
NT
NT
TMS2
3-236
Boards
Peripheral Boards
SF
ESF
Rather than connecting to a main distribution frame (MDF), the TST1 connects to a
channel service unit (CSU). The CSU supplies the required secondary protection.
Interfaces
50
1
X2
To trunk
TST1
X1
to
CUC
CUCR
Figure 3-108
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-237
Boards
Peripheral Boards
Interface Assignments
Table 3-117
Pin
1
2
3
4
3-238
Pin
5
6
7
8
X2
transmit tip
not connected
not connected
not connected
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Peripheral Boards
TS2 (trunk module S2M) S30810-Q2913-X100 (Figure 3-109) - for use in the HiPath 3550 (wall housing)
TS2R (trunk module S2M rack) S30810-K2913-Z100 (Figure 3-110) - for use in
the HiPath 3500 (19-inch housing)
To support country-specific CAS protocols, you can use the Euro-ISDNCAS-Gateway ECG. The ECG cabinet is a protocol converter that converts the Euro-ISDN protocol into the Channel Associated Signaling CAS protocol. Refer to the installation instructions, which are provided with each ECG cabinet, for information on the
connection and power supply.
For HiPath 3000 V1.0 or later, you can also use the new TMCAS board to support
country-specific CAS protocols.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-239
Boards
Peripheral Boards
TS2 Interfaces
S2M interface:
TS2
50
X2
To
8
X1
MW8 (RJ48C)
jack (MW line)
CUC
X5
2
Figure 3-109
TS2R Interfaces
TS2R
50
To
S2M interface:
X1
MW8 (RJ48C)
jack (MW line)
CUCR
X5
2
Figure 3-110
3-240
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Peripheral Boards
Network Interfaces
The TS2 board is connected to the network transfer point (NT1) via the symmetrical
line (120 ohms, four-wire twisted-pair cable) at X2 or via a MW line at X5.
Note: use the connection kits listed on page 3-243 for NT connections in Spain and
Portugal.
Symmetrical Line (120 ohms)
The maximum cable length (approx. 130 m) depends on the quality of the cable used
and its signal attenuation. Use shielded cables only to guarantee proper operation.
Connect the cable to the X2 using an 8-pin Wieland terminal (TS2 only).
Table 3-118
Pin
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
X2 (TS2 only)
48 V (NT1 feeding), max. 15 W
0 V (NT1 feeding)
GND
Board ID for TMCAS
Transmit a-wire
Transmit b-wire
Receive a-wire
Receive b-wire
Pin
X5
Pin
X5
1
Receive b-wire
6
free
2
Receive a-wire
7
free
3
free
8
free
4
Transmit b-wire
11
GND
5
Transmit a-wire
12
GND
An additional line must be provided from pins 1 and 2 on the X2 connector to NT1
for NT1 feeding.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-241
Boards
Peripheral Boards
TS2/TS2R
Figure 3-111
Public network
NT1
Keep the cable from the NT to HiPath 3550 or HiPath 3500 as short as possible to
ensure proper operation.
Caution
There should be absolutely no ground connection between the HiPath 3550 wall
housing and the NT. Do not connect the shield of the connecting cable you are using
either on the HiPath 3550 side or on the NT side.
If the System HiPath 3550 is separately grounded (such as with the HiPath 3500 19
housing), you may make a connection between HiPath 3550 and NT.
NT1 Power Supply
3-242
TS2 board
The NT1 supply voltage of 48 V can be tapped from the X2 connector (see Table 3-118). There is a power limit of < 15 W for this voltage, which the system
feeds over the CUC.
TS2R board
The NT1 power supply must come from an S30122-X7321-X (S30122-X7321X100 with UPS operation) optiset E local power supply.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Peripheral Boards
Public
network
TS2/TS2R
Interface
converter
NT
Cable 2
Portugal
Public
network
TS2/TS2R
Figure 3-112
Interface
converter
Cable 2
Cable 3
NT
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-243
Boards
Peripheral Boards
3.3.33 4SLA (Not for U.S.), 8SLA, (for All Countries) and 16SLA (Not for U.S.)
Introduction
The 4SLA, 8SLA, and 16SLA (subscriber line analog) modules connect HiPath 3550
and HiPath 3350 to analog telephones and supplementary equipment (such as group
3 fax machines and entrance telephone adapters) via analog interfaces.
The 8SLA is supported in the U.S.; the 4SLA and 16SLA are not.
Interfaces
Analog ports
1 to 4
Stns. 1 to 4
Analog ports
5 to 8
Stns. 5 to 8
(not with 4SLA)
Figure 3-113
3-244
50
1
X2
8
X1
To
CUP
CUC
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Peripheral Boards
Interface Assignments
Table 3-120
Pin
X2 (Analog Ports 1 to 4)
X3 (Analog Ports 5 to 8)
a1
a5
b1
b5
a2
a6
b2
b6
a3
a7
b3
b7
a4
a8
b4
b8
Table 3-121
Pin
X2 (Ports 1-4)
X3 (Ports 5-8)
R1
R5
T1
T5
R2
R6
T2
T6
R3
R7
T3
T7
R4
R8
T4
T8
Note: Pinouts shown are at the board itself. The supplied main distribution frame cable (MDF cable) reverses the signal order before the MDF.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-245
Boards
Peripheral Boards
1
X2
Analog ports
1 to 4
Stns. 1 to 4
50
Analog ports
5 to 8
Stns. 5 to 8
X3
X1
8
16SLA
Analog ports
9 to 12
Stns. 9 to 12
X4
To
CUP
CUC
Analog ports
13 to 16
Stns. 13 to 16
1
X5
8
Figure 3-114
Table 3-122
Pin
X2
(Analog Ports
1 to 4)
X3
(Analog Ports
5 to 8)
X4
(Analog Ports
9 to 12)
X5
(Analog Ports
13 to 16)
a1
a5
a9
a 13
b1
b5
b9
b 13
a2
a6
a1
a 14
b2
b6
b 10
b 14
a3
a7
a 11
a 15
b3
b7
b 11
b 15
a4
a8
a 12
a 16
b4
b8
b 12
b 16
The operating mode (short or long line with the appropriate flash times) can be set up
for each subscriber line interface with HiPath 3000 Manager E (the menu Settings:
Set up station > Station > Parameters > Flags).
3-246
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Peripheral Boards
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-247
Boards
Peripheral Boards
3.3.34 8SLAR
Introduction
The 8SLAR (subscriber line analog rack) module provides eight analog interfaces for
connecting analog telephones and supplementary equipment (such as group 3 fax
machines and entrance telephones) in HiPath 3500 and HiPath 3300 (19-inch housing).
Interfaces
Port 1
11
X1
Analog ports
1 to 8
(8-pole MW8
jacks)
X2
2
To
CUPR
CUCR
88
Port 8
Figure 3-115
Table 3-123
MW8
Jack
X2, Pin
Analog Ports
1 to 4
MW8
Jack
X2, Pin
Analog Ports
5 to 8
14
Tip/a 1
54
Tip/a 5
15
Ring/b 1
55
Ring/b 5
24
Tip/a 2
64
Tip/a 6
25
Ring/b 2
65
Ring/b 6
34
Tip/a 3
74
Tip/a 7
35
Ring/b 3
75
Ring/b 7
44
Tip/a 4
84
Tip/a 8
45
Ring/b 4
85
Ring/b 8
2
3
4
3-248
50
6
7
8
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Peripheral Boards
Ring voltage against negative supply voltage (tip wire/RING): two telephones
maximum
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-249
Boards
Options
3.4 Options
3.4.1 ALUM4
Introduction
In the event that HiPath 3550 or HiPath 3350 experiences a voltage drop, voltage dip
or unrecoverable system errors, the ALUM module can transfer up to four analog
trunks directly to four analog telephones, bypassing the system.
The ALUM4 Module provides power failure transfer for MSI ground-start or loop-start
trunks, but ground-start trunks require a physical ground-actuator button.
When the system is deactivated or when an error occurs, the trunks are connected
directly to the telephones. When normal operation resumes, the trunks are again
routed through the system.
Only analog telephones can be used for the transfer, and they must use the same signaling method as the trunk; otherwise, dialing is not possible.
ALUM4 Module Function
System
1
Pins 1-8
From analog
CO trunks
X3
To analog
stations
X4
To analog
trunk board
Pins 9-16
Figure 3-116
3-250
To central board
or analog subscriber board
ALUM4 Function
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Options
Interfaces
To OPAL
1
From
trunk
X1
X3
16
X6
8
ALUM module
1
To
telephone
X4
X2
8
To next option
Figure 3-117
>
Split the cable from X6 and connect half to the analog trunk board and half to the
CB analog ports or analog subscriber boards.
Pin
Connector X3
Connector X4
Connector X6
R1 from trunk 1a
AE1 to Stn. 1a
AT1 to TLA a
T1 from trunk 1b
BE1 to Stn. 1b
BT1 to TLA b
R2 from trunk 2a
AE2 to Stn. 2a
AT2 to TLA a
T2 from trunk 2b
BE2 to Stn. 2b
BT2 to TLA b
R3 from trunk 3a
AE3 to Stn. 3a
AT3 to TLA a
T3 from trunk 3b
BE3 to Stn. 3b
BT3 to TLA b
R4 from trunk 4a
AE4 to Stn. 4a
AT4 to TLA a
T4 from trunk 4b
BE4 to Stn. 4b
BT4 to TLA b
TA1 to SLA* a
10
TB1 to SLA* b
11
TA2 to SLA* a
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-251
Boards
Options
Table 3-124
Pin
Connector X3
Connector X4
Connector X6
12
TB2 to SLA* b
13
TA3 to SLA* a
14
TB3 to SLA* b
15
TA4 to SLA* a
16
TB4 to SLA* b
X3
(to MDF)
X4
(to MDF)
Y-Cable from X6 to
TMGL4
Y-Cable from X6 to
Analog Ports1
Pin
Assignment
Pin
Assignment
T to analog port 1
T to TMGL4 port 1
1 To the analog station ports on the CBPC (recommended) or to four consecutive ports on an 8SLA.
Note: Pinouts shown are at the board itself. The supplied main distribution frame cable (MDF cable) reverses the signal order for X3 and X4 before the MDF.
3-252
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Options
To trunk via X3
HiPath 3550 or
HiPath 3350
ALUM
R1 Relay
K1-B
T1
K2-B
BT1 (T1)
AT1 (R1)
Trunk board
Connector X6
TA1 (R1)
TB1 (T1)
K1-C
AE1
Subscr. board
K2-C
Relay
BE1
Figure 3-118
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-253
Boards
Options
LEDs
TMGL4
2/1
4/3
6/5
8/7
10/9
X 3 *)
(green)
(red)
X1
CO Trunk
X4
ANI4
X2
Module side
*) Pins: Component side/solder side
Figure 3-119
3-254
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Options
LED
Meaning
Action
On
(but
glowing
weakly)
Start up system.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-255
Boards
Options
Table 3-126
LED
On
(for approx.
1 s)
Meaning
Action
Off
Checksum is OK.
3-256
Pin
Connector X3
Component Side
Connector X3
Solder Side
Connector X4
--
Not assigned
Tip, trunk 1
Ring, trunk 1
--
Ring, trunk 1
--
Tip, trunk 1
Tip, trunk 2
Ring, trunk 2
--
Ring, trunk 2
--
Tip, trunk 2
Tip, trunk 3
Ring, trunk 3
--
Ring, trunk 3
--
Tip, trunk 3
Tip, trunk 4
Ring, trunk 4
--
Ring, trunk 4
--
Tip, trunk 4
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Options
Table 3-127
Pin
Connector X3
Component Side
Connector X3
Solder Side
Connector X4
10
Not used
--
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-257
Boards
Options
Caution
Remove the trunk slip-on connectors from the TMGL4 board before starting to work
on the system.
Be sure to reinstall the ANI4 and TMGL4 boards in their slots before reconnecting
the trunks.
1.
Disconnect the trunks from the TMGL4 board (Figure 3-120, fig. 1).
2.
3.
4.
5.
Use the ribbon cable supplied with the board to connect the ANI4 to the TMGL4,
making sure that the color markings (Pin 1) at both ends of the cable are facing
up (Figure 3-120, fig. 2).
6.
Connect the trunk slip-on connectors to the ANI4 board (Figure 3-120, fig. 3).
7.
Fig. 1
Fig. 2
Fig. 3
Pin 1
Pin 1
Figure 3-120
3-258
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Options
TMGL4R
X1
ANI4R
X2
Module side
Figure 3-121
X3 Pin
Signal
X3 Pin
Signal
Tip, trunk 3
Tip, trunk 1
Ring, trunk 3
Ring, trunk 1
Tip, trunk 4
Tip, trunk 2
Ring, trunk 4
Ring, trunk 2
10
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-259
Boards
Options
The HiPath 3000 systems use different modules or boards for playing announcements and music on hold. For details on connecting these boards, refer to the manufacturers installation instructions.
Overview
Table 3-129
Board
AM
Notes
EXM
S30817-Q902-B401
EXMR
S30122-K7403-Z
MPPI
S30122-X7275-X
MPPI
S30122-K5380-X200
UAM
S30122-X7217-X
3-260
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Options
Table 3-129
Board
UAMR
Part Number
S30122-X7402-Z
Notes
Cable duct
Figure 3-122
EXM Slot for HiPath 3550 and HiPath 3350 (Not for U.S.)
Connection of EXMR
Front panel
of the system
X1
EXMR
X2
(component side)
Cinch jack
Cable C39195-Z7001-C79
Figure 3-123
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-261
Boards
Options
Expert mode code 22 11 allows you to choose between music on, music off, ring tone,
or music on unscreened transfer. If the EXMNA module is connected, you must select
Music on using Manager T or HiPath 3000 Manager E. The module is operational as
soon as it is plugged in.
Interfaces
Ribbon
cable to
CB
X1
10
To external
music source
Figure 3-124
EXMNA
X2
Cable duct
Figure 3-125
3-262
EXMNA Slot for HiPath 3550 and HiPath 3350 (for U.S. Only)
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Options
Table 3-130
Pin
Connector X1
Connector X2
GND
Input
Not assigned
Input
Not assigned
Not assigned
EXMCL
Not assigned
EXMDIR
HRES
EXMD
EXMDET
+5 V
10
Not assigned
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-263
Boards
Options
On = 24 dBm
Off = 10 dBm
Switch on GEE8
On
X10
Figure 3-126
3-264
X11
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Options
GEE 12
12 kHz
GEE 16
16 kHz
GEE 50
50 Hz
Remarks
also for Silent Reversal
The call charge detection channel is looped in the trunk and then routed to the TLA
Interfaces
To OPAL
1
10
X1
to TLA
X3
X5
10
1
to CO
LS
GEE module
X4
X2
To next option
Figure 3-127
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-265
Boards
Options
Contact Assignments
Table 3-132
Pin
Connector X3
Conn. X4
Conn. X5
GND *
CO 1 (AL1)
0V
CO 1 (BN 1)
CO 1 (BL1)
0V
CO 1 (AN 1)
CO 2 (AL2)
RTS
CO 2 (BN 2)
CO 2 (BL2)
CTS
CO 2 (AN 2)
CO 3 (AL3)
RXD
CO 3 (BN 3)
CO 3 (BL3)
TXD
CO 3 (AN 3)
CO 4 (AL4)
0V
CO 4 (BN 4)
CO 4 (BL4)
+5V
CO 4 (AN 4)
0V
+5V
10
3-266
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Options
Card ejector
Figure 3-128
Board Components
The following list describes the purpose of the components on the HOPE board:
The LED status indicator signals the state of the Hicom Office PhoneMail system
The software load/diagnostic button is for software loads (for example, loading a
language)
The digital station connector connects the HOPE board to the corresponding digital ports, using a modular cable
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-267
Boards
Options
The PCMCIA slot is for Office PhoneMail software cards (for example, language
cards)
The card ejector ejects the software cards from the PMCIA slot
3-268
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Options
OPAL (option adapter cable long) C39195-A7001-B130 (Figure 3-129) - for use
in HiPath 3550 and HiPath 3350 (wall housing).
OPALR (option adapter cable long rack) C39195-A7001-B142 (Figure 3-130) for use in HiPath 3500 and HiPath 3300 (19-inch housing).
OPAL Interfaces
To option board
Ribbon cable
folded and secured
OPAL (C39195-A7001-B130)
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-269
Boards
Options
OPALR Interface
To option board
To CBRC interface
Figure 3-130
3-270
OPALR (C39195-A7001-B142)
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Options
TRUNK
a
PFT
R
E
L
A
Y
TMB
TMA
SMA
SMB
SLA
Trunk circuit
SLA board
(optional)
SLB
Analog tel.
Figure 3-131
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-271
Boards
Options
2 x PFT1
or
1 x PFT4
System side
Figure 3-132
3-272
Line network
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Options
X1
1
X2
1 TMA
TMB
A
B
SMA
SMB
SLA
SLB
1
TMA 10
TMB
A
B
SMA
SMB
SLA
SLB
10
TMA
1
TMB
A
B
SMA
SMB
SLA
SLB
- 48V
PFT
10
X4
TMA
TMB
A
B
SMA
SMB
SLA
SLB
1
X3
Figure 3-133
PFT4
X1
TMA
1
TMB
A
B
SMA
SMB
SLA
SLB
- 48V
PFT
10
PFT1
PFT1 (S30777-Q539-X) and PFT4 (S30777-Q540-X) Board Assignment (Not for U.S.)
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-273
Boards
Options
3.4.11 REAL
Functions
The tasks of the REAL (S30807-Q5913-X) board in HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 are
divided into two functional areas (see Figure 3-137):
Relay
Four individual, controllable relays (K1 to K4) are available for special connections. The relays are energized by the CBCPR board via the REAL socket X05
connecting cable. The switch contacts for all relays are floating and protected by
surge protectors.
In addition, a 48 V line fused using a PTC resistor is routed to the main distribution frame and can be used there for external applications (max. 80 mA).
48 V lines are provided at pins 17 and 37 (SU connector X06) for external applications with higher power requirements. These lines have a load capacity of
max. 15 W.
In the event of a power failure or during a restart or reload (low potential of trunk
failure transfer signal from CBCPR), the relays are deactivated:
As a result, the signals to the line trunk module and subscriber line module
are split and the trunk is connected directly to the subscriber line. (This is the
way you must wire the connections as well).
If the power supply voltage returns after an interruption and a trunk call is in
progress, activation of the trunk failure transfer relay is prevented (by optocoupler).
3-274
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Options
Relay Specifications
The electrical characteristics of the relays are as follows:
X70
07
X05
X06
REAL
with
connecting
cable
Figure 3-134
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-275
Boards
Options
Ribbon cable
X80
PSUI
X70
07
X05
REAL
Figure 3-135
3-276
Backplane of
basic cabinet
Not used in U.S.
X8 (REAL MDF)
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Options
REAL
X06
MDFU
REAL
02 10a
11 9a
NC1
PFTASa
X06
PFTASb
Relay
K1
S1
NO1
31 9b
NC2
22 10b
13 11a
Relay
K2
S2
NO2
33 11b
NC3
15 13a
04 12a
Relay
K3
S3
PFTALb
Relay
K5
PFTALa
32 8a
42 8b
43 7b
23 7a
PFTTLb
PFTTLa
44 6b
14 6a
24 12b
NO3
PFTTSb
45 5b
35 13b
06 14a
NC4
S4
Current
sensor
Relay
K5
MDFU
Relay
K6
Relay
K4
PFTTSa
05 5a
26 14b
NO4
Relay
K6
16 4a
48 V,
max.
80 mA
46 4b
27 3a
48 2b
GND
17 15a
48 V,
max.
15 W
Figure 3-136
37 15b
X06 MDFU
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-277
Boards
Options
Cable and Connector Assignment (Backplane, MDFU/MDFU-E, Patch Panel) (Not for U.S.)
Table 3-133
Color
Group
Pair
1
2
3
4
a-Wire
wht/blu
blu/wht
wht/ora
ora/wht
wht/grn
grn/wht
wht/brn
brn/wht
wht/gry
6
7
2
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
Color
Group
Pair
3-278
gry/wht
red/blu
blu/red
red/ora
ora/red
red/grn
grn/red
red/brn
brn/red
red/gry
gry/red
blk/blu
blu/blk
blk/ora
ora/blk
blk/grn
grn/blk
blk/brn
brn/blk
blk/gry
gry/blk
yel/blu
blu/yel
a-Wire
b-Wire
SU Connector
BP: Xx8
MDFU/
MDFU-E
REAL
19
1a
39
1b
38
2a
48
GND
2b
27
GND
3a
47
S0 Patch Panel
MW8
3b
16
48 V (max. 80 mA)
4a
46
48 V (max. 80 mA)
4b
05
PFTTSa
5a
45
PFTTSb
5b
14
PFTTLa
6a
44
PFTTLb
6b
23
PFTALa
7a
43
PFTALb
7b
32
PFTASa
8a
42
PFTASb
8b
11
NC1
9a
31
NO1
9b
02
S1
10a
22
S2
10b
13
NC2
11a
33
NO2
11b
04
NC3
12a
24
NO3
12b
15
S3
13a
35
S4
13b
06
NC4
14a
2
1
26
NO4
14b
17
48 V (max. 15 W)
15a
37
48 V (max. 15 W)
15b
08
16a
28
16b
SU Connector
BP: Xx8
REAL
MDFU/
MDFU-E
Subs. line
module
(SLA)
Subsc. line
(telephone)
Trunk
Trunk
module
S0 Patch Panel
MW8
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Options
REAL Module Relay Contacts (Backplane and MDF) (for U.S. Only)
REAL
Backplane
6
NC1
Relay
K1
S1
4
3
NO1
NC2
Relay
K2
S2
8
7
NO2
10
NC3
Relay
K3
S3
12
9
NO3
11
NC4
Relay
K4
S4
14
13
NO4
48 V
MDF
10
9
GND
13
12
37
38
14
Figure 3-137
21
X5
32
PFTALA
Relay
K5
Current
sensor
16
PFTTLB
22
31
PFTTLA
18
Telephone
PFTTSB
30
24
SLA16
Relay
K6
PFTTSA
20
39
Relay
K6
3
27
4
48 VF
max. 15 W
19
33
CO
36
40
31, 34
PFTALB
35
11
33
1, 2, 26
Relay
K5
34
MDF
8
TMGL8
PFTASB
17
15
48 VS
max.
80 mA
29
X8
X5
X8
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-279
Boards
Options
X3
10
1
MDF
X1
STBG4
X4
Trunk
X2
8
Board side
Figure 3-138
Table 3-134
Contact
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
3-280
Connector X3
Not assigned
BL 1
AN 1
BL 2
AN 2
BL 3
AN 3
BL 4
AN 4
Not assigned
Connector X4
AL 1
BL 1
AL 2
BL 2
AL 3
BL 3
AL 4
BL 4
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Options
STRB (control relay board) S30817-Q932-A (Figure 3-139) - for the use in HiPath
3550 and HiPath 3350 (wall housing)
STRBR (control relay board rack) S30817-Q932-Z (Figure 3-140) - for the use in
HiPath 3500 and HiPath 3300 (19-inch housing)
Actuators are relays that can be energized from any station by means of a code (such
as a door opener). Sensors (such as thermostats or motion detectors) can detect a
change of status in the connected equipment and activate a feature or dial a station
number stored in the system. The STRB or STRBR has four double-pole, doublethrow relays as shown in Figure 3-141 on page 3-283.
The board has a total of 4 outputs (in the form of 2 floating switch contacts each) for
externally activating an electrically isolated normally open (NO) contact. It also has 4
control inputs in the form of optocouplers. A diode is required to isolate the contact
from the external power supply.
Caution
CDBase data is stored on the board. When replacing the board, be sure to store the
CDBase data elsewhere. If a used board is used, old data may still be present on
the board.
Only factory technicians should use the Reset options procedure (code 29-3-3 in expert mode). Using the procedure during operation returns all options to their factory
defaults, and they must be reset before they can accept data again from the central
board.
Application
You can route the +12 V signal for power failure alert to the control input of the optocoupler for connector X4 or X6. Route the signal through a normally open (NO) contact that is electrically isolated from the external device, then program the alert type.
For safety, the control voltage for the optocoupler is electrically isolated from the systems other partial voltages.
For the manual relay on/off function and door opener, you must enter the desired
switching time (expert mode code 26 2).
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-281
Boards
Options
STRB Interfaces
X5
1 8
8
1
X6
X1
1
STRB
X4
X2
To next option
Figure 3-139
STRBR Interfaces
8-pole MW8
jacks
11
:
18
21
:
28
31
:
38
41
:
48
X1
X3
STRBR
X2
To next option
Figure 3-140
3-282
Attention
The STRB or STRBR interface is a SELV (Safety Extra-Low Voltage Circuit) interface, as defined by IEC 60950.
Do not connect any circuits whose voltages exceed the following limit values:
Maximum of 30 VAC (42 Vpeak) or 60 VDC.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Options
STRB or STRBR
K1.21
K1.22
K1.23
Relay
K1.11
K1.12
K1.13
+12 V
+12 VI
OPTKP1
Sensor
To system
Figure 3-141
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-283
Boards
Options
X3
X4
X5
X6
Signal Name
Function
K 4.21
K 4.22
K 4.23
K 3.21
K 3.22
K 3.23
K 2.21
K 2.22
K 2.23
K 1.21
K 1.22
K 1.23
+12VI
OPTKP 2
+12VI
OPTKP 1
K 3.12
K 3.13
K 2.11
K 2.12
K 2.13
K 1.11
K 1.12
K 1.13
OPTKP 3
+12VI
OPTKP 4
+12VI
K 4.11
K 4.12
K 4.13
K 3.11
Note for U.S. only: Pinouts shown are at the board itself. The supplied main distribution frame cable
(MDF cable) reverses the signals from pins:
1 and 2
3 and 4
5 and 6
7 and 8
3-284
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Options
X3, Pin
Signal Name
11
ACT4-2M
12
ACT4-2B
13
ACT4-2A
14
ACT4-1M
15
ACT4-1B
16
ACT4-1A
17
P12VI
18
SENSE4
21
ACT3-2M
22
ACT3-2B
23
ACT3-2A
24
ACT3-1M
25
ACT3-1B
26
ACT3-1A
27
P12VI
28
SENSE3
31
ACT2-2M
32
ACT2-2B
33
ACT2-2A
34
ACT2-1M
35
ACT2-1B
36
ACT2-1A
37
P12VI
38
SENSE2
41
ACT1-2M
42
ACT1-2B
43
ACT1-2A
44
ACT1-1M
45
ACT1-1B
46
ACT1-1A
47
P12VI
48
SENSE1
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Function
+12 V optocoupler 4
+ 12 V optocoupler 3
+ 12 V optocoupler 2
+ 12 V optocoupler 1
Control input optocoupler 1
3-285
Boards
Options
26
X2
3-286
Figure 3-142
Figure 3-143
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Options
Connector Assignment
To CB
X7: Edge connector
25-pin
TTL/RS-232
Level-converter and
electrical isolation
X2: Sub-D-socket
25-pin sockets
TxD
TxD
RxD
RxD
RTS
RTS
CTS
CTS
DSR
DSR
DTR
DTR
Vcc
GND
GND
Figure 3-144
Table 3-137
Connector X2
Signal
I/O
TxD_B
RxD_B
RTS_B
CTS_B
DSR_B
20
DTR_B
0V
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-287
Boards
Options
9-Pole Jack
Signal
Pin
3-288
25-Pin Connector
Pin
DCD
RxD
TxD
DTR
20
GND
DSR
RTS
CTS
RI
22
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Boards
Options
9-pole jack
9-pole jack
DCD 1
DCD
RxD
RxD
Receive Data
TxD
TxD
Transmit Data
DTR 4
DTR
DSR 6
DSR
RTS 7
RTS
Request To Send
CTS 8
CTS
Clear To Send
GND 5
GND
Ground
RI
Ring Indicator
RI
Figure 3-145
Shield
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-289
Boards
Options
3-290
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Installation
Overview
4 Installation
4.1 Overview
Chapter Contents
This chapter discusses the topics listed in the table.
Topic
HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 Installation, page 4-2
Loading the System Software and Inserting Subboards on the Central Control
Board, page 4-69
HiPath 3550, HiPath 3350, HiPath 3500 and HiPath 3300 Installation, page 4-81
Installation Procedure
HiPath 3500 and HiPath 3300 Installation (19-Inch Housing), page 4-105
HiPath 3250 and HiPath 3150 Installation (Not for U.S.), page 4-118
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
4-1
Installation
HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 Installation
Warning
The system may be installed by authorized service personnel only.
4-2
Tools:
TORX screwdriver
Help:
For U.S. only: AuroraDuet, AuroraExpert, AuroraRemote, or similar, ISDN protocol analyzer (for PRI)
For U.S. only: Punch-down tool suitable for the block used (such as 66 block)
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Installation
HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 Installation
Step
Installation Activity
HiPath 3750 Installation
1.
2.
3.
Mounting the Main Distribution Frame (MD- Mounting the System Cabinet in the 19FU or MDFU-E) (Not for U.S.), page 4-7
Inch Cabinet, page 4-47
4.
Single cabinet
Two cabinets (stacked)
Two cabinets (side-by-side)
6.
7.
Laying the Line Network and Setting Jump- Connecting the Line Network to the Patch
ers on the MDFU or MDFU-E, page 4-40
Panel, page 4-68
8.
Loading the System Software and Inserting Subboards on the Central Control Board,
page 4-69
9.
10.
11.
12.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
4-3
Installation
HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 Installation
board configuration
applies to both HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 and is described starting in Section
4.2.5.
4-4
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Installation
HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 Installation
Do not expose the systems to direct sources of heat (such as sunlight and heaters).
Ensure the availability of a power source that meets the requirements described
in Section 4.2.3.1 on page 4-6.
Ensure that Siemens equipment is 40 in. (101.6 cm) from other electrical equipment. The National Electrical Code (NEC) requires 36 in. (91.44 cm) of clearance
in front of electrical equipment and 40 in. (101.6 cm) of clearance from other electrical service equipment.
The equipment room for the system should provide adequate space for installation and maintenance activities (such as removing and replacing boards). Leave
at least 16 in. (42 cm) on all sides of the system, and 36 in. (91.44 cm) in front.
You will find information on the design and dimensions of HiPath 3750 in Section
2.3.1.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
4-5
Installation
HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 Installation
Frequency
110 Vac
130 Vac
47 Hz
63 Hz
Receptacle
Configurations
NEMA 5-15, 2-pole,
3-wire, grounding
WARNING
Under no circumstances should any HiPath 3750 system or combination of HiPath
3750 systems be connected directly to a wall outlet; use a UL Listed or CSA Certified transient surge protector for every two cabinets.
Must have a UL Listed or CSA Certified transient surge protector between the
outlet and the system. Up to two cabinets can be connected to the surge protector. Under no circumstances should any HiPath 3750 system or combination of
systems be connected directly to a wall outlet.
Must not be located more than 8 feet (2.4 m) from the system
Must provide fused 120 Vac (single-phase) power at 50 to 60 Hz capable of delivering 20 amperes
Should have a warning attached to the circuit breaker that controls it to prevent
accidental removal of power
Do not connect the power until the system is properly grounded as described in Section 4.2.4.5 on page 4-52. Refer to Section 5.2.3 on page 5-3 for more information
about connecting the power supply.
4-6
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Installation
HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 Installation
Activity
1.
2.
Determine whether any damage has occurred during transport and report
it to the appropriate departments or the shipper.
3.
Caution
Use only equipment and materials that are in perfect working order. Do not start up
equipment with visible damage.
4.2.3.3 Mounting the Main Distribution Frame (MDFU or MDFU-E) (Not for U.S.)
Introduction
The following are used as main distribution frames:
MDFU (one MDFU unit per system cabinet), which was used for Hicom 150 E
OfficePro in Release 2.0 and earlier (see Figure 4-23).
Installation Notes
The MDFU or MDFU-E should be installed in the direct vicinity of the system (note
length of connecting cable) and at eye level. Mount it on the wall according to the instructions that came with it. The bag attached to the cover contains a drill template
and screws and wall anchors for attaching the MDF to the wall.
Procedure for Mounting the MDF on the Wall
Step
Activity
1.
2.
Insert the wall anchors and screw in the screws, leaving 5 mm projecting.
3.
Mount the MDFU or MDFU-E on the brackets and remove the packing
protection covering.
4.
Remove the housing cover and tighten the screws through the holes.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
4-7
Installation
HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 Installation
Danger
Be sure to ground the system properly before starting it up and connecting the stations.
4.2.3.4.1 Overview
System Configurations
WARNING
A fully equipped HiPath 3750 cabinet weighs 22 kg (48.46 lb.). We recommend lifting cabinets only before they are equipped. Do not attempt to lift objects that you
think are too heavy for you; use a hand truck or get assistance.
The following setup options are possible for system cabinets:
System
One cabinet on a horizontal surface
One cabinet on a wall (for U.S. only)
Two cabinets stacked on a horizontal surface
Two cabinets stacked on a wall (for U.S. only)
Two cabinets side-by-side on a horizontal surface
Three cabinets on a horizontal surface (two stacked)
4-8
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Installation
HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 Installation
Activity
1.
Insert a slotted screwdriver (with the blade vertical) into a recess (1).
2.
Carefully swing the handle of the screwdriver toward the center of the cabinet (2) until the fastener snaps out and the cover loosens.
3.
Then insert the screwdriver in the second recess (3), loosen its snap fastener. You can then remove the cover.
(3)
Cabinet
(1)
(2)
Figure 4-1
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
4-9
Installation
HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 Installation
WARNING
An empty HiPath 3750 cabinet weighs 32 lb. (14.53 kg). Mount the cabinets before
equipping them with boards and do not attempt to lift objects that you think are too
heavy for you; get help.
Procedure
Step
Activity
1.
2.
Place the system cabinet in the installation site and make sure that it is
level and stable.
U.S. only: For wall mounting, refer to information below.
Keyed holes
Latch
Latching assembly
Figure 4-2
4-10
Wall-mounting bracket
Swing-Out assembly
Installation
HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 Installation
WARNING
An empty HiPath 3750 cabinet weighs 32 lb. (14.53 kg). Mount the cabinets before
equipping them with boards and do not attempt to lift objects that you think are too
heavy for you; get help.
Step
Activity
1.
2.
3.
Install the screws in the top two holes, tightening them until 0.25 in.
(6.35 mm) is protruding.
4.
5.
Close the swing-out assembly and hang the bracket and cabinet on the
top screws.
6.
Swing the cabinet open and tighten the top screws completely.
7.
Insert and fully tighten the bottom screw in the round hole.
8.
You can invert the bracket to have the cabinet swing out in the opposite direction.
WARNING
Do not fasten power cords to building surfaces when mounting cabinets on the wall.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
4-11
Installation
HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 Installation
Figure 4-3
4-12
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Installation
HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 Installation
Activity
1.
2.
Mount the stabilizer feet (not for U.S.) on the basic cabinet (BC). Place the
basic cabinet in the installation site and make sure that it is level and stable.
3.
Place the expansion cabinet (EC1) on the basic cabinet. Make sure that
the EC1 feet slide into the depressions in the top of the BC.
4.
If mounting the system on the floor or on a table, attach the two cabinets
using the four connecting plates each held by two screws with washers
(Figure 4-4 on page 4-14). Be sure to fasten all four of the adjoining
corners. Make sure that the connecting plates are mounted in the correct
direction (inside the cabinets and pointing inward).
5.
For U.S. only: If mounting the system on the wall, refer to page 4-15.
>
DANGER
The connecting plates must be installed to ensure proper grounding for systems
mounted on a floor or other horizontal surface.
You can install seismic anchors for greater stability, as is required in some installations. Refer to Section 4.2.3.4 on page 4-22 for more information and take note that
the bolts and inserts included in the seismic anchor kit are suitable for concrete
floors; bolts for other surfaces must be supplied separately.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
4-13
Installation
HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 Installation
EC1
EC1
BC
BC
EC1
BC
Washers
Back
Front
Figure 4-4
Inside the
cabinet
4-14
Caution
Be careful when breaking out the recesses. Remove any sharp edges and corners.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Installation
HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 Installation
DANGER
The second cabinet also requires an earth ground as described on page 4-27. Do
not fasten wall-mounted cabinets with the connecting plates, as this will interfere
with the earth ground.
Wall-Mount Kit
Keyed holes
Latch
Latching assembly
Figure 4-5
Wall-mounting bracket
Swing-Out assembly
WARNING
An empty HiPath 3750 cabinet weighs 32 lb. (14.53 kg). Mount the cabinets before
equipping them with boards and do not attempt to lift objects that you think are too
heavy for you; get help.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
4-15
Installation
HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 Installation
Activity
1.
2.
Use a wall-mounting bracket as a template to drill three holes in the backboard for each cabinet. Use the keyed holes in the top of the bracket and
the round hole in the bottom of the bracket.
3.
Install the screws in the top two holes for each bracket, tightening them
until 0.25 in. (6.35 mm) is protruding.
4.
5.
Close the swing-out assembly and hang each bracket and cabinet on the
top screws.
6.
Swing each cabinet open and tighten the top screws completely.
7.
Insert and fully tighten the bottom screws in the round holes.
8.
You can invert the brackets to have the cabinets swing out in the opposite direction.
4-16
WARNING
Do not fasten power cords to building surfaces when mounting cabinets on the wall.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Installation
HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 Installation
Figure 4-6
WARNING
Be careful when breaking out the recesses. Remove any sharp edges and corners.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
4-17
Installation
HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 Installation
Caution
Always mount the stabilizer feet on stacked, surface-mounted system cabinets to
ensure stability (Figure 4-7).
Step
Activity
1.
Place the stabilizer feet beneath the right and left outer edges of the cabinets. Insert the cabinet feet into the two holes in the stabilizer feet (1).
2.
Attach the stabilizer feet to the metal housing of the cabinet (2) by inserting two screws per foot into the pre-drilled holes in the housing.
3.
(2)
(2)
(1)
Figure 4-7
>
4-18
(1)
(2)
For U.S. only: You can install seismic anchors for greater stability, as is required in
some installations. Refer to Section 4.2.3.4 on page 4-22 for more information and
note that the bolts and inserts included in the seismic anchor kit are suitable for concrete floors; bolts for other surfaces must be supplied separately.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Installation
HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 Installation
Activity
1.
2.
Place the system cabinets side by side in the installation site and make
sure that they are level and stable. Correct any differences in height.
3.
If mounting the system on the floor or on a table, attach the two cabinets
using four connecting plates each held by two screws with washers (Figure 4-8). Be sure to fasten all four of the adjoining corners.
Make sure that the connecting plates are mounted in the correct direction
(inside the cabinets and pointing inward).
BC
EC1
BC
EC1
Front
BC
EC1
Washers
Inside the cabinet
Back
Figure 4-8
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
4-19
Installation
HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 Installation
Caution
Only two cabinets may be stacked vertically. When setting up a three-cabinet system place EC2 next to the BC.
Procedure
Step
>
4-20
Activity
1.
2.
Mount one stabilizer foot (not for U.S.) on the basic cabinet and one on
the expansion cabinet (EC2). Place EC2 next to the BC in the installation
site and make sure that it is level and stable. Correct any differences in
height.
3.
Place expansion cabinet EC1 on the basic cabinet. Insert the feet of EC1
into the depressions in the top of the BC.
4.
Attach the three cabinets using four connecting plates, each held by two
screws with washers (Figure 4-9).
Make sure that the connecting plates are mounted in the correct direction
(inside the cabinet and pointing inward).
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Installation
HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 Installation
EC1
EC1
BC
Washers
EC2
BC
Front
EC2
EC1
EC1
EC2
Inside the
cabinet
BC
BC
Washers
Back
Figure 4-9
>
To lay the cables between the BC and EC2, remove the lower grills in the two rear
covers.
To lay the connecting cables between the BC and EC1, cut out the pre-stamped
recesses in the bottom of EC1 and top of the BC with a pair of diagonal cutting
pliers and break them out with a pair of flat-nosed pliers.
WARNING
Be careful when breaking out the recesses. Remove any sharp edges and corners.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
4-21
Installation
HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 Installation
>
Local building codes may require the use of seismic anchors in critical locations,
such as hospitals. The HiPath 3750 seismic anchor kit includes bolts and inserts
suitable for concrete floors. Consult the site planner for code requirements, or if the
customer wishes to install the seismic anchors on another type of floor.
Activity
1.
Hook the anchor into the center holes in the lower grill on each cabinet,
front and back.
2.
The anchor for the back of the cabinets is wider to provide space for cables.
Seismic Anchoring
Front
Figure 4-10
4-22
Back
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Installation
HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 Installation
Figure 4-11
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
4-23
Installation
HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 Installation
DANGER
The HiPath 3750 system and the MDFU or MDFU-E must be grounded by a separate protective ground conductor (minimum cross-section: 2.5 mm2) as shown in
Figure 4-12. Make sure that the ground conductor is securely installed and strainrelieved.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in electrical shock.
If one or two surface-mounted expansion cabinets are used in addition to the base
cabinet, the metal connecting plates must be installed to properly ground the expansion cabinets.
The illustrations starting with Figure 4-13 show different grounding options.
DANGER
If your personnel are not qualified to work on the low-voltage network (230 Vac), you
must hire a licensed electrician to install the ground using option 1b (Figure 4-14).
>
4-24
To avoid ground loops from remotely operated devices (V.24 system peripherals),
the devices should be connected to the same low-voltage network (sub-distribution
board) if possible.
If the building floor plan does not permit this, you may need a line driver to isolate
the external devices if any malfunctions occur.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Installation
HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 Installation
Grounding the System and Main Distribution Frame (Not for U.S.)
HiPath 3750, BC
MDFU or MDFU-E
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
4-25
Installation
HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 Installation
HiPath 3750
Figure 4-13
L1 N PE
230 Vac
Grounding outlet
HiPath 3750
Wall outlet (or similar)
green with yellow stripe
Figure 4-14
4-26
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Installation
HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 Installation
Ground field
Run an earth ground conductor from the earth ground to the cabinet frame ground
located in the center of the backplane. The minimum cross-section required is 14
AWG.
Figure 4-15 on page 4-28 shows the earth ground connections for the basic cabinet
(BC). If expansion cabinets are added to surface-mounted systems, the metal connecting plates bond them to the basic cabinet. If two cabinets are mounted on the
wall, the second cabinet requires an earth ground as well. Do not use the metal connecting plates on wall-mounted systems.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
4-27
Installation
HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 Installation
Power cord/plug
HiPath 3750
AC outlet
Fuse box
facility
20A
Ground
lug
120 Vac, 60 Hz
Neutral ground
Earth ground
7
Figure 4-15
DANGER
This wire installation must be completed by a qualified electrician and
must comply with the national and local electrical Codes.
Basic Cabinet Earth Ground (for U.S. Only)
4-28
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Installation
HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 Installation
Activity
Target
1.
< 10 ohms
Prerequisites:
Check the ohmic resistance between the individual system parts (basic cabinet, expansion
cabinets, main distribution frame).
< 1 ohms
Prerequisite:
HiPath 3750 is not yet connected to the lowvoltage network via the power cable.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
4-29
Installation
HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 Installation
>
All cables that leave the cabinet must be attached to the ventilation grill of the metal
back panel using cable ties.
>
The 8-slot basic cabinet has seven slots, while the expansion cabinets each have
eight slots for peripheral boards.
Backplane of the 8-Slot Basic Cabinet
X90
X80
X70
X60
X50
X40
X30
X20
UPSM
X10
CBCPR
X11
EC1
X12
X5
X13
EC2
X14
REAL
(BC
only)
X6
X88
X78
X68
X58
X48
X38
X28
X89
X79
X69
X59
X49
X39
X29
X7
Figure 4-16
4-30
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Installation
HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 Installation
X90
X80
X70
X60
X50
X40
X30
X20
UPSM
X10
X13
BC
X14
not used
not
used
Figure 4-17
X98
X88
X78
X68
X58
X48
X38
X28
X99
X89
X79
X69
X59
X49
X39
X29
Connector
Cabinet
X7
BC
X5
BC
X6
BC
X11
BC
X12
BC
X13
BC
EC1
EC2
X14
BC
EC1
EC2
X28 - X88
All
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Function
4-31
Installation
HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 Installation
Table 4-3
4-32
Connector
Cabinet
Function
X98
EC1
EC2
X29 - X89
All
X99
EC1
EC2
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Installation
HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 Installation
Then
Connect BC to EC1 = 2 cables (S30267-Z178-A13)
(see Figure 4-18)
Connect BC to EC1 = 2 cables (S30267-Z178-A13)
BC = S30777-U757-X,
S30777-U757-X103 (for
U.S. only)
EC1 = S30777-U708-X100,
S30777-U708-X103 (for
U.S. only)
Backplane part numbers
BC = S30777-Q757-X
EC1 = S30777-Q708-X100
Connecting cable part
numbers
Connect BC to EC1 =
S30267-Z178-A13
Figure 4-18
EC1
X13
X14
BC
X11
X12
X13
X14
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
4-33
Installation
HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 Installation
BC = S30777-U757-X,
S30777-U757-X103 (for U.S. only)
EC1
BC = S30777-Q757-X
X13
X14
X13
BC
X11
X12
X13
X14
X14
Figure 4-19
The cables between the basic cabinet and the expansion cabinets are connected in
a star configuration.
Terminating Resistors in 8-Slot Cabinets
4-34
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Installation
HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 Installation
Not for U.S.: You can use up to nine CABLUs per MDFU (Figure 4-23) and
21 CABLUs per MDFU-E (Figure 4-24), each with a 16 TW terminal strip or a 25 TW
terminal strip (9 x 30 mm).
Use open-end cables for special applications in which the prefabricated CABLUs cannot be used.
CABLUs for the Slots Containing Peripheral Boards (Figure 4-40) (Not for U.S.)
If
Then
Slot
with
SLMO81,
SLMO24,
SLA8N1,
SLA16N1
or
SLA24N
Slot with
TMS2
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
4-35
Installation
HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 Installation
If
Then
1 For these boards, a CABLU with 16 TW is also sufficient. To make it easier to expand the user configuration
(for example, by replacing the SLMO8 with SLMO24), we recommend the use of a CABLU with 24 TW.
CABLUs for the Slots Containing Peripheral Boards (Figure 4-40) (for U.S. Only)
If
Then
Slot with
Route 16 TW to the main distribution frame via SU_Xx8 and 8 TW
24-port
via SU_Xx9, using standard CABLU S30267-Z365-A30 (SU conperipheral board nectors are labeled 8 and 9.). Both cables are connected to the
same 50-pin Champ jack.
Slot with max. Route 16 TW to the main distribution frame via SU_Xx8 using
16-port
standard CABLU S30267-Z366-A30.
peripheral board
Slot with
TMST1
4-36
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Installation
HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 Installation
MW8 (RJ48C)
jack
(to the CSU or
networked
system)
Figure 4-20
SIPAC 1
SU jack
(Xx9 backplane)
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
4-37
Installation
HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 Installation
a
b
a
b
a
b
a
b
a
b
a
b
a
b
a
b
a
b
a
b
a
b
a
b
a
b
a
b
a
b
a
b
10
10
11
11
12
12
Connect the
wires
13
14
13
14
15
15
16
16
a
b
a
b
a
b
a
b
a
b
a
b
a
b
a
b
a
b
a
b
a
b
a
b
a
b
a
b
a
b
a
b
Cable with film sheath: No. 6 (conductive copper tape) 1.5 windings. Ground
wire shortened to 25 mm and soldered onto conductive tape (1).
Stripped length
250 5
4-38
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Installation
HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 Installation
Color
Group
Pair
a-Wire
wht/blu
b-Wire
Group
Pair
a-Wire
11
blk/blu
blu/wht
2
blu/blk
wht/ora
12
blk/ora
ora/wht
3
ora/blk
wht/grn
13
blk/grn
grn/wht
4
grn/blk
wht/brn
14
blk/brn
brn/wht
5
brn/blk
wht/gry
15
blk/gry
gry/wht
2
red/blu
gry/blk
4
blu/red
b-Wire
16
yel/blu
blu/yel
red/ora
ora/red
red/grn
grn/red
red/brn
brn/red
10
red/grn
grn/red
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
4-39
Installation
HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 Installation
4.2.3.8 Laying the Line Network and Setting Jumpers on the MDFU or MDFU-E
Danger
Connect the system to protective ground before connecting the stations.
>
If you jumper stations on the MDFU or MDFU-E (for example, with an ICCS network)
without first entering the relocate code, when you reconnect them the stations affected will go into operation with the data of the stations originally installed.
Connect the polarized surge protectors to the plugging locations on the splitting strip
described above (see Figure 4-21).
4-40
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Installation
HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 Installation
a
1
9 10 11 12 13 14 15
16
E = Receive
S = Transmit
1Ea 1Sa
1Eb 1Sb
a
1
9 10 11 12 13 14 15
16
S0 bus 8
S0 bus 1 ...
Splitting strip for 16 TW (C39334-A166-A1)
CABLU
S30269-Z100-A14: Cable 1 (SU Xx8)
No. 25
not used
a
11
13
15
17
19
21
23
25
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
4-41
Installation
HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 Installation
328.8 mm
1
2
367.0 mm
3
4
Jumper
channel
5
6
7
9 slots (9 x 30 mm)
8
9
Special built-in comps.
2 x PFT1
or
1 x PFT4
System side
Figure 4-23
4-42
Line network
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Installation
HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 Installation
328.8 mm
1
2
3
4
Jumper
channel
669.0 mm
5
6
21 slots (9 x 30 mm)
19
20
21
Special built-in comps.
2 x PFT1
or
1 x PFT4
System side
Line network
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
4-43
Installation
HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 Installation
DANGER
Ground the system properly before connecting the stations.
Caution
The TMST1 Module can be installed only in conjunction with a Listed channel service unit (CSU).
4-44
DANGER
To protect against surge voltage caused by lightning, use secondary protection for
the following HiPath 3750 boards when their wiring leaves the building where the
main distribution frame is housed:
SLA16
SLA16N
SLA24N
TMDID8
TMGL8
TMST1 (When this module is connected to the public network, secondary protection must be provided by the CSU.)
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Installation
HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 Installation
board configuration
applies to both HiPath 3700 and HiPath 3750 and is described starting in Section
4.2.5.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
4-45
Installation
HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 Installation
Normal Input
Voltage
Frequency
110 Vac
130 Vac
47 Hz
63 Hz
Receptacle
Configurations
NEMA 5-15, 2-pole,
3-wire, grounding
4-46
Activity
1.
2.
Determine whether any damage has occurred during transport and report
it to the appropriate departments or the shipper.
3.
Caution
Use only equipment and materials that are in perfect working order. Do not start up
equipment with visible damage.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Installation
HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 Installation
Danger
Be sure to ground the system properly before starting it up and connecting the stations.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
4-47
Installation
HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 Installation
Activity
1.
Insert a slotted screwdriver (with the blade vertical) into a recess (1).
2.
Carefully swing the handle of the screwdriver toward the center of the cabinet (2) until the fastener snaps out and the cover loosens.
3.
Then insert the screwdriver in the second recess (3), loosen its snap fastener. You can then remove the cover.
(3)
Cabinet
(1)
(2)
Figure 4-25
4-48
Warning
The front and rear covers on all system cabinets must be closed before the system
is started up in a 19-inch cabinet.
To replace a cover, position the snap fasteners in the two guides and press down on
the cover until it snaps into place.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Installation
HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 Installation
Warning
Never attempt to lift a system cabinet into the 19-inch cabinet without assistance.
Step
Activity
1.
Attach a right-handed and a left-handed support bracket (A in Figure 426) to the 19-inch cabinet using two screws per bracket.
2.
3.
4.
Attach the two angle brackets (B in Figure 4-26) to the front of the system
cabinet using two screws per bracket.
5.
Attach the four angle brackets (C in Figure 4-26) to the rear of the system
cabinet for base and cover support.
6.
Lift the system cabinet into the 19-inch cabinet and sit the cabinet on the
two support brackets (A). Slide the cabinet into the 19-inch cabinet until
the front edge of the system cabinet is flush with the front of the 19-inch
frame.
7.
Attach the system cabinet to the angle bracket (B) in the 19-inch cabinet
frame using two screws per bracket.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
4-49
Installation
HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 Installation
B
C
Figure 4-26
4-50
Caution
Be careful when breaking out the recesses. Remove any sharp edges and corners.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Installation
HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 Installation
B
Figure 4-27
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
4-51
Installation
HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 Installation
NO
NO
A potential equalization bus must be installed in the 19-inch cabinet and connected to the ground wire.
Danger
If your personnel are not qualified to
work on the low-voltage network (230
Vac), you must hire a licensed electrician to install the ground.
YES
Does the 19-inch cabinet have
a potential equalization bus
at which the HiPath 3700 can
be grounded as shown in Figure 4-28?
YES
If you answer Yes to both questions, the system (system cabinets, patch panels)
may be grounded as described below.
4-52
Danger
Each HiPath 3700 system cabinet and each patch panel (S30807-K6143-X) must
be grounded as shown in Figure 4-28 by a separate protective ground conductor
(minimum cross-section = 2.5 mm2). Make sure that the ground conductor is securely installed and strain-relieved.
Please note:
The 19-inch cabinets potential equalization bus may only be used if it is grounded
by a separate protective ground conductor.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in electrical shock.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Installation
HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 Installation
HiPath 3700, BC
Patch panel
S30807-K6143-X
Figure 4-28
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
4-53
Installation
HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 Installation
>
To avoid ground loops from remotely operated devices (V.24 system peripherals),
the devices should be connected to the same low-voltage network (sub-distribution
board) if possible.
If the building floor plan does not permit this, you may need a line driver to isolate
the external devices if any malfunctions occur.
Activity
Target
1.
Check the ohmic resistance of the ground connection to the 19-inch cabinet:
Perform measurement between the PE (protective earth) on a socket in the internal installation
(at the systems installation site) and HiPath
3700.
< 10 ohms
Prerequisites:
No device in the 19-inch cabinet is connected to the low-voltage network via the power
cable.
Check the ohmic resistance between the individual system parts (basic cabinet, expansion
cabinets, patch panel).
< 1 ohm
Prerequisite:
HiPath 3700 is not yet connected to the lowvoltage network via the power cable.
4-54
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Installation
HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 Installation
>
All cables that leave the cabinet must be attached to the ventilation grill of the metal
back panel using cable ties.
>
The 8-slot basic cabinet has seven slots, while the expansion cabinets each have
eight slots for peripheral boards.
Backplane of the 8-Slot Basic Cabinet
X90
X80
X70
X60
X50
X40
X30
X20
UPSM
X10
CBCPR
X11
EC1
X12
X5
X13
EC2
X14
REAL
(BC
only)
X6
X88
X78
X68
X58
X48
X38
X28
X7
X89
Figure 4-29
X79
X69
X59
X49
X39
X29
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
4-55
Installation
HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 Installation
X90
X80
X70
X60
X50
X40
X30
X20
X10
UPSM
X13
BC
X14
not used
not
used
Figure 4-30
X98
X88
X78
X68
X58
X48
X38
X28
X99
X89
X79
X69
X59
X49
X39
X29
4-56
Connector
Cabinet
Function
X7
BC
X5
BC
X6
BC
X11
BC
X12
BC
X13
BC
EC1
EC2
X14
BC
EC1
EC2
X28 - X88
All
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Installation
HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 Installation
Table 4-6
Connector
Cabinet
X98
EC1
EC2
X29 - X89
All
X99
EC1
EC2
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Function
4-57
Installation
HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 Installation
Then
Connect BC to EC1 = 2 cables (S30267-Z178-A13)
(see Figure 4-31)
Connect BC to EC1 = 2 cables (S30267-Z178-A13)
Connect BC to EC2 = 2 cables (S30267-Z178-A13)
(see Figure 4-32)
BC = S30777-U757-X,
S30777-U757-X103 (for
U.S. only)
EC1 = S30777-U708-X100,
S30777-U708-X103 (for
U.S. only)
Backplane part numbers
BC = S30777-Q757-X
EC1 = S30777-Q708-X100
Connecting cable part
numbers
Figure 4-31
4-58
EC1
X13
X14
BC
X11
X12
X13
X14
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Installation
HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 Installation
BC = S30777-U757-X,
S30777-U757-X103 (for U.S. only)
EC1
BC = S30777-Q757-X
X13
X14
X13
BC
X14
Figure 4-32
X11
X12
X13
X14
The cables between the basic cabinet and the expansion cabinets are connected in
a star configuration.
Terminating Resistors in 8-Slot Cabinets
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
4-59
Installation
HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 Installation
4.2.4.7.2 Connecting the Patch Panel and Backplane (in the 19-Inch Cabinet)
Introduction
Set up the connection between the patch panel and system using CABLUs (prefabricated cabling units) with the following characteristics:
Not for U.S.: Open-end cable (for STMD8) or SIVAPAC socket connectors
(for all other boards)
CABLUs for the Slots Containing Peripheral Boards (Not for U.S.)
4-60
If
Then
Slot
with
SLMO81,
SLMO24,
SLA8N1,
SLA16N1
or
SLA24N
Route 16 TW to the patch panel via SU Xx8 and 8 TW via SU Xx9 using a standard cable (with 16 TW) for each connection. Connect both
cables (= 1 CABLU with SU connectors labeled 8 and 9) to the same
SIVAPAC socket connector (25 TW).
Order number for CABLU with a 24 TW:
Slot
with
STMD8
Slot
with
TMS2
Slot with
any other
peripheral
board
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Installation
HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 Installation
If
Then
Slot
with
REAL
1 For these boards, a CABLU with 16 TW is also sufficient. To make it easier to expand the user configuration
(for example, by replacing the SLMO8 with SLMO24), we recommend that you use a CABLU with 24 TW.
CABLUs for the Slots Containing Peripheral Boards (for U.S. Only)
If
Then
Slot with
Route 16 TW to the patch panel via SU_Xx8 and 8 TW via
24-port
SU_Xx9, using standard CABLU S30267-Z365-A30 (SU connecperipheral board tors are labeled 8 and 9.). Both cables are connected to the same
50-pin Champ jack.
Slot with max. Route 16 TW to the main distribution frame via SU_Xx8 using
16-port
standard CABLU S30267-Z366-A30.
peripheral board
Slot with
TMST1
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
4-61
Installation
HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 Installation
>
All incoming cables must be attached to the patch panel using cable ties.
Information on MW8 jack assignment on the front of the patch panel is provided in the
board descriptions (in the Cable and Connector Assignment table) in Chapter 3.
Surge Protector
To divert surges caused by lightning, insert surge protectors on
Connect the polarized surge protectors to slots F1 F8 provided on the patch panel
(see Figure 4-34).
4-62
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Installation
HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 Installation
X1
X11
X12
X13
X14
X15
1
1
1
1
X9
X10
1
1
PFT1
17 19 21 23 25 27 29 31
18 20 22 24 26 28 30 32
1 3 5 7 9 11 13 15
2 4 6 8 10 12 14 16
33 35 37 39 41 43 45 47
34 36 38 40 42 44 46 48
Connection via the MW8 jacks on the front of the patch panels. Using jumper wire, bridges must be inserted between the terminal strips X12 and X14
and between X13 and X15. The contact between the connector X5 and the
first eight MW8 jacks is only set up when wire bridges are present.
Direct connector jumpering on the X12/X13 connector. Bridges are not necessary in this case.
2
1
3
2
4
3
5
4
6
5
7
6
X12/X14
8
7
X13/X15
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
a b a b a b a b a b a b a b a b
Figure 4-34
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
4-63
Installation
HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 Installation
>
All incoming cables must be attached to the patch panel using cable ties.
24
22
20
18 ...
... 8
23
21
19
17 ...
... 7
Pin
as a trunk connection
Transmit +
Receive +
Receive +
Transmit +
Receive
Transmit
Transmit
Receive
CABLUs must be manually connected to the S0 patch panel (Figure 4-36). You can
use the Krone wiring tool for this.
Refer to the following tables for information on the assignment of the MW8 jacks:
4-64
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Installation
HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 Installation
87632145
Pin assignment of MW8 jacks
Twist the wire pairs before laying them.
Figure 4-36
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
4-65
Installation
HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 Installation
Stripped length
250 5
(1)
Pair
a-Wire
wht/blu
wht/ora
b-Wire
Color
Group
Pair
a-Wire
red/blu
red/ora
blu/wht
wht/grn
wht/brn
red/grn
red/brn
11
blk/blu
12
blk/ora
b-Wire
blu/blk
ora/blk
13
blk/grn
14
blk/brn
grn/blk
brn/red
10
gry/wht
a-Wire
grn/red
brn/wht
wht/gry
Pair
ora/red
grn/wht
Color
Group
blu/red
ora/wht
3
b-Wire
brn/blk
red/grn
15
blk/gry
16
yel/blu
grn/red
gry/blk
4
blu/yel
Figure 4-37
4-66
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Installation
HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 Installation
MW8 (RJ48C)
jack
(to the NT,
CSU or networked system)
Figure 4-38
SIPAC 1
SU jack
(Xx9 backplane)
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
4-67
Installation
HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 Installation
Danger
Connect the system to protective ground before connecting the stations.
Telephones and trunks are connected directly to the MW8 jack on the front of the
patch panel. Information on MW8 jack assignment on the front of the patch panel is
provided in the board descriptions (in the Cable and Connector Assignment table)
in Chapter 3.
>
If you jumper stations on the patch panel (for example, with an ICCS network) without first entering the relocate code, when you reconnect them the stations affected
will go into operation with the data of the stations originally installed.
17 19 21 23 25 27 29 31
33 35 37 39 41 43 45 47
2 4 6 8 10 12 14 16
18 20 22 24 26 28 30 32
34 36 38 40 42 44 46 48
SLA16N/SLC16/SLC16N
1 3 5 7 9 11 13 15
17 19 21 23 25 27 29 31
33 35 37 39 41 43 45 47
2 4 6 8 10 12 14 16
18 20 22 24 26 28 30 32
34 36 38 40 42 44 46 48
SLA24N
SLA16N/SLC16/SLC16N
1 3 5 7 9 11 13 15
17 19 21 23 25 27 29 31
33 35 37 39 41 43 45 47
2 4 6 8 10 12 14 16
18 20 22 24 26 28 30 32
34 36 38 40 42 44 46 48
SLA16N/SLC16/SLC16N
Figure 4-39
4-68
SLA16N/SLC16/SLC16N
SLA24N
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Installation
HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 Installation
4.2.5 Loading the System Software and Inserting Subboards on the Central
Control Board
Caution
Always wear an antistatic wristband when working on the system (especially when
handling boards). Connect the wristband to the slide-in shelf in the cabinet using the
alligator clip.
Outside the U.S., the cabinets are already equipped with the boards needed for the
customer-specific requirements when the system is delivered.
In the U.S., you may need to install the boards.
The central boards are not always fully equipped when delivered. Optional plug-in
boards are packaged individually.
See Chapter 3 for information on slots for subboards on the central control boards.
Caution
Place the central control board on a flat surface before inserting subboards (such
as CMA, CMS, or IMODC).
The spacing bolts supplied guarantee the correct insertion of the subboard, so you
should always mount them (see Figure 3-5).
Otherwise you may damage the board.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
4-69
Installation
HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 Installation
UPSM power supply unit -> slot 09 in the BC, slot 18 in EC1, slot 27 in EC2.
4-70
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Installation
HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 Installation
Basic Cabinet BC
Slot no.:
Slot width
(mm):
UPSM
CBCPR
02
03
04
05
06
07
08
45
30
30
30
30
30
30
45
90
X10
X20
X30
X40
X50
X60
X70
X80
X90
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
UPSM
EC2:
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
UPSM
Slot width
(mm)
30
30
30
30
30
30
30
30
90
X10
X20
X30
X40
X50
X60
X70
X80
X90
Figure 4-40
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
4-71
Installation
HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 Installation
TML8W with GEE8: Use a 45 mm slot for the TML8W even if you are not installing a GEE8 so that you can easily add a GEE8 later.
TMDID8
Narrow boards requiring a slot 30 mm (1.2 in.) wide (= all other boards)
You can insert wide boards into a 30 mm (1.2 in.) slot, but if you do so, you can no
longer use the slot to its right.
Caution
Always wear an antistatic wristband and observe the measures for protecting electrostatically sensitive devices.
4-72
The maximum configuration has not yet been reached. While sequentially scanning the slots for each board, the system software checks whether the maximum
number of stations or trunks has been exceeded. If it has, the board is not activated. The board LED shows the boards status.
At least one B channel on line trunk modules is available for the slot (only the
available number of B channels is activated).
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Installation
HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 Installation
Expansion cabinet 1
U
P
S
M
Basic cabinet
U
P
S
M
C
B
C
P
R
Figure 4-41
Expansion cabinet 2
U
P
S
M
HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 - Initialization of Subscriber Line Circuits and Ports
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
4-73
Installation
HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 Installation
CR8N
HXGM, HXGM2
16
IVML24
24
4-74
SLC16, SLC16N
SLMO8, SLMO24
STMD8
16
TIEL
TMDID8
TML8W
TMOM
TMS2
30
TMST1
24
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Installation
HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 Installation
Caution
The following rules for population with boards must be observed to ensure the errorfree and non-blocking operation of the system:
SLC16, SLC16N
Maximum one SLC16 or SLC16N per PCM segment. The SLC16 or
SLC16N should be configured alone on the PCM segment, where possible.
Note the following information on the subject of multi-SLCs: SLC16 and
SLC16N Board Distribution in HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 Cabinets on
page 3-137.
SLMO24
A maximum of two SLMO24s per PCM segment; the number of connected stations (hosts (primary) and clients (secondary) may not be more than 64.
The figures below show the PCM segments (64 time-division multiplex channels
each) for the different HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 system configurations.
8-Slot cabinets
C 000000 0
B 234567 8
C
P
R
U
P
S
M
BC
Figure 4-42
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
4-75
Installation
HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 Installation
8-Slot cabinets
C 000000 0
B 234567 8
C
P
R
U
P
S
M
U
P
S
M
EC1
BC
Figure 4-43
1 111111 1
0 123456 7
8-Slot cabinets
1 111111 1
0 123456 7
U
P
S
M
EC1
C 000000 0
B 234567 8
C
P
R
BC
Figure 4-44
4-76
U
P
S
M
1 222222 2
9 012345 6
U
P
S
M
EC2
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Installation
HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 Installation
64 Erlangs
04 + 05
64 Erlangs
06 + 07 + 08
64 Erlangs
02 + 03
64 Erlangs
04 + 05
64 Erlangs
06 + 07 + 08
64 Erlangs
10 + 11
64 Erlangs
12 + 13
64 Erlangs
14 + 15
64 Erlangs
16 + 17
64 Erlangs
02 + 03
64 Erlangs
04 + 05
64 Erlangs
06 + 07 + 08
64 Erlangs
10 + 11 + 19 + 20
64 Erlangs
12 + 13 + 21 + 22
64 Erlangs
14 + 15 + 23 + 24
64 Erlangs
16 + 17 + 25 + 26
64 Erlangs
Single-cabinet system
(see Figure 4-42)
Two-cabinet system
(see Figure 4-43)
Three-cabinet system
(see Figure 4-44)
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
448 Erlangs
448 Erlangs
4-77
Installation
HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 Installation
Then
Unlocking the
board (1)
Swing both plastic levers outward simultaneously. You can now pull
the board out of the system on its guide rails.
Locking
the board (2)
Slide the board into the system using its guide rails. Insert the
hooks on the locking levers into the recesses in the shelf. Press
down on both levers simultaneously in the direction of the shelf until they snap into place.
(1)
(2)
(2)
(1)
Figure 4-45
4-78
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Installation
HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 Installation
The special REAL board is mounted on the metal back panel (basic cabinet only) and
connected to the backplane with a ribbon cable.
TIEL
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
4-79
Installation
HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 Installation
DANGER
Before beginning work, make sure that the system is grounded and disconnected
from the power supply. For U.S. only: Use lockout/tagout (LOTO) procedures.
Observe the measures for protecting electrostatically sensitive devices (see page
1-9).
>
4-80
Step
Activity
Materials
Action
1.
Card map
2.
3.
After finishing the visual inspection, you can begin starting up the HiPath 3750 or
HiPath 3700 system as described in Section 5.2.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Installation
HiPath 3550, HiPath 3350, HiPath 3500 and HiPath 3300 Installation
4.3 HiPath 3550, HiPath 3350, HiPath 3500 and HiPath 3300 Installation
4.3.1 Installation Prerequisites
Warning
The system may be installed by authorized service personnel only.
Tools:
TORX screwdriver
Electric drill
Hammer
Level
Tape measure
Help:
For U.S. only: AuroraDuet, AuroraExpert, AuroraRemote, or similar, ISDN protocol analyzer (for PRI)
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
4-81
Installation
HiPath 3550, HiPath 3350, HiPath 3500 and HiPath 3300 Installation
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
10.
11.
12.
13.
4-82
HiPath 3550, HiPath 3350, HiPath 3500 and HiPath 3300 - System
Installation Procedure
Installation Activity
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Installation
HiPath 3550, HiPath 3350, HiPath 3500 and HiPath 3300 Installation
To guarantee sufficient system ventilation, keep the area surrounding the housing clear as follows: allow 30 cm clearance on the left (for board replacement),
and 10 cm clearance on the right, top and bottom of the housing.
Do not expose the systems to direct sources of heat (such as sunlight and heaters).
Ensure that the installation site is in the immediate vicinity of an electrical outlet
Ensure that Siemens equipment is 40 in. (101.6 cm) from other electrical equipment. The National Electrical Code (NEC) requires 36 in. (91.44 cm) of clearance
in front of electrical equipment and 40 in. (101.6 cm) of clearance from other electrical service equipment.
Ensure that the equipment room for the system provides adequate space for installation and maintenance activities, including removing and replacing the cover.
See Figure 4-46 on page 4-84 for space requirements on the sides of the system.
We recommend using a plywood backboard at least 0.5 in. (127 mm) thick and
measuring at least 4 ft. (122 cm) by 4 ft. (122 cm).
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
4-83
Installation
HiPath 3550, HiPath 3350, HiPath 3500 and HiPath 3300 Installation
You will find information on the design and dimensions in the following sections:
HiPath 3550 and HiPath 3350 Space Requirements (for U.S. Only)
MDF
Allow 18 in.
(460 mm)
HiPath 3550
or
HiPath 3350
8 in.
(203 mm)
20 in.
(508 mm)
HiPath 3550 and HiPath 3350 Space Requirements (for U.S. Only)
For U.S. only: The system measures 18 by 17.7 inches (460 x 450 mm). It requires
18 in. (460 mm) of clearance on the left, and at least 8 in. (203 mm) of clearance on
the top and right. Allow 20 in. (508 mm) of clearance on the bottom (for cords). Observe also the NEC requirements on page 4-83.
4-84
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Installation
HiPath 3550, HiPath 3350, HiPath 3500 and HiPath 3300 Installation
Normal Input
Voltage
Frequency
Receptacle
Configurations
110 Vac
130 Vac
47 Hz
63 Hz
Should have a warning attached to the circuit breaker that controls it to prevent
accidental removal of power
Recommended: Add a power surge protector between the outlet and the system
Step
Activity
1.
Compare the components included in the delivery with the packing slip
or customer receipt to make sure that they are complete.
2.
Determine whether any damage has occurred during transport and report it to the appropriate departments or the shipper.
3.
Danger
Use only equipment and materials that are in perfect working order. Do not start up
equipment with visible damage.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
4-85
Installation
HiPath 3550, HiPath 3350, HiPath 3500 and HiPath 3300 Installation
4.3.3.3 Mounting the Main Distribution Frame (HiPath 3550 only) (Not for U.S.)
Introduction
The main distribution frame unit (MDFU) (see Figure 4-47) is the main distribution
frame used.
Installation Notes
The MDFU should be installed in the direct vicinity of the system (note length of connecting cable) and at eye level. Mount it on the wall according to the instructions that
came with it. The bag attached to the cover contains a drill template and screws and
wall anchors for attaching the MDF to the wall.
The MDFU must be grounded. Refer to Section 4.3.3.6 for an explanation of the procedure.
Procedure for Mounting the MDFU on the Wall
Step
4-86
Activity
1.
2.
Insert the wall anchors and screw in the screws, leaving 5 mm projecting.
3.
Mount the MDFU on the brackets and remove the packing protection covering.
4.
Remove the housing cover and tighten the screws through the holes.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Installation
HiPath 3550, HiPath 3350, HiPath 3500 and HiPath 3300 Installation
328.8 mm
1
2
367.0 mm
3
4
Jumper
channel
5
6
7
9 slots (9 x 30 mm)
8
9
Spec. built-in comp.
2 x PFT1
or
1 x PFT4
System side
Figure 4-47
Line network
MDFU Layout and Dimensions (367.0 x 328.8 x 125.4 mm) (Not for
U.S.)
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
4-87
Installation
HiPath 3550, HiPath 3350, HiPath 3500 and HiPath 3300 Installation
Warning
To prevent injuries, you must observe the following notes for the removal and attachment of the HiPath 3550 and HiPath 3350 housing cover.
Procedure
4-88
Step
Action
1.
Loosen the two screwed plugs on the housing cover with a slotted screw
driver. Hold the housing cover so that it does not fall.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Installation
HiPath 3550, HiPath 3350, HiPath 3500 and HiPath 3300 Installation
Step
Action
2.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
4-89
Installation
HiPath 3550, HiPath 3350, HiPath 3500 and HiPath 3300 Installation
Not an
attachment
point
Hang system
and tighten screws
PSU/
UPS
Cable
duct
Hous. back panel
Oblong holes for
wall attachment
Attachment of
PSU
UPS
to the housing
back panel
30 cm
Minimum clearance for board replacement (for U.S.: 18 in.)
4-90
Figure 4-48
Figure 4-49
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Installation
HiPath 3550, HiPath 3350, HiPath 3500 and HiPath 3300 Installation
4.3.3.6 Grounding the System and the External Main Distribution Frame
Grounding the System (Not for U.S.)
>
Because of their safety class, the HiPath 3550 and HiPath 3350 (wall housing) do
not have to be grounded.
If protective grounding is required in certain countries (for example in Finland, Norway, U.S.), the HiPath 3550 and HiPath 3350 must be grounded by a separate protective ground conductor via the ground connection marked
.
HiPath 3550: Shipments always include an MDFU (Germany only) and two
grounding cables. Use one of the cables to ground the MDFU. It is not necessary
to ground the connection between the MDFU and HiPath 3550 (see Figure 4-50).
HiPath 3350: This system type does not require an external main distribution
frame. The connecting cables to the peripherals are attached directly to the
boards and routed to the outside via a cable duct inside the housing.
Danger
An external main distribution frame which requires grounding (if the existing ground
connection is marked
), must be grounded by a separate ground wire (minimum cross section = 2.5 mm2).
Failure to observe this requirement may cause irreversible damage to the system.
Refer to Figure 4-50 when replacing a customer system using the existing external
main distribution frame.
For U.S. Only
The customer supplies a main distribution frame (MDF) to complete the communications system. Mount and ground the MDF in accordance with the manufacturers instructions.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
4-91
Installation
HiPath 3550, HiPath 3350, HiPath 3500 and HiPath 3300 Installation
O
L
D
Communication system to be
replaced
S
Y
S
T
E
M
N
E
W
Grounding
screw
S
Y
S
T
E
M
e.g. MDFU
4-92
HiPath 3550 and HiPath 3350 - Grounding an External Main Distribution Frame
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Installation
HiPath 3550, HiPath 3350, HiPath 3500 and HiPath 3300 Installation
Caution
The TST1 Module (HiPath 3550) can be installed only in conjunction with a Listed
channel service unit (CSU).
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
4-93
Installation
HiPath 3550, HiPath 3350, HiPath 3500 and HiPath 3300 Installation
Then
SLA8N
SLA16N
SLA24N
SLC16
SLC16N
SLMO24
Slot with
any other
peripheral
board
HiPath 3550 - MDFU Ports for Peripheral Boards in HiPath 3750 Format
The two arrows on the left mark the connections for the cables coming from the
main distribution frame (MDFU).
Figure 4-51
4-94
HiPath 3550 - Backplane Connection for a Peripheral Board in HiPath 3750 Format
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Installation
HiPath 3550, HiPath 3350, HiPath 3500 and HiPath 3300 Installation
HiPath 3550 and HiPath 3350 - CABLU for Connection to the External Main Distribution
Frame
Jumper strip (25 TW) for installation in the external main distribution frame
Figure 4-52
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
4-95
Installation
HiPath 3550, HiPath 3350, HiPath 3500 and HiPath 3300 Installation
Screw connections to
the network
Figure 4-53
Plug connection
to the HiPath 3550
or HiPath 3350
system
If you have an external main distribution frame (MDFU), use CABLU S30269-Z41A30 (Figure 4-52) to connect the peripheral boards to the customers line network. As
shown in Figure 4-53, you can connect the 8-pin slip-on connectors directly to the
boards. The line network connects to the jumper strip.
4-96
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Installation
HiPath 3550, HiPath 3350, HiPath 3500 and HiPath 3300 Installation
The TST1 Module (HiPath 3550) connects to a customer-supplied channel service unit (CSU) using the supplied cable. The CSU provides the required secondary protection.
Each port on the STLS4 Module connects to an S0 bus using the supplied, silversatin connector cord and a surface-mounted RJ45X jack (a biscuit block). The
surface-mounted RJ45X jack is not supplied.
The signals must be reversed in the RJ45X jack; see Figure 3-68 on page 3-161.
The board in Slot 10 of HiPath 3550 connects using a special cable from the
backplane to the main distribution frame (MDF).
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
4-97
Installation
HiPath 3550, HiPath 3350, HiPath 3500 and HiPath 3300 Installation
min. 15 mm
Ferrite sleeve
C39022-Z7000-C7
Power cable
Figure 4-54
4-98
HiPath 3550 and HiPath 3350 - Power Cable with Ferrite Sleeve
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Installation
HiPath 3550, HiPath 3350, HiPath 3500 and HiPath 3300 Installation
Digital and Analog Trunks and Subscriber Lines of the HiPath 3550 (Wall Housing)
>
With maximum system configuration, there are not enough ferrite sleeves in the accessory pack for all trunks and subscriber lines. In this case, you will need to order
additional ferrite.
If
Then
Trunk board Guide both standard cables from SU_X8 and SU_X9 (see Figure 4or subscrib- 51) to the MDF through two ferrite sleeves (C39022-Z7000-C7) each.
er line mod- The ferrite should be placed as far inside the housing as possible.
ules in HiPath 3750
format
Trunk board
or subscriber line modules in
small format
Guide the trunk and subscriber lines of all ports connected on a board
through a ferrite sleeve twice, i.e. in a loop. The ferrite should be fixed
in the cable duct as much as possible. If the number of lines makes
this impossible, the ferrite can be attached directly at the output of the
cable duct.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
4-99
Installation
HiPath 3550, HiPath 3350, HiPath 3500 and HiPath 3300 Installation
>
Restrictions for equipment with the IVMP8, IVMS8, LAN Bridge, TST1 and TS2
boards must be observed.
PSU
UPS
Cable
duct
1
2
Slot levels
Figure 4-55
4-100
Optional boards
CUC
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Installation
HiPath 3550, HiPath 3350, HiPath 3500 and HiPath 3300 Installation
Slot 2
Slot 3
Opt.5
Slot 6
Slot 7
Slot 8
Slot 9
Wall
CBCC
Slot 4
Slot 5
OPAL
V.24
To MDF
1
Figure 4-56
2
3
4
Slot levels
Figure 4-57
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
4-101
Installation
HiPath 3550, HiPath 3350, HiPath 3500 and HiPath 3300 Installation
PSU
UPS
Cable
duct
1
2
Optional boards
3
CUP
Slot levels
Figure 4-58
Opt.2
Opt.3
Opt.4
Opt.5
Slot 2
Slot 3
V.24
Wall
CBCC
Slot 4
Slot 5
Opt.1
OPAL
Slot levels
Figure 4-59
4-102
Installation
HiPath 3550, HiPath 3350, HiPath 3500 and HiPath 3300 Installation
HiPath 3550
(see Figure 4-56)
HiPath 3350
(see Figure 4-59)
2 / 3 (CBCC)
24 Erlangs
16 Erlangs
16 Erlangs
16 Erlangs
16 Erlangs
16 Erlangs
30 Erlangs1
10
64 Erlangs
2 / 3 (CBCC)
24 Erlangs
16 Erlangs
16 Erlangs
198 Erlangs
56 Erlangs
1 Use of a TS2 board results in a capacity of 30 Erlangs. A maximum of one TS2 per HiPath 3550 is possible, and the board
may only be installed in slot 7 or 9, thus resulting in 30 Erlangs for slot 7 or 9.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
4-103
Installation
HiPath 3550, HiPath 3350, HiPath 3500 and HiPath 3300 Installation
Caution
Before beginning the work, make sure that the system is grounded and disconnected from the power supply. For U.S. only: Use lockout/tagout (LOTO) procedures.
Always wear an antistatic wristband and observe the measures for protecting electrostatically sensitive devices (see page 1-9).
Step
>
4-104
Activity
Materials
1.
2.
Possible remedies
Correct the board
configuration and
notify the sales department.
After finishing the visual inspection, you can begin starting up the system as described in Section 5.3.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Installation
HiPath 3550, HiPath 3350, HiPath 3500 and HiPath 3300 Installation
Danger
The HiPath 3500 and HiPath 3300 systems can only be operated with a closed
housing.
The system must be powered down and de-energized as follows before the housing
is opened:
Disconnect the line cord on any connected battery pack (for UPSC-DR only).
Disconnect the line cord on any connected EPSU2-R (for UPSC-DR only).
Installation in the 19-inch cabinet (with assembly kit 39165-A7027-D1 for HiPath
3500, assembly kit 39165-A7027-D4 for HiPath 3300)
You can also install an expansion cabinet rack ECR (not for U.S. and Canada) in
which you can install a battery pack (for uninterruptible power supply) and/or an additional external power supply EPSU2-R (if the systems internal power supply is not
sufficient) (see Section 6.4).
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
4-105
Installation
HiPath 3550, HiPath 3350, HiPath 3500 and HiPath 3300 Installation
Do not expose the systems to direct sources of heat (such as sunlight or heaters).
You will find information on the design and dimensions in the following section:
Frequency
4-106
110 Vac
130 Vac
47 Hz
63 Hz
Receptacle
Configurations
NEMA 5-15, 2-pole,
3-wire, grounding
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Installation
HiPath 3550, HiPath 3350, HiPath 3500 and HiPath 3300 Installation
Step
Activity
1.
Compare the components included in the delivery with the packing slip
to make sure they are complete.
2.
Determine whether any damage has occurred during transport and report it to the proper departments.
3.
Caution
Use only equipment and materials that are in perfect working order. Do not start up
equipment with visible damage.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
4-107
Installation
HiPath 3550, HiPath 3350, HiPath 3500 and HiPath 3300 Installation
4.3.4.4 Attaching a HiPath 3500 or HiPath 3300 to the Wall (19-Inch Housing) (Not for U.S.)
Procedure for Wall Mounting (see Figure 4-60)
Step
Activity
1.
Drill a hole in the selected wall, insert a wall anchor and screw in the
screws.
2.
Screw the angle brackets (A) and (B) for HiPath 3500 and HiPath 3300
onto the base of the device.
3.
Mount the system with the angle bracket (A) on the screws.
4.
Drill a second hole in the wall for the lower angle bracket (B), insert a wall
anchor and attach the angle bracket with a screw.
Wall Mounting
A
HiPath 3500 or HiPath 3300
B
Figure 4-60
4-108
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Installation
HiPath 3550, HiPath 3350, HiPath 3500 and HiPath 3300 Installation
Activity
1.
HiPath 3500 only: Attach the two angle brackets (A) to the 19-inch cabinet
using two screws per bracket.
2.
Attach the two angle brackets (B) to the left and right of the HiPath 3500
or HiPath 3300 using two screws per bracket.
3.
Slide the HiPath 3500 or HiPath 3300 system into the 19-inch cabinet and
attach it to the left and right of the 19-inch frame with screws.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
4-109
Installation
HiPath 3550, HiPath 3350, HiPath 3500 and HiPath 3300 Installation
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3500
Figure 4-61
4-110
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Installation
HiPath 3550, HiPath 3350, HiPath 3500 and HiPath 3300 Installation
NO
NO
A potential equalization bus must be installed in the 19-inch cabinet and connected to the ground wire.
Danger
If your personnel are not qualified to
work on the low-voltage network (230
Vac), you must hire a licensed electrician to install the ground.
YES
Does the 19-inch cabinet have
a potential equalization bus
at which the HiPath 3500 or HiPath 3300 can be grounded?
YES
If you answer Yes to both questions, the HiPath 3500 and HiPath 3300 systems
may be grounded as described below.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
4-111
Installation
HiPath 3550, HiPath 3350, HiPath 3500 and HiPath 3300 Installation
Activity
1.
Connect the grounding cable to the potential equalization bar on the 19inch cabinet.
2.
Connect the grounding cable to the systems ground connection with the
grounding screw supplied (point A).
3.
Attach the grounding cable (strain relief) to the system (point B) with a cable tie.
A
Grounding cable
Danger
The HiPath 3500 or HiPath 3300 19-inch housing to be wall-mounted must be
grounded by a separate protective ground conductor (such as a potential equalization bar). Make sure that the ground conductor is securely installed and strain-relieved.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in electrical shock.
4-112
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Installation
HiPath 3550, HiPath 3350, HiPath 3500 and HiPath 3300 Installation
Clip
Tooth lock washer
Housing cover
Figure 4-63
Line Network
The connecting cords to the peripherals can be connected directly to the relevant
MW8 jacks on the front panel of the 19-inch housing.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
4-113
Installation
HiPath 3550, HiPath 3350, HiPath 3500 and HiPath 3300 Installation
Caution
For safety, operate HiPath 3500 only with the housing front closed. Always use dummy panels (C39165-A7027-B115) to close slots that are not equipped with boards.
Slot
levels:
5 (options)
Slots 1-3
4 (CBRC)
Figure 4-64
>
4-114
Slot 6
Slot 7
3 (peripheral boards)
Slot 8
Slot 9
2 (peripheral boards)
Slot 4
Slot 5
1 (peripheral boards)
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Installation
HiPath 3550, HiPath 3350, HiPath 3500 and HiPath 3300 Installation
Caution
For safety, operate HiPath 3300 only with the housing front closed. Always use dummy panels (C39165-A7027-B115) to close slots that are not equipped with boards.
Slot
levels:
3 (options)
Slots 1-3
Slot 4
Figure 4-65
2 (CBRC)
Slot 5
1 (peripheral boards)
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
4-115
Installation
HiPath 3550, HiPath 3350, HiPath 3500 and HiPath 3300 Installation
HiPath 3500
(see Figure 4-64)
HiPath 3300
(see Figure 4-65)
2 / 3 (CBRC)
24 Erlangs
16 Erlangs
16 Erlangs
16 Erlangs
16 Erlangs
16 Erlangs
30 Erlangs1
2 / 3 (CBRC)
24 Erlangs
16 Erlangs
16 Erlangs
134 Erlangs
56 Erlangs
1 Use of a TS2R board results in a capacity of 30 Erlangs. A maximum of one TS2R per HiPath 3500 is possible, and the
board may only be installed in slot 7 or 9, thus resulting in 30 Erlangs for slot 7 or 9.
4-116
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Installation
HiPath 3550, HiPath 3350, HiPath 3500 and HiPath 3300 Installation
TLA4R (MSI)
Caution
Before beginning work, make sure that the system is grounded and disconnected
from the power supply. For U.S. only: Use lockout/tagout (LOTO) procedures
Observe the measures for protecting electrostatically sensitive devices (see page
1-9).
Step
>
Activity
Materials
1.
2.
Action
Correct the board
configuration and
notify the sales department.
After finishing the visual inspection, you can begin starting up the system as described in Section 5.3.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
4-117
Installation
HiPath 3250 and HiPath 3150 Installation (Not for U.S.)
4.4 HiPath 3250 and HiPath 3150 Installation (Not for U.S.)
4.4.1 Installation Procedure
Step
Activity
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
Do not expose the systems to direct sources of heat (such as sunlight or heaters).
You will find information on the design and dimensions of HiPath 3250 and HiPath
3150 in Section 2.3.4.
4-118
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Installation
HiPath 3250 and HiPath 3150 Installation (Not for U.S.)
Step
Activity
1.
Compare the components included in the delivery with the packing slip
to make sure they are complete.
2.
Determine whether any damage has occurred during transport and report it to the proper departments.
3.
Caution
Use only equipment and materials that are in perfect working order. Do not start up
equipment with visible damage.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
4-119
Installation
HiPath 3250 and HiPath 3150 Installation (Not for U.S.)
4-120
Step
Activity
1.
Drill a hole for the wall anchor [B], insert the wall anchor and screw in the
screws, leaving 5 mm projecting.
2.
Insert the screwdriver into the hole on the housing cover under the triangle [A]. Slide the housing cover in the direction of the arrow and remove.
3.
If you have to remove the second housing cover (for board expansion),
press the right and left locking elements [D] on the back of the system with
a screwdriver and then slide the cover down [E]. Then press the cover
firmly until the locking elements snap into place.
4.
5.
Mark the position of the second wall anchor hole [C]. Remove the system.
6.
Drill a hole for the wall anchor [C] and insert the wall anchor.
7.
Mount the system again on the screw [B]. Screw in the screw [C], position
the system and tighten the screw [C].
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Installation
HiPath 3250 and HiPath 3150 Installation (Not for U.S.)
Housing cover
100 mm
Rear of housing
[B]
100 mm
100 mm
[A]
[C]
100 mm
[E]
[D]
Figure 4-66
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
4-121
Installation
HiPath 3250 and HiPath 3150 Installation (Not for U.S.)
Connection Overview
Figure 4-67
4-122
X3
8
PSU One
Reset/Reload switch
Run LED
2 S0 interfaces
V.24 interface,
9-pin SUB-D connector
MMC
X9
4 a/b interfaces
X1
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Installation
HiPath 3250 and HiPath 3150 Installation (Not for U.S.)
Figure 4-68
16
17
11
18
12
13
X3: S0
14
801 - 804
20
21
22
11
12
X3: S0
801/2
CO
Figure 4-69
17
STN.
>
After completing the visual inspection, you can start up the system as described in
Section 5.3.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
4-123
Installation
HiPath 3250 and HiPath 3150 Installation (Not for U.S.)
4-124
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Startup
Overview
5 Startup
5.1 Overview
Chapter Contents
This chapter discusses the topics listed in the table.
Topic
HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 Startup, page 5-2
HiPath 3550, HiPath 3350, HiPath 3250, HiPath 3150, HiPath 3500 and HiPath
3300 Startup, page 5-11
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
5-1
Startup
HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 Startup
WARNING
Only authorized service personnel should start up the system.
5-2
1.
2.
3.
Carrying Out the Country Initialization and Selecting the Password Type,
page 5-6
4.
5.
6.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Startup
HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 Startup
Activity
1.
Verify the voltage and plug in the power supply cable for each cabinet
2.
Watch the RUN LED on the CBCPR to observe the individual steps of
the system boot (Table 5-2).
RUN LED
Meaning
Off
No power
On
Off
Reset switch held down more than 5 seconds (LED is extinguished to acknowledge that a reload has begun)
On
System boot
Off
for 0.1 s
Flashing
0.5 s on/0.5 s off
Flashing
0.1 s on/0.1 s off
1 The flashing rhythm depends on the load. The higher the system load the slower the flashing
rhythm.
>
The HiPath 3750 or HiPath 3700 is ready when the date 1. JAN 00 and the time
00.00 appear in the display on the system telephone.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
5-3
Startup
HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 Startup
Then
Missing or defective
board
No action.
Underequipped
board variant
Over-equipped
board variant
5-4
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Startup
HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 Startup
Procedure: reinitialization
Proceed as follows if measures to expand the system configuration require reinitialization of the numbering plan:
Step
Activity
1.
2.
Description
A continuous numbering plan is generated (as was the case when the
system was first initialized).
Notes:
Only those ports provided for in accordance with the maximum configuration are activated if the maximum
line configuration is exceeded (too
many trunk boards).
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
5-5
Startup
HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 Startup
5.2.5 Carrying Out the Country Initialization and Selecting the Password
Type
>
Since the system software no longer provides all languages, some systems no longer start up on the customary local language after the country code is entered. You
must now load the local language prior to country initialization, using HiPath
3000 Manager E (see Section 7.13.5)
After carrying out the country initialization, but before loading the required local language, the displays come up in German.
The first time the system boots, the displays come up in German. Carry out the country initialization on the system telephone with internal station number 100 (port 01).
This process loads the country-specific language and features and ensures that the
system meets the countrys conditions for approval.
In Germany, no country adaptation is required after a reload because the system
boots with the German country code by default.
Subsequently the selection of the password type is required.
Input Procedure
Table 5-3
5-6
Step
Entry
Explanation
1.
*95
2.
31994
3.
31994
Default password
4.
XXXXX
5.
XXXXX
6.
29-5
7.
8.
XX
Country initialization
Selection of password type is requested:
1 = Variable password
2 = Fixed password
Country code is requested (see Table A-4 on page
A-9). The system subsequently boots up with the
country-specific default information.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Startup
HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 Startup
Table 5-3
Step
Explanation
Notes:
On step 4 and step 5: If a new password is issued, both steps are omitted when
calling the system again.
On step 6: No country adjustment is necessary for Germany because the system starts up with German codes.
On step 7: When selecting the fixed password, the default password (31994)
overwrites the new password entered under step 4.
Entering the country code starts the system. Any data that has already been stored,
such as system speed-dialing destinations and classes of service, is deleted or reset
to the default value.
>
After you enter a country code, the default data is guaranteed to load correctly only
if the system software has been officially released for that country.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
5-7
Startup
HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 Startup
Input Procedure
Table 5-4
5-8
Step
Input
Description
1.
*95
2.
Service
3.
XXXXX
Enter password
4.
5.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Startup
HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 Startup
>
Changes to the system (such as key programming) that were made using HiPath
3000 Manager E during an offline programming session will be lost when the database is loaded.
When you program the system offline, the assignments of trunk and subscriber
ports depend on the order in which the boards are inserted. Usually, the boards are
inserted from the lowest slot to the highest.
Refer to Chapter 7, Implementing Features, for information on how to program individual features.
Meaning of Call Charge and Hardware Options in the Transmission Dialog Box of HiPath
3000 Manager E
If
Then
You want to trans- Activate the call charge and hardware options (using HiPath
fer the most re- 3000 Manager E). This returns the system to the status it had
cent CDB to a
before bootstrapping.
bootstrapped
system.
CDB already in
the system.
Transfer changes to the CDB without using the call charge and
hardware options (in HiPath 3000 Manager E). Make sure you
select delta mode.
Activate the call charge option to transfer the following additional information to the
system:
Station PINs
Feature counters
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
5-9
Startup
HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 Startup
Activate the hardware option to transfer the following additional data to the system:
Active callbacks
The system restarts when you transfer the CDB with the hardware option activated.
Check the time and date display on each optiset E telephone. If a display does
not appear, the telephone or the link may be defective. Check if either the terminal or the link is defective. Replace the terminal or fix the link.
Carry out the telephone test described in Section 12.6.7 on page 12-20 on all
telephones.
5-10
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Startup
HiPath 3550, HiPath 3350, HiPath 3250, HiPath 3150, HiPath 3500 and HiPath 3300 Startup
5.3 HiPath 3550, HiPath 3350, HiPath 3250, HiPath 3150, HiPath 3500 and
HiPath 3300 Startup
*HiPath 3250 and HiPath 3150 not available in the U.S.
5.3.1 Overview
Section Contents
This section contains information on how to start up the HiPath 3550, HiPath 3350,
HiPath 3250, HiPath 3150, HiPath 3500 and HiPath 3300 communication systems.
WARNING
Only authorized service personnel should start up the system.
Caution
For safety, operate HiPath 3500 and HiPath 3300 only with the housing front closed.
Always use dummy panels (C39165-A7027-B115) to close slots that are not
equipped with boards.
Startup
Step
Activity
1.
2.
3.
Carrying Out the Country Initialization and Selecting the Password Type,
page 5-13
4.
5.
6.
When the date 1. JAN 00 and the time 00.00 appear in the display on the system
telephone, the system is ready.
>
Changes to the system (such as key programming) made during an offline programming session will be lost when data is restored to the PC.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
5-11
Startup
HiPath 3550, HiPath 3350, HiPath 3250, HiPath 3150, HiPath 3500 and HiPath 3300 Startup
HiPath 3550, HiPath 3350, HiPath 3250, HiPath 3150, HiPath 3500 and HiPath 3300 RUN
LED
The central board has a RUN LED that indicates the system status.
Table 5-6
RUN LED
Meaning
Off
No power
On
Off
Reset switch held down more than 5 seconds (LED is extinguished to acknowledge that a reload has begun)
On
System boot
Off
for 0.1 s
Flashing
0.5 s on/0.5 s off
Flashing
0.1 s on/0.1 s off
1 The flashing rhythm depends on the load. The higher the system load the slower the flashing
rhythm.
5-12
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Startup
HiPath 3550, HiPath 3350, HiPath 3250, HiPath 3150, HiPath 3500 and HiPath 3300 Startup
5.3.4 Carrying Out the Country Initialization and Selecting the Password
Type
>
Since the system software no longer provides all languages, some systems no longer start up on the customary local language after the country code is entered. You
must now load the local language prior to country initialization, using HiPath
3000 Manager E (see Section 7.13.5).
After carrying out the country initialization, but before loading the required local language, the displays come up in German.
The first time the system boots, the displays come up in German. Carry out the country initialization on the system telephone with the internal station number 100 (HiPath
3550 and HiPath 3500) or 11 for (HiPath 3350, HiPath 3250, HiPath 3150 and HiPath
3300) (port 01). This process loads the country-specific language and features and
ensures that the system meets the countrys conditions for approval.
In Germany, no country initialization is required following a reload because the system boots with the German country code by default.
Subsequently the selection of the password type is required.
Input Procedure
Table 5-7
Step
Entry
1.
*95
2.
31994
3.
31994
Default password
4.
XXXXX
5.
XXXXX
6.
29-5
7.
8.
XX
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Explanation
Start system administration
Country initialization
Selection of password type is requested:
1 = Variable password
2 = Fixed password
Country code is requested (see Table A-4 on page
A-9). The system subsequently boots up with the
country-specific default information.
5-13
Startup
HiPath 3550, HiPath 3350, HiPath 3250, HiPath 3150, HiPath 3500 and HiPath 3300 Startup
Table 5-7
Step
Explanation
Notes:
On step 4 and step 5: If a new password is issued, both steps are omitted when
calling the system again.
On step 6: No country adjustment is necessary for Germany because the system starts up with German codes.
On step 7: When selecting the fixed password, the default password (31994)
overwrites the new password entered under step 4.
Note: Entering the country code initiates a hard reset. Any data that has already been
stored, such as system speed-dialing destinations and classes of service, is deleted
or reset to its default value.
>
5-14
After you enter a country code, the default data is guaranteed to load correctly only
if the system software has been officially released for that country.
HiPath 3550, HiPath 3350, HiPath 3250, HiPath 3150, HiPath 3500 and HiPath
3300 have not been introduced in some of the countries listed in Table A-4 on page
A-9. The correct loading of the default data is not guaranteed for those countries.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Startup
HiPath 3550, HiPath 3350, HiPath 3250, HiPath 3150, HiPath 3500 and HiPath 3300 Startup
Input Procedure
Table 5-8
Step
Input
Description
1.
*95
2.
Service
3.
XXXXX
Enter password
4.
5.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
5-15
Startup
HiPath 3550, HiPath 3350, HiPath 3250, HiPath 3150, HiPath 3500 and HiPath 3300 Startup
>
Changes to the system (such as key programming) made using HiPath 3000 Manager E during an offline programming session will be lost when the database is loaded.
When you program the system offline, the assignments of trunk and subscriber
ports depend on the order in which the boards are inserted. Usually, the boards are
inserted from the lowest slot to the highest.
Refer to Chapter 7, Implementing Features for information on how to program individual features.
Meaning of Call Charge and Hardware Options in the Transmission Dialog Box of HiPath
3000 Manager E
If
Then
You want to trans- Activate the call charge and hardware options (using HiPath
fer the most re- 3000 Manager E). This returns the system to the status it had
cent CDB to a
before bootstrapping.
bootstrapped
system.
CDB already in
the system.
Transfer changes to the CDB without using the call charge and
hardware options (in HiPath 3000 Manager E). Make sure that
delta mode is selected.
Activate the call charge option to transfer the following additional information to the
system:
5-16
Station PINs
Feature counters
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Startup
HiPath 3550, HiPath 3350, HiPath 3250, HiPath 3150, HiPath 3500 and HiPath 3300 Startup
Activate the hardware option to transfer the following additional data to the system:
Active callbacks
The system restarts when you transfer the CDB with the hardware option activated.
The telephone
The jack
The cabling
Carry out the telephone test described in Section 12.6.7 on page 12-20 on all telephones.
Checking for Proper System Booting
Set up internal and external calls at random to check if the system is functioning properly.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
5-17
Startup
HiPath 3550, HiPath 3350, HiPath 3250, HiPath 3150, HiPath 3500 and HiPath 3300 Startup
The first time the system is initialized, its capacity is determined and stored in the
CDB (customer database). After each system reset, this data is accessed and
used to generate the numbering plan.
Same board type detected but with fewer channels: Board is activated with
fewer ports, leaving a gap.
Same board type detected but with a greater number of channels: Board is
activated with the number of channels stored in memory (EEPROM); the additional ports are not activated.
Board was inserted as the last in the board placement sequence: All
boards are activated and the numbering plan continues without a gap.
Board was inserted before another board in the board placement sequence: It is activated and appended to the last board in the numbering
plan.
Reinitialization: With newly defined passwords, the system is returned to its original, preinitialization state. The system configuration data stored in the CDB is
deleted; you can make changes to the capacity stage.
If you expand the system configuration, proceed as follows:
>
Disconnect the system from the power supply and insert the new boards.
Switch the system back on. the numbering plan continues without a gap, just
like during initial activation.
When the station numbering plan changes, the station-specific data also changes.
5-18
If the configuration exceeds the capacity limit for trunks, the ports are activated
only up to the capacity limit.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Startup
HiPath 3550, HiPath 3350, HiPath 3250, HiPath 3150, HiPath 3500 and HiPath 3300 Startup
(Not for U.S.) Combining subscriber lines and trunks on the same S0 board can
result in gaps in trunk numbering because all the ports on the board are initially
activated as trunks and are not reconfigured until later on.
S0 stations: If ISDN terminals are connected to an STLS board (S0 bus), their station numbers are derived from the MSN programmed in the terminal regardless
of the configuration.
(Not for U.S.) The MSN is first assigned by the system when the S0 port is configured on the Euro-bus and can be read out by system administration (Manager T: Code 20 4 3 > S0 bus MSN).
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
5-19
Startup
HiPath 3550, HiPath 3350, HiPath 3250, HiPath 3150, HiPath 3500 and HiPath 3300 Startup
EURO-bus
CorNet-N secondary (only HiPath 3550, HiPath 3350, HiPath 3500, HiPath 3300)
Using Manager T, you can also set up configurations for networking and dedicated lines
Use the S0 interface S01 for connection to the public telecommunications network (ISDN trunk).
You can also connect S0 interfaces S02 to S04 to the ISDN trunk or to ISDN terminals
(ISDN telephone, Fax Group 4, PC, dialing aid) via an S0 bus.
Connection (networking) to HiPath 3000 and HiPath 4000 (CorNet-N) can also be set
up via S0 interfaces S01 to S04.
S0 connection options:
Point-to-multipoint (PMP)
5-20
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Startup
HiPath 3550, HiPath 3350, HiPath 3250, HiPath 3150, HiPath 3500 and HiPath 3300 Startup
When you set up an S0 bus, it is assigned an MSN. This MSN is the first free station
number in the system. The S0 station is immediately available under this MSN, without an outgoing seizure.
>
Not for U.S.: If no MSN is entered in the terminal, a default MSN is automatically
assigned after you change the S0 port to Euro-bus in system administration.
6-pin MW6
4-pin MW4
8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
6 5 4 3 2 1
4 3 2 1
SX SR SR SX
SX SR SR SX
SX SR SR SX
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
5-21
Startup
HiPath 3550, HiPath 3350, HiPath 3250, HiPath 3150, HiPath 3500 and HiPath 3300 Startup
System
S01 to S04
To use the STLS board for an internal S0 bus, you must cross
the SR and SX wires before the
first device jack.
MW8 through-jack
(MW8=8-pin)
SR.1 Receive 5
SX.1 Transmit 3
SX.2 Transmit 6
SR.2 Receive 4
SX SR SR SX
Twisted-pair
8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
* = Not crossed with TA S0
*
8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
TAE connector
Additional
power
supply
6
5
4
3
100 ohms/0.25 W
Terminating resistor in last jack
Maximum ranges:
1
System
,,,
5-22
20 m (66 ft.)
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Startup
HiPath 3550, HiPath 3350, HiPath 3250, HiPath 3150, HiPath 3500 and HiPath 3300 Startup
You must enter the station number in the codes for internal stations.
The station number for the internal S0 station must not be assigned to the station
number of a subscriber board in the standard numbering plan.
Example
Under port configuration (code 20 4 1) for the port used, set DSS1 trunk PMP in
the ISDN parameters of the system settings.
Enter the MSNs in the table for direct inward dialing (DID) numbers. In HiPath
3550, HiPath 3350, HiPath 3250, HiPath 3150, HiPath 3500, and HiPath 3300,
one station, one group or one hunt group can be reached via direct inward dialing
for each MSN assigned.
HiPath 3000 is always the last station to be looped in on the S0 bus because the
terminating resistors (2 x 100 ohms) are permanently installed in this systems
trunk circuit. For this reason, remove any existing terminating resistors from the
last socket.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
5-23
Startup
HiPath 3550, HiPath 3350, HiPath 3250, HiPath 3150, HiPath 3500 and HiPath 3300 Startup
5-24
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
6-1
6.2 Replacing Peripheral Boards for HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700
Caution
Always wear an antistatic wristband when working on the system (especially when
handling boards).
In the HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 only, you can remove and insert peripheral
boards during operation (hot plugging). The following startup rules apply.
Caution
To ensure that the system operates without blocking, you must follow the rules in
Abschnitt 4.2.6, Configuration Notes auf Seite 4-70 concerning the board configuration.
Table 6-1
Then
Inserting new
board in free slot
Board is integrated in the system per the rules for initial installation (refer to Initializing the Boards on page 4-72).
Replacing with un- The system activates the board and retains the surplus ports
derequipped board in the database.
of same type
6-2
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Table 6-1
Then
Replacing board The system activates the board with the same number of ports
with overequipped as on the old board.
board of same type After the old board is removed, you can reinitialize the slot using HiPath 3000 Manager E or Manager T.
When the new board is inserted, the system activates it as if it
had been inserted in a free slot. However, the CDB (customer
database) area used by the old board is left as a gap.
In the case of subscriber line modules, you can use HiPath
3000 Manager E to retain the old station data by copying it to
the new board, or you can delete it (reset to the default state).
Copying is not possible for trunk boards.
Replacing with a The system does not automatically activate the board.
different board type After removing the old board, you can initialize the slot using
HiPath 3000 Manager E or Manager T.
After you have inserted the new board, the system activates it
as if it had been inserted in a free slot. However, the CDB area
used by the old board is left as a gap.
In the case of subscriber line modules, you can use HiPath
3000 Manager E to retain the old station data by copying it to
the new board, or you can delete it (reset to the default state).
Copying is not possible for trunk boards.
Suggested Configuration (for U.S. Only)
To prevent B-channel blocking, install the TMST1 Module only in the BC or in the first
two slots of the ECs. HiPath 3000 Manager E observes this rule when performing offline configuration.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
6-3
WARNING
Follow the safety and operating instructions provided by the printer manufacturer.
Introduction
You can use a printer as a CDR printer (serial data transmission) or as a call charge
computer output device (parallel data transmission).
Connection of a CDR Printer
HiPath 3750/
HiPath 3700
25-pin
connector
CDR printer
GND 1
1 GND 1)
TXD 2
2 TXD
RXD 3
3 RXD
RTS 4
4 RTS
CTS 5
5 CTS
DSR 6
6 DSR
DCD 8
8 DCD
DTR 20
20 DTR
GND 7
7 GND 2)
Printer
25-pin
connector
1) Frame ground
2) Signal ground
Figure 6-1
Output Formats
For information about the output formats (compressed or uncompressed) for call detail recording central, see Section 7.15.8 on page 7-494.
6-4
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
6.4 Installing an ECR with HiPath 3700, HiPath 3500, HiPath 3300 (not for
U.S. and Canada)
Caution
An expansion cabinet rack (ECR) equipped with an external power supply unit
(EPSU2-R) may only be operated if the housing is closed.
Before opening the housing, disconnect the ECR from the power supply by
placing the switch for the battery power and the switch for the line voltage both
on the ECR front panel to their OFF positions,
Introduction
When installing the system, an ECR in the 19 cabinet is required if
the internal system power supply unit for HiPath 3500 or HiPath 3300 is not sufficient enough to provide power to the overall telephone configuration (corded or
cordless telephones). In this case, the EPSU2-R external power supply unit is installed in the ECR.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
6-5
6-6
Top: Line output to UPSC-DR connection socket for HiPath 3500 and HiPath
3300
Output voltage from batteries or EPSU2-R [2] to UPSC-DR for HiPath 3500 and
HiPath 3300
or
Output voltage from batteries [2] to UPSM for HiPath 3700
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
If an EPSU2-R external power supply unit is installed in the ECR, the following additional display and control elements are also included:
EPSU2-R 2.5 A/T [4] fuse for batteries (Caution: Do not confuse with battery fuse
on the ECR front panel.)
LED [5] for the 48 V output voltage (DC output) in the EPSU2-R (see Table 6-2)
LED [6] for the line input voltage (AC input) in the EPSU2-R (see Table 6-2)
[4]
[5]
[6]
[2]
[1]
Figure 6-3
[3]
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
6-7
Table 6-2
6-8
LED [6]
LED [7]
(DC output)
(AC input)
Explanation
on
on
off
on
on
off
off
off
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
6.4.2 Components
The following components are also included in the delivery:
Mounting set for ECR wall installation or ECR table setup: C39165-A7027-D2
EPSU2-R: S30122-K7221-X900
A cable for making the ECR HiPath 3500 or HiPath 3300 electrical connection
is included in the delivery: C39195-Z7001-C14
Connecting cable, ECR (batteries) HiPath 3700 (UPSM + power failure signalling (lamp-wire connector)): Signalling equipment, for example, can be operated
over a relay that is connected in series.): C39195-A7002-B11
Caution
Both of the above-mentioned connecting cables are system specific.
>
Use the power cable to ground the ECR. Fixed, separate grounding is not required.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
6-9
Caution
Before opening the housing, disconnect the ECR from the power supply by
placing the switch for the battery power and the switch for the line voltage both
on the ECR front panel to their OFF positions,
X1
1
2
3
X2
L1
N
PE
L1
N
PE
1
2
3
PE
Housing
X3
Four batteries
12 V/7 Ah
F1 T6,3 A
3
4
1
2
+48 V
48 V UP
48 V BatB
S2
+48 V
Figure 6-4
6-10
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Caution
When storing an ECR equipped with batteries or if the ECR is inactive for a long period of time, remove the battery fuse (6.3 A/T) in the front panel of the ECR. When
shipping an ECR with built-in batteries, remove the batteries beforehand.
Figure 6-5
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
6-11
Danger
Only V39113-W5123-E891 (12 V/7 Ah) batteries are authorized for connection to
the UPSC-DR/UPSM and installation in the ECR.
The use of other battery types is forbidden.
The ECR and four batteries are packaged separately. To install the batteries in the
ECR, proceed as follows:
Step
Action
1.
Place the switch for the battery power and the switch for the line voltage
both on the ECR front panel to their OFF positions (see Section 6.4.1).
2.
3.
4.
Take housing front off of the ECR by removing the three screws on the
back and pushing the housing front toward the back.
5.
[A]
6.
6-12
[B]
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Step
7.
Action
Carefully insert the batteries in the recesses [C] provided.
[C]
8.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
6-13
Step
Action
9.
[D]
6-14
10.
Replace the ECR housing front and tighten the three fastening screws
on the back.
11.
12.
13.
Place the switch for the battery power and the switch for the line voltage
both on the ECR front panel to their ON positions (see Section 6.4.1).
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Caution
An ECR equipped with an EPSU2-R may only be operated if the housing is closed.
Before opening the housing, disconnect the ECR from the power supply by
placing the switch for the battery power and the switch for the line voltage both
on the ECR front panel to their OFF positions
X1
1
2
3
X2
L1
N
PE
L1
N
PE
PE
Input
Housing
EPSU2-R
48 V BatE
X3
48 V CD
Batt
Out
+48 V
+48 V
Four batteries
12 V/7 Ah
F1 T6,3 A
48 V BatB
S2
+48 V
Figure 6-6
1
2
3
3
4
1
2
+48 V
48 V UP
Fan
(not available with all
systems)
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
6-15
Caution
When storing an ECR equipped with batteries or if the ECR is inactive for a long period of time, remove the battery fuse (6.3 A/T) in the front panel of the ECR.
When shipping an ECR with built-in batteries, remove the batteries beforehand.
EPSU2-R
Figure 6-7
6-16
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Action
1.
Place the switch for the battery power and the switch for the line voltage
both on the ECR front panel to their OFF positions (see Section 6.4.1).
2.
3.
4.
Take housing front off of the ECR by removing the three screws on the
back and pushing the housing front toward the back.
5.
Cut off the plug on the fan connection line if there is one.
Strip both wire ends and attach wire end sleeves.
6.
7.
Replace the ECR housing front and tighten the three fastening screws
on the back.
8.
9.
10.
Place the switch for the battery power and the switch for the line voltage
both on the ECR front panel to their ON positions (see Section 6.4.1).
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
6-17
[A]
Figure 6-8
6-18
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
If you install the fan at a later time, you must make sure that the identification ([B] in
Figure 6-9) is in the upper right corner when viewed from outside.
[B]
Figure 6-9
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
6-19
>
It is not possible to upgrade HiPath 3550 to HiPath 3500 or HiPath 3350 to HiPath
3300. This would require replacing the complete system.
HiPath 3150
SW Release 1.0/2.0/
2.2/3.0/SW Version
1.0
HiPath 3250
SW Release 1.0/2.0/
2.2/3.0/SW Version
1.0
HiPath 3350
SW Release 1.0/2.0/
2.2/3.0/SW Version
1.0
6-20
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
HiPath 3550
SW Release 1.0/2.0/
2.2/3.0/SW Version
1.0
HiPath 3750
SW Release 1.0/2.0/
2.2/3.0/SW Version
1.0
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
6-21
6-22
Action
1.
2.
3.
4.
Convert CDB:
5.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Overview
7 Implementing Features
7.1 Overview
Chapter Contents
This chapter discusses the following topics:
(The information on the HiPath 3250 and HiPath 3150 does not apply to the U.S.)
Topic
Starting System Administration, page 7-19
Features for All Traffic Types, page 7-20
Features for General Incoming Traffic, page 7-58
Features for General Outgoing Traffic, page 7-152
Features for General External Traffic, page 7-168
Features for Incoming External Traffic, page 7-189
Features for Outgoing External Traffic, page 7-229
Least Cost Routing (LCR) (Not for U.S.), page 7-284
Least Cost Routing (for U.S. Only), page 7-297
Features for Internal Traffic, page 7-312
Tenant Service, page 7-351
Other Features, page 7-357
Networking, page 7-429
Features for Call Detail Recording, page 7-472
Euro-ISDN Features (Not for U.S.), page 7-523
U.S. ISDN (for U.S. Only), page 7-555
U.S. ISDN Features (for U.S. Only), page 7-564
Host Link Interface, page 7-596
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-1
Implementing Features
Overview
7-2
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Overview
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-3
Implementing Features
Overview
7-4
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Overview
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-5
Implementing Features
Overview
CorNet-N
access for least cost routing (U.S. only)
call waiting
consultation hold
extension number
incoming calls
name display
number display
pickup
station name
toll restriction 1, 2
transfer
COS
credit card call access
CSO, see carrier-select override
CSTA interface
currency
call charge display with
customer-specific display
CW
D
data calls
date
date and time display
D-channel encoding type
dedicated service
deferring a call
delete all station numbers
denied list for undialed trunks
dial plan
least cost routing (U.S. only) 1, 2
dialed number identification service
dial-in control server access for least cost routing (U.S. only)
DID
direct inward dialing 1, 2
U.S. ISDN
direct inward system access
description
direct station selection
DISA
7-6
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Overview
display
called party
connected party 1, 2
date and time
number of stations with direct trunk access (Austria only)
distinctive ringing
DND
DNIS
do not disturb
ringer cutoff
door opener
DSS
DTMF DID
DTMF or rotary pulse dialing
selecting in least cost routing (U.S. only)
DTMF tones
and least cost routing (U.S. only)
dual-tone multifrequency
converting for PRI
dual-tone multifrequency direct inward dialing
dual-tone multifrequency transmission (DTMF)
E
E911 emergency call service for USA
ECT
editing station numbers
editing the telephone number
EKTS
electronic key telephone system
DID
U.S. ISDN
electronic notebook
and least cost routing (U.S. only)
emergency call service ECS
emulation type
en-bloc dialing
en-bloc sending
end-of-dialing recognition
enhanced radio paging equipment (not for U.S.)
features
entrance telephones
equal access
Euro-ISDN features
executive MULAP groups
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-7
Implementing Features
Overview
7-8
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Overview
inter-exchange carriers
CAC
CIC
operator access
protocols
interfaces
BRI
PRI
internal directory
internal paging 1, 2
internal traffic
internal traffic restriction groups
feature
INWATS facility
ISDN
CAID 1, 2
SDID
SPID
K
key programming 1, 2
keypad
converting DTMF for PRI
keypad dialing
keys
DSS
redial
repdial
L
LAN interface, PSTN interface
language settings
languages, loading
last number redial (LNR)
LCR, see least cost routing
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-9
Implementing Features
Overview
7-10
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Overview
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-11
Implementing Features
Overview
N
N11 access
names
assigning to stations
called party display
calling party display
translating station numbers for speed dialing
national and international codes for outgoing calls
networking
call forwarding with rerouting
call waiting
callback on free/busy
CDR with networking
central attendant console
conference
consultation hold/transfer/pickup
distinctive ringing in the network
incoming calls 1, 2
numbering
recall
satellite capability
sharing central voice mail server
sharing system speed dialing in a gateway system
station number/name display
supported features
toggle
toll restriction with CorNet N
network-wide busy signaling optiClient Attendant
night answer
activating 1, 2
night service
number of B channels for PRI parameters
O
offset 1, 2
open numbering
operation of least cost routing (U.S. only)
operator assisted credit card call access
optional control relay modules
relay
OptiPage
7-12
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Overview
optiPoint 500
adapters
key module
optiPoint BLF
optiPoint Attendant
optiPoint BLF
optiPoint key module
originating B-channel selection
outdial rules
least cost routing
letters (U.S. only)
parameters (U.S. only)
least cost routing (U.S. only) 1, 2
outdial rules for least cost routing (U.S. only)
outgoing calls
LNR
redial
outgoing preference
OUTWATS facility
overflow
least cost routing (U.S. only)
overflow (UCD)
overload indication
P
paging
parameters
for LCR outdial rules (U.S. only)
park
path replacement
phantom direct inward dialing
assigning numbers
pickup
call key
trunk key
point-to-point connection
PRI carrier access for least cost routing (U.S. only)
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-13
Implementing Features
Overview
7-14
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Overview
room monitor
route table
least cost routing (U.S. only)
route table paths
least cost routing (U.S. only)
route table search order
least cost routing (U.S. only)
routing tables (LCR)
routing tables (U.S. only)
S
screened transfer
search order
of LCR route table
selecting DTMF or rotary pulse dialing in LCR (U.S. only)
selective seizure of a DID number via a MUSAP key
sending information text
sensors
service profile identifier
BRI
maximum values
services in the talk state
setting the signaling method for analog stations
shared transfer switch
signaling of direct inward dialing numbers for incoming calls
silent monitoring
silent reversal at start and end of call
simple PSE, see radio paging equipment
speaker call
special access
speed dialing
network
station
system
station number configuration via Manager T
station numbers, deleting
station redial
and least cost routing (U.S. only)
station speed dialing in system
stations
speed dialing
universal night answer
stimulus interface
storing procedures
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-15
Implementing Features
Overview
SUB
subaddressing
subscriber groups
suppress station number
switch (relay)
system administration
activating services in the talk state
system number - incoming
system number - outgoing
system speed dialing
and least cost routing (U.S. only)
in tenant systems
network
outgoing external traffic
sharing in a gateway system
system telephone lock
changeover
class of service
T
targeted call pickup outside of a PU group
Team configuration
example with 2 members
example with 8 members
Team keys
Team/Top
telephone lock
individual
system
temporary signaling method changeover
temporary station number display suppression
tenant services
configuring
terminal portability (TP)
terminating B-channel selection
text messages
three-party conference 1, 2
three-party service
tie trunk non-ISDN facility
TIEL
time
time of day evaluation for least cost routing (U.S. only)
time table, LCR (U.S. only)
7-16
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Overview
toggle
trunk key
toll fraud monitoring
toll restriction
and least cost routing (U.S. only)
Top configuration
example with 1 exec./1 secr.
example with 2 exec./2 secr.
Top keys
traffic restriction groups
transfer
U.S. ISDN
UCD groups
transfer from announcement
transit traffic
translate station numbers to names for system speed dialing
trunk group calling service
trunk groups
trunk keys
trunk queuing
trunk seizure type
trunk signaling method
trunks
setting up in least cost routing (U.S. only)
trunk-to-trunk conference
U
U.S. ISDN
B-channel allocation
BRI 1, 2
CO protocol
D-channel encoding type
emulation type
frame/line/encoding
interfaces
multi-device connection
number of B channels (PRI)
PRI 1, 2
protocol type
trunk group calling service
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-17
Implementing Features
Overview
7-18
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Starting System Administration
Input
1.
*95
2.
XXXXX
Explanation
Start system administration
Enter user name:
Fixed password concept: User name = 31994
3.
>
XXXXX
Enter password:
Only an optiset E memory telephone can accept input in the form of alphanumeric
characters. Do not change a user name or a password to a name that includes alphanumeric characters unless Manager T or Manager TC will always use an optiset
E memory telephone.
For an example of the first time system administration is called via Manager T after
the system is booted, refer to page 12-37.
Input
1.
XXXXX
Explanation
Enter user name:
Fixed password concept: User name = 31994
2.
XXXXX
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Enter password:
7-19
Implementing Features
Features for All Traffic Types
Toggle and Automatic Hold (refer to Section 7.3.3 for more details)
When a station, using a trunk key or call key, is engaged in one conversation and
another call is incoming on another key, you can automatically place the current
call on exclusive hold and answer the incoming call by pressing the flashing key.
You can then toggle between the 2 calls at will. The lines are alternately on Consultation Hold and the last call handled will recall if you go on-hook.
Alternatively, you can place your original caller on Common Hold, by first pressing the HOLD key before answering the incoming call. Anyone with an appearance of the Trunk key or Call key can take the call by pressing the slowly flashing
key.
Consultation Hold and transfer (refer to Section 7.3.4 and Section 7.3.5 for
more details)
When a station is engaged in a conversation, whether or not the call is on an outside line button or not, you can place the current conversation on Consultation
Hold to consult with another internal or external party. The held party is on exclusive hold on your telephone.
Hold and retrieve trunk (refer to Section 7.6.4 for more details)
This allows the display user to place an outside trunk call on hold whether there
is an appearance of the trunk or not on the telephone. Pressing the Hold/transfer
key, the trunk is placed on exclusive hold and the display provides the information
7-20
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for All Traffic Types
on the held trunk, which reads Line held on xxx, where xxx is the trunk number.
You can go on-hook. To retrieve the held line, press the Retrieve line button or
dial the access code followed by the trunk number.
Related Topics
Model-Specific Data
Subject
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
Feature available in
HW requirements
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
Requirement or Condition
Internal calls
(for U.S. Only)
Configuration Options
This feature does not have to be explicitly configured.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-21
Implementing Features
Features for All Traffic Types
Action
1.
Set up a call.
2.
3.
4.
7-22
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for All Traffic Types
Model-Specific Data
Subject
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
Feature available in
HW requirements
Max. 10
Max. 10
SW requirements
Number of calls
parked simultaneously
V1.0 or later
Max. 10
Max. 10
Max. 10
Requirement or Condition
Park
Park
Unpark
Conference
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-23
Implementing Features
Features for All Traffic Types
Subject
Requirement or Condition
Call forwarding
In the case of a recall, a parked call does not follow call forwarding.
DTMF
If the park slot selected for parking a call is already occupied, a tone sounds, and the number does not appear on
the screen. Select another park slot.
DND
A station in DND can place a call in a park location; however, if the parked call recalls and no other destination has
been identified in call management, the call automatically
is disconnected after the recall timer expires.
MOH
CorNet-N
DISA
Configuration Options
This feature does not have to be explicitly configured.
Testing the Feature
Check the feature for error-free functioning as follows:
Step
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
Action
Set up a call.
Park the call. Enter service code *56 or press the feature key.
Suffix-dial a park slot.
Resume the call. Enter service code *56 or press the feature key.
Suffix-dial a park slot.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for All Traffic Types
7.3.3 Toggle
Definition
Toggle enables a user to toggle between two parties, placing one of the parties on
hold. The toggle feature can be used for internal and external calls.
The rules for consultation hold also apply to the active call. Users cannot toggle between conference calls.
Model-Specific Data
Subject
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
Feature available in
HW requirements
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
Requirement or Condition
Hold
DTMF
Line keys
Users with line keys (Call keys, Trunk keys) can toggle between one call and another by pressing the flashing line
key for the other incoming call, and Toggle between both
by pressing one line key then the next. The lines are in exclusive hold.
Exception: In the case of the General Call key appearances, users should always press the Hold button, followed by
the Release button, before pressing another General Call
key appearance. This places the first call on Common Call.
Otherwise the call remains on Consultation Hold.
Music on Hold
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-25
Implementing Features
Features for All Traffic Types
Configuration Options
This feature does not have to be explicitly configured.
Testing the Feature
Check the feature for error-free functioning as follows:
Step
Action
1.
Use the consultation hold feature to set up a second call from a call in
progress.
2.
You can then toggle between the two parties using *2.
7-26
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for All Traffic Types
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
Feature available in
HW requirements
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
Requirement or Condition
Recall
Recall timer
A transferred call that is not answered recalls to the transferring station. The recall timer, Callback timeout for transfer before answering (default is 45 seconds), is started
when the transferring station releases the call from the station. This timer also controls the length of time that a caller
is camped on the destination station.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-27
Implementing Features
Features for All Traffic Types
Subject
Requirement or Condition
Call charges
Call charges
If the destination is an external destination, the call charges are assigned to the transferring station as long as the
destination answers the call.
DSS
Pressing a DSS key from a talking state, results in an immediate Consultation call with the party designated by the
DSS key. In effect, it replaces the procedure: Consult +
destination.
Do Not Disturb
Music on Hold
External destinations
Busy stations
Only two calls can be transferred to a busy station simultaneously. On a display telephone, the state of the called
party (if internal) is displayedBusy or Do Not Disturb.
Configuration Options
7-28
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for All Traffic Types
Action
1.
Set up a call.
2.
3.
Hang up the phone to transfer the call to the internal station before the
station answers.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-29
Implementing Features
Features for All Traffic Types
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
Feature available in
HW requirements
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
7-30
Requirement or Condition
Call charges
External destination
DSS
Pressing a DSS key from a talking state, results in an immediate Consultation call with the party designated by the
DSS key. In effect, it replaces the procedure Consult + destination.
Music on Hold
External destinations
Busy stations
Only two calls can be transferred to a busy station simultaneously. On a display telephone, the state of the called
party (if internal) is displayedBusy or Do Not Disturb.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for All Traffic Types
Subject
Requirement or Condition
Transfer to CF station
Configuration Options
This feature does not have to be explicitly configured.
Testing the Feature
Check the feature for error-free functioning as follows:
Step
Action
1.
Set up a call.
2.
3.
When the called station answers, transfer the call and hang up. In the
case of external destinations, the transfer must be initiated.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-31
Implementing Features
Features for All Traffic Types
7.3.6 Conference
Definition
A user can combine up to five stations into a conference call.
The user setting up the conference can individually disconnect stations from the conference or release the conference entirely. In addition, the user can also exit the conference without terminating it, even if the conference includes external stations (trunkto-trunk conference).
If internal stations still remain in the conference, the new conference leader is the user
who has been in the conference the longest. If only external stations remain in the
conference and no backward release criterion is present (on loop-start trunks), a timer, Time until warning tone, in main station interface transit con, is started; the default
time is: 5 minutes. When this timer expires, the remaining stations receive a warning
tone and the conference is disconnected after default 10 seconds. This timer, Time
from warning tone until release, is variable from 0 to 42 min.
The initiator of the conference is designated as the Conference Master. If the conference master leaves the conference, control of the conference is passed on to the first
internal member which was part of the conference.
Members of the conference call can leave the conference by going on-hook or by answering a call waiting. However, they must call the conference master to be added on
to the conference once again.
Model-Specific Data
Subject
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
Feature available in
HW requirements
SW requirements
7-32
V1.0 or later
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for All Traffic Types
Requirement or Condition
Conference
Internal users cannot participate in more than one conference in the system (except with CorNet-N).
Analog stations
Analog stations
Analog stations are not checked to see if they are voice devices.
Call charges
Toll charges are assigned to the party who set up the toll
call. When a call is transferred or released, the toll charges
are assigned to the remaining internal station from the moment the call is released.
CSTA Phase II places a limit on the length of CSTA messages. Conferences with more than three participants exceed this limit and can cause the connected applications
to malfunction when at least one station is monitored by
CSTA.
This is why the option to expand conferences to include
more than three participants is not offered in the menu and
will be rejected if you try to invoke it with a code.
DISA
Park
Silent Monitoring
Silent Monitoring limits the maximum number of conferences. Maximum number of conferences possible in system = maximum number of simultaneous Silent Monitoring
stations.
Configuration Options
This feature does not have to be explicitly configured.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-33
Implementing Features
Features for All Traffic Types
Action
1.
Using the consultation procedure, place an existing call on hold and set
up a second call.
2.
3.
7-34
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for All Traffic Types
EXMNA (connection option for an external music source) (for U.S. only)
EXM (connection option for an external music source) (not for U.S)
All HiPath 3000 models allow you to define up to six MOH sources on analog interfaces for the six possible ITR groups (Section 7.12.1, Tenant Service Configuration).
Devices other than Genius or Mozart must be connected to a 600 Ohm transformer.
The EXMNA card limits the level at which MOH can be heard over outside lines and
is therefore FCC compliant without external limiters.
Callers hear MOH if in Consultation Hold state, Park state, and in a transfer state if
configured. Also, queued callers in an UCD environment can hear MOH if so configured.
MOH can be configured in one of three ways:
1.
2.
MOH with ring tone: The held party will first hear MOH during the Consultation
process. When a call is transferred to the destination, the MOH is replaced by
ringback tone.
3.
MOH without Ring Tone: The held party will hear MOH until the called party answers the call.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-35
Implementing Features
Features for All Traffic Types
Model-Specific Data
Subject
Feature available in
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
HW requirements
HW options
SW requirements
EXM,
EXMR,
EXMNA,
MPPI
V1.0 or later
Requirement or Condition
EXMNA is used only in the U.S.
EXM, EXMR, EXMNA, Connecting the EXM, EXMR, EXMNA or MPPI board auMPPI
tomatically switches the system over to the external music
source.
MOH
MOH source
MOH source at analog If the MOH source is turned on (loop active) you need to
ports
disconnect and then reconnect it (interrupting the loop) after configuring the analog port.
Configuration Options
This feature can be configured using Manager T or HiPath 3000 Manager E.
7-36
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for All Traffic Types
Action
1.
Configure MOH:
22-11 => System settings - Music on hold - State (0...2)
Status options: 0 = off, 1 = on, without ring tone, 2 = on, with ring tone
2.
Action
1.
Internal MOH:
Options
2.
System parameters
3.
System settings
4.
Music on hold
5.
6.
Connections
7.
Ext. connection
8.
External MOH
Assign the MOH to internal traffic restriction (ITR) groups.
Action
1.
Set up a call.
2.
3.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-37
Implementing Features
Features for All Traffic Types
7.3.8 Announcements
Definition
For uniform call distribution (UCD), announcement before answering, and DTMF direct inward dialing (DID), users can connect announcement equipment. This announcement replaces music on hold (MOH) in certain situations (such as during hold
or while a station is busy or being transferred).
Announcement devices can be connected to analog interfaces, or can be connected
using E&M in the HiPath 3750 or HiPath 3700 system. Start/stop control can be implemented using relays and sensors or E&M. Up to 32 stations can be connected to
an announcement device.
Both interfaces provide sequenced messages (as opposed to barge-in); however, the
E&M interface can advise the announcement device to return to start when the queue
is empty. With the SLA interface method, the announcement device must reach the
end of its message before returning to start. This can be critical if the message is
lengthy.
The following types of announcement are available:
Model-Specific Data
Subject
Feature available in
HW requirements
SW requirements
7-38
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
x
free analog subscriber
ports (+
REAL for
Start/
Stop),
analog tie
traffic
TIEL
V1.0 or later
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for All Traffic Types
Subject
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
Announcement devices
16
Simultaneous announcements
32
32
32
32
32
Configuration Options
This feature can be configured using Manager T or HiPath 3000 Manager E.
Configuring the Feature Using Manager T
Configure the feature using Manager T as follows:
Step
Action
1.
2.
3.
Announcement device via sensors (HiPath 3550, HiPath 3350, HiPath 3500, HiPath 3300)
4.
Action
1.
2.
Connections
3.
Announcement device
4.
Configure sensors
Options
5.
Connections
6.
Sensors
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-39
Implementing Features
Features for All Traffic Types
7-40
Action
1.
2.
3.
4.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for All Traffic Types
Model-Specific Data
Subject
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
Feature available in
HW requirements
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
Requirement or Condition
Redial
You can use the redial feature when you are in a consultation call.
Do not disturb
It is not possible to set up a consultation call to a busy subscriber who has activated do not disturb.
DTMF mode
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-41
Implementing Features
Features for All Traffic Types
Subject
Internal consultation
hold key
Requirement or Condition
This key function is useful for communication systems with
automatic line seizure (Prime Line), as it allows an internal
consultation hold to be initiated by means of one key actuation.
Configuration Options
This feature does not have to be explicitly configured.
Testing the Feature
Check the feature for error-free functioning as follows:
Step
Action
1.
Set up a call.
2.
3.
4.
5.
7-42
Toggle/Connect
Conference
Transfer
Consult
Save Number
Start Conference
Start Transfer
Mute On
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for All Traffic Types
The user can further consult with other parties, placing the second on Consultation Hold simultaneously in order to contact a third party. The user can conference the second and third party, exit the conference and return to the first caller.
If the telephone has DSS keys (Repdial keys with internal station numbers assigned to the key), pressing a DSS key while connected to anther party will automatically place that call on Consultation Hold and ring the DSS destination. The
Prime Line feature must not be configured in the system.
Conference (*3)
Toggle (*2)
Refer to the Operating Instructions for HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0 for information on operating the feature.
For a list of additional documentation, refer to Table 1-1, List of Available Documentation for HiPath 3000
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-43
Implementing Features
Features for All Traffic Types
7.3.10 Recall
Definition
A held call that is not answered or a call that was not switched successfully is signaled
at the initiating station as a recall. A display telephone at the initial callers location
can display the number of either the switched internal or external station or the number of the destination.
An automatic recall is always carried out if:
1.
A call was parked for a certain period or was placed on common hold and was
not answered. The recall occurs when the hold/park timer expires (recall a
parked connection).
2.
An unscreened transfer was placed to a party who did not answer the call within
a certain period (recall a transferred/switched trunk).
3.
An unscreened transfer was placed to a station and the destination did not exist,
was busy with a second call, the telephone was defective (in the case of digital
telephones) or the transfer type was not allowed (transfer external call to external
destination). An immediate recall is carried out in these cases.
In SMR-H V1.2 or later, not only the initiating station but also other stations in the
same call pickup group can pick up a recall if the system flag Call pickup after recall
is set.
Timer Relationship
7-44
Call Park Recall and Call Transfer Recall have separate timers.
The Park timeout and cancellation of hold timer is started when a call is parked
in a park location. When the time expires, the call recalls the originator. Default
time is 180 seconds. If the originator is busy or in the Program/Service mode,
when the timer expires, the recalling party is camped on to the originator, until the
current conversation is terminated. Upon going on-hook, the recalling party immediately rings the originator. If the recalling party is an internal station, and has
a DSS appearance on the originators telephone, it will start flashing when the
timer expired.
If the originator is DND when the time expires, the recall overrides DND and the
telephone rings.
The Callback timeout for transfer before answering timer is started when a caller
is transferred to another destination by an internal user. When the time expires,
the call recalls the originator. Default time is 45 seconds. If the originator is busy
or in the Program/Service mode when the timer expires, the recalling party is
camped-on to the originator, until the current conversation is terminated. Upon
going on-hook, the recalling party immediately rings the originator. If the recalling
party is an internal station, and has a DSS appearance on the originators telephone, it will start flashing when the timer expired.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for All Traffic Types
If the originator is DND when the time expires, the recall overrides DND and the
telephone rings.
When a call recalls the originator, the Intercept timeout for recall timer is started.
The call will ring at the originator for the length of this timer. When the time expires the call is routed to the configured intercept position. Default is 30 seconds.
When an unanswered call is routed to the intercept position, a final timer, Timeout
before recall to ATT is activated, is started. The call will ring at the intercept position for the length of this timer. When the time expires, the call is released from
the system. Default time is 60 seconds.
Model-Specific Data
Subject
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
Feature available in
HW requirements
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
Requirement or Condition
The function also works when the recalling station is a
member of the same call pickup group.
Configuration Options
This feature does not have to be explicitly configured.
Configuring the Feature Using HiPath 3000 Manager E
Although this feature does not have to be explicitly configured, HiPath 3000 Manager
E permits the recall time to be configured as follows:
Step
Action
1.
System parameters
2.
Time parameters
3.
4.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-45
Implementing Features
Features for All Traffic Types
Action
1.
Set up a call.
2.
3.
4.
5.
7-46
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for All Traffic Types
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
Feature available in
HW requirements
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
Requirement or Condition
If a dial pulsing signal is detected, the code receiver remains active so toll restrictions are not circumvented.
Configuration Options
This feature can be configured using Manager T or HiPath 3000 Manager E.
Configuring the Feature Using Manager T
Configure the feature using Manager T as follows:
Step
Action
1.
2.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-47
Implementing Features
Features for All Traffic Types
7-48
Action
1.
2.
Set up station
3.
Parameter
4.
Flags
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for All Traffic Types
Ring No answer, Busy, Invalid number dialed, Incomplete number, on an unanswered recalls and when an attempt is made to dial from specific stations which
have activated CodeLock.
In the case of Ring No Answer, the system first checks the Call Management tables for further configured destinations. If there are no none, the call is then diverted to the intercept position.
CorNet-N
CorNet-N calls can be internal or external depending on their source. If the calling
party is an internal station in a remote node, the call is flagged as internal. If the call
is from a trunk in the remote node, the call is flagged as external.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-49
Implementing Features
Features for All Traffic Types
Model-Specific Data
Subject
Feature available in
HW requirements
General requirements
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
Requirement or Condition
Overflow
You can configure numeric and time overflow to a programmable overflow destination.
A maximum of 6 optiset E or optiPoint telephones can be
configured with overflow display.
Undialed trunk
Second number
Configuration Options
This feature can be configured using Manager T or HiPath 3000 Manager E.
Configuring the Feature Using Manager T
Configure the feature using Manager T as follows:
Step
7-50
Action
1.
2.
3.
4.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for All Traffic Types
Action
1.
2.
System parameters
3.
Intercept / Attendant
Action
1.
2.
3.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-51
Implementing Features
Features for All Traffic Types
if the party which was connected to the called party goes on-hook, the overridden
and overriding parties remain connected.
if the overriding party goes on-hook first, the original conversation can continue
and the conference bridge is removed.
If the called party had activated DND, the conversation will nevertheless be overridden. However, a station authorized to use the Busy Override feature, cannot
override a station with DND active and in an idle state.
Any Voice terminal in the system can be configured for this capability.
A station with Data security (Manager T) or Call Waiting rejection (HiPath 3000 Manager E) active, cannot be overridden.
CorNet-N
Override cannot be invoked over a CorNet-N link.
Model-Specific Data
Subject
Feature available in
HW requirements
SW requirements
7-52
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
V1.0 or later
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for All Traffic Types
Requirement or Condition
You cannot override a call if the called station or the internal party it is connected to is entered as a data station
(voice channel signaling security), or if the called party is
dialing a number.
Hunt group
S0 station
Attendant console
Configuration Options
This feature can be configured using Manager T or HiPath 3000 Manager E.
Configuring the Feature Using Manager T
Configure the feature using Manager T as follows:
Step
Action
1.
2.
Action
1.
2.
Set up station.
3.
4.
Flags
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-53
Implementing Features
Features for All Traffic Types
Action
1.
2.
3.
7-54
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for All Traffic Types
Flickering: Waiting call was not answered within 30 seconds; there are more calls
than can be processed by the attendant consoles.
Model-Specific Data
Subject
Feature available in
HW requirements
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
Requirement or Condition
An LED that is already flickering is not reset to flashing.
Configuration Options
This feature can be configured using Manager T or HiPath 3000 Manager E.
Configuring the Feature Using Manager T
Configure the feature using Manager T as follows:
Step
Action
1.
2.
3.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-55
Implementing Features
Features for All Traffic Types
Action
1.
2.
Set up station
3.
Key programming
7-56
Action
1.
2.
3.
4.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for All Traffic Types
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
Feature available in
HW requirements
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
Requirement or Condition
Action
1.
2.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-57
Implementing Features
Features for General Incoming Traffic
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
Feature available in
HW requirements
ANI4
ANI4R
ANI4
ANI4R
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
Requirement or Condition
Country specifics
Trunk boards
Configuration Options
This feature does not have to be explicitly configured.
7-58
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for General Incoming Traffic
Type 2
External Call CO 2
Type 3
External Call CO 3
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-59
Implementing Features
Features for General Incoming Traffic
Model-Specific Data
Subject
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
Feature available in
HW requirements
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
Requirement or Condition
Ring signals are country-specific and determined by the
approval authorities.
Configuration Options
This feature can be configured using Manager T or HiPath 3000 Manager E.
Configuring the Feature Using Manager T
Configure the feature using Manager T as follows:
Step
7-60
Action
1.
2.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for General Incoming Traffic
Action
1.
2.
Set up station.
3.
Station
4.
5.
1.
2.
System parameters
3.
Tones/ring types
Action
1.
2.
3.
4.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-61
Implementing Features
Features for General Incoming Traffic
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
Feature available in
HW requirements
16
16
SW requirements
Number of waiting
calls per station
V1.0 or later
16
16
16
7-62
Requirement or Condition
CorNet-N
Group call
If one or more stations in a group call are free, the call will
be offered to them. The other group members are not signaled. If all stations are busy, all of them receive a call waiting signal.
Speaker call
Recall
Recalls of low-priority external calls that cannot be signaled are intercepted. Displaced internal calls are released.
Users can deactivate the call waiting tone for external calls
using a procedure or HiPath 3000 Manager E. This setting
does not affect signaling on the display.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for General Incoming Traffic
Subject
Requirement or Condition
Individual stations can enable/disable the tone at their station. Default is: Tone On.
Call Waiting Rejection This station flag prevents any type of call waiting tone to be
on
injected in the conversation. This flag is also called Data
Line Security in the HiPath 3000 Manager E. When set,
this flag will also prevent this station from being overridden.
The calling station will only hear busy tone.
Configuration Options
This feature can be configured using HiPath 3000 Manager E.
Configuring the Feature Using HiPath 3000 Manager E
Configure the feature using HiPath 3000 Manager E as follows:
Step
Action
1.
2.
Intercept/AC
3.
1.
2.
Trunks/networking
3.
4.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-63
Implementing Features
Features for General Incoming Traffic
7-64
Step
Action
1.
2.
3.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for General Incoming Traffic
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-65
Implementing Features
Features for General Incoming Traffic
Block 2
Block 1
16 = incoming calls
1616 = call allocation trunk, day
L1
DAY
Without DID
during day
11
22
16 = incoming calls
1618 = call forwarding - no answer
16183 = ext. calls, day
Stn no. 11 14
.
22 14
Lmax G7
Entries:
R1-Rn; G1-Gm
Gm 3
.
Rn
DID day
16182
Internal calls
Stn no. 11 16
Internal
day/night
NIGHT
Without DID
during night
Lmax
Figure 7-1
7-66
G8
14
Gm 1
.
Rn 16
16184
Ext. calls, night
Stn no. 11 15
.
23
Entries:
R1-Rn; G1-Gm
DID
night
24 16
15
14 15
G1 15
Gm 15
.
Rn
V3.0 or later =
Implementing Features
Features for General Incoming Traffic
Block 3
16 = incoming calls
Block 4
16 = incoming calls
Call forwarding 1
to stn. no. 4
Call dest. 1. 2. 3.
G1
(group 1)
5.
4.
W R4 G1
R47 1
List 2
W R7 G2
R11 2
List 3
W R8 Gm
*1
R9 A2 A3
R1 G3
List 1
.
.
.
.
Call dest.
List 14
List 15
R4 G8
R20
10
21
3
List 16
W
.
.
Call management dest.
.
. max. list
see page 7-68
14 28
72
19
11 23
12
37
.
.
.
.
Gm
(group)
.
.
.
12 37
.
.
.
= is called immediately
= is called after the first forwarding time (column 5)
Entries:
Rx
= no entry
= the port assigned to the
no. is called
Gx = group x with the call type
assigned there
W(dial) = selected stn no. or stn.
S = system search
Ax = UCD group x (1-60) is called
Figure 7-2
G2
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.....
= no night bell
Rx = the port assigned to the no. is called
*1-*4 = relay option, relay 1 - 4
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-67
Implementing Features
Features for General Incoming Traffic
Model-Specific Data
Subject
Feature available in
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
70
500
376
Number of UCD
groups
60
60
70
10
7-68
Requirement or Condition
Call management
CM does not treat a station as a call forwardingno answer destination if its telephone has failed, if the user has
activated do not disturb or has activated data protection
and is busy, or if the user does not have trunk access (for
external calls).
Call management
Group/hunt group
Entrance telephone
DTMF DID
With DTMF DID/DISA, an analog call can be released before the call forwardingno answer process has concluded because the system uses fixed timers to prevent the
trunks from freezing up.
Night bell
Call management
Implementing Features
Features for General Incoming Traffic
Subject
Requirement or Condition
Call management
System search
Configuration Options
This feature can be configured using Manager T or HiPath 3000 Manager E.
Configuring the Feature Using Manager T
Configure the feature using Manager T as follows:
Step
Action
1.
2.
16-11
3.
16-12
4.
16-13
5.
16-14
6.
16-14-1
7.
16-14-2
8.
9.
10.
16-14-3
11.
16-14-4
12.
16-14-5
13.
16-15
14.
16-15-1
15.
16-15-2
16.
16-15-3
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-69
Implementing Features
Features for General Incoming Traffic
Step
Action
17.
16-16
18.
16-17
19.
16-18
20.
16-18-1
21.
16-18-2
22.
16-18-3
23.
16-18-4
24.
16-18-5
25.
16-18-6
26.
16-18-7
27.
16-19
28.
16-20
Action
1.
2.
Incoming calls
7-70
Action
1.
2.
3.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for General Incoming Traffic
7-71
Implementing Features
Features for General Incoming Traffic
Related Topic
Section 7.4.4, Call Management (CM), on page 7-65
Model-Specific Data
Subject
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
Feature available in
HW requirements
SW requirements
Max. no. of CFNA destinations per station
no.
V1.0 or later
3
7-72
Requirement or Condition
Call forwarding - no
answer
If the CFNA destination is unavailable and no other call forwarding operation is configured for the trunk, call forwardingno answer is not carried out.
DISA
DND
Analog telephones
There is no indication at these telephones that the call being presented is a forwarded call.
Display telephones
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for General Incoming Traffic
Subject
Requirement or Condition
Hunting to external
call forwarding destination
The system-wide flag controls the call forwarding - no answer if an external CF has been activated within a call destination list.
If the flag is not set, the call forwarding - no answer ends at
the external CF destination.
If the flag is set, the call forwarding - no answer continues
out of the external CF destination to the station entered in
the call destination list.
Note: For CF on loop start trunks, the flag functions only if
you have entered a call cycle for the cal forwarding - no answer.
Configuration Options
This feature can be configured using Manager T or HiPath 3000 Manager E.
Configuring the Feature Using Manager T
Configure the feature using Manager T as follows:
Step
Action
1.
2.
Action
1.
Options
2.
Incoming calls
3.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-73
Implementing Features
Features for General Incoming Traffic
7-74
Action
1.
2.
3.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for General Incoming Traffic
Call forwardingbusy
Callers who call a busy extension receive a busy signal. The call destination list
determines whether the system carries out call forwardingbusy.
Group call
A group is always busy if all members of the group are busy.
Hunt group
A hunt group is always busy if all hunt group members are busy.
Free group
A free group is busy if at least one group member is busy and the caller reached
the group by dialing the group number.
UCD groups
The system does not check this parameter for UCD groups.
Announcements
This parameter has no effect on announcements.
if a station signals a call and the call forwarding destination is busy, the call remains
at the station. The system checks the call forwarding destination repeatedly until the
destination is free.
Incoming calls on trunks that do not support busy signaling are forwarded or intercepted.
Model-Specific Data
Subject
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
Feature available in
HW requirements
SW requirements
Max. no. of CF destinations per station no.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
V1.0 or later
3
7-75
Implementing Features
Features for General Incoming Traffic
Requirement or Conditions
Call forwarding - no
answer
If the call forwarding destination is unavailable and no other call forwarding operation is configured for the trunk, call
forwardingno answer is not carried out.
Call waiting
Hunting to external
call forwarding destination
The system-wide flag controls the call forwarding - no answer if an external CF has been activated within a call destination list.
If the flag is not set, the call forwarding - no answer ends at
the external CF destination.
If the flag is set, the call forwarding - no answer continues
out of the external CF destination to the station entered in
the call destination list.
Note: For CF on loop start trunks, the flag functions only if
you have entered a call cycle for the cal forwarding - no answer.
Configuration Options
This feature can be configured using Manager T or HiPath 3000 Manager E.
7-76
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for General Incoming Traffic
Action
1.
2.
3.
Action
1.
Options
2.
Incoming calls
3.
Action
1.
2.
3.
The system forwards the call to the programmed destination after the
programmed period of time.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-77
Implementing Features
Features for General Incoming Traffic
An external destination
A hunt group
The user is notified when call forwarding is activated. Notification can be in the form
of a special dial tone, an indication on the display, or an LED signal.
Outgoing calls can still be made when call forwarding is activated.
End users can choose to forward only external calls or only internal calls. One single
access code is used to deactivate any of these choices.
The following are the default feature access codes:
Call forwarding is implemented on a station number basis, regardless of how the call
reached the activating telephone. If trunk keys have been configured, CF can also be
activated individually for a specific trunk key.
External Destination
The call forward destination can be an external party. Instead of entering an internal
station number, enter the trunk access code, followed by the external number. Since
it is possible that an incoming external call could be forwarded to an external destination, the system will check whether the combination of trunks can guarantee release
supervision. (See table below) If not, a timer is started Time up to warning tone for
7-78
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for General Incoming Traffic
MSI - transit and default is 300 seconds. When the timer expires, a warning tone is
heard by both parties and another timer is started Time between warning tone and
release, default of 10secs, after which time the trunks are released.
CorNet-N
Calls can be forwarded over a CorNet-N link.
If a call is forwarded to another node, and it in turn is forwarded back to the originating
node, the CorNet-N links will be released, if the function Rerouting is activated.
Incoming Caller ID (PRI, BRI) is passed from one destination to another within the
same system. It is not transferred over CorNet-N to a remote node. If a voice mail system is located in a remote mode, and the call is forwarded, the voice mail system will
receive the station number of the original called party.
Model-Specific Data
Subject
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
Feature available in
HW requirements
20
20
SW requirements
Max. no. of simultaneous CFW operations
V1.0 or later
150
50
20
Requirement or Condition
Chaining
MSN trunk forwarding In V1.0 or later, any user who has an assigned MSN for direct inward dialing can forward this number to the trunk
(the feature must be requested from the carrier).
Ext. call forwarding
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-79
Implementing Features
Features for General Incoming Traffic
Subject
Requirement or Condition
Prime Line
Analog telephones
Configuration Options
This feature does not have to be explicitly configured.
7-80
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for General Incoming Traffic
Action
1.
2.
Select the type (1 = all calls, 2 = external calls only, 3 = internal calls
only).
3.
4.
The call arrives at the destination station according to the call forwarding
type (all calls, external calls only, or internal calls only).
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-81
Implementing Features
Features for General Incoming Traffic
Paging
The type of group determines how the system handles each group. This means that
each group can be either a group call or a hunt group. Names can be assigned to the
individual groups from the system administration.
Default numbers are provided in the Manager T and E but can be changed:
General Hunt Group Call default call numbers are 350 to 499.
UCD group default call number are from 440 to 499 (within in the General Hunt
Group).
Model-Specific Data
Subject
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
Feature available in
HW requirements
20/8
20/8
SW requirements
Groups/stations
V1.0 or later
800/20
150/20
20/8
Requirement or Condition
Call forwarding
Call groups
Configuration Options
This feature can be configured using Manager T or HiPath 3000 Manager E.
7-82
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for General Incoming Traffic
Action
1.
Configure groups
2.
3.
4.
Action
1.
Configure groups
Options
2.
Incoming calls
3.
Hunt group
Action
1.
2.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-83
Implementing Features
Features for General Incoming Traffic
7-84
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for General Incoming Traffic
Displays
Internal calls: At the calling party, the display shows the name of the group assigned via Manager T (16-15-3) or HiPath 3000 Manager E (Incoming Call ->
Hunt Group -> Name). The group members with a display telephone see the station number placing the call Call from: xxx.
External calls: The group members display will show the calling party number.
(same as call to a single station).
Model-Specific Data
Subject
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
Feature available in
HW requirements
20/8
20/8
SW requirements
Groups/stations
V1.0 or later
800/20
150/20
20/8
Requirement or Condition
Analog telephones
Intercept
Call waiting
Busy stations receive call waiting or ring injection if no other stations are available.
Hunt group
Configuration Options
This feature can be configured using Manager T or HiPath 3000 Manager E.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-85
Implementing Features
Features for General Incoming Traffic
Action
1.
2.
3.
4.
Action
1.
2.
Incoming calls
3.
Hunt group
Action
1.
Set up a group.
2.
3.
7-86
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for General Incoming Traffic
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
Feature available in
HW requirements
20/8
20/8
SW requirements
Groups/stations
V1.0 or later
800/20
150/20
20/8
Requirement or Condition
The call does not camp on if the busy station has activated
call waiting rejection.
Group
If an optiset E or optiPoint telephone in the group is defective, the group is treated as though it were busy.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-87
Implementing Features
Features for General Incoming Traffic
Configuration Options
This feature can be configured using Manager T or HiPath 3000 Manager E.
Configuring the Feature Using Manager T
Configure the feature using Manager T as follows:
Step
Action
1.
2.
3.
4.
Action
1.
2.
Incoming calls
3.
Hunt group
7-88
Action
1.
Set up a group.
2.
3.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for General Incoming Traffic
Circular selection: The search begins with the station after the last station selected. If the call is not answered, it is forwarded to the next station after a timeout
(CFNA in call management).
Linear selection: When a call arrives, the search always begins with the first station in the group.
The stations can be reached either by a hunt group number or by the users station
number, depending on the hunt group type.
You can set up hunt groups in call management.
Each Hunt Group can be assigned a name in database with 16 characters maximum.
The stations can be reached either by a hunt group pilot number or by the users station number, depending on the hunt group.
In the case of a Linear Hunt group, the last member of the hunt can be a pseudo number leading to a voice mail system. The pseudo number is the call number which will
be transmitted to the voice mail system. It is also possible to have a call forwarding
within the destination list.
One station can simultaneously be a member of two groups. Calls from either group
are presented to the agent in the normal manner. If the user has a display telephone,
he or she can identify the source of the call by the name assigned to the trunk/trunk
group.
Model-Specific Data
Subject
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
Feature available in
HW requirements
20/8
20/8
SW requirements
Groups/stations
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
V1.0 or later
800/20
150/20
20/8
7-89
Implementing Features
Features for General Incoming Traffic
Requirement or Condition
Call waiting
Call signaling
If all hunt group stations hang up simultaneously, call signaling begins at all stations that previously had waiting
calls.
If all stations in the hunt group activate DND, a call management procedure handles the call.
Hunt group
Queue
Overflow, call forward- You can use call management to set up an overflow station
ingno answer
as a CFNA destination for hunt groups.
7-90
Group call
Telephone type
CDRC
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for General Incoming Traffic
Configuration Options
This feature can be configured using Manager T or HiPath 3000 Manager E.
Configuring the Feature Using Manager T
Configure the feature using Manager T as follows:
Step
Action
1.
2.
3.
4.
1.
2.
Action
1.
2.
Incoming calls
3.
Hunt group
1.
2.
Incoming calls
3.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-91
Implementing Features
Features for General Incoming Traffic
Action
1.
2.
3.
7-92
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for General Incoming Traffic
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
Feature available in
HW requirements
20/8
20/8
SW requirements
Groups/stations
V1.0 or later
800/20
150/20
20/8
Requirement or Condition
User access
The user must be part of a subscriber group to have access to this feature.
The default access codes are #85 to leave the Hunt Group
and *85 to rejoin the group.
DISA
Call Management
If all members of a group invoke the Leave Hunt Group feature, internal callers are diverted to the next Call Management destination, or if not defined, the call receives a busy
tone.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-93
Implementing Features
Features for General Incoming Traffic
Configuration Options
This feature does not have to be explicitly configured.
Testing the Feature
Check the feature for error-free functioning as follows:
Step
Action
1.
2.
When the group is called, the telephone that left the group does not ring.
7-94
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for General Incoming Traffic
>
UCD groups are handled differently from the Call/Hunt Groups in the system call
processing.
There are 150 Subscriber groups in the system. Of which, 60 can be UCD groups.
The default access pilot numbers are 440 to 499.
The Pilot number can be changed but it must be a unique number, up to 6 digits in
length. A name can be given to each group, with up to 16 characters each.
The agents states are maintained in the event of a power failure.
Agents
Any type of telephone can be part of a UCD group. Analog connections can also be
used for remote agents (teleagents).
A UCD group contains agents that belong to a work group. Agent indexes are associated with each of the UCD groups. Each index contains up to 32 agent IDs. A maximum of 150 agents can be active simultaneously in the system. Accordingly, 150
fixed agent IDs can be assigned to one of up to 60 UCD groups. An ID can only be
assigned to one group. Several IDs can be assigned to one agent, permitting the
agent to work in more than one UCD group; however, the agent can only be active in
one group at a time.
Certain system features are only available to UCD members.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-95
Implementing Features
Features for General Incoming Traffic
An agent can logon/logoff from any optiset E, optiPoint or analog telephone connection in the system using an ID. The agent is available after logon, and is permanently
assigned to this device until logoff. An agent can only be logged on from one device
at a time and only one agent can be logged on per device. Each agent is assigned to
one work group only. After logging off, the agent is no longer available for UCD calls.
At logon, this assignment to the UCD groups is checked. The port to which an agent
logs on is stored in the non-volatile memory in order to retain the assignments should
the system be reset.
Agent Indexes are defined in the following manner:
Manager T: 31-1.
Operation
With uniform call distribution (UCD), an incoming internal or external call is assigned
to the station idle longest in a UCD group.
Incoming calls are routed to the UCD group using one the following:
DID
auto-attendant application
station transfer
Prim. Ring cycles is the time the system places an unanswered call in an unavailable
state before the next available agent is offered the call.
If the overflow queue timer expires before an agent is available, the call can be directed to another UCD group, a station, voice mail, or an external destination. If the overflow target is another UCD group, the caller remains in queue in the original group
and is also be placed in queue in the overflow queue. Overflow targets are configured
using the Call destination table.
A numeric threshold value can be assigned to each group. If the number of calls in
queue equals the threshold value, the call overflows.
The UCD group can be forwarded (night answer for UCD).
7-96
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for General Incoming Traffic
>
Each group can specify an overflow time. This time is only used to monitor a forwarded call to a remote UCD application.
Each group can specify the delay time before a queued call is switched to the recorded announcement device. The value for this timer is 0-600 seconds. Every call to an
UCD Group gets an announcement. If no announcement device is configured, the internal MOH is sent to the calling party. To suppress the announcement, the delay
should be configured to the maximum value, assuming that the call will be answered
within this time.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-97
Implementing Features
Features for General Incoming Traffic
Feature Keys/Codes
Agents using display telephones can program vacant keys with the following UCD
functions:
Table 7-1
Log on/off
*401/#401
Lit
Available/Not available
*402/#402
Lit
Work on/off
*403/#403
Lit
*404/#404
Lit
Calls in Queue
*405
N/A
Otherwise, agents can dial the access code from an idle state or press the Program/
Service key during a conversation and scroll to and select UCD and scroll to the UCD
feature to activate/deactivate.
Non-display and analog telephones must dial the access codes from an idle state or
during a conversation after putting the caller temporarily on Consultation Hold and dialing the access code. To return to the call, the agent must press the Consultation key
once again, or do a hookswitch flash in the case of an analog telephone.
Model-Specific Data
Subject
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
Feature available in
HW requirements
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
UCD groups
60
60
10
UCD agents
Max. 150
Max. 150
Max. 150
ID numbers
150
150
150
7-98
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for General Incoming Traffic
Action
1.
2.
3.
Action
1.
2.
Incoming calls
3.
UCD groups
Action
1.
2.
The logged-on agent who was idle the longest receives the call.
3.
If all agents are busy or unavailable, the call is placed in a defined queue.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-99
Implementing Features
Features for General Incoming Traffic
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
Feature available in
HW requirements
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
Number of calls in
queue (per UCD
group)
30
for UCD groups 1 to 59,
72
for UCD group 60
Configuration Options
This feature can be configured using Manager T or HiPath 3000 Manager E.
7-100
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for General Incoming Traffic
Action
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
Action
1.
2.
Incoming calls
3.
UCD groups
Action
1.
Call the UCD group when all stations are busy. The system plays an announcement or music on hold.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-101
Implementing Features
Features for General Incoming Traffic
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
Feature available in
HW requirements
SW requirements
Priority levels
V1.0 or later
10
10
10
Configuration Options
This feature can be configured using Manager T or HiPath 3000 Manager E.
7-102
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for General Incoming Traffic
Action
1.
2.
3.
Action
1.
2.
Incoming calls
3.
UCD parameters
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-103
Implementing Features
Features for General Incoming Traffic
Available: UCD calls are signaled to the UCD group member (agent).
Unavailable: The UCD member (agent) has logged off from the workstation (to
take a break or leave the group).
Work time: The user (agent) needs time to process a UCD call.
Autowork time: The member (agent) is automatically removed from the UCD
group for a certain period after processing a call.
UCD incoming call: The member (agent) is processing a UCD call (even after
transfer).
Non-UCD external outgoing call: The member (agent) is engaged in an outgoing external non-UCD call.
Members (agents) can log off when they have completed their work and are no longer
available. They can still be reached directly via their direct inward dialing (DID) number.
>
The above list of UCD subscriber states do not represent the actual display prompts
on the telephone.
After a user logs onto the system, the status of the UCD station is automatically set
to Available. The display prompt confirms this status. Whenever the agent changes
states, the change is displayed; however, the highest priority display (Available/not
available) appears and remains on the display.
7-104
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for General Incoming Traffic
Model-Specific Data
Subject
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
Feature available in
HW requirements
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
Requirement or Condition
Call forwardingno
answer (CFNA)
If a member (agent) does not accept a call, the system automatically treats the member like an unavailable agent
when CFNA is activated.
Configuration Options
This feature does not have to be explicitly configured.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-105
Implementing Features
Features for General Incoming Traffic
Available: *402
Display telephones can program Feature keys Available/Not available on the optiset
E and optiPoint. Non-display telephones can have a key programmed using HiPath
3000 Manager E.
Model-Specific Data
Subject
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
Feature available in
HW requirements
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
7-106
Requirement or Condition
CFNA is activated when all members (agents) have left the
UCD group.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for General Incoming Traffic
Configuration Options
This feature does not have to be explicitly configured.
Testing the Feature
Check the feature for error-free functioning as follows:
Step
Action
1.
Enter the code for leaving the UCD group at a station in the group.
2.
Calls for the UCD group are no longer signaled at that station.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-107
Implementing Features
Features for General Incoming Traffic
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
Feature available in
HW requirements
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
Configuration Options
This feature can be configured using Manager T or HiPath 3000 Manager E.
Configuring the Feature Using Manager T
Configure the feature using Manager T as follows:
Step
7-108
Action
1.
Configure work
2.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for General Incoming Traffic
Action
1.
Configure work
2.
Incoming calls
3.
UCD parameters
Action
1.
2.
Set up a call.
3.
4.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-109
Implementing Features
Features for General Incoming Traffic
Devices that always start at the beginning of the message when activated (such
as greeting messages).
7-110
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for General Incoming Traffic
For more information, refer to Music on Hold (Internal or External Source) on page 735.
Model-Specific Data
Subject
Feature available in
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
HW requirements
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
Ann. devices
16
Requirement or Condition
Seven announceAlthough only four announcement devices can be connectments per group in Hi- ed to HiPath 3550 and HiPath 3500, seven announcePath 3550
ments can be used per group by connecting an individual
announcement device or combining the four devices.
Configuration Options
This feature can be configured using Manager T or HiPath 3000 Manager E.
Configuring the Feature Using Manager T
Configure the feature using Manager T as follows:
Step
Action
1.
Configure announcement
2.
3.
4.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-111
Implementing Features
Features for General Incoming Traffic
Action
1.
Configure announcement
Connections
2.
Announcement
3.
Announcement device
7-112
Step
Action
1.
Announcement devices connected to SLA boards are called directly (announcement and music on hold only).
Announcements via TIEL connections can be tested only if they have
been registered as a wait queue for UCD or as an announcement for announcement before answering.
2.
If announcement devices are connected to SLA boards, the corresponding announcement or music on hold must be played.
If they are connected to a TIEL board, the announcement must be
played when an ACD/UCD group is called.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for General Incoming Traffic
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
Feature available in
HW requirements
SW requirements
Overflow per group
V1.0 or later
3
Configuration Options
This feature can be configured using Manager T or HiPath 3000 Manager E.
Configuring the Feature Using Manager T
Configure the feature using Manager T as follows:
Step
Action
1.
2.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-113
Implementing Features
Features for General Incoming Traffic
Action
1.
2.
Incoming calls
3.
7-114
Action
Do not answer a call to the UCD group.
After the call forwardingno answer time has expired, the call is signaled at the overflow destination.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for General Incoming Traffic
>
The system routes calls to agents configured for AICC whether there is a headset
physically connected or not.
Model-Specific Data
Subject
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
Feature available in
HW requirements
V1.0 or later
optiPoint or optiset E,
headset, release key
SW requirements
General requirements
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Requirement or Condition
Analog stations cannot use this feature because the system cannot guarantee that a telephone is physically connected to the port.
7-115
Implementing Features
Features for General Incoming Traffic
Subject
Display telephones
Requirement or Condition
A brief tone is heard in the headset, signalling to the agent
that a call has arrived, and the call is answered automatically.
Configuration Options
This feature can be configured using Manager T or HiPath 3000 Manager E.
Configuring the Feature Using Manager T
Configure the feature using Manager T as follows:
Step
Action
1.
2.
7-116
Action
1.
2.
Incoming calls
3.
UCD groups
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for General Incoming Traffic
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
Feature available in
HW requirements
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
Requirement or Condition
Agent status
UCD night answer can be activated independently of system night answer and vice versa. If a call reaches a UCD
group by way of system night answer, the call remains in
the UCD group independently of UCD night answer.
Group-specific night
answer destination
The group-specific night answer destination can be an internal, external, or any other UCD group.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-117
Implementing Features
Features for General Incoming Traffic
Configuration Options
This feature does not have to be explicitly configured.
Testing the Feature
Check the feature for error-free functioning as follows:
Step
Action
1.
2.
3.
7-118
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for General Incoming Traffic
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
HW requirements
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
General requirements
Configuration Options
Action
1.
With a UCD station logged on, use a code or procedure to display the
number of calls waiting in the queue.
2.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-119
Implementing Features
Features for General Incoming Traffic
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
Feature available in
HW requirements
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
Requirement or Condition
Only the most important functions are accessible via
codes (logon, work, unavailable).
Configuration Options
This feature can be configured using Manager T or HiPath 3000 Manager E.
Configuring the Feature Using Manager T
Configure the feature using Manager T as follows:
Step
7-120
Action
1.
2.
3.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for General Incoming Traffic
Action
1.
2.
Incoming calls
3.
UCD groups
Action
1.
2.
Call the UCD group. The call is signaled at the home station.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-121
Implementing Features
Features for General Incoming Traffic
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
Feature available in
HW requirements
SW requirements
Max. number of UCD
groups
V1.0 or later
60
60
10
Requirement or Condition
Announcements
Recall
The recall time for transferring calls to UCD groups is longer than for other stations.
Configuration Options
This feature does not have to be explicitly configured.
7-122
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for General Incoming Traffic
>
Some states require that the outside caller be advised that the call may be monitored.
This feature is available for all telephones except IP telephones.
Silent monitoring is not possible if the overriding station uses an IP telephone or if a
call being conducted on an IP telephone should be overridden.
The microphone is automatically muted if the overriding station is an optiset E or optiPoint terminal. This feature is not available when using a mobile telephone (CMI) because in this case the system does not support automatic microphone muting.
Model-Specific Data
Subject
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
Feature available in
HW requirements
SW requirements
V1.2 or later
Requirement or Condition
Silent Monitoring
To enable the feature for a station, you must set the station
flags for Silent Monitoring and Override class of service on.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-123
Implementing Features
Features for General Incoming Traffic
Subject
Requirement or Condition
Silent Monitoring
This feature can be used in the following countries only: Australia, Brazil, France, Great Britain, Hong Kong, India, Ireland,
Malaysia, the Netherlands, Singapore, South Africa, Thailand,
USA, international markets. For V3.0 SMR-6 or later, this feature is also available in Argentina, Belgium, and Spain. With
V3.0 SMR-11 or later, the feature can also be used in Portugal.
Silent monitoring
The call can be overridden only using code *944 + station number (not from a menu).
Signaling
Conference
Configuration Options
This feature can be configured using Manager T or HiPath 3000 Manager E.
Configuring the Feature Using Manager T
Configure the feature using Manager T as follows:
Step
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
7-124
Action
Enable Silent Monitoring
14-13 => busy override
Select station
Select authorization: 0 = not authorized, 1 = authorized
14-34 => monitoring
Select station
Select authorization: 0 = not authorized, 1 = authorized
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for General Incoming Traffic
Action
1.
2.
Configure station
3.
Station
4.
5.
Action
1.
Set up a call.
2.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-125
Implementing Features
Features for General Incoming Traffic
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
Feature available in
HW requirements
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
7-126
Requirement or Condition
Call forwarding
Call forwarding
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for General Incoming Traffic
Subject
Callback
Requirement or Condition
If a callback is initiated to a station with DND activated, the
callback is not executed until DND is deactivated. If the
subscriber with DND activated initiates a callback, this will
override the DND function.
The feature can be activated by users for their own stations, or can be activated by one user for another (Associated Services).
Configuration Options
This feature does not have to be explicitly configured.
Testing the Feature
Check the feature for error-free functioning as follows:
Step
Action
1.
2.
Call the station with DND activated. You should hear a busy signal.
Display Telephones
From an idle state, the user dials the default access code *97; the display confirms the action with the prompt Do Not Disturb on. The prompt remains on the
display as a reminder to the user. Furthermore, when the user goes off hook, he
or she hears a broken dial tone as a further reminder. To cancel DND, the user
dials the default access code #97; the action is confirmed by the display prompt
Do not disturb off.
The user can also program a button on the telephone to activate/de-activate the
feature. The LED remains on as long as Do not disturb is active on that telephone.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-127
Implementing Features
Features for General Incoming Traffic
The user can also activate/deactivate the feature while engaged in a conversation by pressing the Program/Service key followed by the access code. This will
have no effect on the current call, nor will it have any effect on any call campedon prior to the activation of DND. Those camped on calls will be presented to the
user. However, any call which attempts to camp on after DND is activated, is denied.
7-128
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for General Incoming Traffic
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
Feature available in
HW requirements
SW requirements
General requirements
V1.0 or later
optiset E or optiPoint with display
Requirement or Condition
You can only activate this feature for optiset E or optiPoint
telephones with display.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-129
Implementing Features
Features for General Incoming Traffic
Action
1.
2.
7-130
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for General Incoming Traffic
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
HW requirements
UP0/E stn. UP0/E stn. UP0/E stn. UP0/E stn. UP0/E stn.
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
General requirements
Subscriber group
Lists/entries
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Maximum of 10 entries
650/10
650/10
100/10
100/10
100/10
7-131
Implementing Features
Features for General Incoming Traffic
Requirement or Condition
Analog trunk
Power failure
Internal/external calls
You can store either external calls only or both internal and
external calls.
Repeated calls
Group
Storing an external
answered call
You can access the store station number function manually from the service menu.
Configuration Options
This feature can be configured using Manager T or HiPath 3000 Manager E.
Configuring the Feature Using Manager T
Configure the feature using Manager T as follows:
Step
7-132
Action
1.
2.
3.
Class of service:
4.
5.
6.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for General Incoming Traffic
Action
1.
Class of service:
Options
2.
Set up station
3.
Stations
4.
5.
6.
System parameters
7.
System flags
Action
1.
2.
If a Caller list key is programmed, the LED lights up. Otherwise, retrieve
the entries from the caller list via the menu or by entering a code (*82).
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-133
Implementing Features
Features for General Incoming Traffic
The user can also manually save a dialed destination number: during the call, the
user scrolls to Save Number or presses the Program/Service key and scrolls to
Save Number. If the user programmed a button for this function, the LED lights.
The LED of the feature button is extinguished whenever the user accesses the
Caller List, whether there are still calls in the list or not.
>
An outgoing number saved by the user, cannot be automatically deleted; the user
must manually do so. These outgoing numbers are identifiable by the digit zero in
the field for the number of calls; the digit is set to zero.
If the user is part of a Hunt Group or Call Group, the user can view unanswered
calls to his or her number and to the Group number, whether the telephone rang
or not. To view these calls, the user presses the Next prompt on the telephone:
the display shows calls to his or her personal number and if any, calls to the group
name. Further selecting Next, scrolls through the Groups unanswered numbers.
7-134
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for General Incoming Traffic
Model-Specific Data
Subject
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
Feature available in
HW requirements
8/8
8/8
SW requirements
Groups/stations
V1.0 or later
32/32
32/32
8/8
Requirement or Condition
Call pickup
Recall
Callback
Transfer
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-135
Implementing Features
Features for General Incoming Traffic
Subject
Requirement or Condition
Groups
Call waiting
Configuration Options
This feature can be configured using Manager T or HiPath 3000 Manager E.
Configuring the Feature Using Manager T
Configure the feature using Manager T as follows:
Step
Action
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7-136
Action
1.
2.
Incoming calls
3.
Call pickup
4.
5.
Set up station
6.
Key programming
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for General Incoming Traffic
Action
1.
2.
Use the pickup key or enter *57 to pick up the call from another station
in this pickup group.
Display telephones
An incoming call to one member of a Call Pick up group is displayed at all other
stations: Call for xxx. where xxx is the station being called. Selecting the command Pick up - group? connects the user to the calling party.
If the called party does not answer the call within three rings, the other members
of the group can be alerted of the incoming call by a brief ring burst to attract their
attention to the display.
Alternatively, a feature button can be programmed on the telephones to facilitate
call pick up. Users can program the key on their telephones, or the key can be
programmed via HiPath 3000 Manager E. When a call enters the Pick up group,
the LED flashes. To pick up the call, the user presses the key.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-137
Implementing Features
Features for General Incoming Traffic
Model-Specific Data
Subject
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
Feature available in
HW requirements
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
Requirement or Condition
Call waiting
CDRC
Configuration Options
This feature does not have to be explicitly configured.
7-138
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for General Incoming Traffic
Action
1.
2.
3.
4.
Action
1.
2.
Set up station
3.
Key programming
Action
1.
Call a station.
2.
Display Telephones
Directed Call Pickup can be invoked from a Consultation state; that is, upon hearing a telephone ring, the user presses the Consultation prompt, putting the current conversation on Consultation Hold. The user then dials the access code and
the destination number or accepts the call shown on the display. The user can
then dispose of the call in a normal manner before returning to the held party.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-139
Implementing Features
Features for General Incoming Traffic
The same procedure applies to the optiset E memory telephone, except that
more than one ringing call can be seen simultaneously on the screen, which allows the user an easier interface as to which call to answer.
7-140
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for General Incoming Traffic
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
HW requirements
UP0/E station
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
General requirements
Requirement or Condition
Answering machine
The answering machine port must be configured as an answering machine in system administration.
Answering machine
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-141
Implementing Features
Features for General Incoming Traffic
Configuration Options
This feature can be configured using Manager T or HiPath 3000 Manager E.
Configuring the Feature Using Manager T
Configure the feature using Manager T as follows:
Step
Action
1.
Configure port
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
7-142
Action
1.
Configure port
Options
2.
Set up station
3.
Stations
4.
Parameters
5.
Type
6.
7.
Set up station
8.
Program keys
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for General Incoming Traffic
Action
1.
2.
After the answering machine has answered the call, press the programmed DSS key to pick up the call from the answering machine.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-143
Implementing Features
Features for General Incoming Traffic
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
HW requirements
UP0/E station
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
General requirements
Requirement or Condition
Program key
You must also enter the station number when programming the key.
Analog port
Info key
Configuration Options
This feature can be configured using Manager T or HiPath 3000 Manager E.
7-144
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for General Incoming Traffic
Action
1.
Configure key
*91 => Access key programming.
2.
3.
4.
Action
1.
Configure key
Options
2.
Set up station
3.
Program keys
Action
1.
2.
3.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-145
Implementing Features
Features for General Incoming Traffic
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
HW requirements
UP0/E station
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
General requirements
Requirement or Condition
You must have trunk keys or at least two call keys programmed on the telephone.
Configuration Options
This feature can be configured using Manager T or HiPath 3000 Manager E.
7-146
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for General Incoming Traffic
Action
1.
Configure key
*91 => Access key programming.
2.
3.
Assign the Call key or Trunk key service to the key selected.
Action
1.
Configure key
Options
2.
3.
Program keys
Action
1.
2.
Press an available trunk or call key on this telephone to set up an outgoing connection.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-147
Implementing Features
Features for General Incoming Traffic
Station number assignment does not need to be explicitly configured. This feature allows users to modify the preset internal station numbers using Manager T.
You can use the menu option Search for number to locate individual station numbers.
After you enter an internal station number, its logical port is displayed in the format
SSPP (SS = slot, PP = port).
Model-Specific Data
Subject
Feature available in
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
150
150
20
20
Requirement or Condition
An internal station or group number must always be unique
in the system and must not conflict with other station numbers in the numbering plan.
Configuration Options
This feature can be configured using Manager T.
7-148
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for General Incoming Traffic
Action
1.
2.
3.
4.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-149
Implementing Features
Features for General Incoming Traffic
The rejected call then follows the Call Management. If there is no other call forwarding
destination, an external call is intercepted by the attendant console. In the case of a
loop start call, the call will remain frozen in the queue if no subsequent destinations
can be reached. In all other cases, the call is cleared down.
Model-Specific Data
Topic
Feature available in
HW requirements
SW requirements
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
V1.2 or
later
V1.2 or
later
V1.2 or
later
V1.2 or
later
Requirement or Condition
Recall, callback, park, Transferred recalls, queued callbacks, held or parked calls
hold
cannot be rejected.
Group call, hunt group In these cases, the entire group call ends and follows Call
call, MULAP
Management. The call is released if there is no other call
destination.
7-150
Call forwarding
There is no immediate call forwarding after the call is rejected. The entries in Call Management determine the next
step.
Intercept
Intercept
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for General Incoming Traffic
Configuration Options
This feature does not have to be explicitly configured.
Testing the Feature
Check the feature for error-free functioning as follows:
Step
Action
1.
Press the release key (optiset E or optiPoint) or the consult key (CMI) on
an internal or external incoming initial call.
2.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-151
Implementing Features
Features for General Outgoing Traffic
Individually while engaged in an internal or external call by pressing a key or entering a code.
Afterwards, all keystrokes from the dialing keypad are transmitted as DTMF digits. The feature is activated temporarily and is deactivated when the handset is
replaced.
DTMF mode remains activated even when the following features are activated:
Transfer
Consultation hold
Toggle
Call pickup
Users can configure the pulse/pause in the system. However, configuring the pulse/
pause is not recommended. Contact your second-level service organization if required.
Model-Specific Data
Subject
Feature available in
HW requirements
SW requirements
7-152
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
V1.0 or later
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for General Outgoing Traffic
Requirement or Condition
Station on hold
Conference, call park, DTMF mode remains activated during a conference, durrecall
ing a recall, or in call park mode.
Other features during
DTMF mode
When DTMF mode is active, you must always use the Program/Service key to activate features during a call.
Voice mail
DTMF mode is automatically activated when a station configured as voice mail is selected.
US DTMF Default
Configuration Options
This feature can be configured using Manager T or HiPath 3000 Manager E.
Configuring the Feature Using Manager T
Configure the feature using Manager T as follows:
Step
Action
1.
2.
Action
1.
2.
System parameters
3.
System flags
4.
DTMF automatic
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-153
Implementing Features
Features for General Outgoing Traffic
Action
1.
2.
3.
1.
2.
3.
7-154
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for General Outgoing Traffic
Room Monitor
Speaker Call
internal calls
The function #0=Reset all services does not deactivate this feature. It is not possible
to change the PIN from a locked telephone. This PIN is the same PIN that a user must
enter when entering the system via Direct Inward System Access (DISA). The external user can activate/deactivate Individual Telephone Lock from a DISA connection,
but the user cannot change the PIN from a DISA connection.
Model-Specific Data
Subject
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
Feature available in
HW requirements
SW requirements
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
V1.0 or later
7-155
Implementing Features
Features for General Outgoing Traffic
Requirement or Condition
After telephone lock is activated, the extension trunk access is set to a system-wide class of service (default = 1).
Telephone lock
While telephone lock is active, you cannot activate any features that could result in charges being assigned to this station. Exception: system speed dialing.
Telephone type
Non-display/analog
feature reminder
Configuration Options
This feature does not have to be explicitly configured.
Testing the Feature
Check the feature for error-free functioning as follows:
Step
Action
1.
2.
3.
7-156
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for General Outgoing Traffic
For a list of additional documentation, refer to Table 1-1, List of Available Documentation for HiPath 3000
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-157
Implementing Features
Features for General Outgoing Traffic
Room Monitor
Speaker Call
internal calls
The function #0 = Reset all services does not deactivate this feature. It is not possible
to change the PIN from a locked telephone.
If the authorized station has activated a Telephone Lock, the authorized user must
first deactivate the Telephone Lock feature before attempting to activate/deactivate
another stations Telephone Lock.
To activate/deactivate another stations telephone lock, the authorized station does
not need to know or use the individuals PIN. No PIN is required to activate/deactivate
the other stations Telephone Lock.
Related Topics
7-158
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for General Outgoing Traffic
Model-Specific Data
Subject
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
Feature available in
HW requirements
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
Requirement or Condition
After telephone lock is activated, the extension trunk access is set to a system-wide COS (default = 1).
Telephone lock
While telephone lock is active, you cannot activate any features except for system speed dialing, room monitor,
speaker call, and conferences with internal stations.
At the destination telephone, the user is advised of a feature activation by hearing broken dial tone when going off
hook, or if the user has a button for this feature, the LED
will be lit. If the telephone is unlocked, the broken dial tone
is removed and/or the LED is extinguished.
Non-display/analog
If the authorized station is a non-display or analog telephone, the user, from an idle state, can access the feature
by dialing *943, followed by the destination station for
which Telephone Lock is to be activated/deactivated, followed by * to activate or # to deactivate. Confirmation tone
is returned only after all digits have been dialed. Error tone
will not be returned if the authorized station inadvertently
attempts to lock an already locked telephone, or attempts
to unlock an already unlocked telephone
Configuration Options
This feature can be configured using Manager T or HiPath 3000 Manager E.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-159
Implementing Features
Features for General Outgoing Traffic
Action
1.
2.
3.
Define a station number for the station authorized to activate the system
telephone lock.
Action
1.
2.
System parameters
3.
System settings
7-160
Action
1.
2.
After the system has been programmed, you can no longer place the external calls prohibited by the class of service.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for General Outgoing Traffic
7.5.4 Hotline
Definition
With the hotline feature, the telephone automatically connects to a predefined internal
or external destination after the user lifts the handset. Users can also configure the
feature so that the two locations connect only after a defined period (hotline after timeout). This delay is configured centrally and can be activated and deactivated on each
station.
Call forwarding and call forwardingno answer are evaluated at the destination.
If the Hotline Delayed station (originator) dials a digit before the timeout limit, the timer
is cancelled and the station is not forwarded to the Hotline destination whether another digit is dialed or not.
Model-Specific Data
Subject
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
Feature available in
HW requirements
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
Hotline destinations
Requirements/Conditions
Subject
Requirement/Condition
DND
Destination
Configuration Options
This feature can be configured using Manager T or HiPath 3000 Manager E.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-161
Implementing Features
Features for General Outgoing Traffic
Action
1.
Configure hotline
2.
3.
4.
5.
Action
1.
Configure hotline
Options
2.
Set up station
3.
Parameters
4.
Flags
5.
Hotline destination
Options
6.
System parameters
7.
System settings
7-162
Action
1.
Configure a hotline.
2.
3.
The telephone connects to the hotline destination as configured (immediately or after a timeout).
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for General Outgoing Traffic
Press the programmed key + enter local station number + enter PIN
The feature remains activated until the active station terminates the call.
As long as this feature is activated, the current telephone (passive station) cannot be
reached under its actual station number. Do not disturb is activated.
An active station can be a:
Station
MULAP (in this case, the PIN of the primary station in the MULAP group is requested)
Hunt group
ACD group
Model-Specific Data
Subject
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
Feature available in
HW requirements
SW requirements
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
V1.0 or later
7-163
Implementing Features
Features for General Outgoing Traffic
Requirement or Condition
Services
Recall
Busy indication
Configuration Options
This feature can be configured using HiPath 3000 Manager E.
7-164
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for General Outgoing Traffic
Action
1.
Options
2.
Set up station
3.
Key programming
Action
1.
2.
Enter PIN.
3.
When the LED on the Mobile PIN key lights up, the feature is activated.
4.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-165
Implementing Features
Features for General Outgoing Traffic
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
TMS2
TS2 /
TS2R
Requirement or Condition
B channel allocation is not useful in IP networking because
it is not possible at this time to assign incoming calls to the
correct trunk group.
Configuration Options
This feature can be configured using HiPath 3000 Manager E.
7-166
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for General Outgoing Traffic
Action
1.
2.
Lines/networking
3.
Action
1.
2.
Check the status of the boards to see whether a B channel on the required route was seized each time.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-167
Implementing Features
Features for General External Traffic
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
x
STMD8
S0 trunks
V1.0 or later
Requirement or Condition
ISDN terminals
Configuration Options
This feature can be configured using Manager T or HiPath 3000 Manager E.
7-168
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for General External Traffic
Action
1.
Configure S0 port
2.
1.
2.
Action
1.
Configure S0 port
Options
2.
Trunk/networking
3.
Trunks
4.
Flags
5.
ISDN flags
1.
2.
Set up station
3.
Station
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-169
Implementing Features
Features for General External Traffic
The ISDN devices are assigned a call number for internal dialing and an 11-digit Multiple Subscriber Number (MSN) for incoming DID applications.
Each ST port consists of two 64 Kbps channels. Two devices can be connected to the
ISDN adapter. Eight devices can be connected to an S0 port on an interface card. The
devices connected on an S0 port share the 128 Kbps bandwidth for video and data
calls.
Basic Rate Interface (BRI) Operation
In a BRI environment, each CO B channel is assigned a Special Profile Identifier
(SPID) number and a Terminal Identifier (TID) for identification purposes from the
Public Network. The SPID and TID received from the network provider must be associated with the call number assigned to the data or video equipment connected to the
ST interface. If a system is equipped with three BRI trunks, the maximum number of
ISDN data sessions is either three 128 Kbps sessions or six 64 Kbps sessions. Typically CACH (Call Appearance Call Handling) values or Phantom Directory numbers
are required for Voice terminals only. In some COs, CACH values or Phantom Directory numbers can be required for the ST data devices as well.
Due to the complexity of BRI configuration, it is recommended that ST applications
be limited to 128 Kbps. The call number for each ST port must be associated with a
Public Network SPID. This means that the number of 64-Kbps channels that can be
called up is limited to the number of Public Network SPIDs.
Refer to the Configuration Note for S0 Device Installation.
>
The STLS4 module is used also as a trunk interface in Europe. For subscriber applications, the receive and transmit leads must be reversed before connecting to the
first device on the bus. This crossover is already performed in the ISDN adapter.
Usually the ST device is connected to an ISDN NT-1 adapter and the SPID-TID numbers assigned by the CO are programmed in the device. However, since the ST device is located behind the switch on an ST bus, the HiPath 3000 provide SPID-TID
7-170
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for General External Traffic
identification control. Each ST channel used by the ST device requires a Call Number
for internal dialing. An MSN number also is required to enable the ST device to communicate with the HiPath 3000 system.
The protocol should always be set to ATT NI-1 in the ST device. The HiPath 3000 perform all protocol conversions.
Primary Rate Interface (PRI) Operation
In a PRI or CorNet-N environment, SPIDs, TIDs and CACH values are not required.
Internal SPID/TID entries called Multiple Subscribers Numbers (MSN) are used by
the ST devices for call setup. DID numbers must be assigned to each channel that
connects to an ST device.
The DID numbers can be assigned from the numbers received from the CO. The DID
number can be from 1 to 11 digits. The DID numbers are required to set up incoming
calls to the device.
Assign a call number to each No-Port station port used for the ST device. The call
number can be from 1 to 6 digits. The call number does not need match the DID number.
An MSN number must be assigned to the ST device for each B-Channel required for
the application. The MSN numbers act as SPIDs for the ST device. The MSN number
can be from 7 to 14 digits. If the entry is 9 to 14 digits, the last 2 digits are used as the
TID number. The last 2 digits should be 00 for B channel 1, and they should be 01 for
B channel 2 on each ST interface used.
It is suggested that the MSN number consists of the DID number, followed by 5 zeros,
followed by a 2-digit TID number.
Related Topic
Section 7.18.10, Multiple Subscriber Number, on page 7-574
Model-Specific Data
Subject
Feature available in
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
HW requirements
S0 board
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-171
Implementing Features
Features for General External Traffic
Requirements/Conditions
Subject
Requirement/Condition
ISDN terminals
Configuration Options
This feature can be configured using Manager T and HiPath 3000 Manager E.
Programming Feature Using Manager T
Configure the feature using Manager T as follows:
Step
Action
1.
Configure S0 port
*9531994
2.
1.
2.
7-172
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for General External Traffic
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-173
Implementing Features
Features for General External Traffic
Alternatively, the user can dial the default access code *63 followed by the held line
number; the user is reconnected to the held party. A Feature key can also be programmed on a users telephone to retrieve a held line.
The recall timer used is Time for parking and change to hold. The default value is 180
seconds.
Model-Specific Data
Subject
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
Feature available in
HW requirements
SW requirements
Trunk groups
V1.0 or later
16 trunk
16 trunk
8 trunk
groups groups, 64 groups
with up to B chan- with max.
72 B channels
all B channels per
nels per
trunk
trunk
group
group
6
7-174
Requirement or Condition
Analog trunks
optiset E or optiPoint,
trunk group key
You can program up to 6 or 4 trunk group keys on an optiset E or optiPoint telephone. If all trunks in a trunk group
are busy, its trunk group key lights up.
Overflow
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for General External Traffic
Configuration Options
This feature can be configured using Manager T or HiPath 3000 Manager E.
Configuring the Feature Using Manager T
Configure the feature using Manager T as follows:
Step
Action
1.
2.
3.
4.
Action
1.
2.
Lines/networking
3.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-175
Implementing Features
Features for General External Traffic
Meaning
Off
Trunk is free
Continuously lit
Trunk is busy
Flickering
Flashing slowly
Trunk is on hold
Flashing rapidly
Users can use the trunk keys for the following features:
Call pickup
Answer calls
A Trunk key is used for receiving incoming trunk calls and placing outgoing calls on
the selected trunks. A Trunk key represents an analog CO trunk appearance, a BRI
link appearance, a T1 DS0 channel, or an analog E&M Tie line channel.
>
A Trunk key can not be programmed on the same station that is using Call Keys to
manage the trunk group associated with the trunk appearance.
A Trunk key can appear on more than one station. All stations with the appearance of
the Trunk key can also ring on an incoming call, if they are programmed in a Call
Group, otherwise they only have LED signalization.
A user can place a trunk appearance on Common Hold by pressing the Hold key and
going on-hook. The trunk appearance will flash slowly at all other appearances of the
Trunk key.
Calls placed on Trunk keys are subject to COS toll restriction levels and rules.
7-176
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for General External Traffic
Trunk keys can be used in a Centrex environment. The system can cut through immediately to the Centrex CO to allow the user to hear if special tones, indicating Message Waiting. In this case, Dial Tone Detection must be turned off because the special CO tones are not recognized by the HiPath 3000 as dial tone.
Feature Interaction:
Call pickup: An incoming call ringing on a Trunk key can be picked from another
station via the feature Call Pickup - Group or via Call Pickup - Directed.
Retrieve trunk on common hold: Another user with the appearance of the
same Trunk key, can retrieve a trunk call on Common Hold (Appearance flashing
slowly) by pressing the flashing key.
Answer calls: Any user with the appearance of the trunk can answer an incoming call on the Trunk key by pressing the flickering Trunk key.
Toggle between several different trunks: If a user has an appearance of several Trunk keys on his or her telephone, the user can toggle between any of the
trunks by pressing the desired Trunk key. The first trunk is placed on Consultation
Hold at the station. Any subsequent depression of another Trunk key places the
last call on Consultation Hold at that telephone. If the user goes on-hook at any
point, the last held party is immediately recalled per the Consultation Hold procedure.
Operating
If the default station templates are in effect, this feature can only be used on display
telephones.
Placing a call: The user presses an idle Trunk key. Simulated dial tone can be
presented to the user until the trunk cuts through (See Routing Parameters ->
Analog Trunk Seizure delay).
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-177
Implementing Features
Features for General External Traffic
Receiving a call: An incoming call is signalled audibly and visually at the station.
The display shows the trunk group name. If Caller ID is available, the user display
indicates the calling partys Caller ID number. Calling party name is not available.
The user presses the flickering key to answer the call.
Model-Specific Data
Subject
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
Feature available in
HW requirements
UP0/E telephone
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
Configuration Options
This feature can be configured using Manager T or HiPath 3000 Manager E.
Configuring the Feature Using Manager T
Configure the feature using Manager T as follows:
Step
Action
1.
2.
3.
7-178
Action
1.
2.
Set up station
3.
Key programming
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for General External Traffic
Action
1.
2.
3.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-179
Implementing Features
Features for General External Traffic
Toggle
Pickup
Operating
If the default station templates are in effect, this feature can only be used on display
telephones.
Answering and signaling initial calls and recalls: The Call key can also operate as a Loop key. That is, a user can have two or more Call keys on his or her
telephone representing the same trunks. The first incoming call will be presented
to the first idle Call key; the second call to the next idle Call key, and so on. The
call can be transferred using the Consultation Hold function using a feature button or with the dialog keys. Unanswered calls or unretrieved parked calls recall
the station on the Call key and can be answered again on the Call key (Common
hold: still assigned to that Call key).
Toggle: If a user has an appearance of several Trunk keys on his or her telephone, the user can toggle between any of the Call keys by pressing the desired
Call key. The first trunk is placed on Consultation Hold at the station. Any subsequent depression of another Call key places the last call on Consultation Hold at
that telephone. If the user goes on-hook at any point, the last held party immediately recalls per the Consultation Hold procedure.
Pickup: An incoming call ringing on a Call key can be picked up from another
station via the feature Call Pickup - Group or via Call Pickup - Directed.
Conversely, if a user with a Call key on the telephone, picks a trunk call from another station, the trunk appears on the Call key.
7-180
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for General External Traffic
Placing a call: The user presses a Call key. The user is presented with simulated
dial tone if LCR is in effect or, if not, CO dial tone.
Receiving a call: An incoming call is signalled audibly and visually at the station.
The display will show the Trunk group name. If Caller ID is available, the user display will indicate the calling partys Caller ID number. Calling party name is not
available. The user presses the flickering key to answer the call. The LED of the
Call key remains lit.
Model-Specific Data
Subject
Feature available in
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
HW requirements
Digital telephone
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
10
10
10
10
10
Requirement or Condition
The busy state is not displayed for the entire trunk group.
Unscreened transfer,
recall
Configuration Options
This feature can be configured using Manager T or HiPath 3000 Manager E.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-181
Implementing Features
Features for General External Traffic
Action
1.
2.
3.
Action
1.
2.
Set up station
3.
Key programming
7-182
Action
1.
2.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for General External Traffic
Networked systems
Transition from a private network to the public network and vice versa
>
Call forwarding
Transfer
Callback (CorNet-N and QSig networks; if supported on the trunk side, transit
traffic can be used externally as well)
Message waiting for central voice mail servers in CorNet-N and QSig (not for
U.S.) networks.
External access from a remote node is not possible over HiPath 3550 or HiPath
3500 BRI trunks. Such calls are intercepted to the HiPath 3550 or HiPath 3500 intercept position.
Definition of Features Associated with Transit Traffic
Call forwarding: A trunk-to-trunk connection is possible using Call Forwarding No Answer (only with a pseudo port) or Call Forwarding (CF) to an external destination. Care should be taken concerning the release capability of the trunks.
Using LCR, an incoming call can also be forwarded (CF or CNA) to a CorNet-N
link to a station in the remote node, to the Attendant in the remote node, to a voice
mail system in the remote node, or rerouted to an external destination by the remote node. When calls from a HiPath 3000 are routed through a CorNet-N link
to internal and external destinations, the CorNet-N channels must be split between these functions. In the case of a transfer to a remote voice mail system,
the HiPath 3000 sends the originally called destinations station number to the
voice mail to activate the proper answer message.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-183
Implementing Features
Features for General External Traffic
>
Always refer to the latest CorNet-N Configuration Note or the CorNet-N Sales Positioning Guide for the latest information.
Transfer: It is possible for the user to transfer calls (screened and un-screened)
to an external destination or to a remote node, via a CorNet-N link.
The transfer can also be initiated by a voice mail call processing feature or by an
IVR which automatically transfers, unscreened, a call to an external or CorNet-N
destination.
Message waiting for central voice mail servers in CorNet-N networks: Message Waiting notification is possible from a remote voice mail system connected
via CorNet-N links. In the case of PhoneMail, the SW version must be 6.3 or higher.
Model-Specific Data
Subject
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
Feature available in
HW requirements
S0/S2M board
SW requirements
TLA board
V1.0 or later
Requirement or Condition
Loop-start trunks are automatically released after a programmable period (default: 310 seconds. A tone sounds
10 seconds before release). The time parameters only can
be changed by using HiPath 3000 Manager E.
Configuration Options
This feature can be configured using HiPath 3000 Manager E.
7-184
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for General External Traffic
Action
1.
2.
System parameters
3.
System flags
Action
1.
2.
3.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-185
Implementing Features
Features for General External Traffic
If using Manager T, always enter the speed dial number first, then enter the corresponding name. Manager T does not allow a name to be entered for a specific
index unless a number has been previously entered. Names can only be entered
using the memory telephone or HiPath 3000 Manager E.
2.
Manager T and HiPath 3000 Manager E both check the first digit(s) of the speed
dial number you are programming against the default or current digits used in
your database for external access codes. For example: entering the speed dial
number 71 510 555 1212, may be disallowed if the numbers 7 or 71 or 715 are
not CO access codes.
Model-Specific Data
Subject
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
Feature available in
HW requirements
300
300
SW requirements
Number of speed dialing numbers
V1.0 or later
1000
1000
300
Configuration Options
This feature can be configured using Manager T or HiPath 3000 Manager E.
7-186
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for General External Traffic
Action
1.
2.
3.
4.
Action
1.
2.
System parameters
3.
Action
1.
2.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-187
Implementing Features
Features for General External Traffic
7.6.8 Message Waiting Indication (MWI) at the Trunk Interface (V3.0 or Later)
Definition
You can use this function only if the public exchange supports it.
You can activate and delete the Mailbox key.
This function supports sending (service menu or code) from the idle, ringing, busy,
and talk states and supports the receiving of messages.
On the receiver side, telephones with a display show the message Please call back.
Model-Specific Data
Subject
Feature available in
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
HW requirements
SW requirements
Configuration Options
This feature does not have to be explicitly configured.
7-188
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for Incoming External Traffic
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
Feature available in
HW requirements
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
Requirement or Condition
DTMF DID
A number of calls can be waiting simultaneously at the stations entered in the call allocation tables.
Intercept
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-189
Implementing Features
Features for Incoming External Traffic
Configuration Options
This feature can be configured using Manager T or HiPath 3000 Manager E.
Configuring the Feature Using Manager T
Configure the feature using Manager T as follows:
Step
Action
1.
2.
3.
4.
Action
1.
2.
Incoming calls
3.
7-190
Step
Action
1.
In the case of analog trunks, assign the trunk to one station in call management.
2.
Call the analog trunk via the central office. The station entered in call
management rings.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for Incoming External Traffic
If the primary telephone has activated call waiting, group ringing takes place after
a 5-second delay.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-191
Implementing Features
Features for Incoming External Traffic
If the primary telephone cannot receive a call, or if call waiting is inactive, call
ringing does not take place.
Model-Specific Data
Subject
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
Feature available in
HW requirements
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
Requirement or Condition
Recall
System search
Callback
Appointment
No group ringing when If the flag is set, no group ringing will take place if the stabusy
tion is busy.
Configuration Options
This feature does not have to be explicitly configured.
Testing the Feature
Check the feature for error-free functioning as follows:
Step
7-192
Action
1.
2.
3.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for Incoming External Traffic
no answer
busy
wrong number
incomplete
recall
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-193
Implementing Features
Features for Incoming External Traffic
System Administration assigns which trunks ring into which station (See Call Management) in Day mode and in Night mode. When the system is switched to night service, the system checks against the Call Allocation - Night list in Manager T (Ringing
Line Assignments list in HiPath 3000 Manager E) to see where to send the incoming
call. The destinations can be either an individual station or a group.
Users can also use a central bell in conjunction with Night answer to alert any personnel (night shift) to night calls. In Call Management, an additional station can be
called by means of the Additional call number entry shown as Second Target in Call
Destination Lists in HiPath 3000 Manager E. This entry supports the common ringer
function. An actuator (relay) or an additional extension at which a call is also to be
signaled is entered here. The last field Type defines when ringing assignment takes
place (immediate or after CF timeout).
The night bell (instead of a telephone) may be physically connected to the station interface, in which case, the night bell can be answered by dialing the station number
or by call Pick up, if so configured.
>
An external night bell adapter may be required to prevent excessive current from
damaging the station interface.
A Night answer station can be any type of telephone, providing their COS allows, at
minimum, for incoming calls.
When in Night mode, all stations use the Night COS table. The table, similar to the
Day COS table, also has 15 classes to choose from. (Refer to Section 7.8.10, Configurable Toll Restriction for details).
A variable night station (universal night answer position) can be specified. The variable night station can be configured by any of the stations authorized to place the system in Night Service mode.
This feature can be activated/deactivated via a DISA connection by the station user.
If the feature is used frequently, the user can place the feature on a vacant button on
the telephone. The feature button name is Night answer on in the button menu. During programming of the button, it can be configured to activate the default destination(s) or a variable destination. The variable destination can still be overwritten by
the access code. In either case, the LED on the key remains lit.
7-194
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for Incoming External Traffic
>
If there are several authorized stations, they must all activate Telephone Lock to ensure security.
Model-Specific Data
Subject
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
Feature available in
HW requirements
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
Requirement or Condition
Call forwarding
Night station
Lines
Variable night answer makes no distinction between the individual trunks; that is, calls on all trunks reach the night
station.
Configuration Options
This feature can be configured using Manager T or HiPath 3000 Manager E.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-195
Implementing Features
Features for Incoming External Traffic
Action
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7-196
Action
1.
2.
Incoming calls
3.
4.
5.
Classes of service
6.
Stations
7.
8.
9.
System parameters
10.
Diversion criteria
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for Incoming External Traffic
Action
1.
2.
3.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-197
Implementing Features
Features for Incoming External Traffic
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
HW requirements
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
7-198
Requirement or Condition
These stations cannot be reached from the outside by direct inward dialing.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for Incoming External Traffic
Configuration Options
This feature can be configured using Manager T or HiPath 3000 Manager E.
Configuring the Feature Using Manager T
Configure the feature using Manager T as follows:
Step
Action
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
Action
1.
2.
Set up station
3.
Stations
4.
5.
Lines/networking
6.
Routes
7.
8.
System parameters
9.
Diversion criteria
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-199
Implementing Features
Features for Incoming External Traffic
Action
1.
2.
3.
7-200
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for Incoming External Traffic
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-201
Implementing Features
Features for Incoming External Traffic
Model-Specific Data
Subject
Feature available in
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
HW requirements
SW requirements
Max. no. of MUSAP
keys per telephone
10
10
V1.0 or later
10
10
10
Requirement or Condition
MUSAP keys do not seize trunk groups directly. After you
press the key, you must dial the trunk group separately.
Configuration Options
This feature does not have to be explicitly configured.
The MUSAP key can be configured using Manager T or HiPath 3000 Manager E.
Configuring a MUSAP Key Using Manager T
Configure a MUSAP key using Manager T as follows:
Step
7-202
Action
1.
2.
3.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for Incoming External Traffic
Action
1.
Options
2.
Set up station
3.
Key programming
4.
Action
1.
2.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-203
Implementing Features
Features for Incoming External Traffic
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
HW requirements
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
Requirement or Condition
Not for S0 stations (not for U.S.).
Configuration Options
This feature can be configured using Manager T or HiPath 3000 Manager E.
Configuring the Feature Using Manager T
Configure the feature using Manager T as follows:
Step
7-204
Action
1.
2.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for Incoming External Traffic
Action
1.
2.
Set up station.
3.
Station
4.
5.
6.
7.
System parameters
8.
Tones/ring types
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-205
Implementing Features
Features for Incoming External Traffic
Associated services:
Advisory message on/off, group ringing on/off, telephone lock on/off, do not disturb on/off, call forwarding on/off, leave/join hunt group, reset services.
An internal station can also be reached via DISA. In the case of a fixed numbering
plan (such as in France), virtual networking is also possible.
The DISA access line can be configured as dedicated, or it can be accessed during
day or night operation; these parameters are set in the General Flags of Lines/Networking/Parameters tabs in HiPath 3000 Manager E; in the DISA day/night field, code
receiver (CR) parameters can be configured for each line.
One of the following options may be selected:
The DISA trunk is released at the completion of each function/feature. The user must
reenter the system if another function needs to be accomplished.
The stations authorized to access the system via DISA must first be configured in
System Administration. Refer to Configuring the Feature Using Manager T on page
7-207 or Configuring the Feature Using HiPath 3000 Manager E on page 7-208.
A DISA trunk can be a DID number or a LS/GS trunk. If the DISA trunk is a DID number, this number is programmed in System parameters. The field allows up to 12 digits. If the trunk is LS/GS, the trunk is programmed in the Ringing Assignments.
7-206
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for Incoming External Traffic
A password is required to log onto the system. This password consists of the internal
station call number and the Telephone Code lock PIN. Entry of the password is only
acknowledged after a timeout or entry of the end symbol #. This selection is systemwide and is done in the System Parameters.
Model-Specific Data
Subject
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
Feature available in
HW requirements
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
Requirement or Condition
Analog trunk
Night answer
Trunk
Configuration Options
This feature can be configured using Manager T or HiPath 3000 Manager E.
Configuring the Feature Using Manager T
Configure the feature using Manager T as follows:
Step
Action
1.
2.
3.
Configure DISA
4.
5.
6.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-207
Implementing Features
Features for Incoming External Traffic
Action
1.
2.
Set up station
3.
Station
4.
Parameter
5.
Flags
6.
Configure DISA
Options
7.
System parameters
8.
System settings
7-208
Action
1.
Configure DISA.
2.
3.
4.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for Incoming External Traffic
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-209
Implementing Features
Features for Incoming External Traffic
PC AC
Station
Hunt group
If an intercept position or AC is configured in the system, calls are routed to this intercept position during an intercept. If an intercept position has not been configured, intercepted calls are signaled at the station that has a call assignment for the intercepted trunk.
During intercepts, call management is entered using the intercept station as the basis. If the intercept position cannot be reached, the call is signaled at a night bell, if
entered, or the call waits in a queue at the intercept position.
Users can activate the intercept feature under the following conditions:
Intercept no answer
If there is no answer, the call follows the entries in call management. If the end of
the CM elements is reached, the system determines whether or not an intercept
after timeout should occur. If the system cannot find a station to which it can route
the call, the call is intercepted.
7-210
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for Incoming External Traffic
Codelock Diversion
If the telephone lock for a station is active, and a trunk group code is dialed from
that station, the call is immediately forwarded to the intercept destination. The
Codelock Diversion function is set individually for each station through the Flags
screen in the Set up Station Parameters.
One intercept position can be configured for Day operation. During Night Service, the
same destination or a different destination can be configured as the intercept position.
Model-Specific Data
Subject
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
Feature available in
HW requirements
SW requirements
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
V1.0 or later
7-211
Implementing Features
Features for Incoming External Traffic
Requirement or Condition
Hunt group
Release
Incomplete dialing
Tenant service
When a tenant service is configured, users can only configure intercepts on a cross-system basis. This means that
intercept no answer (for example) applies to all system users.
Configuration Options
This feature can be configured using Manager T or HiPath 3000 Manager E.
Configuring the Feature Using Manager T
Configure the feature using Manager T as follows:
Step
Action
1.
Configure intercept
2.
3.
4.
7-212
Action
1.
Configure intercept
Options
2.
System parameters
3.
Diversion criteria
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for Incoming External Traffic
Intercept no answer
Step
Action
1.
Seize the trunk and call any station in the system using DID.
2.
The called station is switched to the intercept position or the call forwarding station in accordance with the ring cycle.
Intercept busy
Step
Action
1.
2.
3.
The call is either signaled at the intercept position or forwarded as entered in CM.
Action
1.
Seize the trunk and use DID to dial any station in the system with an incomplete station number (for instance, omit the third digit in the DID
number).
2.
3.
Seize the trunk and dial a DID number that does not exist in the system.
4.
Action
1.
Seize the trunk and dial the system station number without a DID number.
2.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-213
Implementing Features
Features for Incoming External Traffic
7-214
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for Incoming External Traffic
Model-Specific Data
Subject
Feature available in
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
HW requirements
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
Requirement or Condition
DTMF DID
Intercept
Configuration Options
This feature can be configured using Manager T or HiPath 3000 Manager E.
Configuring the Feature Using Manager T
Configure the feature using Manager T as follows:
Step
Action
1.
2.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-215
Implementing Features
Features for Incoming External Traffic
Action
1.
2.
Trunks/networking
3.
4.
5.
7-216
Action
1.
2.
3.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for Incoming External Traffic
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
TIEL or
analog
port
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Analog port
SW requirements
No. of callers who can
hear an announcement simultaneously
V1.0 or later
32
32
32
32
32
7-217
Implementing Features
Features for Incoming External Traffic
Requirement or Condition
If the announcement port is entered as a call forwarding
no answer destination, the appropriate announcement is
played if the group or station is busy. The call is then forwarded to the next station or the programmed intercept criteria apply.
Configuration Options
This feature can be configured using Manager T or HiPath 3000 Manager E.
Configuring the Feature Using Manager T
Configure the feature using Manager T as follows:
Step
Action
1.
2.
3.
4.
Action
1.
2.
Connections
3.
Announcement equipment
7-218
Action
1.
2.
3.
Implementing Features
Features for Incoming External Traffic
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
HW requirements
Analog
trunk
(loop
start)
Analog
trunk
(loop
start)
SW requirements
V1.0
or later
V1.0
or later
Requirement or Condition
Collect call barring per Only available in Brazil. This setting is ignored in all other
trunk
countries.
Configuration Options
This feature can be configured using Manager T or HiPath 3000 Manager E.
Configuring the Feature Using Manager T
Configure the feature using Manager T as follows:
Step
Action
1.
2.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-219
Implementing Features
Features for Incoming External Traffic
7-220
Action
1.
2.
Lines/networking
3.
Parameters
4.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for Incoming External Traffic
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
TMAMF
TMAMF
(HiPath
3550 only)
SW requirements
V1.0 or
later
V1.2 or
later
Requirement or Condition
Collect call barring per Neither the system-wide parameters for collect call barring
trunk
nor the setting made for the stations affect trunk calls (analog trunks).
Collect call barring per Only for MFC R2 countries that offer this feature.
trunk
Configuration Options
This feature can be configured using Manager T or HiPath 3000 Manager E.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-221
Implementing Features
Features for Incoming External Traffic
Action
1.
2.
3.
4.
Action
1.
2.
Set up station
3.
4.
5.
7-222
Action
1.
2.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for Incoming External Traffic
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
TMAMF
TMAMF
(HiPath
3550 only)
SW requirements
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
V1.0 or
later
V1.2 or
later
7-223
Implementing Features
Features for Incoming External Traffic
Requirement or Condition
Nigeria = 06h
Oman = 07h
Syria = 09h
Tunisia = 0Ah
Caller ID
Caller ID
Configuration Options
This feature can be configured using Manager T or HiPath 3000 Manager E.
Configuring the Feature Using Manager T
Configure the feature using Manager T as follows:
Step
>
7-224
Action
1.
2.
3.
4.
If caller ID is active, remove the trunk group code so that it will not appear on the
screen.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for Incoming External Traffic
Action
1.
2.
Lines/networking
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
Action
1.
2.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-225
Implementing Features
Features for Incoming External Traffic
7.
7-226
The CAS center operator hits the CAS flash key after have talked to the customer and found out which extension number to transfer the call to.
The CAS center PBX transmits a hook switch flash over the RLT.
The branch PBX recognizes the hook switch flash and puts the DID trunk on
hold and gives dial tone back to the CAS operator.
The CAS center operator dials the destination extension number.
The branch PBX receives the extension number and starts to ring the phone.
At this point the CAS center operator can
stay on the call and wait for answer and do a supervised transfer, or
release the call and let the transfer finish as unsupervised transfer.
When the CAS operator releases the call the RLT drops, the branch PBX finishs
the transfer.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for Incoming External Traffic
8.
9.
Model-Specific Data
Subject
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
Feature available in
HW requirements
TMST1
TST1
SW requirements
V1.0
V1.0
Requirement or Condition
HiPath 3000 supports the CAS store PBX (branch) of the
application.
CAS center PBX (cen- Support for the CAS center PBX (center) of the application
ter)
is supplied by another type of PABX (e. g. Rolm 9005 or a
Lucent switch) that supports the center where the attendants are located in the application.
Configuration Options
This feature can be configured using HiPath 3000 Manager E.
Configuring the Feature Using HiPath 3000 Manager E
Configure the feature using HiPath 3000 Manager E as follows:
Step
Action
1.
2.
3.
4.
Card configuration
5.
T1 configuration: ports used for the TIE lines are set to trunks and ports
used for the RLTs are set to stations.
6.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-227
Implementing Features
Features for Incoming External Traffic
Step
Action
7.
8.
Station: Param column: double-click this field for the relevant station
(TMST1 / TST1) to display the "Parameter" mask.
Choose operating mode template 21_OPS_RLT_short.
9.
10.
Incoming calls
11.
Groups/hunt group
12.
Configure announcement
13.
14.
Announcement
7-228
Action
1.
2.
The incoming call will ring into the linear hunt group.
If the group is busy, the call is queued and an announcement is applied
to the caller. If one of the ports gets idle the call is applied.
3.
4.
Answer the call and press a trunk transfer key. Enter the call number for
the destination station at the HiPath 3000 system.
Supervised transfer or unsupervised transfer must be possible.
5.
The HiPath 3000 must receive, process and transfer the call to the destination.
6.
When the call is answered at the destination station, the T1 OPS DS0
channel and the associated T1 immediate Start RLT at the CAS center
PBX will be returned to an idle state. Control of the call will be returned
to the HiPath 3000 (CAS store PBX) as if the call was being transferred
and released by a local analog station.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for Outgoing External Traffic
Press the key three times to dial the number that was stored the longest.
On optiset E or optiPoint telephones without displays, the system stores only the last
number dialed.
For V1.2 or later, the system also uses the last number redial memory to store account codes ACCT that were entered. This is true only if the appropriate system-wide
flags are set.
Last Number Redial
This feature applies only to non-display optiset E or optiPoint models; however, it uses
the same feature key (Redial) as the Expanded Redial feature for display telephones.
Only external calls are saved. Every new outgoing call overwrites the previous number stored. This is also true if System or Station speed dial is used. When using LCR
access, only the number dialed by the station is stored in the LNR memory.
A call to a user in a networked system over a CorNet-N link is stored in LNR memory;
likewise, an external call routed via CorNet-N to a trunk in another node, is also
stored.
This feature cannot be invoked if Telephone Lock has been activated.
Each time users place and dial an external destination, the number is stored. If the
destination was busy or not reachable, users can press the redial key to redial the
same number.
This feature can only be invoked from the Redial key. No feature access code is possible.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-229
Implementing Features
Features for Outgoing External Traffic
Expanded Redial
This feature applies only to display optiset E or optiPoint; however, it uses the same
feature key (Redial) as the Last Number Redial feature for non-display telephones.
The system stores the last three external calls dialed by a display telephone. The expanded redial memory operates in a first-in-first-out (FIFO) manner; that is, the fourth
external call number placed from that telephone is placed at the top of the redial table,
and the oldest call is removed from memory, and so on.
Only external calls are saved. This is also true if System or Station speed dial is used.
A call to a user in a networked system over a CorNet-N link is stored; likewise, an external call routed via CorNet-N to a trunk in another node is also stored.
This feature cannot be invoked if Telephone Lock has been activated.
Any post-dialed digits beyond the initial destination, (for example, digits sent to a connected voice mail system) are not stored in expanded redial memory. In the case of
a call routed through LCR, only the number dialed by the station is stored.
This feature can only be invoked from the Redial key. No feature access code is possible.
To reach the last number dialed, the user presses the Redial key once, and after a
brief delay the number is dialed. Alternatively, the user can view the last three entries
by pressing the Redial key successively and selecting the number to be redialed.
Model-Specific Data
Subject
Feature available in
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
HW requirements
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
7-230
25 digits+code
3
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for Outgoing External Traffic
Requirement or Condition
LNR
LNR
Telephone lock
Internal calls
Telephones without
displays
Configuration Options
The last number redial feature does not have to be explicitly configured.
The redial with ACCT flag can be enabled using HiPath 3000 Manager E.
Configuring the Feature Using HiPath 3000 Manager E
Configure the feature using HiPath 3000 Manager E as follows:
Step
Action
1.
2.
System parameters
3.
Flags
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-231
Implementing Features
Features for Outgoing External Traffic
Action
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
Press the redial key. Press the redial key to step through the stored numbers (and the ACCT).
8.
The system dials the station number (ACCT) after a short waiting time.
7-232
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for Outgoing External Traffic
System Speed Dial feature is system-wide and cannot be split, for example in the
case of Tenant Service.
The default access code is *7 followed by the index number. The abbreviated
speed dial numbers are therefore:
System model
Abbreviated number
HiPath 3350
*7 000 to *7 299
HiPath 3550
*7 000 to *7 999
HiPath 3750
*7 000 to *7 999
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-233
Implementing Features
Features for Outgoing External Traffic
Model-Specific Data
Subject
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
Feature available in
HW requirements
300
300
SW requirements
Speed dialing entries
in the system
V1.0 or later
1000
1000
300
16
16
16
16
7-234
Requirement or Condition
Translation of station
numbers to names
Tenant service
Entrance telephone
Manager T
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for Outgoing External Traffic
Subject
Disallowed digits
Requirement or Condition
Manager T and HiPath 3000 Manager E both check the
first digit(s) of the speed dial number you are programming
against the default or current digits used in your database
for external access codes. For example: entering the
speed dial number 71 510 555 1212, may be disallowed if
the digits 7 or 71 or 715 are not CO access codes.
Configuration Options
This feature can be configured using Manager T or HiPath 3000 Manager E.
Configuring the Feature Using Manager T
Configure the feature using Manager T as follows:
Step
Action
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-235
Implementing Features
Features for Outgoing External Traffic
Action
1.
2.
System parameters
3.
4.
Enter the trunk group code, station number, and name for the desired
speed dialing destination.
7-236
Action
1.
2.
3.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for Outgoing External Traffic
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
Feature available in
HW requirements
300
300
SW requirements
Speed dialing entries
in system
Max. length of speed
dialing entry
V1.0 or later
1000
1000
300
Requirement or Condition
Translation of station
numbers to names
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-237
Implementing Features
Features for Outgoing External Traffic
Subject
Requirement or Condition
Tenant system
Entrance telephone
ITR groups
ITR groups
Configuration Options
This feature can be configured using Manager T or HiPath 3000 Manager E.
Configuring the Feature Using Manager T
Configure the feature using Manager T as follows:
Step
7-238
Action
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
10.
11.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for Outgoing External Traffic
Action
1.
2.
System parameters
3.
4.
Enter the trunk group code, station number, and name for the desired
speed dialing destination.
5.
Action
1.
2.
Access the speed dialing destination by entering a code (*7 + destination number) or using a key + destination number.
3.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-239
Implementing Features
Features for Outgoing External Traffic
7-240
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for Outgoing External Traffic
Model-Specific Data
Subject
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
Feature available in
HW requirements
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
Maximum number of
station speed dialing
entries per station
10
10
10
10
10
Maximum length of
station speed dialing
entry
25
digits +
code
25
digits +
code
25
digits +
code
25
digits +
code
25
digits +
code
Maximum number of
speed dialing entries
in the system
2000
2000
300
300
300
Requirement or Condition
Telephones without
display
Following station number entry, telephones without a display must wait for the confirmation tone.
Analog telephones
(with DP), S0 stations
optiset E or optiPoint
telephones
Repdial keys, station Station speed dialing destinations can be assigned until
speed dialing memory station speed dialing memory in the system is exhausted.
Speed dialing memory is used for both repdial keys and
station speed dialing destinations.
Rotary dial analog
telephones
Configuration Options
This feature does not have to be explicitly configured.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-241
Implementing Features
Features for Outgoing External Traffic
7-242
Action
1.
2.
3.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for Outgoing External Traffic
7.8.5 Trunk Seizure Type and Prime Line On (Automatic Line Seizure)
Definition
The HiPath 3000 systems permit trunk seizure via the trunk keys or call keys on an
optiset E or optiPoint telephone.
Trunk seizure is also possible from any telephone using the trunk or trunk group
codes. To seize the second trunk using a trunk or call key, Prime Line must be active
and a second trunk group assigned.
Trunk seizure via trunk group code is not possible by entering the trunk group code
and pressing the trunk group key.
When the system receives a seizure request, it searches for an available trunk in the
trunk group. If a trunk is available, it is seized.
Prime Line
The Prime Line feature is a system-wide feature that allows users to dial directly to
external destinations without the use of Trunk or Trunk Group keys. The external access code is automatically dialed by the system. Only one outgoing Trunk Group is
possible with this arrangement. To dial internal stations, the user must first press the
Internal key and dial the station number.
When this feature is NOT active in the system, the reverse operation is true; that is,
internal stations can be dialed directly, while outside connections require a Trunk,
Trunk Group key or an access code.
Model-Specific Data
Subject
Feature available in
HW requirements
SW requirements
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
Trunk board
V1.0 or later
Requirement or Condition
Trunks
COS changeover
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-243
Implementing Features
Features for Outgoing External Traffic
Subject
Requirement or Condition
Entrance telephone
Hold/park
Automatic line seizure optiset E entry and optiset E basic, and optiPoint 500 entry
(Prime Line on)
cannot use this feature.
Prime Line on (automatic line seizure)
With automatic line seizure, you can program trunks in different trunk groups. You cannot define an overflow from
trunk group 1 to another trunk group.
Configuration Options
This feature can be configured using Manager T or HiPath 3000 Manager E.
Configuring the Feature Using Manager T
Configure the feature using Manager T as follows:
Step
7-244
Action
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for Outgoing External Traffic
Action
1.
2.
Lines/networking
3.
Routing parameters
4.
5.
Lines/networking
6.
Trunks
7.
8.
Set up station
9.
Key programming
Action
1.
2.
Dial a number.
3.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-245
Implementing Features
Features for Outgoing External Traffic
Section 7.9, Least Cost Routing (LCR) (Not for U.S.), on page 7-284
Section 7.10, Least Cost Routing (for U.S. Only), on page 7-297
Model-Specific Data
Subject
Feature available in
HW requirements
SW requirements
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
V1.0 or later
7-246
Requirement or Condition
CorNet-N
QSig
USA, PRI
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for Outgoing External Traffic
Configuration Options
This feature can be configured using Manager T or HiPath 3000 Manager E.
Configuring the Feature Using Manager TT
Configure the feature using Manager T as follows:
Step
Action
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
Action
1.
2.
Automatic LCR
Action
1.
2.
3.
The trunk is seized when the timer has expired and outdialing is completed.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-247
Implementing Features
Features for Outgoing External Traffic
After dialing of administrable digits (for example, discriminating digit in the main
communications server, LCR)
Dial Tone Detection may not be appropriate, for example, in a Centrex environment,
where different tones (to indicate CO Call Forwarding activation, etc.) need to be
heard by the user. In such cases, the Trunk Supervision flag (Dial Tone Detection)
must be turned off. Then a trunk seizure delay can be programmed before dialing can
begin. If trunk supervision is activated, the system waits until a dial tone is detected,
even if No pause is selected in this field.
The Trunk Seizure delay choices are No Pause, 1, 3, 6 or 9 seconds.
If Trunk Supervision is activated, and dial tone is not detected (timer: Dial Tone Monitoring time, default 10 seconds), this line is taken out of operation if there is no dial
tone after seizure. Thereafter, the system checks at cyclical intervals whether a dial
tone is once again present. When it is, the line in question is put back into operation.
Dial tone monitoring time.
The Dial Tone Monitoring timer is only accessible via the Expert Level in HiPath 3000
Manager E. Contact your second-level service group if a change is required.
Model-Specific Data
Subject
Feature available in
7-248
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
HW requirements
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for Outgoing External Traffic
Requirement or Condition
Audible tone
Audible tone
Configuration Options
This feature can be configured using Manager T or HiPath 3000 Manager E.
Configuring the Feature Using Manager T
Configure the feature using Manager T as follows:
Step
Action
1.
2.
Action
1.
2.
Lines/network
3.
4.
Configure times
Options
5.
System parameters
6.
Time parameters (Dial tone monitoring time and Time between HT analysis and dialing).
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-249
Implementing Features
Features for Outgoing External Traffic
7-250
Action
1.
2.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for Outgoing External Traffic
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
Feature available in
HW requirements
Trunk connection
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
Requirement or Condition
The longer the time for end of dialing, the longer it takes for
the final digit to be transmitted on an analog trunk.
Configuration Options
This feature can be configured using HiPath 3000 Manager E.
Configuring the Feature Using HiPath 3000 Manager E
Configure the feature using HiPath 3000 Manager E as follows:
Step
Action
1.
2.
System parameters
3.
Time parameters
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-251
Implementing Features
Features for Outgoing External Traffic
7-252
Action
1.
2.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for Outgoing External Traffic
Pulses are analyzed in the case of DP, while tones are analyzed in the case of DTMF.
When the system uses analog trunk boards, the signaling method is automatically detected as long as the user has not configured a signaling method or pause before dial.
Otherwise, the signalling method can be set on a per trunk basis.
Model-Specific Data
Subject
Feature available in
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
HW requirements
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
Requirement or Condition
Signaling method
Configuration Options
This feature can be configured using Manager T or HiPath 3000 Manager E.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-253
Implementing Features
Features for Outgoing External Traffic
Action
1.
2.
Action
1.
2.
Lines/networking
3.
Trunks
4.
Flags
5.
LS/GS flags
7-254
Action
1.
2.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for Outgoing External Traffic
>
0 = no trunk access
2 to 7 = allowed lists
8 to 13 = denied lists
System configurations with CorNet-N and/or a fax server use class of service 7 for
these trunks and devices. In this case, you should not assign class of service 7 to a
subscriber with restricted access. Instead, use classes of service 0 to 6 and 8 to 14
for these subscribers.
The following list describes the classes of service in greater detail.
No trunk access
Users can make internal calls only. Users can use speed dialing destinations.
Cannot make calls via CorNet-N link.
Allowed lists
Allowed lists define the station numbers that the user is allowed to dial. If no numbers are entered in an allowed list, the station functions like a telephone with outward-restricted trunk access.
Denied lists
Denied lists define the station numbers that the user is not allowed to dial. If no
numbers are entered in a denied list, the station functions like a telephone with
unrestricted trunk access.
The Allowed numbers lists contain the digit sequences which may appear at the start
of a call number. The maximum length of the digit sequence is seven digits (0..9, *,#).
A maximum of 100 entries can be made in the allowed numbers list no. 1 and the lists
numbered 2-6 each contain a maximum of 50 entries.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-255
Implementing Features
Features for Outgoing External Traffic
The Barred numbers lists contain the digit sequences which cause a call number to
be rejected. The maximum length of the digit sequence is seven digits (0..9,*,#). A
maximum of 50 entries can be made in the barred numbers list no. 1 and the lists
numbered 2-6 each contain a maximum of 50 entries.
Model-Specific Data
Subject
Feature available in
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
HW requirements
Trunk connection
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
Number of classes of
service
15
15
15
15
15
Number of characters
in list entries
25
25
25
25
25
7-256
Subject
Requirement or Condition
Toll restriction
The toll restriction classes of service regulate which denied or allowed lists are used for the stations for each trunk
group. The classes of service apply to data and voice stations.
CS/CorNet-N/QSig
Implementing Features
Features for Outgoing External Traffic
Subject
Requirement or Condition
CorNet-N/QSig
When there is an external seizure of a station from the satellite CS (with COS 2-13) over the main CS, the main CSs
first denied list always does the seizing.
For this reason, keep the first denied line of the main CS
free for the assessment of the stations from the satellite
CS.
The system keeps COS 0, 1 and 14 of the satellite CS.
Telephone lock
Configuration Options
This feature can be configured using Manager T or HiPath 3000 Manager E.
Configuring the Feature Using Manager T
Configure the feature using Manager T as follows:
Step
Action
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-257
Implementing Features
Features for Outgoing External Traffic
Action
1.
2.
Classes of service
3.
Permitted/prohibited numbers
4.
5.
Classes of service
6.
Stations
7-258
Action
1.
2.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for Outgoing External Traffic
Can seize a trunk only in the incoming or only in the outgoing direction
The CON matrix permits or suppresses traffic between stations/lines within a subsystem and between subsystems. The CON matrix is configured system-wide.
The system default setting assigns all stations and trunks to ITR group 1. That is, all
stations are allowed to seize all trunks in the system. Which of the six groups can connect to which other groups is entered in the matrix.
Tenant Service call restrictions would be defined with the ITR (CON).
Related Topic
Section 7.8.10, Configurable Toll Restriction, on page 7-255
Model-Specific Data
Subject
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
Feature available in
HW requirements
SW requirements
No. of ITR groups
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
V1.0 or later
6
7-259
Implementing Features
Features for Outgoing External Traffic
Requirement or Condition
ITR group
MOH devices
MOH source
Configuration Options
This feature can be configured using Manager T or HiPath 3000 Manager E.
Configuring the Feature Using Manager T
Configure the feature using Manager T as follows:
Step
Action
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7-260
Action
1.
2.
Class of service
3.
ITR matrix
4.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for Outgoing External Traffic
Step
Action
5.
Class of service
6.
Action
1.
2.
From one station, attempt to call another station in a different ITR group.
3.
Stations with different ITR classes of service cannot make calls to each
other.
4.
Whether stations can make calls to one another depends on their class
of service in the ITR matrix.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-261
Implementing Features
Features for Outgoing External Traffic
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
Feature available in
HW requirements
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
Configuration Options
This feature can be configured using Manager T or HiPath 3000 Manager E.
Configuring the Feature Using Manager T
Configure the feature using Manager T as follows:
Step
7-262
Action
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for Outgoing External Traffic
Action
1.
2.
Class of service
3.
ITR matrix
4.
5.
Class of service
6.
Action
Only the station configured can seize the private trunk.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-263
Implementing Features
Features for Outgoing External Traffic
Trunk ReservationAutomatic
When this flag is activated and if a station is not assigned a free trunk after the usual
trunk seizure procedures (random or specific), Busy tone is signaled at the station.
After a fixed period (5 seconds), a positive acknowledgment tone is applied and the
trunk is reserved, provided that the station has the appropriate CO call privilege.
7-264
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for Outgoing External Traffic
Trunk ReservationManual
>
Trunk reservation is not possible in hands-free mode. In this case, the system interrupts call setup when it recognizes that the line is seized.
Model-Specific Data
Subject
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
Feature available in
HW requirements
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
Requirement or Condition
Queue trunk
Queue trunk
Recall
Speakerphone mode
Trunk
LCR
Configuration Options
This feature can be configured using Manager T or HiPath 3000 Manager E.
Configuring the Feature Using Manager T
Configure the feature using Manager T as follows:
Step
Action
1.
2.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-265
Implementing Features
Features for Outgoing External Traffic
Action
1.
2.
System parameters
3.
Flags
Action
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
Station B rings; user picks up the handset and hears a dial tone.
7-266
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for Outgoing External Traffic
>
The system-wide flag Call Number Suppression Override does not apply in the US.
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
Feature available in
HW requirements
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
Requirement or Condition
System-wide station
number display suppression
If station-wide station number display suppression is activated (CLIR and COLR), it cannot be overridden.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-267
Implementing Features
Features for Outgoing External Traffic
Subject
Requirement or Condition
CLIR
It is possible to ignore an activated CLIR setting and display the station number of the calling station. This feature
is helpful in various situations, as in of emergency calls.
Configuration Options
The feature Temporary station number display suppression does not need to be explicitly configured; however, system-wide flags need to be set.
Programming Feature Using Manager T
Configure the feature using Manager T as follows:
Step
Action
1.
2.
Action
1.
2.
System parameters
3.
7-268
Action
1.
2.
3.
4.
Implementing Features
Features for Outgoing External Traffic
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
Requirement or Condition
The class of service of the selected reference station applies.
Configuration Options
This feature can be configured using Manager T or HiPath 3000 Manager E.
Configuring the Feature Using Manager T
Configure the feature using Manager T as follows:
Step
Action
1.
2.
3.
4.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-269
Implementing Features
Features for Outgoing External Traffic
Action
1.
2.
Permitted/prohibited numbers
3.
4.
7-270
Action
1.
2.
The AC sends dial tone to the user via the Transfer trunk menu option.
3.
The user can set up a call within the allowed area by seizing a trunk (0).
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for Outgoing External Traffic
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
Requirement or Condition
Number of speed dial- You can configure up to six speed dialing groups (from
ing groups
KWZx to KWZy), including overlapping ones.
Configuration Options
This feature can be configured using Manager T or HiPath 3000 Manager E.
Configuring the Feature Using Manager T
Configure the feature using Manager T as follows:
Step
Action
1.
2.
3.
4.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-271
Implementing Features
Features for Outgoing External Traffic
Action
Classes of service/ITR group assignment/
Assign station to speed dialing group
7-272
Action
1.
2.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for Outgoing External Traffic
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
Configuration Options
This feature can be configured using Manager T or HiPath 3000 Manager E.
Configuring the Feature Using Manager T
Configure the feature using Manager T as follows:
Step
Action
1.
2.
Action
1.
2.
System parameters
3.
Intercept/AC
4.
Codelock intercept
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-273
Implementing Features
Features for Outgoing External Traffic
>
The actions carried out using keypad dialing are not subject to any system control.
HiPath 3000 cannot prevent improper use, such as call charges fraud or trunk blocking.
The customer must be informed that Siemens AG accepts no liability whatsoever for
damages resulting from the improper use of this feature!
Model-Specific Data
Subject
Feature available in
7-274
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
HW requirements
SW requirements
V1.2 or later
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for Outgoing External Traffic
Requirement or Condition
Telephone lock
ISDN telephones
Services
Configuration Options
This feature can be configured using Manager T or HiPath 3000 Manager E.
Configuring the Feature Using Manager T
Configure the feature using Manager T as follows:
Step
Action
1.
2.
3.
1.
2.
3.
Select station
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-275
Implementing Features
Features for Outgoing External Traffic
Action
1.
2.
Trunks/networking
3.
Routing parameters
4.
1.
2.
Set up station
3.
Station
4.
5.
7-276
Action
1.
2.
Select trunk.
3.
4.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for Outgoing External Traffic
7.8.19 E911 Emergency Call Service for the USA (for U.S. Only)
Notes on the relocate (hoteling) feature (see Section 7.13.11 on Page 7-385)
The following applies for systems on which E911 emergency service for U.S. is activated:
V3.0 SMR-8 or later: The use of the Relocate feature ensures that the LIN remains assigned to the physical connection port.
Up to and including V3.0 SMR-7: The use of the Relocate feature is not permitted if the system has more than one location identification number (LIN).
>
Definition
The E911 expanded emergency call service makes it possible to transmit information
about the physical location of a station in addition to the station number. Therefore
not only the number of the station placing the call is available in the emergency call
center, but the location too.
This requires that each subscriber line with a valid DID number be assigned a Location Identification Number LIN. The LIN is an unambiguous number that corresponds
to the 10-digit NANP (North American Numbering Plan). Subscriber lines that are
physically close to one another are given the same LIN. The emergency call center
has a database that contains all the LINs and that uses the transmitted LIN to identify
the name and address of the one placing the emergency call.
Danger
Quick help after an emergency call is possible only when valid information concerning the location of the caller who is in trouble is available. For this reason, the correct
assignment of the LINs to the available DID number must always be guaranteed.
If the customer assumes the system administration, then the customer also assumes the responsibility for the correct assignment of the LINs. In this case, the customer must be informed that Siemens AG accepts no liability whatsoever for damages resulting from the improper use of this feature.
V1.2 or later of HiPath 3000 supports this feature for analog (loop start protocol) and
digital trunks (Primary Rate Interface PRI).
Analog trunks require an additional converter (such as Telident STS) to translate the
transmitted DTMF characters (LS protocol) into the CAMA protocol used for the
Emergency Call Service ECS (see Figure 7-3).
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-277
Implementing Features
Features for Outgoing External Traffic
HiPath 3000
Public
telecommunication network
PRI
PRI
HiPath 3000
CorNet-N
CorNet-N
PRI
Analog
PRI
Public
exchange
Emergency
call center
Analog
Database with
Automatic Location
Identification ALI
Analog
Loop Start (HKZ)
Converter
CAMA
Station sends
emergency call
Figure 7-3
Model-Specific Data
Subject
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
HW requirements
SW requirements
Feature for digital
trunks available in
V1.2 or later
HW requirements
SW requirements
V1.2 or later
7-278
Requirement or Condition
for USA only
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for Outgoing External Traffic
Configuration Options
This feature can be configured using HiPath 3000 Manager E.
Configuring the Feature Using HiPath 3000 Manager E
Configure the feature using HiPath 3000 Manager E as follows:
Step
Action
1.
2.
Trunks/networking
3.
Trunks
4.
5.
Action
1.
After installing and configuring the feature, arrange a test call with the
emergency call center; this test call verifies that the call proceeds without errors.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-279
Implementing Features
Features for Outgoing External Traffic
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
HW requirements
trunk connection
SW requirements
Configuration Options
This feature does not have to be explicitly configured.
Testing the Feature
Check the feature for error-free functioning as follows:
Step
7-280
Action
1.
2.
3.
4.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for Outgoing External Traffic
use the routing parameter No. and type, outgoing to define whether the entered
System number - outgoing contains the station number without area code (subscriber), with area code (national), or also with the international country code (international).
You can also activate the flag Suppress station number for special customer applications. This prevents the system from sending out the DID number of the station
along with the Station number - outgoing.
Example: You want to prevent customers from directly reaching a service staff member who is reached centrally with a general service number. To conceal his or her own
DID number, enter the general service number as System number - outgoing and
activate the Suppress station number flag. Then called subscribers see only the
general service number on their display as the CLIP.
In a Centrex environment, you generally enter the number of the Centrex group as
System number - outgoing and deactivate the Suppress station number flag. The
called subscriber then sees the Centrex number plus station DID number as the CLIP.
If the entry under System number - outgoing is empty, the system automatically
sends the entries under System number - incoming.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-281
Implementing Features
Features for Outgoing External Traffic
Model-Specific Data
Subject
Feature available in
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
HW requirements
SW requirements
Requirement or Condition
You must configure the no screening option for the trunk
connection in the public exchange.
Configuration Options
This feature can be configured using Manager T or HiPath 3000 Manager E.
Configuring the Feature Using Manager T
Configure the feature using Manager T as follows:
Step
7-282
Action
1.
2.
3.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for Outgoing External Traffic
Action
1.
2.
Lines/networking
3.
Routes:
Enter system number - incoming
Enter system number - outgoing
Activate or deactivate suppress station number
4.
Routing parameters:
Select No. and type, outgoing
Action
1.
2.
3.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-283
Implementing Features
Least Cost Routing (LCR) (Not for U.S.)
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
Feature available in
HW requirements
15
15
SW requirements
Number of LCR classes of service
V1.0 or later
15
15
15
7-284
Requirement or Condition
LCR
LCR
LCR
LCR
Digits can be transmitted either singly or en-bloc, depending on the access method and the dial plan.
LCR
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Least Cost Routing (LCR) (Not for U.S.)
Subject
Requirement or Condition
LCR
The allowed and denied lists are also used for LCR. The
toll restriction check then refers to the digits dialed at the
station without considering the trunk group code.
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
Feature available in
HW requirements
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Requirement or Condition
Dialing is carried out in the D channel (with ISDN) or as
normal dialing (on analog trunks).
7-285
Implementing Features
Least Cost Routing (LCR) (Not for U.S.)
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
Feature available in
HW requirements
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
7-286
Requirement or Condition
With synchronization during timeout, you must program a
pause of 2 to 12 seconds.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Least Cost Routing (LCR) (Not for U.S.)
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
Feature available in
HW requirements
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
Requirement or Condition
Temporary or permanent station number suppression cannot be activated.
ISDN/SUB addressing The ISDN feature SUB must be applied for or released in
the public network.
Analog trunk
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-287
Implementing Features
Least Cost Routing (LCR) (Not for U.S.)
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
Feature available in
HW requirements
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
HW requirements
SW requirements
7-288
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
V1.0 or later
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Least Cost Routing (LCR) (Not for U.S.)
Outdial rule table: This table determines how the digits dialed by the user will
be converted and dialed by the system. The following special characters can be
defined:
A: Repeat remaining fields (transmit). This letter causes all subsequent digit
fields to be transmitted. The point of reference is the last field pointer before
A. The combination E1A is permitted only at the beginning of a string.
D (n): Dial digit sequence (1 to 25 digits). This letter can be inserted multiple
times and at any position in the string.
E (n): Repeat field from dial plan (from 1 to 10 times). This letter can be inserted multiple times and at any position in the string. E can also appear in
any order with relation to (n). A specific field can be addressed multiple
times, including in sequence. With the exception of E1, this letter can be surrounded by any parameter.
P (n): Pause (1 to 60 times the system-wide pause unit). This letter can be
inserted multiple times and at any position in the string.
M (n): Authorization code (1 to 16). This letter must not be in the final position.
S: Switch, changes signaling methods from DP to DTMF (with CONNECT,
PROGRESS or CALL PROC with PI). This letter can be inserted in the string
only once and may not be in the final position. The C parameter cannot be
used after S.
U: Use subaddress signaling method. This letter can be inserted in the string
only once and may not be in the final position. Subsequent characters are
again dialed in INFO. The S, P, and C parameters cannot be used after U.
C: Access code. This letter can be inserted in the string only once. The subsequent characters are transmitted without a dial pause and are used for single stage, two-stage, DICS (not for U.S.), BRI, and PRI carrier access.
Authorization code: The authorization code is divided into the carrier ID and
customer ID. The carrier ID is entered as one entry in the authorization code table
and the customer ID is entered as another entry in the authorization code table.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-289
Implementing Features
Least Cost Routing (LCR) (Not for U.S.)
The authorization code entry in the outdial rule then consists of the two authorization codes. Only a protected authorization code is supported (represented by
*****).
Schedule: Up to eight time zones per day can be configured for each day of the
week to control LCR. A search is performed based on the schedule ID entered in
the path table to determine whether the current time matches the value entered
in the schedule. If it does and if the correct class of service is present, dialing is
performed as per the outdial rule entered in the path table.
Path table: Up to 254 path tables with 16 paths each can be created. Each path
in a path table is described by a combination of the trunk group, outdial rule, toll
restriction, schedule, and an option for warning against a more expensive route.
The table is scanned from top to bottom. The system checks to determine whether the trunk group is free and the station has the requisite class of service. If so,
the system dials per the outdial rule and schedule entered in the path table.
Depending on the entry in the path table, a warning can be issued to the station
informing the user that the call is being routed. This warning can be signaled by
a warning tone and a display message. The display shows the outdial rule name.
Dial plan: Each station number dialed for external traffic is checked against the
dial plan for up to 30 positions (including field separator and trunk group code).
If the number dialed matches an entry in the dial plan, LCR is handled in accordance with the path table in the dial plan.
To use all available features (such as callback) in conjunction with LCR, the trunk
group code must be separated from the dialed station number by a dash () in
the dial plan (sample dial plan entry: 0CZ).
>
The first entry in a dial plan does not have to be a trunk group code; it can also be
a station number in a networked system.
The following station number entries are valid:
0...9: Permissible digits
-: Field separator
X: Any digit from 0 to 9
N: Any digit from 2 to 9
Z: One or more digits to follow up to the end of dialing
C: Simulated dial tone (can be entered up to three times)
7-290
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Least Cost Routing (LCR) (Not for U.S.)
To block outgoing external calls, enter a dash () in the Routing table field of the
dial plan.
Example:
Dialed Digits
(Code + Station Number)
Path
Table
Explanation
9C1-900-XXX-XXX
9C1-976-123-3456
Do not confuse the hyphen () in the Dialed digits field, which separates the digit
blocks in the number, with the dash in the Path table field, which blocks the numbers.
Digit analysis
Dial plan
Dialed digits
1
Path
table
3 - 1728134 - Z
Path table
2
...
514
Trunk
Outdial rule
group
(name)
Bndel
Wahlregel
TG 1
MCL(Name)
...
Requisite
SchedWarning 254
class of serv. ule
bentigte
Zeitplan Warnung
10 Berechtigung
A
None
TG 1Rtg.
1 1 BT MCL
15 10
Rtg. 1
BT
15
A
A
Tonekeine
Ton
Dialing
(if trunk group is free and the
class of service and schedule are appropriate)
Name
Outdial rule
Type
BT
Primary carrier
MCL Easy
D132A
MCL
D131P6SM1A
Telliance 1
D904711UM2A
DICS
Telliance 2
D904811UM2A
DICS
Telekom
Primary carrier
SCN
D900A
CN
...
50
Figure 7-4
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-291
Implementing Features
Least Cost Routing (LCR) (Not for U.S.)
The dialed call number is used as the criterion for the connection path to be used.
The system can evaluate up to 24 digits of the digit sequence plus up to 9 field separators. The digit sequence that can be dialed can consist of up to 32 digits. The evaluation can be carried out both destination dependently and time dependently and in
dependence on the station's LCR class of service (COS).
The system contains 254 route tables with 16 routes each. The LCR class-of-service
is evaluated hierarchically for LCR.
The outdial rule is described in the HiPath 3000 Manager E by its name, which consists of not more than 16 characters, and in the System Administration by its index.
The station can cancel automatic selection by seizing a line directly (Carrier Select
Override - CSO). The LCR class-of-service cannot be transferred between CorNet-N
networked systems.
General Operating Principle
The system analyzes the number dialed to determine if the digits input are valid. If the
digits are recognized, a reference route table is scanned for Route group choices.
Once the Route group is selected, the availability of the route is checked against the
time schedule. If the Route group is available, the LCR COS requirement assigned to
the route group is compared to the LCR COS associated with the dialing device. If the
LCR COS associated with the dialing station is equal to or greater than the route
group COS, the Toll Restriction tables are checked for additional screening information. This process is repeated for every call using the system LCR application.
7-292
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Least Cost Routing (LCR) (Not for U.S.)
Are there any toll restriction tables that prevent you from dialing
the number on the selected route group?
Call is processed
Figure 7-5
Expensive
warning tone?
When LCR is activated, the check is performed for every trunk seizure (except
when dialing a trunk code).
If all the least expensive connection paths have been seized, LCR automatically
switches to defined more expensive paths. The user can be signaled of this fact
both visually and acoustically.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-293
Implementing Features
Least Cost Routing (LCR) (Not for U.S.)
In the case of outgoing calls on the ISDN network, the dialed number continues
to be displayed until the destination number information on the other party is received.
Digits can be transmitted either per digit or en-bloc, depending on the access
method and the dial plan.
The allowed and denied lists are also used for LCR. The toll restriction check
then refers to the digits dialed on the station without the trunk group code.
Model-Specific Data
Subject
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
Feature available in
HW requirements
SW requirements
7-294
V1.0 or later
254
254
254
254
254
16
16
16
16
16
254
254
254
254
254
Number of characters
per outdial rule
40
40
40
40
40
514
514
514
514
514
32
32
32
32
32
25
25
25
25
25
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Least Cost Routing (LCR) (Not for U.S.)
Requirement or Condition
LCR
Networking
If primary carrier is entered as a type in the outdial rule, rerouting is not done in the path tables.
If routing should be carried out when the trunk is busy or
when S0 lines are disrupted, the type should be set to Single Stage.
Configuration Options
This feature can be configured using Manager T or HiPath 3000 Manager E.
Configuring the Feature Using Manager T
Configure the feature using Manager T as follows:
Step
Action
1.
Configure LCR
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-295
Implementing Features
Least Cost Routing (LCR) (Not for U.S.)
Action
1.
Configure LCR
Options
2.
7-296
Action
1.
Configure LCR.
2.
3.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Least Cost Routing (for U.S. Only)
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-297
Implementing Features
Least Cost Routing (for U.S. Only)
Are there any toll restriction tables that prevent you from dialing
the number on the selected route group?
Call is processed
Figure 7-6
7-298
Expensive
warning tone?
When LCR is activated, the check is performed for every trunk seizure (except
when dialing a trunk code).
If all the least expensive connection paths have been seized, LCR automatically
switches to defined more expensive paths. The user can be signaled of this fact
both visually and acoustically.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Least Cost Routing (for U.S. Only)
In the case of outgoing calls on the ISDN network, the dialed number continues
to be displayed until the destination number information on the other party is received.
Digits can be transmitted either per digit or en-bloc, depending on the access
method and the dial plan.
The allowed and denied lists are also used for LCR. The toll restriction check
then refers to the digits dialed on the station without the trunk group code.
AT&T
MCI
Sprint
Westinghouse
Connections to the local exchange carrier (LEC) are toll-free. Connections to the inter-exchange carrier (IEC) are handled by the carriers listed above. The LEC has a
default IEC that it uses for long distance calls unless the user selects another carrier.
To select another carrier, the user must first dial the IECs Carrier Access Code (CAC)
and Carrier Identification Code (CIC).
There are two different types of CIC numbering schemes: one for a 3-digit CIC and
another for a 4-digit CIC. The four-digit code consists of the three-digit code preceded
by the number 0. For example, the CIC for MCI is 222 or 0222.
The CAC for a three-digit CIC is 10, and the CAC for a four-digit CIC is 101.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-299
Implementing Features
Least Cost Routing (for U.S. Only)
7-300
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Least Cost Routing (for U.S. Only)
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-301
Implementing Features
Least Cost Routing (for U.S. Only)
7-302
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Least Cost Routing (for U.S. Only)
System speed dialing call numbers must be prefixed with the LCR access codes
for proper operation.
Station redial will insert the access code used for the original call.
Repertory dial keys to external destinations must have the LCR access code for
proper operation.
General call keys will be activated when the route is selected by the system.
Call keys will be activated when the route is selected by the system.
MUSAP keys may be used for external calling using the LCR access code.
Basic rate ISDN trunks may be accessed by stations assigned CACH values or
PDID values.
Verified forced account codes may be requested before a selected route group is
accessed.
DTMF or rotary pulse dialing may be selected based on the outdial rule
If speed dialing numbers are used without first selecting the network, the default
network is used (carrier-select override).
When LCR is activated, no digit repetition is performed; the routing tables are followed instead.
Message waiting and automatic callback follow the rules for LCR.
An account code entered by the user is valid for the whole connection, even if
more than one route over different trunk groups was tried during connection setup.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-303
Implementing Features
Least Cost Routing (for U.S. Only)
In the case of connections via other network providers or carriers, the provider or
carrier may not transmit the actual connection costs, i.e., it may send the HiPath
3000 only the charges to the dial-in node (such as a dial-in control server [Europe
only]).
Field 1
9
Field 2
Field 3
492
2000
408
6265932
1
Reset boards
and port assignments stored in
the system.
Field 4
492
Field 5
2000
7-304
0...9
Allowed digits
Implementing Features
Least Cost Routing (for U.S. Only)
>
Notes: The character # within a dial string means end of dialing or signaling method
changeover. For this reason, * and # are not valid entries. Outdial rules may be used
to insert the * and # in the dial string to the public network.
Do not confuse the dash (-) symbol in the destination field, which functions as a field
separator, with the dash in the Route Table field, which functions as a call blocker
(refer to Table 7-3).
If Prime Line is used, no LCR is possible.
For the LCR dial plan to accurately select the route group, the dial-plan entries must
be entered as follows.
Entries should be placed in ascending numeric order from 0 to 9. Specific dialed numbers must precede wildcard entries to prevent conflicts in matches with wildcard entries. Table 7-3 is an example of the suggested entry order.
Table 7-3
Entry No.
Dialed Digits
(code + station no.)
Route Table
9C0Z
9C011Z
9C492-5001
9CNXX-XXXX
9C1-NXX-XXX-XXXX
9C1-900-XXX-XXX
-1
9C1-976-123-3456
-2
...
254
1 In this example, the dash (-) blocks all 900 numbers from being dialed.
2 In this example, the dash (-) blocks only the specific number (976-123-3456)
from being dialed.
The fields formed by the field separators and C in the dial plan can be addressed
selectively to repeat, suppress, exchange, or insert digits.
7.10.13.1 Rules for Creating LCR Dial Plan Entries
The first field should contain only a programmed trunk group access code. It must
not contain any wildcards.
The wildcards N and X can occur more than once in any field except the first field.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-305
Implementing Features
Least Cost Routing (for U.S. Only)
The wildcard Z can occur only in the last field. It represents an undetermined
number of suffix digits.
Route group
Outdial rule
Trunk access
Paths
The system contains 254 path tables, each with 16 paths. LCR evaluates the trunk
access in hierarchical order.
Search Order
The system searches the path table from top to bottom. If the located path is busy, or
if the station does not have the proper class of service, the system continues to the
next path.
Outdial Rule
The outdial rule is described in HiPath 3000 Manager E by its name, which can be up
to 16 characters long, and by its index in system administration.
7-306
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Least Cost Routing (for U.S. Only)
Carrier-Select Override
Users can deactivate automatic selection within the path by selecting a specific carrier (carrier-select override, CSO). For CSO to work, the requested carrier must be
located in the dial plan and the path table assigned by the dial plan, and the user must
have the required trunk access.
The way the digits entered by the user are converted and dialed by the system
The maximum amount of time the LCR function has to control dialing
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-307
Implementing Features
Least Cost Routing (for U.S. Only)
Table 7-4
Number
Name
Outdial Rule
A
Type
Dial All
Corporate network
D4DA
...
254
The outdial rules provide access to different carriers via digit translation. The outdial
rules address the dial plan fields selectively for the following operations:
Repeating digits
Suppressing digits
Exchanging digits
Inserting digits
Inserting pauses
7-308
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Least Cost Routing (for U.S. Only)
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-309
Implementing Features
Least Cost Routing (for U.S. Only)
53276543
7.10.17 Operation
The system does not seize a trunk until it has completed the routing tables. To inform
the user that the telephone is ready for dialing, you can insert a dial tone into the LCR
dial plan using the letter C. The dialed digits are buffered until the system completes
the routing tables. Only then is a connection set up.
The route table (1 to 254) is first determined via the dial plan on the basis of the dialed
destination number. If the destination number is not found in the dial plan, the user
receives a busy signal.
The route table for each route element describes the following:
The out-dial rule determines the outgoing dialing procedure for the selected trunk
group. Selection may be unsuccessful for one of the following reasons:
Time-of-day restriction
In this case, another carrier can be selected via the alternative paths. You can configure an expensive-path warning tone to sound when an expensive carrier is selected.
7-310
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Least Cost Routing (for U.S. Only)
The destination number that the user dialed is generally displayed until the requested
party answers (ALERT or CONNECT). Then the destination number reached is displayed if available. The dialed destination number is stored in the station's redial
memory.
Figure 7-7 shows a sample LCR flow diagram.
Digit analysis
Dial plan
Dialed digits
(code + stn. no.)
1
9 - 5551222 - Z
Route
table
Route table
2
...
514
Trunk
Outdial rule
group
(name)
Trunk
Outdial rule
(name)
TG 1group Sprint
1 ...
Requisite
SchedWarning 254
class of serv. ule
Requisite
SchedWarning
10 class of serv.A ule
None
TG 1TG
MCL
1 1 PacBell
15 10
TG 1
BT
15
ToneNone
Tone
Dialing
(if trunk group is free and the
class of service and schedule are appropriate)
Name
Outdial rule
Type
PacBell
Main Provider
MCI
D222A
PRI
Sprint
D333P6SM1A
2-layer mode
AT&T
D288A
PRI
Siemens
D10231UM2A
CN
AT&T
Primary carrier
SCN
D900A
CN
...
50
Figure 7-7
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-311
Implementing Features
Features for Internal Traffic
>
Without Prime Line, outside connections require a Trunk, Trunk group key, or an access code.
Model-Specific Data
Subject
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
Feature available in
HW requirements
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
7-312
Requirement or Condition
Extension key
Implementing Features
Features for Internal Traffic
Configuration Options
This feature does not need to be explicitly configured; however, Prime Line can be
configured using Manager T and HiPath 3000 Manager E.
Programming Feature Using Manager T
Configure the feature using Manager T as follows:
Step
Action
1.
2.
Action
1.
2.
System Parameters
3.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-313
Implementing Features
Features for Internal Traffic
HW requirements
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
7-314
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for Internal Traffic
Subject
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
100
100
30
16
16
16
16
16
16
50
Model-Specific Data for optiPoint Busy Lamp Field BLF (optiPoint BLF)
Subject
Feature available in
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
HW requirements
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
12
90
90
Number of optiPoint
telephones with optiPoint BLF
Requirement or Condition
DSS
Pick up
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-315
Implementing Features
Features for Internal Traffic
Configuration Options
This feature can be configured using Manager T or HiPath 3000 Manager E.
Configuring the Feature Using Manager T
Configure the feature using Manager T as follows:
Step
Action
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
Confirm entry.
Action
1.
2.
Set up station
3.
Key programming
7-316
Action
Press the DSS key. The programmed extension rings.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for Internal Traffic
7.11.3 Names
Definition
Users can assign names to each station, to each station group, and to each trunk
group. These names are displayed for internal calls (including calls via CorNet-N). If
an incoming call does not contain station number information (analog trunk), the trunk
group name is displayed. If the incoming call contains station number information (ISDN), this information is displayed. Refer to Section 7.6.7, Translate Station Numbers
to Names for System Speed Dialing, on page 7-186 for more information.
A memory telephone is required as Manager T to enter characters of the alphabet.
Characters which can be used: all letters found on the memory telephone keyboard,
digits 0-9, * , #.
If no name has been assigned to an internal station, the number is displayed instead.
Model-Specific Data
Subject
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
Feature available in
HW requirements
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
Maximum number of
letters in station and
group names
16
16
16
16
16
Maximum number of
letters in trunk group
names
10
10
10
10
10
Configuration Options
This feature can be configured using Manager T or HiPath 3000 Manager E.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-317
Implementing Features
Features for Internal Traffic
Action
1.
2.
3.
4.
Enter name.
5.
6.
7.
8.
Enter name.
9.
10.
11.
12.
Enter name.
7-318
Action
1.
2.
Set up station
3.
Station
4.
5.
6.
Incoming calls
7.
Hunt group
8.
9.
10.
Lines/networking
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for Internal Traffic
Step
Action
11.
Trunk groups
12.
Action
1.
2.
3.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-319
Implementing Features
Features for Internal Traffic
the system deletes daily at 11:57 p.m. all callbacks that were initiated towards
other CorNet-N nodes
Callback requests can be set on internal stations and groups, but not to groups located in other CorNet-N nodes.
Callback Requests Set on a Group
A request set on a hunt group is set on the first member of the group.
A request set on a Group Call is set on the first member of the group.
Model-Specific Data
Subject
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
Feature available in
HW requirements
SW requirements
Callbacks per station
7-320
V1.0 or later
5
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for Internal Traffic
Requirement or Condition
Callback
Callback
Every night at 11:57 p.m., all callbacks that are not within
the system (CorNet) are deleted.
Callback
A callback can be set to an internal group (not DSS1, CorNet-N, or QSig [not for U.S.). The callback is stored with
the first station in the group.
Configuration Options
This feature does not have to be explicitly configured.
Operating the Feature
Refer to the Operating Instructions for HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0 for information on operating the feature.
For a list of additional documentation, refer to Table 1-1, List of Available Documentation for HiPath 3000
Display Telephones
The called station does not answer or is busy. The user selects the prompt Callback?. The called station stops ringing, and the display confirms the request with
Will call back.
The next time the called party uses the telephone, the system calls the initiator
back with a special three-ring call. The display informs the initiator Callback:
name of party. The initiator then goes off hook, and the called party rings again.
If the called party answers, the Callback request is deleted. If not, the Callback
request remains active and a Callback is initiated the next time the called party
uses the telephone.
Deleting Callback requests: From an idle state, the initiator dials the default access code #58, or presses Program/Service, scrolls to More Features and scrolls
to and selects #58=View callbacks?. The initiator can then select either of the two
messages Sent and Delete.
Non-Display Telephone
The called station does not answer or is busy. The initiator presses the Consultation key (or performs a switch hook flash in the case of an analog telephone)
and dials the default access code *58. Confirmation tone (three short bursts of
tone) is heard.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-321
Implementing Features
Features for Internal Traffic
The next time the called party uses the telephone, the system calls the initiator
back with a special three-ring call. The initiator then goes off hook, and the called
party rings.
If the called party answers, the Callback request is deleted. If not, the Callback
request remains active and a Callback is initiated the next time the called party
uses the telephone.
Deleting Callback requests: From an idle state, the initiator dials the default access code #58. Because requests may be active for many hours and there is no
way to display to the user to whom the requests were made, the system deletes
all callbacks invoked from the station.
7-322
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for Internal Traffic
Opener: In this configuration, the door opener is set up via an analog interface;
the entrance telephone must be connected via an adapter.
DTMF: This setting specifies whether the door opener is activated by a DTMF
transmitter.
Call forwarding: This specifies determines whether the call from the entrance
telephone is forwarded to an external call forwarding destination.
Model-Specific Data
Subject
Feature available in
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
HW requirements
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
Requirement or Condition
Entrance telephone
ring destination
If a call is already indicating camp-on at the entrance telephone ring destination, an intercept is performed. If the intercept station is also busy, the system searches all optiset
E and optiPoint telephones.
Night answer
Door busy and messenger call are possible using the optiset E control adapter.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-323
Implementing Features
Features for Internal Traffic
Configuration Options
This feature can be configured using Manager T or HiPath 3000 Manager E.
Configuring the Feature Using Manager T
Configure the feature using Manager T as follows:
Step
Action
1.
Before setting up an entrance telephone, you should first delete all features for this station.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
Action
1.
Before configuring an entrance telephone, you should first delete all features for this station.
2.
3.
Set up station
4.
Ext. connection
5.
Door relay
7-324
Action
1.
2.
3.
You can activate the door opener from the ring destination if configured.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for Internal Traffic
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-325
Implementing Features
Features for Internal Traffic
7-326
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for Internal Traffic
Internal Paging
The operation is similar to the feature Speaker Call except that the caller dials *80 followed by a Call Group number. After the hearing the tone, the user can make an announcement.
Stations in a group which are busy or in DND, do not receive the internal paging. Calls
placed to a group while an internal page is in progress, hear only busy, and only camp
on to after the paging has been terminated. Calls placed to a telephone which has
been called via Speaker Call, only hear busy and are not allowed to camp on to until
the Mic. Mute function has been disabled.
Internal Paging and Speaker calls are forwarded if the destination or member of the
paging group is forwarded.
Model-Specific Data
Subject
Feature available in
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
HW requirements
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
Requirement or Condition
Handsfree answerback
When you dial *96, the microphone is automatically activated for each speaker call. You can deactivate this function by dialing #96.
You cannot use this feature with stations that have activated DND.
Toggle, consultation
hold, transfer
Configuration Options
This feature does not have to be explicitly configured.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-327
Implementing Features
Features for Internal Traffic
Action
1.
2.
The destination station receives an alerting tone and the speaker is activated.
7-328
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for Internal Traffic
The user places a consultation call and begins the group announcement.
The system sets up a two-party call when another party lifts the handset or turns
on the speaker, and the party who answered the call hangs up. The remaining
group members are removed from the call.
Speaker calls and internal paging are available on internal optiset E or optiPoint telephones with speakers. You can use a key or code to activate the feature, and you can
program the speaker call capability separately for each extension.
Model-Specific Data
Subject
Feature available in
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
HW requirements
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
Requirement or Condition
Handsfree answerback
When you dial *96, the microphone is automatically activated for each speaker call. You can deactivate this function by dialing #96.
Do not disturb
You cannot use this feature with stations that have activated DND. However, an authorized caller can override do not
disturb, in which case a busy signal sounds for five seconds. The user then receives a call (not a speaker call).
Toggle, consultation
hold, transfer
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-329
Implementing Features
Features for Internal Traffic
Configuration Options
This feature does not have to be explicitly configured.
Testing the Feature
Check the feature for proper functioning as follows:
7-330
Step
Action
1.
Dial a station by entering code *80 or pressing a speaker phone key and
entering the internal destination number (the destination must be an optiset E or optiPoint telephone with speaker or a speaker group).
2.
The destination user hears an alerting tone and the speaker is activated.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for Internal Traffic
Enhanced radio paging equipment (HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 only with
TMOM)
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
HW requirements
Analog ports
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Requirement or Condition
Does not support expanded call processing characteristics
such as those available with enhanced radio paging equipment.
7-331
Implementing Features
Features for Internal Traffic
Configuration Options
This feature can be configured using Manager T or HiPath 3000 Manager E.
Configuring the Feature Using Manager T
Configure the feature using Manager T as follows:
Step
Action
1.
2.
3.
Action
1.
2.
Connections
3.
External connections
7-332
Action
1.
2.
3.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for Internal Traffic
7.11.8.2 Radio Paging Equipment via ESPA/Enhanced Radio Paging Equipment (Not for
U.S.)
Definition
Enhanced radio paging equipment also includes certain communications server functions. It offers the following options:
Selectable displays and ring and paging procedures (selected when entering the
paging request)
Model-Specific Data
Subject
Feature available in
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
HW requirements
TMOM
SW requirements
V1.0
or later
Dependencies/Limitations
Subject
Voice call
Dependency/Limitation
Voice calls are not possible.
Configuration options
This feature can be configured using Manager T or HiPath 3000 Manager E.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-333
Implementing Features
Features for Internal Traffic
Action
1.
2.
3.
Action
1.
2.
Trunk modules
3.
Ext. connection
7-334
Action
1.
2.
3.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for Internal Traffic
Sending a message
Internal extensions can select a text message from an internal system message
list and send the message to any internal optiset E or optiPoint telephone with
display. Users can transmit these messages in the idle, ringing, or busy state, or
during a call. (During a call, the station number information is omitted.) A station
that can be reached via a CorNet-N tie trunk is also considered to be an internal
station. The initiating party can also be an analog voice mail system or central
voice mail server in the CorNet-N network. A separate, fixed text is available for
messages from these devices.
Receiving a message
The system indicates the presence of a message depending on the type of telephone. The following applies to the default setting:
On optiset E or optiPoint telephones with display, a waiting message is signaled via the display and a Mailbox key, if programmed. In addition, there is
acoustic signaling using a special dial tone.
(Not for U.S.) On special analog telephones with a mailbox LED, a waiting
message is signaled via the LED (not a key). These extensions must be configured accordingly. An audible signal also sounds, like on analog telephones. To signal messages with the mailbox LED, set the PSUI ring voltage
(HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700) to 75 V.
You can use HiPath 3000 Manager E to adjust the optic and acoustic signaling in
the following way:
If the flag Status display for info message is not set, the status display Display
infos is not visible until you scroll in the system menu.
Use the Plus Products flag Acoustic message signaling to set whether the signaling on optiset E or optiPoint telephones and other telephones should use the
special dial tone or an announcement (only for HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700) or
if no signaling should be done.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-335
Implementing Features
Features for Internal Traffic
Callback
On telephones with display, a caller can retrieve information such as the senders
name and number, text message, date, and time using a dialog menu. The user
can then call back the sender of the message without entering a station number.
To activate callback on analog telephones, users must use a procedure code; on
optiset E or optiPoint telephones without a display, users can press a Mailbox key.
Deleting a message
The sender and receiver can use a dialog menu or a procedure code to delete
the message. Otherwise, the message is deleted only if it results in a call to the
station.
This feature can be activated/deactivated via a DISA connection, by its own station
user.
Model-Specific Data
Subject
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
Feature available in
HW requirements
30
30
SW requirements
Maximum number of
simultaneous texts
7-336
V1.0 or later
100
100
30
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for Internal Traffic
Subject
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
Maximum number of
characters in text
24
24
24
24
24
10
10
10
10
10
Requirement or Condition
Message texts
Message texts
Voice mail
France
Configuration Options
This feature can be configured using Manager T or HiPath 3000 Manager E.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-337
Implementing Features
Features for Internal Traffic
Action
1.
2.
3.
Action
1.
2.
System parameters
3.
Texts
4.
Info texts
7-338
Action
1.
2.
3.
Select the desired text (0-9), or enter a text if using an optiset E memory
telephone).
4.
5.
Enter the code (#68-0) or press the key to delete the message.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for Internal Traffic
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-339
Implementing Features
Features for Internal Traffic
7-340
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
HW requirements
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
Number of advisory
messages in system
10
10
10
10
10
Max. no of characters
in advisory message
24
24
24
24
24
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for Internal Traffic
Requirement or Condition
With call forwarding, the telephone displays the advisory
message of the called station.
Configuration Options
This feature does not have to be explicitly configured.
Configuring the Feature Using Manager T
Users can change the advisory messages using Manager T and an optiset E memory
telephone):
Step
Action
1.
2.
3.
Action
1.
2.
System parameters
3.
Texts
4.
Advisory message
Action
1.
2.
Call the station from another optiset E or optiPoint telephone with display.
3.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-341
Implementing Features
Features for Internal Traffic
7-342
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for Internal Traffic
Dial and Enter (Return) key: dials the number beside the cursor.
HiPath 3000 Manager E allows you to define whether a station number will appear in
the directory for each station individually.
Model-Specific Data
Subject
Feature available in
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
HW requirements
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-343
Implementing Features
Features for Internal Traffic
Requirement or Condition
Electronic directory
Electronic notebook
(ENB)
Directory
Configuration Options
This feature can be configured using Manager T or HiPath 3000 Manager E.
Configuring the Feature Using Manager T
Configure the feature using Manager T as follows:
Step
7-344
Action
1.
Configure directory
2.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for Internal Traffic
Action
1.
Configure directory
Options
2.
System parameters
3.
System flags
Action
1.
On an optiset E or optiPoint telephone with display, lift the handset. Directory? appears on the display.
2.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-345
Implementing Features
Features for Internal Traffic
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
Feature available in
HW requirements
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
7-346
Requirement or Condition
To monitor a room, telephones without a microphone must
have the handset off-hook (exception: optiset E and optiPoint telephones with speakerphone function).
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for Internal Traffic
Subject
Requirement or Condition
Hunt group
Analog trunks
Room monitor
If an optiset E or optiPoint telephone calls a station activated as a room monitor, the speakerphone function on the
calling telephone is deactivated in the standard configuration.
Configuration Options
This feature can be configured using HiPath 3000 Manager E.
Configuring the Feature Using HiPath 3000 Manager E
Configure the feature using HiPath 3000 Manager E as follows:
Step
Action
1.
2.
System parameters
3.
Flags
4.
Action
1.
2.
Activate the room monitor feature by dialing *88 or pressing the Room
Monitor key.
3.
Call this extension from another internal station. The call is immediately
through-connected. All sounds in the room are transmitted.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-347
Implementing Features
Features for Internal Traffic
Monitored system
Going off-hook, dial the default access code *88 or press the Program/Service
key and scroll to and select the prompt *88=Room monitor?. Leave the telephone
off-hook or in speakerphone mode. The Speaker key remains lit but the speaker
is deactivated. Normal incoming calls do not ring the telephone.
A feature can be programmed on the monitored station if this feature is to be used
frequently.
Monitoring Station
Dial the monitored stations number; connection is established without ring or
tone.
The call is dropped when the monitoring station goes on hook, but the monitored
station can be called from another telephone. The monitoring station can receive
and process calls in the normal manner providing a separate trunk key is used
for external calls. Call waiting tone is applied, but not signaled on the monitored
station.
The feature is deactivated when the monitoring station goes on hook.
7-348
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for Internal Traffic
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
HW requirements
SW requirements
V1.2 or later
Requirement or Condition
Call waiting
Call waiting during editing is possible because the telephone is in the digit input state and is busy for incoming
traffic.
Consultation hold
Configuration Options
This feature can be configured using Manager T or HiPath 3000 Manager E.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-349
Implementing Features
Features for Internal Traffic
Action
Configure edit telephone number:
14-33 => configure station - edit tel. number (0 = off (default), 1 = on)
Action
1.
2.
Configure stations.
3.
4.
Action
1.
2.
3.
7-350
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Tenant Service
Intercept
System number
Caller list
Busy override
DISA
Speaker call
Hotline destinations
Internal calls
Internal directory
CDB printout
Night answer
optiClient Attendant
Park slot
Prime Line
Voice mail
Toll restriction
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-351
Implementing Features
Tenant Service
7-352
Stations
Trunk groups
Intercept position
Door opener
Hotline
DISA trunks
Traffic restriction groups determine the ability of tenants to access each other.
Six MOH devices can be defined for six possible ITR groups. This means that the
analog interfaces used for connection are part of the ITR groups. Which MOH device is used depends on the ITR group of the station that places the call on hold.
You cannot use the logical port 0 as an MOH source.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Tenant Service
Model-Specific Data
Subject
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
Feature available in
HW requirements
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
Hotline destinations
Announcement devices
16
MOH-devices
Trunk groups
16
16
Requirement or Condition
Internal calls
Prime Line
CDB printout
Internal directory
Switch
Simplified dialing
Speed transfer
Intercept
Tenant
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-353
Implementing Features
Tenant Service
Subject
Requirement or Condition
System configuration
Configuration Options
This feature can be configured using Manager T or HiPath 3000 Manager E.
Configuring the Feature Using Manager T
Configure the feature using Manager T as follows:
7-354
Step
Action
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
10.
11.
12.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Tenant Service
Action
1.
Options
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
Lines/networking, Trunks
10.
Lines/networking, Routes
Action
1.
2.
3.
Both customers should be able to seize the trunk using 0. (9 in U.K. and
U.S.)
4.
5.
6.
7.
The ITR groups for customer As stations and trunks receive mutual ITR.
8.
For its own stations, customer A receives mutual ITR for customer Bs
stations.
9.
For its own stations, customer A receives incoming ITR for customer Bs
trunks.
10.
The ITR groups for customer Bs stations and trunks receive mutual ITR.
11.
For its own stations, customer B receives incoming ITR for customer As
trunks.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-355
Implementing Features
Tenant Service
Step
7-356
Action
12.
13.
14.
15.
16.
17.
18.
19.
The intercept is removed in system settings, and for each trunk the intercept position for 0 (9 in U.K. and U.S.) is entered in the call allocation
for trunks.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Other Features
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
Feature available in
HW requirements
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
Requirement or Condition
S0
Recalls
Call waiting
Call hold
Conference
If a station in a conference has activated call waiting rejection, an unprotected station can still be camped-on.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-357
Implementing Features
Other Features
Configuration Options
This feature can be configured using Manager T or HiPath 3000 Manager E.
Configuring the Feature Using Manager T
Configure the feature using Manager T as follows:
Step
Action
1.
2.
3.
4.
Action
1.
Options
2.
Set up station
3.
Stations
4.
Param
5.
Flags
7-358
Action
1.
2.
3.
The call waiting tone does not sound. You receive a busy signal on the
calling station.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Other Features
If it is not possible to synchronize using the ISDN trunk, the switchover data can be
entered in a table that is internal to the system. Edit the table using HiPath 3000 Manager E.
The day and month when daylight savings time should begin or end is specified for
each year. The system switches over, as appropriate, at 2 or 3 a.m.
The date can be displayed in the following formats:
Europe: 20.JUN 01
International: 20 JUN 01
International 2: 20.06.01
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-359
Implementing Features
Other Features
Model-Specific Data
Subject
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
Feature available in
HW requirements
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
Requirement or Condition
Changes can be made from the configuration station only.
Configuration Options
This feature does not have to be explicitly configured for operation on digital trunks
that automatically set the time (not for U.S.). Otherwise, it can be configured using
Manager T or HiPath 3000 Manager E.
Configuring the Feature Using Manager T
Configure the feature using Manager T as follows:
Step
7-360
Action
1.
2.
3.
12
4.
5.
6.
13
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Other Features
Action
1.
2.
System parameters
3.
4.
5.
System parameters
6.
Display
Action
1.
For digital trunks, set up an external call. The date and time are set automatically if the central office generates a message containing this information (not for U.S.).
2.
In systems without digital trunks and for digital trunks in the U.S., set the
date and time using the procedure described above.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-361
Implementing Features
Other Features
7.13.3 Relays
Definition
HiPath 3000 provide control outputs (relays) on an optional control relay module. This
enables you to perform the following functions from any connected telephone by entering codes:
Timer-controlled switch
Night bell
station active
The optional control relay modules STRB (with HiPath 3550 and HiPath 3350) and
STRBR (with HiPath 3500 and HiPath 3300) can be implemented with four control inputs and four outputs each for functions such as monitoring, alarm, control and adjustment. This can be used in security systems or Property Management Systems
(PMS). A control relay module can be connected for each system (HiPath 3550, HiPath 3350, HiPath 3500 and HiPath 3300). The relay card REAL which provides four
control outputs is available for HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700.
The signal input function (control input) is triggered by closing any of the external
floating contacts. The external electric circuit is supplied by the control relay module
and electrically isolated from the system controller by means of an optocoupler.
The relays can be controlled via codes from every connected telephone and remotely
via the trunk line (DISA) by the station user associated with the relay function or for
with the aid of the feature Associated Services.
Assigning Functions to the Actuators (Relays)
No function type
The relevant actuator is either not operating or is entered as a common ringer
under Call management, Call destination lists.
7-362
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Other Features
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-363
Implementing Features
Other Features
Music-on-hold type
The relay is activated if at least one station or a line in the system is not in the
idle condition. The relay is deactivated if all stations and lines in the system are
in the idle condition.
Practical application: Activation of a tape device, CD player, PC connection
power management etc. NONE must be entered as allocated station for this relay
type, and it must only occur once in the system. In the case of this relay type,
shutdown can be delayed if a value greater than 0 has been entered for the
Switching time field. The switching time is a multiple of 100ms.
7-364
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
x
REAL
STRB / STRBR
V1.0 or later
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Other Features
Requirement or Condition
Relays can be controlled from the outside via trunk access.
Configuration Options
This feature can be configured using Manager T or HiPath 3000 Manager E.
Configuring the Feature Using Manager T
Configure the feature using Manager T as follows:
Step
Action
1.
Configure relays
26-1 => Relays - Type
2.
3.
4.
Action
1.
Configure relays
Options
2.
Connections
3.
Actuators
Action
1.
Program a relay
2.
3.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-365
Implementing Features
Other Features
Display telephones
All station types can activate/deactivate the relays.
From an idle state, the user dials the default access code *90 or presses the Program/Service key, scrolls to and selects the prompt *90=Control relay on?, then
enters the relay number.
A feature button can be programmed on an optiset E or optiPoint if the feature is
to be used frequently.
The user can deactivate the relay dialing the default access code #68 or via the
Program/Service procedure.
7-366
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Other Features
7.13.4 Sensors
Definition
HiPath 3000 support control inputs (sensors) via an optional control relay module.
When a sensor is activated, the assigned station is called automatically. After the station answers the call, a message can be played from an announcement device. The
signal input function activates when an external floating contact closes. Optocouplers
provide electrical isolation between the external circuit and the system controller.
The sensors can initiate the following functions:
Actuator on/off
Codelock on/off
Actuator on/off
Display of calls on a specific optiset E or optiPoint telephone with error message during call (destination station number)
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-367
Implementing Features
Other Features
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
Feature available in
HW requirements
SW requirements
STRB / STRBR
V1.0 or later
Requirement or Condition
If the notified station is an internal station, a special ring
sounds.
Configuration Options
This feature can be configured using Manager T or HiPath 3000 Manager E.
7-368
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Other Features
Action
1.
Configure sensors
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
10.
Action
1.
Configure sensors
Options
2.
Connections
3.
System flags
Action
1.
Program a sensor.
2.
3.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-369
Implementing Features
Other Features
HiPath 3750, HiPath 3550, HiPath 3350, HiPath 3700, HiPath 3500, HiPath 3300
(four fixed and four variable languages):
Dutch*, English (UK), English (US), French, German, Italian*, Portuguese *,
Spanish*
HiPath 3250 with SBS, HiPath 3150 with SBS (two fixed and two variable languages):
English (UK), French*, German, Italian*
HiPath 3250 with SBSCO, HiPath 3150 with SBSCS (four fixed and four variable
languages):
Dutch*, English (UK), English (US), French, German, Italian*, Portuguese*,
Spanish*,
The languages marked * are variable and can be replaced (overloaded) by one of
the available languages from the list below. This is possible only with HiPath 3000
Manager E.
You cannot reload an individual text language. Variable languages that should not be
replaced (overloaded) must therefore always be specified separately. It is not possible
to reload a fixed language once it is already there.
Available languages: Catalan, Chinese, Czech, Danish, Dutch, English (UK), English
(US), Estonian, Finnish, French, German, Greek, Hungarian, Italian, Latvian, Lithuanian, Norwegian, Polish, Portuguese, Russian, Serbo-Croatian, Slovak, Slovenian,
Spanish, Swedish, Telekom (Germany), Turkish.
Note the following with regard to system-wide and station-specific language settings:
7-370
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Other Features
Model-Specific Data
Subject
Feature available in
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
HW requirements
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
Requirement or Condition
System administration The following languages are not available for system administration: Czech, Serbo-Croatian, Slovenian, and Turkish.
Configuration Options
This feature can be configured using Manager T or HiPath 3000 Manager E.
Configuring the Feature Using Manager T
Configure the feature using Manager T as follows:
Step
Action
1.
2.
3.
Selection options:
a) Change only the defined station with confirmation.
b) Change all stations of the same type.
c) Change all stations.
4.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-371
Implementing Features
Other Features
Action
1.
2.
3.
1.
2.
Set up station
3.
Stations
4.
Flags
7-372
Action
1.
2.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Other Features
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
Feature available in
HW requirements
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
Requirement or Condition
Trunk group
Call forwarding
Configuration Options
This feature can be configured using Manager T or HiPath 3000 Manager E.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-373
Implementing Features
Other Features
Action
1.
Configure station
2.
Action
1.
Configure station
Options
2.
Set up station
3.
Param
4.
Flags
7-374
Step
Action
1.
2.
3.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Other Features
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-375
Implementing Features
Other Features
Do not disturb
Call forwarding
Telephone lock
Group ringing
Advisory message
Hunt group
Reset services
Actuators
Night answer
Timed reminder
All features set by another station can be deactivated from the station on which the
feature was set. If the destination station has the feature Telephone lock active, services cannot be activated at that telephone. Likewise, a feature which was activated
at a telephone before the telephone was locked and is still active, cannot be deactivated with the Associated Services feature.
The destination station must first be authorized in database (where this applies), in
order to use the feature/function.
Model-Specific Data
Subject
Feature available in
HW requirements
SW requirements
7-376
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
V1.0 or later
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Other Features
Requirement or Condition
From an ISDN terminal, dial the substitute code (75) for the
asterisk (*).
Configuration Options
This feature can be configured using Manager T or HiPath 3000 Manager E.
Configuring the Feature Using Manager T
Configure the feature using Manager T as follows:
Step
Action
1.
Configure station
2.
Action
1.
Configure station
Options
2.
Set up station
3.
Parameter
4.
Flags
Action
1.
2.
3.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-377
Implementing Features
Other Features
Call forwarding on/off (*11, *12, *13/#1): Activating a Call Forwarding to an external destination for another station is possible; however, the station involved
must have the proper COS toll restriction level.
Telephone lock on/off (*66/#66): The correct sequence must be followed: *83 +
stn no. + *66/#66 + PIN.
Group ringing on/off (*81/#81): The correct sequence must be followed: *83 +
stn no. + *81/#81+ stn no. which will also ring.
Advisory message on/off (*69/#69): It is only possible to enter additional information into the variable sections of the advisory message from a display telephone.
Refer to the Operating Instructions for HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0 for information on operating the feature.
For a list of additional documentation, refer to Table 1-1, List of Available Documentation for HiPath 3000
7-378
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Other Features
7.13.8 Display Number of Stations with Direct Trunk Access (for Austria
Only)
Definition
You can use system administration to display the number of stations with direct trunk
access available in the system. This includes all stations currently in operation which
have at least outward restricted trunk access.
Model-Specific Data
Subject
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
Feature available in
HW requirements
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
Requirement or Condition
Available in Austria only
Configuration Options
This feature does not have to be configured explicitly.
Displaying the Feature with Manager T
Display the feature using Manager T as follows:
Step
Action
1.
Display stations
2.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-379
Implementing Features
Other Features
Action
1.
Display stations
System status
2.
System-wide
3.
Telephone
4.
7-380
Step
Action
1.
Display the number of stations with direct trunk access using the procedure.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Other Features
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
Feature available in
HW requirements
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
Requirement or Condition
Call forwarding can be activated during a call.
Configuration Options
This feature does not have to be explicitly configured.
Testing the Feature
Check the feature for error-free functioning as follows:
Step
Action
1.
2.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-381
Implementing Features
Other Features
Call forwarding
Send/cancel messages
Advisory message
Group ringing
Hunt group
Silent camp-on
Do not disturb
Ringer cutoff
Timed reminder
The system can also reset the above features per telephone from a local or remote
location using the HiPath 3000 Manager E administration tool. (Refer to Executing
feature using HiPath 3000 Manager E on page 7-383). The administrator first downloads the information to HiPath 3000 Manager E and working off-line can selectively
view the state of each of the features activated on each telephone. In HiPath 3000
Manager E, the administrator can reset all these features on any telephone and upload the file to the HiPath 3000 system.
The following table illustrates the features that can be reset from the station by dialing
the access code #0, individually.
Station
Call Forward
Call Forward on
Received messages
Advisory message
Answer text
Group Ringing
7-382
Hunt Group
Caller ID suppression
Suppress Calling ID
Implementing Features
Other Features
Do Not Disturb
Do Not Disturb
Ringer cutoff
The additional features in the HiPath 3000 Manager E System Status - Flags screen:
Room Monitor, Lock Code, Call Connection and Direct answering will not be deactivated.
Model-Specific Data
Subject
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
Feature available in
HW requirements
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
Requirement or Condition
Send messages
Sensors/send messages
Configuration Options
This feature can be configured using Manager T or HiPath 3000 Manager E.
Executing feature using HiPath 3000 Manager E
Execute the feature using HiPath 3000 Manager E as follows:
Step
Action
1.
2.
System-wide
3.
Flags
4.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-383
Implementing Features
Other Features
Action
1.
2.
3.
7-384
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Other Features
V3.0 SMR-8 or later: The use of the Relocate feature ensures that the LIN remains assigned to the physical connection port.
Up to and including V3.0 SMR-7: The use of the Relocate feature is not permitted if the system has more than one location identification number (LIN).
>
Definition
This is an expansion of the Relocate feature found in V1.0 or earlier.
The new Relocate feature allows an optiset E and optiPoint 500 station to use a procedure to change the assignment between the physical telephone port and the logical
station data (user profile).
Example: the telephone used by station 220 is connected to the second port of the
SLMO board in slot 01 (220 = 0102) and the telephone used by station 330 is on the
fourth port of the SLMO board in slot 03 (330 = 0304). After executing the relocate
function, the station data belonging to station 220 is assigned to the fourth port of the
SLMO board in slot 03 (220 = 0304) and the data belonging to station 330 is assigned
to the second port of the SLMO board in slot 01 (330 = 0102).
>
You may only exchange user profiles of the same type of optiset E or optiPoint 500
(key layout).
If you exchange user profiles from different types of optiset E or optiPoint 500, individually programmed key functions on the basic device are replaced with the default
values.
You can also use Relocate on preconfigured SLMO or SLU boards, which means on
boards that are not physically present, and on SLMO or SLU ports that do not have
telephones connected.
Virtual (physically not present) SLMO/SLU boards can be preconfigured with HiPath
3000 Manager E. At the ports of these boards, virtual optiset E and optiPoint 500 stations can be configured (including standard (default) and individual key assignments).
After loading a so prepared CDB, Relocate can be executed between real and virtual
telephones (stations). The so preconfigured virtual stations follow the call management, but only after Relocate was executed once.
Examples: The feature is useful in companies that have a large number of field representatives. These staff members are provided with a pool of workstations in the
company headquarters. Furthermore, a separate station configuration (station num-
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-385
Implementing Features
Other Features
ber, key programming, trunk access, etc.) is defined for each staff member. To carry
out work at the company headquarters, the staff member selects a workstation and
activates the Relocate feature on the accompanying optiset E or optiPoint 500 telephone. This provides him or her with his or her personal user profile (station configuration).
A customer has 24 hour help desk operation that does not use UCD. Each desk position will have three different users each day. With the Relocate feature enhancement a user will be able to relocate a virtual port configuration to any desk that is
available. This will then allow the user to receive calls to the DID numbers assigned
to that user.
An additional application of this Relocate feature would be if two users decide to
change desk locations and both users share the same phone types. The users can
easily perform the Relocate operation without the assistance of a Telecommunications engineer.
If you want to use the Relocate feature, you must enable it system-wide. You can carry out one of the following steps on the optiset E or optiPoint 500 telephone to activate
it (the telephone lock PIN is not required if the PIN is set to the default 00000.):
Start the service menu, enter Relocate + internal number of the destination station + telephone lock PIN
Press the appropriate programmed key and enter the internal number of the destination station + telephone lock PIN
After you have entered the destination station number, no other stations may use the
feature until the procedure has completed. When executing the exchange, both telephones involved are reset.
The display of the new station number (display Stn. number: XXXXX) on both telephones signals that the feature has executed successfully.
Model-Specific Data
Subject
Feature available in
HW requirements
SW requirements
7-386
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Other Features
Requirement or Condition
S0 terminals
S0 terminals do not use the Relocate feature. These terminals go into service automatically at any port. In other
words, they be relocated without the feature.
Attention
The LIN of S0 terminals must be updated manually using
HiPath 3000 Manager E when the port is being changed.
E911 emergency ser- The use of the Relocate feature in conjunction with V3.0
vice for U.S.
SMR-8 or later ensures that the LIN remains assigned to
the physical port.
Manager T
UCD
DISA
Associated services
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-387
Implementing Features
Other Features
Subject
Requirement or Condition
For incoming calls to stations, which are no longer physically available, the call follows the call management (CFW to
PM instead dropping the call to the intercept). This mechanism is available 1 minute after proceeding with this feature
or 5 minutes after a system hard restart.
Key LED
Code lock
Hoteling is possible with code lock active. To delete the status indication, during code lock active, is possible.
Activation of relocate
optiClient
IP device
Supported features
Configuration Options
This feature can be configured using Manager T or HiPath 3000 Manager E.
Configuring the Feature Using Manager T
Configure the feature using Manager T as follows:
Step
7-388
Action
1.
2.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Other Features
Action
1.
2.
System parameters
3.
Flags
4.
Action
1.
2.
3.
4.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-389
Implementing Features
Other Features
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
Feature available in
HW requirements
50
50
SW requirements
Maximum no. of timed
reminders (systemwide)
V1.0 or later
50
50
50
7-390
Requirement or Condition
Appointments
Standard analog telephones, optiset E entry, optiset E basic, optiPoint 500 entry, and cordless telephones support
only programming of non-repeating (once only) appointments
Timed reminders
A timed reminder which is due but cannot be signaled (user busy, for example), is postponed until the next cycle.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Other Features
Subject
Requirement or Condition
Configuration Options
This feature does not have to be explicitly configured.
Testing the Feature
Check the feature for error-free functioning as follows (example for HiPath 3750 and
HiPath 3700):
Step
Activity
1.
2.
Enter * 46
3.
4.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-391
Implementing Features
Other Features
Type of Number
Delete
HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3250
HiPath 3150
HiPath 3300
Station numbers
100-349
500-749
100-278
500-687
11-30
51-70
Yes
100-349
500-749
100-287
500-687
11-30
51-70
Yes
Trunk numbers
7801-7920
7801-7860
801-816
Yes
0 = World
9 = U.S.
0 = World
9 = U.S.
0 = World
9 = U.S.
No
80-84
80-84
82-88
Yes
850-859
850-859
---
Yes
891
891
891
Yes
890
890
890
Yes
Digital modem
Internal & DID
879
879
77 & 879
Yes
Group numbers
Internal & DID
350-499
8600-8749
350-499
31-50
Yes
9 = World
0 = U.S.
9 = World
0 = U.S.
9 = World
0 = U.S.
Yes
0 = World
9 = U.S.
0 = World
9 = U.S.
0 = World
9 = U.S.
No
75
75
75
Yes
76
76
76
Yes
*xxx
#xxx
*xxx
#xxx
*xxx
#xxx
No
Service codes
7-392
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Other Features
Model-Specific Data
Subject
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
Feature available in
HW requirements
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
Configuration Options
This feature can be configured using HiPath 3000 Manager E.
Configuring the Feature Using HiPath 3000 Manager E
Configure the feature using HiPath 3000 Manager E as follows:
Step
Action
1.
2.
Action
1.
Using HiPath 3000 Manager E, check whether all the station numbers
were deleted.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-393
Implementing Features
Other Features
7.13.14 Team/Top
Definition
Team/Top is based on MULAP lines, which are generally looped via several telephones. These telephones are combined in a MULAP group that has only one station
number in the system (for more information, refer to Section 7.13.14.3).
7.13.14.1 Team Configuration
Example of a Team with Two Members
MULAP 201
MULAP 202
Join/Leave Group
Join/Leave Group
MULAP 202
MULAP 201
DSS Telephone B
DSS Telephone A
Programmable
Programmable
Programmable
Programmable
DSS
Key
Tel. B
MULAP 2 with
No. 202
0
MULAP 1 with
No. 201
Figure 7-8
7-394
DSS
Key
Tel. A
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Other Features
MULAP 1 and MULAP 2: MULAPs (basic MULAP groups) that appear on both
Telephone A and Telephone B.
A group call key allows you to activate or deactivate incoming MULAP call signaling.
Table 7-6
Transfer in Team (Switch Lines for DSS System Option Not Set)
(Not for U.S.)
Operation
Tel. A
M1
Tel. A
DSS Key B
Tel. B
M1
Tel. B
DSS Key A
XXXX
XX
XXXX
XXX
XXX
XX
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-395
Implementing Features
Other Features
Table 7-7
Transfer in Team (Switch Lines for DSS System Option Set) (for
U.S. Only)
Operation
Tel. A
M1
Tel. A
DSS Key B
Tel. B
M1
Tel. B
DSS Key A
XXXX
XX
XX
XX
XX
1) Tel. B switches lines (exclusive hold), switches to the local station number and calls Tel. A under
the local station number. M1 continues to be signaled as busy on Tel. A.
2) Tel. A can answer only by going off-hook or pressing the Tel. B DSS key. Tel. A then conducts
the call under the local station number.
3) If Tel. B goes on-hook, the connection to Tel. A is released and M1 is placed on common hold.
4) Tel. A can retrieve the held call by pressing M1.
Table 7-8
Tel. A
M2
Explanation
XX
Presses M2
XX
Call on M1
Ringing on M2
XXXX
XX
XXXX
Dial tone
If ringing for MULAP 2 is activated on
Tel. A, Tel. A hears an advisory ring.
Presses M2
XX
Call on M1
XX
Consultation hold
Consultation hold
Switches to M2
7-396
Dial tone
M1 is released, M2 is placed on consultation hold, dial tone remains.
Dial tone
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Other Features
Table 7-8
Tel. A
M1
M2
Explanation
XX
Consultation hold
XX
XX
Presses M1
XX
Tel. B
DSS Key A
M2
Explanation
Consultation hold
XX
Dial tone
Presses M2
XX
XX
Dial tone
1 Because of dual signaling, DSS key A continues to indicate call on hold (state of local station number is always signaled as well).
MULAP 1
0
MULAP 8
Tel. A
Tel. H
Figure 7-9
Tel. B
Tel. G
Tel. C
Tel. F
Tel. D
Tel. E
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-397
Implementing Features
Other Features
Service
Programmable
MULAP 1
Join/Leave Group
Wahlwiederhol.
Programmable
MULAP 2
DSS Tel. B
Mikrofon ein/aus
Programmable
MULAP 3
DSS Tel. C
Lautsprecher
Programmable
MULAP 4
DSS Tel. D
Programmable
MULAP 5
DSS Tel. E
Programmable
MULAP 6
DSS Tel. F
Programmable
MULAP 7
DSS Tel. G
Release
MULAP 8
DSS Tel. H
Figure 7-10
>
7-398
The following options are available for assigning Team keys using HiPath 3000 Manager E:
No key assignment
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Other Features
Model-Specific Data
Subject
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
Feature available in
HW requirements
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
Maximum number of
Team/Top configurations (MULAP groups)
500
50
10
10
10
Maximum number of
stations (members) in
a Team/Top configuration
10
10
Maximum number of
telephones in a Team/
Top configuration
10
10
Maximum number of
MULAPs per telephone
32
32
10
10
10
Requirement or Condition
Manually configured
basic MULAP group
Configuration Options
This feature can be configured using Manager T or HiPath 3000 Manager E.
Configuring the Feature Using Manager T
Teams should normally be configured using HiPath 3000 Manager E. Configuration
using Manager T is possible only to a limited extent.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-399
Implementing Features
Other Features
7-400
Action
1.
2.
Incoming calls
3.
Team/Top
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Other Features
Programmable
Join/Leave Group
Programmable
DSS Executive
Ring Transfer
Exec. MULAP
Ring Transfer
Exec. MULAP
DSS Secretary
Programmable
Programmable
Programmable
Basic MULAP
(Secr. MULAP)
with No. 202
Exec. MULAP
with No. 201
Figure 7-11
Executive MULAP 201 with an executive and executive CMI as executives and
with a secretary as member.
Basic MULAP 202 with a secretary as primary station and an executive and executive CMI as members.
Ring transfer keys: For controlling incoming MULAP call signaling. The default
setting for the ring transfer key is deactivated (LED off). Calls are signaled on
the secretary.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-401
Implementing Features
Other Features
Transfer in Top (Switch Lines for DSS System Option Not Set) (Not
for U.S.)
Operation
Executive Telephone
Exec.
Secr.
MULAP MULAP
DSS Key
Secretary
Exec.
CMI
Mobile
Tel.
Secretary Telephone
Secr.
Exec.
DSS Key
MULAP MULAP Executive
XXXX
XXXX
X
XXXX
XX
XXXX
XXX
XXX
XX
or
Executive answers (3)
Table 7-10
Transfer in Top (Switch Lines for DSS System Option Set) (for U.S.
Only)
Operation
Executive Telephone
Exec.
Secr.
MULAP MULAP
DSS Key
Secr.
Exec.
CMI
Mobile
Tel.
Secretary Telephone
Secr.
Exec.
DSS Key
MULAP MULAP Executive
XXXX
Executive answers
X
XXXX
XX
XX
XX
XX
1) Secretary switches lines; executive is placed on exclusive hold; call signaled on exec. MULAP and exec. CMI.
2) Secretary goes on-hook; connection between exec. and secr. is released. Executive is placed on hold.
3) Executive can retrieve held call on executive MULAP.
7-402
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Other Features
Executive MULAP 1
Secretary MULAP 1
Executive MULAP 2
Secretary MULAP 2
Exec. 1
Exec. 2
Figure 7-12
>
Secr. 1
Secr. 2
The following options are available for assigning Top keys using HiPath 3000 Manager E:
No key assignment
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-403
Implementing Features
Other Features
Service
Programmable
Programmable
DSS Executive 2
Wahlwiederhol.
Programmable
Exec. MULAP 1
Exec. MULAP 2
Mikrofon ein/aus
Programmable
Ring Transfer
Exec. MULAP 1
Ring Transfer
Exec. MULAP 2
Lautsprecher
Programmable
DSS Secretary 1
DSS Secretary 2
Programmable
Secr. MULAP 1
Secr. MULAP 2
Programmable
Programmable
Programmable
Programmable
Programmable
Programmable
Release
Programmable
Programmable
Figure 7-13
7-404
Top with Two Executives and Two Secretaries: Default Key Assignments for Executive 1 on Key Module
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Other Features
Service
Programmable
DSS Executive 1
DSS Executive 2
Wahlwiederhol.
Programmable
Exec. MULAP 1
Exec. MULAP 2
Mikrofon ein/aus
Programmable
Ring Transfer
Exec. MULAP 1
Ring Transfer
Exec. MULAP 2
Lautsprecher
Programmable
Join/Leave Group
DSS Secretary 2
Programmable
Secr. MULAP 1
Secr. MULAP 2
Programmable
Programmable
Programmable
Programmable
Programmable
Programmable
Release
Programmable
Programmable
Figure 7-14
Top with Two Executives and Two Secretaries: Default Key Assignments for Secretary 1 on Key Module
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-405
Implementing Features
Other Features
Model-Specific Data
Subject
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
Feature available in
HW requirements
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
Maximum number of
Team/Top configurations (MULAP groups)
500
50
10
10
10
Maximum number of
stations (members) in
a Team/Top configuration
10
10
Maximum number of
telephones in a Team/
Top configuration
10
10
Maximum number of
MULAPs per telephone
32
32
10
10
10
7-406
Requirement or Condition
Manually configured
executive MULAP
group
Executive as primary
station
An executive can also be a primary station in a basic MULAP group but can be defined as an executive only in an
executive MULAP group.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Other Features
Subject
Requirement or Condition
Executive ring
If an executive in the executive MULAP group calls a nonexecutive in the local executive MULAP group, the call is
signaled by a special, acoustic executive ring.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-407
Implementing Features
Other Features
Subject
Call transfer key, incoming MULAP call
signaling
Requirement or Condition
7-408
All members of an executive MULAP group can program a local ring transfer key for each executive MULAP. A secretary with multiple executives has multiple
executive MULAPs and, therefore, multiple ring transfer keys.
The default setting for the ring transfer key is deactivated (LED off). Calls are signaled on the secretary.
When the ring transfer key is pressed (LED on), MULAP call signaling is transferred within the executive
MULAP group. Executives are signaled with MULAP
call signaling and non-executives are signaled visually.
Calls between members of the executive MULAP
group or within a Top are not affected by ring transfer:
Executives in the executive MULAP group always ring.
Calls to another executive MULAP group always take
ring transfer into account. Exceptions: Calls set up by
means of a DSS key.
Ring transfer can be activated or deactivated using a
Code: Analog telephones, CMI telephones, optiset E and optiPoint telephones.
Afterwards, the MULAP number must be suffix-dialed.
Menu (after dialing the ring transfer code): CMI
telephones, optiset E and optiPoint telephones
with display.
The ring transfer state is not indicated by a special dial
tone.
Ring transfer has priority, meaning that the group call
key is activated only when ring transfer is deactivated.
Signaling on the two keys is separate.
Conversion to V1.0
Top configuration
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Other Features
Configuration Options
This feature can be configured using Manager T or HiPath 3000 Manager E.
Configuring the Feature Using Manager T
Tops should normally be configured using HiPath 3000 Manager E. Configuration using Manager T is possible only to a limited extent.
Configuring the Feature Using HiPath 3000 Manager E
HiPath 3000 Manager E can be used to configure a default Top (Team/Top mask).
Members can be added to the team by drag and drop. The executive MULAP group,
basic MULAP group and its MULAP key, and the ring transfer and DSS keys are configured automatically. The basic and executive MULAP groups are assigned the original station numbers of the primary station/executive and the primary station/executive is assigned a pseudo station number (examples: 4711 becomes **4711, 12345
becomes **2345, 654321 becomes **4321).
Configure the feature using HiPath 3000 Manager E as follows:
Step
Action
1.
2.
Incoming calls
3.
Team/Top
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-409
Implementing Features
Other Features
All members can activate and deactivate MULAP call signaling for each MULAP
using a key (Group Call).
Outgoing preference for all executives, CMI executives and conference corner telephone executives.
Non-executives can activate and deactivate MULAP call signaling using a key
(Group Call).
Secretary MULAPs are configured by means of basic MULAP groups.
7-410
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Other Features
Telephone Types
The following types of telephone can be defined as both primary stations and nonprimary stations in a basic or executive MULAP group:
Analog telephones
optiClient 130
all optiPoint 500 telephones described in Chapter 9 and the optiset E telephones
described in the Hicom 150 H V1.0 Service Manual
LED flashing slowly = MULAP on hold (call can be retrieved or picked up).
A key can be configured for a MULAP group number on each station (including on a
busy lamp field and optiClient Attendant).
LED Statuses of a DSS key
The LED for the DSS key indicates the status of the DSS destination as follows:
LED on = DSS destination is busy (off-hook, in talk state, etc.) or the telephone
on which the DSS key was configured is calling the destination.
LED flashing rapidly = The telephone (DSS destination) is not being called by a
DSS key.
Example: Telephone A has a DSS key to telephone B. Telephone C calls telephone B. The DSS key LED on telephone A flashes rapidly.
LED flashing slowly = The telephone on which the DSS key was configured has
placed a destination on hold.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-411
Implementing Features
Other Features
7-412
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Other Features
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Although the MULAP settings determine the incoming preference, this setting applies to a particular
telephone. If more than one MULAP is connected to
a telephone, an incoming preference can be set for
each MULAP. Only the last setting entered for the
incoming preference applies to the telephone.
If incoming preference is deactivated, a call cannot
be answered by going off-hook or pressing the
speaker key; the system attempts to execute an
outgoing seizure.
If No incoming preference is selected for a telephone, the setting applies to all incoming calls to
this telephone. Calls to the local station number can
be answered only by pressing a station number,
DSS or general call key.
7-413
Implementing Features
Other Features
Outgoing Calls
Initiating an outgoing call An outgoing call can be initiated by going off-hook,
pressing the speaker key, or pressing a call, digit, MULAP, station number or DSS key.
When an outgoing call is initiated, a station number is
assigned and the called party is displayed. In the default
configuration (device without MULAP), the local station
number is assigned when the line is seized. If seizure is
via a MULAP, the MULAP group number is assigned.
Outgoing Preference
Outgoing preference
(automatic outgoing seizure)
7-414
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Other Features
Busy Signaling
If one MULAP group member presses the MULAP key
or seizes the MULAP by preference (goes off-hook,
presses the speaker key or dials while on-hook), MULAP keys indicate the busy state on all the stations in
the MULAP group.
Station Number Key, DSS Key
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-415
Implementing Features
Other Features
Line Switchover
Call Pickup
Calls to MULAP groups are not signaled in any call pickup group and cannot be picked up.
Night, Intercept and Overflow Destinations
MULAP groups can be used as night, intercept and
overflow destinations.
Telephone Directory
Administration (Manager T/HiPath 3000 Manager E) indicates which station number or name will appear when
the directory is displayed.
Call Forwarding
CF destination
7-416
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Other Features
Call forwarding via asso- In this case, the MULAP number must be entered twice,
ciated services
once to indicate the source and once to indicate the
trunk.
Execution of call forwarding
Secretarial function
transfer
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-417
Implementing Features
Other Features
7-418
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Other Features
Number/Name Display
Toggle
Transfer
Conference
When the user goes on-hook, the call is transferred or
an immediate recall is performed.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-419
Implementing Features
Other Features
7-420
Unscreened and
screened transfer (important Top feature)
If a member of the local MULAP is called while on consultation hold (by dialing the local station number, pressing the station number key or pressing the DSS key (not
for U.S.)), the ring/call continues to be signaled/conducted on the MULAP after the transfer. Before the transfer,
common hold is signaled on both MULAP members
and the held call can be picked up.
This function is signaled only on the MULAP station initiating consultation hold or hold. The MULAP LED indicates a call (busy indication on all other MULAP stations). The call is always signaled by an acoustic ring
and display (MULAP ring and group call are ignored).
Consultation hold on
second line
Consultation hold on a second line occurs when a second MULAP line is activated after consultation hold is
initiated from a MULAP line.
This function is useful when activating features that can
only be activated from consultation hold (such as transfer and conference).
Once a second line has been placed on consultation
hold, the first line is released.
Example of an application: A call is being conducted on
MULAP M1. By pressing a trunk key, the user switches
the line to MULAP M2, thus placing M1 on exclusive
hold. A new connection is set up on M2. In order to add
the party on M1 to a conference, the user must press
consultation hold, M1 (M2 is released) and conference.
The conference continues on M1.
Instead of being added to a conference, the call can be
transferred. In this case, the two parties are interconnected and M1 is released.
Conference
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Other Features
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-421
Implementing Features
Other Features
The following table shows which services (features) can be programmed on procedure keys. The table also shows any conditions that apply to the use of the procedure
keys.
Refer to Table A-1 for the code numbers for activating or deactivating the services
(features) in the list.
during incoming
call
Comments
during outgoing
call
Feature
X
X
Associated dialing
7-422
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Other Features
Associated services
Comments
during incoming
call
during outgoing
call
Feature
Group ringing on
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-423
Implementing Features
Other Features
Comments
during incoming
call
during outgoing
call
Feature
Night answer on
Park on
Parked call retrieval
X
X
Retrieval of an external
call from common hold
Send messages (message waiting)
Silent monitoring
Speaker call
Switch relays on
X
X
X
X
Voice selections
7-424
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Other Features
Model-Specific Data
Subject
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
Feature available in
HW requirements
SW requirements
V1.2 or later
Requirement or Condition
Procedure length
optiClient Attendant
Pause
Suffix-dialing
PIN
Configuration Options
This feature can be configured using HiPath 3000 Manager E.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-425
Implementing Features
Other Features
Action
1.
2.
Configure station
3.
Program key
4.
Select key
5.
Action
1.
2.
3.
7-426
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Other Features
16:53
123456
Figure 7-15
16:53
123456
Figure 7-16
Th 07 FEB 02
HiPath
>
Default Display in Idle State
Th 07 FEB 02
Sea View Hotel >
Example of a Customer-Specific Display in Idle State
Model-Specific Data
Subject
Feature available in
HW requirements
SW requirements
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
V3.0 or
later
V3.0 or
later
V3.0 or
later
V3.0 or
later
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Requirement or Condition
The display appears only when the telephone is in the idle
state.
7-427
Implementing Features
Other Features
Configuration Options
This feature can be configured using HiPath 3000 Manager E.
Configuring the Feature Using HiPath 3000 Manager E
Configure the feature using HiPath 3000 Manager E as follows:
Step
Activity
1.
2.
System parameters
3.
System settings
7-428
Step
Activity
1.
The new text appears in the display on all telephones immediately after
you change it.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Networking
7.14 Networking
Definition
In this case, networking means
the connection of HiPath 3000 systems with other systems such as HiPath 4000.
A HiPath 3000 system represents a so-called zone (node); the connected workpoint
clients and a gatekeeper (HiPath HG1500) belong to this zone. Furthermore, the
zone can also include a gateway and a HiPath AllServe server.
Zones networked to one another form a domain, which is defined by the common,
cross-zone administration platform, the HiPath AllServe server.
Networking possibilities
The following table lists the possibilities that V3.0 of the HiPath 3000 offers for networking communication systems, zones, and domains.
Table 7-11
Protocol
Remarks
Example uses
TDM-based
CorNet-N
QSig
E&M
IP-based
CorNet-IP
(CorNet-N)
>
For examples of maximum possible distances from the CO for CorNet-N direct networking, refer to Table 2-9 on page 2-23.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-429
Implementing Features
Networking
Feature
Basic call
CorNet-N
QSIG ISO
QSIG ECMA
supported
supported
supported
Segmentation
not supported
supported (no
transit)
supported
supported
supported
supported
supported
Classmarks
supported
supported
supported
supported
Call intrusion
not supported
supported
supported
Call offering
not supported
not supported
not supported
Call waiting
not supported
supported
supported
supported
supported
supported
supported
supported
supported
not supported
not supported
not supported
supported
supported
supported
supported
not supported
not supported
Path replacement
supported
not supported
not supported
supported
supported
supported
supported
supported
supported
supported
supported
supported
supported
Conference (CONF)
supported
Recall
Call interception
Private numbering plan
7-430
not supported
supported
supported
supported
supported
supported
not supported
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Networking
Table 7-12
Feature
CorNet-N
QSIG ISO
QSIG ECMA
not supported
supported
not supported
not supported
supported
(transmitting
system only)
CDR routing
supported
(with IP networking only)
not supported
supported
COS changeover
not supported
supported
not supported
not supported
supported
not supported
supported
Billing
not supported
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-431
Implementing Features
Networking
CorNet-N on fractional T1
The HiPath 3000 support fractional T1 service, which can be used in a CorNetN, PRI or analog T1 (non-ISDN) environment. Any of the B channels that have
been disabled in the HiPath 3000 configuration can be used for other T1 applications. External multiplexing equipment is required to provide mapping of the alternate applications T1 channels into the unused B channels of the CorNet-N
link. (Refer to CorNet-N Configuration and Sales Positioning guides).
7-432
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Networking
SW requirements
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
Digital
trunk
board or
analog
tie trunk
board
Digital
trunk
board
Digital
trunk
board
V1.0 or later
Requirement or Condition
Closed numbering
With closed numbering, trunk group codes must be deleted for CorNet trunk groups, although trunk access codes
remain.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-433
Implementing Features
Networking
Subject
Requirement or Condition
CorNet-N trunk
groups
On CorNet-N trunk groups that can seize a trunk in the remote CS, the second discriminating digit in the trunk group
must be entered from the remote CS.
Analog trunks
Configuration Options
This feature can be configured using Manager T or HiPath 3000 Manager E.
Configuring the Feature Using Manager T
Configure the feature using Manager T as follows:
Step
Action
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
7-434
Action
1.
2.
Lines/networking
3.
Routing parameters
4.
5.
Lines/networking
6.
Trunks
7.
Parameters, Flags
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Networking
Step
8.
Action
Routes
Action
Call a station in another networked system.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-435
Implementing Features
Networking
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
HW requirements
TIEL
board
SW requirements
V1.0 or
later
Configuration Options
This feature can be configured using Manager T or HiPath 3000 Manager E.
7-436
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Networking
7.14.3 Numbering
Definition
In private networks, users can assign station numbers, trunk access codes, and feature codes according to a customer-defined numbering plan.
HiPath 3000 support both closed and open numbering.
Closed numbering
assumes the uniqueness of all station numbers in the network. Each station in
the network can call another station by dialing its number.
Open numbering
means that a station is identified by a node number and its station number. This
could mean that stations in different nodes have the same station number.
In a HiPath 3000 network you must select the same type of numbering for all nodes.
Model-Specific Data
Subject
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
Feature available in
HW requirements
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
Requirement or Condition
Users can change internal numbering only using HiPath
3000 Manager E.
Configuration Options
This feature can be configured using HiPath 3000 Manager E.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-437
Implementing Features
Networking
Action
1.
Options
2.
Set up station
3.
Station
4.
Automatic LCR
7-438
Action
Call the internal number of another networked station.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Networking
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
Feature available in
HW requirements
SW requirements
Restrictions
V1.0 or later
Host/client
(master/slave)
Client
(slave)
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Requirement or Condition
The following 15 classes of service exist for class-of-service transfer:
7-439
Implementing Features
Networking
Subject
Requirement or Condition
When there is an external seizure of a station from the satellite CS (with COS 2-13) over the main CS, the main CSs
first denied list always does the seizing.
For this reason, keep the first denied line of the main CS
free for the assessment of the stations from the satellite
CS.
The system keeps COS 0, 1 and 14 of the satellite CS.
Configuration Options
This feature can be configured using Manager T or HiPath 3000 Manager E.
Configuring the Feature Using Manager T
Configure the feature using Manager T as follows:
Step
Action
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
7-440
Action
1.
2.
Classes of service
3.
Station
4.
Allowed/denied numbers
5.
Lines/networking
6.
Lines: parameters
7.
Routes
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Networking
Step
8.
Action
Routing parameters
Action
1.
Dial an external, outgoing connection from the satellite CS via the main
CS.
2.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-441
Implementing Features
Networking
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
Feature available in
HW requirements
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
Requirement or Condition
If a system in a network has local trunk accesses, a local
buffer box can be used for the call charges.
Call via the trunk gate- If a station in a CS conducts an outgoing call via the CO
way of the remote CS access of the remote CS, the call details that apply to the
CS in which the trunk is seized are output as call type 6 (direct outward dialing).
7-442
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Networking
Configuration Options
This feature can be configured using Manager T or HiPath 3000 Manager E.
Configuring the Feature Using Manager T
Configure the feature using Manager T as follows:
Step
Action
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
Action
1.
2.
Call charges
3.
Output format
Action
Conduct a chargeable call. The call charges are displayed as configured.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-443
Implementing Features
Networking
Toll restriction
Extension number
Station name
Model-Specific Data
Subject
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
Feature available in
HW requirements
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
Configuration Options
This feature does not have to be explicitly configured.
Testing the Feature
Check the feature for error-free functioning as follows:
Step
7-444
Action
1.
2.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Networking
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
Feature available in
HW requirements
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
Requirement or Condition
Unscreened transfer
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-445
Implementing Features
Networking
Configuration Options
This feature does not have to be explicitly configured.
Configure the feature using HiPath 3000 Manager E as follows:
Step
7-446
Action
1.
2.
Lines/networking
3.
Parameters
4.
B channel mode
5.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Networking
7.14.8 Recall
Definition
The system initiates a recall if the network cannot perform an unscreened transfer.
The recall applies locally and not network-wide.
In homogeneous HiPath 3000 networks, an unanswered call from one node to another recalls the initiating station in the originating node.
In non-homogeneous networks, an unanswered call to a non-HiPath 3000 system recalls at the transferring systems intercept position or originator, depending on the
system configuration.
Model-Specific Data
Subject
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
Feature available in
HW requirements
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
Configuration Options
This feature does not have to be explicitly configured.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-447
Implementing Features
Networking
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
Feature available in
HW requirements
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
Configuration Options
This feature does not have to be explicitly configured.
Testing the Feature
Check the feature for error-free functioning as follows:
Step
7-448
Action
1.
2.
If internal call waiting is enabled for this station, the station is campedon.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Networking
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
Feature available in
HW requirements
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
Configuration Options
This feature does not have to be explicitly configured.
Testing the Feature
Check the feature for error-free functioning as follows:
Step
Action
1.
2.
This station receives the same call signaling as it would for an internal
call.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-449
Implementing Features
Networking
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
Feature available in
HW requirements
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
Configuration Options
This feature does not have to be explicitly configured
Testing the Feature
Check the feature for error-free functioning as follows:
Step
7-450
Action
1.
2.
3.
When the user is free or lifts the handset, the system calls you back.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Networking
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
Feature available in
HW requirements
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
Requirement or Condition
Each user can use the station number suppression function to activate or deactivate station number and name display.
Configuration Options
This feature can be configured using Manager T or HiPath 3000 Manager E.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-451
Implementing Features
Networking
Action
1.
2.
Action
1.
2.
System parameters
3.
Display
7-452
Action
1.
2.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Networking
>
Rerouting is deactivated
This option is only available for CorNet-N networking, and must be activated in the
same way in both networked systems.
Refer to the CorNet-N Configuration Notes for the proper setting.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-453
Implementing Features
Networking
Model-Specific Data
Subject
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
Feature available in
HW requirements
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
Configuration Options
This feature can be configured using Manager T or HiPath 3000 Manager E.
Configuring the Feature Using Manager T
Configure the feature using Manager T as follows:
Step
Action
1.
2.
Action
1.
2.
Lines/networking
3.
Routing parameters
7-454
Step
Action
1.
2.
3.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Networking
7.14.14 Toggle
Definition
The conditions described under Section 7.3.3, Toggle also apply to networked systems. That is, station users can use the Toggle feature to toggle between callers, including those originated or received on CorNet-N call routes.
Model-Specific Data
Subject
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
Feature available in
HW requirements
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
Requirement or Condition
A station on hold cannot toggle between calls.
Configuration Options
This feature does not have to be explicitly configured.
Testing the Feature
Check the feature for error-free functioning as follows:
Step
Action
1.
Set up a call.
2.
3.
4.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-455
Implementing Features
Networking
7.14.15 Conference
Definition
The conditions described in Section 7.3.6, Conference also apply to networked systems.
If conference participants are distributed over different networked HiPath systems, up
to five participants can be connected per system to one common, cross-system conference call. For example, two networked HiPath systems allow the setup of a conference call with up to 10 participants.
Voice station users on the HiPath 3000 can establish internal and external conference
calls using local and CorNet-N call routes as needed. The system limits the number
of conferees in a conference to five. A party in another node connected to the conference via CorNet-N is allowed to add additional parties within its own node using its
own conference circuit. Members of a conference within another node will not be updated with the conference display information (number of conferees in the conference) of the HiPath 3000 system.
Model-Specific Data
Subject
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
Feature available in
HW requirements
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
Requirement or Condition
A conference can be set up between voice stations only.
Configuration Options
This feature does not have to be explicitly configured.
7-456
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Networking
Action
1.
Set up a call.
2.
3.
4.
5.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-457
Implementing Features
Networking
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
Feature available in
HW requirements
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
Requirement or Condition
Central busy signaling Max. 100 stations per networked system (node) can be inoptiClient Attendant
cluded.
Configuration Options
This feature does not have to be explicitly configured.
7-458
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Networking
Free
Internal busy
External busy
Do not disturb
Call forwarding
Defective
Model-Specific Data
Topic
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300
Feature available in
Hardware requirements
Software requirements
V1.2 and
later
V1.2 and
later
V1.2 and
later
Dependencies/Restrictions
Topic
Central busy signaling A maximum of 100 stations per networked system (node)
optiClient Attendant
can be included.
Configuration Options
The feature can be configured with:
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-459
Implementing Features
Networking
>
7-460
Activity
1.
2.
Lines/networking:
QSIG features
The node ID of Pro 1 (main PBX) must be entered under System
no. target system.
The PABX number of the LAN trunk group of Pro 1 must be entered
under Call no. target system.
3.
Route table:
The LAN trunk group must be entered.
4.
Configure station...: Here, busy signaling must be activated for each desired station in the satellite PBX (Pro 2).
Stations (parameters): Select the station flag Central busy signaling for each desired station.
The following settings must also be made in the optiClient Attendant software:
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Networking
Activity
1.
In the main PBX (Pro 1 in the example), dial the following call number:
PABX number of satellite PBX (Pro 2) + call number of a station in the
satellite PBX (Pro 2).
2.
3.
When the station accepts the call, the busy state of this station is signaled on the optiClient Attendant.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-461
Implementing Features
Networking
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
Feature available in
HW requirements
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
Configuration Options
This feature does not have to be explicitly configured.
Testing the Feature
Check the feature for error-free functioning as follows:
7-462
Step
Action
1.
From the satellite CS, dial the system speed dialing code for the main
CS.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Networking
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
Feature available in
HW requirements
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
Requirement or Condition
Follow the configuration guidelines.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-463
Implementing Features
Networking
Configuration Options
This feature does not have to be explicitly configured.
Testing the Feature
Check the feature for error-free functioning as follows:
7-464
Step
Action
1.
Activate call forwarding from a networked station to the central voice mail
server.
2.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Networking
7.14.20 QSig
Definition
CorNet-N is usually the protocol used for networking HiPath CS with each other.
QSig, the cross-vendor signaling protocol, is used for networking HiPath and non-HiPath CS. In homogeneous networks, HiPath 3000 supports the following basic features.
In QSig environments, you can operate HiPath 3000 as an end node, transit node, or
gateway.
You can use the QSig protocols, which are based on the following specifications:
ECMA V1.0 and ECMA V2.0 (for the MWI feature only)
with the partial specifications
ETS 300172: Basic Call/ECMA 143
ETS 300239: Generic Functions / ECMA 165
These networked systems collectively act like a single system, transmitting the following over the S0 trunk:
Callback option
Station number
Name
Party category
Transit counter
Called parties with toll restriction 0 (no direct trunk access) for a QSig trunk, cannot
answer an incoming QSig call for another station (call pickup, trunk key). However,
direct calls and forwarded calls to the B party are possible.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-465
Implementing Features
Networking
CorNet-N
All existing features implemented for both CorNet-N and QSig support interworking in the QSig direction and vice-versa. The only exceptions are the callback feature (CCBS/CCNR) and the message waiting indication (MWI) because the message flows between the two protocols and the ones between two nodes are too
different.
ETSI
The requirements for interworking between CorNet-N and ETSI apply here as
well.
Consultation hold
To remote system:
Consultation calls over a second trunk are possible, that is the calls are switched
from the local system over two B channels, and they can be transferred. When a
user releases the call, the call last placed on hold becomes active.
Callback
7-466
Callback calls are deleted manually, when the CS is reset, a trunk fails, a port is
reprogrammed. The same applies to calls from A to B and from B to A.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Networking
Call forwarding
The system supports only the CFU (call forwarding unconditional) QSig version.
Name display
Only UPPERCASE letters are transferred. Users can specify whether a transferred name or the callers station number is displayed.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-467
Implementing Features
Networking
7-468
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Networking
Free
Busy internally
Busy externally
Defective
The numbering plan in this network must be closed and it must be possible to access
the CS via the first administered QSig port on the remote system.
Operating states cannot be transmitted via CSs functioning as gateway or transit
nodes.
7.14.20.9 System Telephone Lock-Reset Code (V3.0 SMR-3 or Later)
Manufacturer-specific expansions to the QSig protocol (QSig+) allow the individual
telephone lock code of a station networked over QSig+ to be reset to the default value
00000.
Initiate the reset with the code System telephone lock/Reset code or by selecting
the correct entries in the service menu. The system then prompts you to enter the station number (with the leading trunk group code, if needed). Mark the end of the entry
with the confirm key or the # key on telephones without a display.
Requirements for resetting the telephone lock code:
The telephone number of the telephone that you are using to initiate the reset
must be entered as a station for system telephone lock (system settings).
The system must be networked over the QSig+ protocol with the ISO-QSig protocol version.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-469
Implementing Features
Networking
The telephone number of the telephone that you are using to initiate the
changeover must be entered as a station for system telephone lock (system
settings).
The system must be networked over the QSig+ protocol with the ISO-QSig protocol version.
Model-Specific Data
Subject
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
Feature available in
HW requirements
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
Configuration Options
This feature can be configured using Manager T or HiPath 3000 Manager E.
7-470
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Networking
Activity
1.
Configure QSig
2.
3.
Activity
1.
Configure QSig
2.
Lines/Networking
3.
4.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-471
Implementing Features
Features for Call Detail Recording
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
V1.0 or later
TML8W
TLA2/4/8 + GEE12
TLA4R
Requirement or Condition
In countries where silent reversal is not signaled at the end
of a call, the call duration is determined by the calling party
hanging up the phone.
Configuration Options
This feature can be configured using Manager T or HiPath 3000 Manager E.
7-472
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for Call Detail Recording
Action
1.
2.
Action
1.
2.
Lines/networking
3.
Parameter
4.
MSI flags
5.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-473
Implementing Features
Features for Call Detail Recording
7.15.2 Advice of Charges at Station During Call (AOC-D) (Not for U.S.)
Definition
Call charge information can be recorded on both analog and digital trunks.
Call charge evaluation for connections on loop start trunks is performed using the call
charge pulses transmitted from the trunk in countries where call charge pulses are
used.
In the case of digital trunks, the display on the users telephone shows the call detail
information received during an external call with the AOC (advice of charges) feature, assuming that the carrier provides this information.
The following types of AOC are supported in the public network:
The charges are not displayed if the call was not fully set up or if HiPath 3000
is unable to evaluate the call detail information of a service provider.
As long as the user has not initiated another action, the final call charges for a call are
displayed for a specific period of time at the end of a call and then added up in call
charge memory.
Call charge pulses are converted to monetary amounts on the basis of the call charge
factor defined as a currency amount (including any extra charges that may apply) per
call charge unit or pulse (refer to Section 7.15.11, Call-Charge Display With Currency
(Not for U.S.)).
7-474
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for Call Detail Recording
Model-Specific Data
Subject
Feature available in
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
HW requirements
Loop start:
Loop start:
optiset E or optiPoint
GEE8;
GEE12/16/50;
telephone with display
optiset E optiset E or optiPoint
or opti- telephone with display
Point telephone
with display
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
General requirements
Requirement or Condition
Analog telephone
Loop start
Loop start trunks require a separate call metering receiving equipment board.
Transfer
In the case of AOC-D, the station to which a call is transferred receives only those call charges that have accrued
since the transfer.
Recall
Toggle
Configuration Options
This feature can be configured using Manager T or HiPath 3000 Manager E.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-475
Implementing Features
Features for Call Detail Recording
Action
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
Action
1.
2.
Call charges
3.
Output format
7-476
Action
Conduct a chargeable call. The charges for this call are displayed as
configured.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for Call Detail Recording
Display
Yes
Activated
Charge admin
Yes
Not activated
Charge admin
No
Activated
Call duration
No
Not activated
When the option is activated, the call duration is displayed for incoming calls; otherwise the call number/name of the calling party is displayed.
With V3.0 SMR-12 or later, the following applies: Call timer display option not activated = Default. Display of call duration has priority.
Call detail information
from CO
Display
Yes
Activated
Call duration
Yes
Not activated
Charge admin
No
Activated
Call duration
No
Not activated
When the option is activated, the call duration is displayed for incoming calls; otherwise the call number/name of the calling party is displayed.
The start of call detail recording is activated by means of a timer for analog trunks (5
seconds after the end of dialing). With digital trunks, call detail recording starts when
the call is answered (with Connect). The dialed call number is displayed up to this
starting point. Digits dialed using suffix dialing are displayed for approximately
5 seconds. The call duration then appears in the display once more. When the station
ends the call, the display for the free status (current time and date) appears.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-477
Implementing Features
Features for Call Detail Recording
Model-Specific Data
Subject
Feature available in
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
HW requirements
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
Requirement or Condition
The system does not support the call duration display feature on S0 and cordless telephones (not for U.S.).
Configuration Options
This feature can be configured using HiPath 3000 Manager E.
Configuring the Feature Using HiPath 3000 Manager E
Configure the feature using HiPath 3000 Manager E as follows:
Step
7-478
Action
1.
System parameters
2.
Display
3.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for Call Detail Recording
Every optiset E, optiPoint, analog telephone, S0 (or MSN), and cordless telephone in the system has two storage devices:
The contents of the individual call memory appear first. A short time later, the
contents of the cumulative call charge memory are displayed.
You can use the system telephone (phone with programming authorization) as a
charge display station. The user of this station can use the system administration
to:
Display the cumulative call charge memory for all stations (organized by station numbers).
Call charge pulses are converted to monetary amounts on the basis of the call charge
factor defined as a currency amount (including any extra charges that may apply) per
call charge unit or pulse (refer to Section 7.15.11, Call-Charge Display With Currency
(Not for U.S.)).
From the system telephone, you can print the latest CDRS data on a printer connected to the V.24 interface, thereby printing the cumulative call charges for all stations
connected to the system.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-479
Implementing Features
Features for Call Detail Recording
If only one optiset E control adapter is connected, you can choose any slot in the
telephone.
If two optiset E control adapters are connected, set the right adapter to Printer
Pipe Mode for call data output. The other adapter is used in API1 or API2 mode.
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
HW requirements
Loop start:
Loop start:
optiset E or optiPoint
GEE8;
GEE12/16/50
telephone with display
optiset E optiset E or optiPoint
or opti- telephone with display
Point telephone
with display
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
General requirements
Requirement or Condition
Adapter in API2 mode If an optiset E control adapter is in API2 mode, you cannot
switch it to Printer Pipe mode.
7-480
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for Call Detail Recording
Configuration Options
This feature does not have to be explicitly configured.
Use Manager T or HiPath 3000 Manager E to configure output to the UP0/E port.
Testing the feature
Check the feature for error-free functioning as follows:
Step
Action
1.
2.
At the end of the call, enter *65 on your own telephone to display the
charges, or display the charges for the station on the programming telephone.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-481
Implementing Features
Features for Call Detail Recording
If only one optiset E control adapter is connected, you can choose any slot in the
telephone.
If two optiset E control adapters are connected, set the right adapter to Printer
Pipe Mode for call data output. The other adapter is used in API1 or API2 mode.
CDRA provides the following data at the end of each call segment:
7-482
The external station number dialed (for outgoing calls) or the station number of
the calling party (for incoming calls).
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for Call Detail Recording
The data is entered at the beginning of each call segment and at the end of the call.
Up to 20 call segments can be logged simultaneously. This data is stored in the system until it is output to the printer and deleted from the attendant console using a procedure. If an overflow occurs, the oldest entry is overwritten first. The stored data is
lost if there is a power failure.
Signals on the CDRA display key:
LED off:
Either CDRA call details that have been displayed at least once are waiting, or
no entry was made.
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
Loop start:
GEE8
Loop start:
GEE12/16/50
HW requirements
(telephone)
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
General requirements
Requirement or Condition
Call charges
Conference
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-483
Implementing Features
Features for Call Detail Recording
Subject
Pay phone
Requirement or Condition
A user can always display the call charges of only those
call segments which were conducted from the assigned
pay phones.
Adapter in API2 mode If an optiset E control adapter is in API2 mode, you cannot
switch it to Printer Pipe mode.
Configuration Options
This feature can be configured using Manager T or HiPath 3000 Manager E.
Configuring the Feature Using Manager T
Configure the feature using Manager T as follows:
Step
Action
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
7-484
Action
1.
Configure CDRA
System status
2.
Call charges
3.
Output format
4.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for Call Detail Recording
Action
1.
2.
At the end of the call, the LED on the Display charges key lights up.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-485
Implementing Features
Features for Call Detail Recording
7.15.6 Call Detail Recording Per Trunk (CDRT) (Not for U.S.)
Definition
The system has a cumulative memory function for call charge amounts accrued per
trunk. One memory area is permanently assigned to each trunk.
A system telephone can display and delete the cumulative memory via the system
administration. Call charge deletion requires confirmation. The current CDRT data
can be printed out via system administration. The printout contains a list of CDRT
data for all trunks connected to the system. The current CDRT data can be printed
out on a printer connected to one of the V.24 (RS-232) interfaces on the system.
Call charge pulses are converted to monetary amounts on the basis of the call charge
factor defined as a currency amount (including any extra charges that may apply) per
call charge unit or pulse (refer to Section 7.15.11, Call-Charge Display With Currency
(Not for U.S.)).
CDRT Data Output to UP0/E Port
You can also output the CDRT data to a UP0/E port. To do this, an optiset E control
adapter, to which you can attach a printer or terminal, must be connected to this port.
The system supports only one adapter per call data output. You can configure the output as follows:
If only one optiset E control adapter is connected, you can choose any slot in the
telephone.
If two optiset E control adapters are connected, set the right adapter to Printer
Pipe Mode for call data output. The other adapter is used in API1 or API2 mode.
7-486
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for Call Detail Recording
Model-Specific Data
Subject
Feature available in
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
HW requirements
Loop start:
Loop start:
optiset E or optiPoint
GEE8
GEE12/16/50
telephone with display
optiset E optiset E or optiPoint
or opti- telephone with display
Point telephone
with display
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
General requirements
Requirement or Condition
Adapter in API2 mode If an optiset E control adapter is in API2 mode, you cannot
switch it to Printer Pipe mode.
Configuration Options
This feature does not have to be explicitly configured.
Use Manager T or HiPath 3000 Manager E to configure output to the UP0/E port.
Configuring the Feature Using Manager T
Configure output to the UP0/E port using Manager T as follows:
Step
Action
1.
2.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-487
Implementing Features
Features for Call Detail Recording
Action
1.
2.
Call charges
3.
Output format
4.
7-488
Action
1.
2.
Display the call charges for the trunk from the system telephone.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for Call Detail Recording
>
The account code feature is used together with central call detail recording (CDRC).
This feature enables you to assign call charges for a specific project to an account
code so that call charges for specific projects can be printed out.
Users can enter an ACCT from any station.
ACCT offers two procedures and three options:
Procedures:
Mandatory ACCT:
Users must enter an ACCT before the start of a call (after a trunk group is seized).
For incoming calls, the ACCT entry is optional. The system applies the ACCT according to the option selected. If least cost routing is active, a flag in the dial plan
signals that you need to enter an ACCT after the access code. The system treats
this input as a mandatory ACCT.
ENB
LCR Active
LCR Inactive
ACCT requested
ACCT requested
SSD
ISD
Redial
Caller list
DSS key
A mandatory ACCT can be defined in the dial plan (LCR).|
Optional ACCT:
Users can enter an optional ACCT from any telephone before the start of a call.
During an incoming or outgoing call, users can enter the ACCT from Upn telephones only. You can enter an ACCT during a call from optiset E entry, optiset E
basic, and optiPoint 500 entry telephones only if the ACCT feature was programmed on a key or if automatic DSS system-wide has been turned off.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-489
Implementing Features
Features for Call Detail Recording
Options:
Account codes are not printed out of call detail recording (CDRC) if the RS-232 output
is connected directly to a printer because the printer format does not have a sufficient
number of columns. However, if a call-accounting device is used, the compressed format of CDRC will include the account code information.
The ACCT is assigned to all subsequent parts (even if transferred or forwarded to another station) of the current call for CDRC.
There are 1000 possible account code entries; only digits 0-9 are allowed in an account code number.
If an optiset E or optiPoint user finds that during a call the current account code applied to a call is incorrect or that a different account code is needed, the user can enter
a different code number. The system will overwrite the currently flagged account
code. CDRC sends a call record after each segment; therefore, previously completed
call segments will be identified with the old account code number.
7-490
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for Call Detail Recording
The non-verified and forced parameters determine, per trunk group, whether an account code is optional (non verified) or mandatory (forced). There are 16 possible
trunk groups for the HiPath 3750, HiPath 3550, HiPath 3700 and HiPath 3500 systems, and eight for the HiPath 3350 and HiPath 3300 system. The default setting is
non-verified (optional).
>
If you select forced for a trunk group, all stations using that trunk group are required
to use account codes to dial out. If you want some users to use account codes and
other users not to use account codes, you need to program different trunk groups.
With the Check number of characters option, the contents of the account code number are not checked. You determine how many digits are permitted by using the dropdown list box Characters to be checked in HiPath 3000 Manager E, or Code Length
in Manager T. The number of digits checked can be from one to eleven digits.
Model-Specific Data
Subject
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
Feature available in
HW requirements
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
Number of ACCTs in
the system
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
11
11
11
11
11
Requirement or Condition
Electronic notebook
(ENB)
Conference
An ACCT entered during a conference with external station is assigned to all participating calls and trunks.
Redial
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-491
Implementing Features
Features for Call Detail Recording
Subject
Requirement or Condition
Telephones
S0 telephones
If the unchecked ACCT option is selected on S0 telephones, you must always enter the full number of digits
(you cannot press #).
If the ACCT is checked, or a fixed number of digits is entered, the system detects the end of the ACCT.
No check option
Invalid entry
If the ACCT entry is incorrect, the user sees the display Invalid entry and the call is dropped.
Non-display telephones
Configuration Options
This feature can be configured using Manager T or HiPath 3000 Manager E.
7-492
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for Call Detail Recording
Action
1.
Configure ACCT
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
Action
1.
Configure ACCT
System status
2.
Call charges
3.
Project codes
4.
Action
1.
2.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-493
Implementing Features
Features for Call Detail Recording
7-494
UP0/E port
An optiset E control adapter, to which you can attach a printer or PC, must be
connected to the UP0/E port. The system supports only one adapter per call data
output. You can configure the output as follows:
If only one optiset E control adapter is connected, you can choose any slot
in the telephone.
If two optiset E control adapters are connected, set the right adapter to Printer Pipe Mode for call data output. The other adapter is used in API1 or API2
mode.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for Call Detail Recording
Compressed format (via V.24 / via LAN) for PC or call charge computer
The system outputs all data (including ACCT) without separating spaces, without
headers, and without form feed. Call charge pulses, call charge amounts or arithmetic units are output.
In V3.0 SMR-6 or later, you have the option of giving a consecutive number from 0000
to 9999 to each entry in a call data record in compressed format (via V.24 and TFTP)
and long output format. Once the upper limit has been reached, the counter restarts
at 0000. By default, the counter is not active, which means that there is no numbering
output.
Note: At present, call data record numbering is only released (activated) on a projectspecific basis.
You should note that when numbering is active, applications for evaluating charges
are usually not able to process the call data because the call data record format has
changed.
The following rules apply to the line format:
The carriage return (CR) and line feed (LF) control characters are transmitted at
the end of each record.
Data not supplied and unused fields are filled with spaces.
In compressed format, the data output is consecutive. No form feed (FF) is transmitted.
In long format, each page contains a one-line header followed by a blank line. After 62 characters are printed, a form feed automatically executes.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-495
Implementing Features
Features for Call Detail Recording
Additional information (such as incoming call, outgoing call, transferred call, conference, DISA, call setup charges), 2 characters
7-496
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for Call Detail Recording
Options
>
All fields are predefined and cannot be changed except for the options mentioned
in this section.
The last four digits of the destination number can be suppressed in the call
record. If selected, the last four spaces are filled with the symbol ?.
The Call Duration field can be suppressed from the record. If selected, this field
is blank.
Incoming calls can be recorded. The default value is No (only outgoing calls are
recorded.
A call record is started as soon as an incoming call starts ringing into the system.
Other configurable parameters: which RS-232 port is to be used for the CDRC
output and the baud rate (2400, 9600, or 19200).
Model-Specific Data
Subject
Feature available in
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
General requirements
Number of calls buffered
150
50
50
50
Requirement or Condition
PC/printer failure,
buffer full
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-497
Implementing Features
Features for Call Detail Recording
Subject
Requirement or Condition
Configuration Options
This feature can be configured using Manager T or HiPath 3000 Manager E.
Configuring the Feature Using Manager T
Configure the feature using Manager T as follows:
Step
Action
1.
Configure CDRC
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
11-3-7 => call detail recording - CDR central - outgoing without connect.
9.
10.
7-498
Action
1.
Configure CDRC
System status
2.
Call charges
3.
Output format
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for Call Detail Recording
Action
1.
2.
The call charge details are transferred to the V.24 (RS-232) interface.
CDRC outgoing without connection can be tested using a call that is not chargeable.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-499
Implementing Features
Features for Call Detail Recording
Output formats
Compressed Output Format for Call Details Output via Application Programming Interface (V.24) (Example with Call Data Record Numbering)
--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------1
1
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
0
1
1234567890123456789012345678901234567890123456789012345678901234567890123456789012345678901234567890123456789012345
1 Number (5 characters, including field separator)
|
2 Date (8 characters)
|
|
3 Time (8)
|
|
|
4 Trunk (3)
|
|
|
| 5 Internal station number (6)
|
|
|
| |
6 Ring duration (5)
|
|
|
| |
|
7 Call duration (8)
|
|
|
| |
|
|
8 Station number (25)
|
|
|
| |
|
|
|
9 Call charge pulse (11)
|
|
|
| |
|
|
|
|
10 Information element (2)
|
|
|
| |
|
|
|
|
| 11 ACCT (11)
|
|
|
| |
|
|
|
|
| |
12 MSN (11)
|
|
|
| |
|
|
|
|
| |
|
13 Seizure
|
|
|
| |
|
|
|
|
| |
|
code (5)
|
|
|
| |
|
|
|
|
| |
|
|
14 LCR
|
|
|
| |
|
|
|
|
| |
|
|
route (2)
|
|
|
| |
|
|
|
|
| |
|
|
| ...
|
|
|
| |
|
|
|
|
| |
|
|
|
...
V
V
V
V V
V
V
V
V
V V
V
V
V
0091 11.12.0008:23:23 4
16
00:05:2302317324856
12 2
902725 841
(1)
0092 11.12.0009:12:45 3
18
00:01:23834756
34 212345678901
2 (2)
0093 11.12.0009:25:34 2
1100:34
1
(3)
0094 11.12.0010:01:46 1
12
00:12:5383726639046287127384
5 2
0095 11.12.0010:03:42 2
14
05:42:4338449434444495598376
245 2
0096 11.12.0010:23:24 2
15
00:02:221234567890123412????
83 2
(4)
0097 11.12.0011:12:45 3
18
00:01:23834756
34 2
0098 12.12.0012:23:34 3
1200:1500:03:12
1
(5)
0099 12.12.0012:23:50 4
11
00:03:583844733399
7 2
0100 12.12.0013:23:54 3
17
00:02:233844733399
835
(6)
0101 12.12.0014:05:24 3
18
00:01:23834756
31 2
0102 12.12.0014:38:43 2
12
00:03:242374844
63 2
(7a)
0103 12.12.0014:43:33 3
12
00:00:255345545556
5 2
(7b)
0104 12.12.0014:44:12 2
12
00:12:122374844
1238
(7c)
0105 12.12.0014:44:12 3
12
00:12:125345545556
1038
(7d)
0106 12.12.0014:56:24 2
12
00:23:462374844
8432
(7e)
0107 13.12.0009:43:52 1
5
00:01:0539398989983
76 4
(8)
0108 14.12.0012:23:34 1
600:1400:02:3427348596872347569036
3
(9)
0109 ** 100 calls lost **
(10)
0110 15.12.0009:44:34 4
15
00:02:12189????
23 2
0111 15.12.0009:56:33 3
14
00:05:451283394495
28 2
0112 15.12.0012:20:26 1
12
0230298007766
0
(11a)
0113 15.12.0012:23:34 1
1200:3400:02:340230298007766
1
(11b)
0114 15.12.0013:43:25 3
15
00:05:2408972212345
1
(12a)
0115 15.12.0013:43:25 4
15
00:05:240231471154321
74 9
(12b)
0116 15.12.0013:45:28 4
18
0230298007252
0
(13a)
0117 15.12.0013:45:28 4
32
0230298007252
0
(13a)
0118 15.12.0013:45:28 4
16
0230298007252
0
(13a)
0119 15.12.0013:46:18 4
1600:50
0230298007252
1
(13b)
0120 15.12.0013:49:28 4
16
00:00:0002317324856
2
(14)
0121 01.01.0000:00:00 8
23 2
(15)
0122 05.06.0221:24:04 1
104
23:57:25384021101
718 2
(16a)
0123 05.06.0222:40:27 1
104
01:16:23384021101
3932
(16b)
---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
7-500
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for Call Detail Recording
Call data record 91: Outgoing connection from stn 16 on trunk 4 using the
MSN 902725. End of call at 8:23:23 on 12/11/00. Duration of the call: 5 minutes, 23 seconds. Called number: 02317324856. Accrued call charge pulses
(blank in U.S.): 12. The seizure code 841 was used for call setup.
(2)
Call data record 92: Outgoing connection with 11-digit account code (ACCT)
12345678901. Route 2 was used for LCR.
(3)
Call data record 93: Unanswered incoming call without station number (missing origin address, active station number suppression CLIR at calling station).
(4)
Call data record 96: Outgoing connection with suppression of the last 4 digits.
(5)
Call data record 98: Incoming connection with ringing and call duration.
(6)
(7)
(8)
(9)
(10)
Call data record 109: Loss message: 100 records were lost.
Due to a problem such as the following:
Printer is offline
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-501
Implementing Features
Features for Call Detail Recording
7-502
(11)
Call data records 112 to 113: Incoming call with transmitted caller station
number:
(11a) Caller list: When the call arrives, an information line is immediately output indicating the date, time, trunk, station number, incoming external station
number (if available), and information element 0 (used, for example, with a
PC: start database search -> message appears on stations monitor).
(11b) Station 12 accepted the call after a ringing duration of 34 seconds. This
line is output at the end of the call.
(12)
Call data records 114 to 115: Call forwarding with an external destination:
(12a) Incoming call for station 15 on trunk 3 with transmitted station number,
no ringing duration due to call forwarding (see 12b),
(12b) Call forwarded (12a) to trunk 4 for station number 0231471154321, 74
call charge pulses (not for U.S.) have accrued for the forwarded call.
(13)
Call data records 116 to 119: Incoming call to subscriber group (stations 18,
32, and 16):
(13a) The three entered stations are called simultaneously; they are listed in
the order in which they were entered in the group (the second station is listed
first).
(13b) The call was not accepted by any group member. After the call has
ended, a line is output indicating the ringing duration for the last called or entered station.
(14)
Call data record 120: Outgoing connection attempt (CDRC outgoing without
connection) from Stn 16 on line 4 at 13:49:28 (1:49:28 p.m.) on December
15, 2000. Number called: 02317324856.
(15)
Call data record 121: Output after a power failure or reset: 23 call detail units
on trunk 8 were present before the power failure.
When a power failure or reset occurs, the call charges accrued for each trunk
are stored in nonvolatile system memory (CDRT).
The system checks for consistency between the output and internally stored
data following a power failure or system restart. The system also checks to
determine whether call charges are still stored that have not yet been output
via the V.24 (RS-232) interface. If this is the case, the system outputs a data
line using the format illustrated in the example (15) for each affected trunk:
(output does not include station number).
(16)
Call data records 122 and 123: Outgoing call with a total call length > 24 h
(16a) When a call lasts longer than 23:55 h, a first call data record is output.
In this example, this record contains the current call time of 23:57:25 h. The
call length contained in this call data record can vary between 23:55:00 h
and 23:59:59 h. The call type here has the value 2 = outgoing connection.
(16b) When the call ends, this continuation record is output, identified by the
call type 32 (call type 2, with the offset +30 added as a code for the continuation data record).
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for Call Detail Recording
Compressed Output Format for Call Details Output via LAN Interface
--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------1
1
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
0
1
12345678901234567890123456789012345678901234567890123456789012345678901234567890123456789012345678901234567890
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------1 Date (8 characters)
|
2 Time (8)
|
|
3 Trunk (3)
|
|
| 4 Internal station number (6)
|
|
| | 5 Ring duration (5)
|
|
| | | 6 Call duration (8)
|
|
| | | |
7 Station number (25)
|
|
| | | |
|
8 Call charge pulses (11) (blank in U.S.)
|
|
| | | |
|
| 9 Information element (2)
|
|
| | | |
|
| | 10 ACCT (11)
|
|
| | | |
|
| | |
11 MSN (11)
|
|
| | | |
|
| | |
|
12 Seizure code (5)
|
|
| | | |
|
| | |
|
|
13 LCR route (2
|
|
| | | |
|
| | |
|
|
| ...
|
|
| | | |
|
| | |
|
|
|
...
V
V
V V V V
V
V V V
V
V
V
13.12.99;08:23:23;4;16;;00:05:23;02317324856;12;2;12345678901;902725;841;;
---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
>
Call detail records can be output via a LAN interface using two different settings:
DOS mode (carriage return (CR), line feed (LF)) = default or UNIX mode (line
feed (LF)) at the end of a call data record.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-503
Implementing Features
Features for Call Detail Recording
1 to 5
Right
Left
(with
leading
zeros)
6 to
13
Left
22 to
24
17 to
19
Right
25 to
30
20 to
25
Right
7-504
1 to 8
Definition
Orientation
Fields
Field
position
Table 7-13
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for Call Detail Recording
Orientation
Definition
Fields
Field
position
Table 7-13
31 to
35
26 to
30
Left
Left
44 to
68
25
Left
39 to
63
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-505
Implementing Features
Features for Call Detail Recording
69 to
79
64 to
74
Definition
11
Orientation
Fields
Field
position
Table 7-13
Right
Calculation Detail
With
Without
Pulses
Amounts
HiPath arithmetic
units output with
surcharge
Monetary
amounts output
with surcharge
The system outputs the data whenever charges accrue for the call segment (even when calls
are transferred). If no call charge information is
available, these 11 positions remain blank.
7-506
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for Call Detail Recording
10
69 to
79
64 to
74
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Definition
0 = Call information (caller list) is output immediately when an incoming call is received (output can be suppressed). This
can be used, for instance, for a database
search by a PC. When multiple stations are
called, a line is output for each individual
station (without ring duration, call duration,
call detail information).
Orientation
Fields
Field
position
Table 7-13
Right
7-507
Implementing Features
Features for Call Detail Recording
Con- Contin- 80 to
tinua- uation 81
tion
of 9
of 10
7-508
75 to
76
+20 = Offset as a code for call setup charges (connection setup without call duration)
Orientation
Definition
Fields
For V.24 output
with activated
counter
Field
position
Table 7-13
Right
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for Call Detail Recording
Orientation
Definition
Fields
For V.24 output
with activated
counter
Field
position
Table 7-13
10
11
Left
12
11
93 to
103
88 to
98
11
Right
13
12
104
to
108
99 to
103
Right
14
13
109
to
110
104 to
105
Right
15
14
111
to
112
106 to
107
Right
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-509
Implementing Features
Features for Call Detail Recording
Number of characters
Orientation
Table 7-13
16
15
113
108
17
16
114
to
117
109 to
112
Right
15
14
111
to
112
106 to
107
Right
16
15
113
108
17
16
114
to
117
109 to
112
Right
18
17
118
to
119
113 to
114
Field
position
7-510
Fields
Definition
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for Call Detail Recording
Long Output Format for Call Data (Example With Call Data Record Numbering)
The header in the long output format (Figure 7-16) is output in the language used
across the system.
After 62 lines have printed (including header), a form feed (FF) is carried out and
the next page begins with a header.
>
--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------Date
0093
0094
0095
0096
Time
11.12.93
11.12.93
11.12.93
11.12.93
Trk
08:23:23
09:12:45
09:25:34
10:01:46
4
3
2
1
Amount I
16
00:05:23 02317324856
18
00:01:23 834756
11 00:34
12
00:12:53 837266390462871
20,23
0,69
413,69
2
2
1
2
---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Definition
For output
with
deactivated
counter
Number of
characters
Fields
For output
with activated
counter
Field
1 to 5
Date
6 to 13
Time
Trk
Orientation
Table 7-14
Right
(with
leading zeros)
1 to 8
Left
15 to 22
10 to
17
Left
24 to 26
19 to
21
Right
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-511
Implementing Features
Features for Call Detail Recording
Orientation
Definition
For output
with
deactivated
counter
Fields
For output
with activated
counter
Field
Table 7-14
Stn
28 to 33
23 to
28
Right
Ring
35 to 39
30 to
34
Left
Duration 41 to 48
36 to
43
Left
7-512
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for Call Detail Recording
Definition
For output
with
deactivated
counter
Number of
characters
Fields
For output
with activated
counter
Field
Table 7-14
Station 50 to 64
number
45 to
59
15
Left
Amount 66 to 76
61 to
71
11
Right
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-513
Implementing Features
Features for Call Detail Recording
7-514
0 = Call information (caller list) is output immediately when an incoming call is received
(output can be suppressed). This can be
used, for instance, for a database search by
a PC. When multiple stations are called, a
line is output for each individual station (without ring duration, call duration, call detail information).
Orientation
Definition
For output
with
deactivated
counter
Fields
For output
with activated
counter
Field
Table 7-14
Right
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for Call Detail Recording
Continu- 83 to 84
ation of
field
I
85 to 86
Definition
For output
with
deactivated
counter
Number of
characters
Fields
For output
with activated
counter
Field
78 to
79
80 to
81
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Orientation
Table 7-14
7-515
Implementing Features
Features for Call Detail Recording
HW requirements
SW requirements
7-516
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
V1.0 or later
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for Call Detail Recording
Configuration Options
This feature can be configured using HiPath 3000 Manager E and a special password.
Configuring the Feature Using HiPath 3000 Manager E
Configure the feature using HiPath 3000 Manager E as follows:
Step
Action
1.
Options
2.
System parameters
3.
Time parameters
Action
1.
Set up an outgoing connection (station has external call forwarding) using direct inward dialing and the DISA function.
2.
When the timer expires, the message Time exceeded appears on the
AC display
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-517
Implementing Features
Features for Call Detail Recording
7.15.10 Printer Pipe Mode (V.24 [RS-232] Range Extension for Call Data)
Definition
This feature outputs call charges to the optiset E control adapter. Only one printer
pipe mode can be active in a system, and only one call detail recording (CDR) output
can be supported in a system (via RS-232 or the optiset E control adapter).
Model-Specific Data
Subject
Feature available in
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
Requirement or Condition
The parameters for call data output to the optiset E control
adapter are permanently set to 9600,N, 8, 1.
Configuration Options
This feature can be configured using Manager T or HiPath 3000 Manager E.
Configuring the Feature Using Manager T
Configure the feature using Manager T as follows:
Step
7-518
Action
1.
2.
3.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for Call Detail Recording
Action
1.
Call charges
2.
Output format
3.
Port assignment
4.
Action
1.
2.
If CDRC is set, a call data record appears on the output device (such as
the printer) at the end of the call.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-519
Implementing Features
Features for Call Detail Recording
With AOC-D and AOC-S, digital exchanges can also transmit currency amounts that
are then added to the call data evaluated in the system. These amounts are not multiples of the call charge pulses or call detail units; they are actual currency amounts.
The new calculation accuracy parameter helps avoid inaccuracies from arising when
recording the call data. It determines
The number of decimal points the system uses for evaluating the call data = minimum currency amount.
The maximum number of currency amounts added up in memory = maximum total currency amount.
Set the Calculation accuracy parameter so that the system accuracy is equal to the
accuracy of the currency amounts transmitted by the ISDN exchange. If the maximum
of three decimal places is insufficient, the system automatically rounds up the number
to the next unit. The following values are possible:
Calculation Accuracy
3
(Pounds Sterling)
2
(e.g. for euros)
Minimum Currency
Amount
1 x 103 = 0.001
Maximum Currency
Amount
3
1 x 10 x (232 1) =
around 4.3 million
1 x 102 = 0.01
1 x 102 x (232 1) =
around 43 million
1 x 101 x (232 1) =
around 430 million
1 x 100 x (232 1) =
around. 4.3 billion
1 x 101 = 0.1
1 x 100 = 1
If you set Calculation accuracy = Via call charge pulse, the system switches back to
evaluating call data in the form of call-charge pulses.
7-520
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Features for Call Detail Recording
You cannot use HiPath arithmetic units if the digital exchange supplies call charge
pulses.
Model-Specific Data
Subject
Feature available in
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
Requirement or Condition
Select the factor for converting call detail units to currency
amounts as follows:
Conversion factor =
(call charge factor in %) / (100 x 10calcuation accuracy)
Configuration Options
This feature can be configured using Manager T or HiPath 3000 Manager E.
Configuring the Feature Using Manager T
Configure the feature using Manager T as follows:
Step
Action
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-521
Implementing Features
Features for Call Detail Recording
7-522
Action
1.
2.
Call charges
3.
Factors
4.
5.
Call charges
6.
7.
8.
9.
Communication
10.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Euro-ISDN Features (Not for U.S.)
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
HW requirements
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
Requirement or Condition
Long S0 bus
Not available with TA-S0 and STMD8 (HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700).
Features
PC connected to S0
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-523
Implementing Features
Euro-ISDN Features (Not for U.S.)
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
HW requirements
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
CO feature
Station feature
7-524
Requirement or Condition
The extensions in the communications server must have at
least outward restricted class of service, and direct inward
dialing must be permitted.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Euro-ISDN Features (Not for U.S.)
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
HW requirements
S0 trunk board
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
CO feature
Station feature
Requirement or Condition
MSN
MSN
CDRC
MSN
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-525
Implementing Features
Euro-ISDN Features (Not for U.S.)
Model-Specific Data
Subject
Feature available in
7-526
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
HW requirements
S0 trunk connection
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
CO feature
Station feature
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Euro-ISDN Features (Not for U.S.)
Configuration Options
This feature can be configured using Manager T or HiPath 3000 Manager E.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-527
Implementing Features
Euro-ISDN Features (Not for U.S.)
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
HW requirements
HW requirements
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
CO feature
Station feature
7-528
Requirement or Condition
Must be released by the carrier.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Euro-ISDN Features (Not for U.S.)
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
HW requirements
S0 trunk connection
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
Co feature
Station feature
Requirement or Condition
CLIR
CLIR
CLIR
*86 = activate
#86 = deactivate
It is not possible to ignore an activated CLIR setting per
station.
Configuration Options
This feature can be configured using Manager T or HiPath 3000 Manager E.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-529
Implementing Features
Euro-ISDN Features (Not for U.S.)
Action
1.
2.
Action
1.
2.
System parameters
3.
Display
4.
1.
2.
System parameters
3.
Display
4.
7-530
Action
1.
Configure CLIR.
2.
3.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Euro-ISDN Features (Not for U.S.)
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
HW requirements
HW requirements
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
CO feature
Station feature
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Requirement or Condition
Must be released by the carrier.
7-531
Implementing Features
Euro-ISDN Features (Not for U.S.)
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
HW requirements
S0 trunk connection
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
CO feature
Station feature
7-532
Requirement or Condition
Same CDB entry as CLIR.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Euro-ISDN Features (Not for U.S.)
The charges are not displayed if the call was not fully set up or if HiPath 3000
is unable to evaluate the call detail information of a service provider.
Model-Specific Data
Subject
Feature available in
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
HW requirements
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
CO feature
Station feature
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Requirement or Condition
Some countries transmit call charge pulses instead of the
amount. In this case, the received pulses are converted to
currency amounts using a call charge factor (as on analog
trunks).
7-533
Implementing Features
Euro-ISDN Features (Not for U.S.)
All calls
This is possible even if the same station is already set as a forwarding destination
or if the forwarding destination has already activated call forwarding.
The message Chaining invalid no longer appears when you enter a second call
forwarding destination during programming.
When a user forwards a dialed party to a station which already activated unconditional, immediate call forwarding to another station, the system monitors the
number of call forwarding operations allowed. A preprogrammed counter limits
the number of call forwarding operations to a total of 5.
The following example clarifies this procedure:
Use call management to define the lines for busy and no reply.
7-534
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Euro-ISDN Features (Not for U.S.)
Model-Specific Data
Subject
Feature available in
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
HW requirements
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
CO feature
Station feature
Requirement or Condition
CF
CF
Call forwarding is always executed for the first basic access, that is the first S0 port must also be available in the
system.
Internal to S0
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-535
Implementing Features
Euro-ISDN Features (Not for U.S.)
Model-Specific Data
Subject
Feature available in
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
HW requirements
S0 trunk connection
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
CO feature
Station feature
7-536
Requirement or Condition
CF
CFU
CFU
Implementing Features
Euro-ISDN Features (Not for U.S.)
Configuration Options
This feature does not have to be explicitly configured.
>
To activate the external call forwarding of a particular MSN, the S0 port must be set
to point-to-multipoint.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-537
Implementing Features
Euro-ISDN Features (Not for U.S.)
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
HW requirements
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
CO feature
Station feature
7-538
Subject
Requirement or Condition
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Euro-ISDN Features (Not for U.S.)
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
HW requirements
S0 trunk connection
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
CO feature
Station feature
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Requirement or Condition
The flow of information is in one direction only.
7-539
Implementing Features
Euro-ISDN Features (Not for U.S.)
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
HW requirements
S0 trunk connection
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
CO feature
Station feature
Requirement or Condition
MCID
Malicious call ID is supported only on a direct trunk connection and not in tie traffic (QSig or CorNet-N).
MCID
MCID
MCID internal to S0
Configuration Options
This feature can be configured using Manager T or HiPath 3000 Manager E.
7-540
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Euro-ISDN Features (Not for U.S.)
Action
1.
2.
Action
1.
2.
Set up station
3.
Station
4.
Param
5.
Flags
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-541
Implementing Features
Euro-ISDN Features (Not for U.S.)
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
HW requirements
S0 trunk connection
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
CO feature
Station feature
7-542
Requirement or Condition
CCBS
CCBS
CCBS
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Euro-ISDN Features (Not for U.S.)
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
HW requirements
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
CO feature
Station feature
Requirement or Condition
CH
CH
Non-ISDN stations do not receive an advisory announcement (except that the station is placed on hold in the CS).
CH
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-543
Implementing Features
Euro-ISDN Features (Not for U.S.)
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
HW requirements
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
CO feature
Station feature
7-544
Requirement or Condition
For multi-device connections only. In the case of CSs, the
conference is executed in the CS. The information element
is transmitted to the trunk.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Euro-ISDN Features (Not for U.S.)
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
HW requirements
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
CO feature
Station feature
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Requirement or Condition
For multi-device connections only. In the case of CSs, call
waiting is executed in the CS. The information element is
transmitted to the trunk.
7-545
Implementing Features
Euro-ISDN Features (Not for U.S.)
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
HW requirements
S0 trunk board
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
CO feature
Station feature
7-546
Requirement or Condition
TP
TP
TP
TP internal to S0
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Euro-ISDN Features (Not for U.S.)
USS2: Information is exchanged during the ringing phase. The number of messages is limited to two per trunk group. USS2 is available for telecommunications
ports only.
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
HW requirements
S0 trunk connection
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
CO feature
Station feature
Requirement or Condition
USS1
In the case of a multi-device connection, the user must ensure that only one device transmits a message to an incoming call.
USS1
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-547
Implementing Features
Euro-ISDN Features (Not for U.S.)
7-548
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
HW requirements
S0 trunk connection
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
CO feature
Station feature
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Euro-ISDN Features (Not for U.S.)
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
HW requirements
S0 subscriber line
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
CO feature
Station feature
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Requirement or Condition
Only the DID, CLIP, CLIR, and AOC features are supported.
7-549
Implementing Features
Euro-ISDN Features (Not for U.S.)
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
S0 board
HW requirements
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
CO feature
Station feature
Requirement or Condition
Only one national or international prefix exists for the entire
system. The programmed prefix (and the carrier codes)
can be up to 2 digits long.
Configuration Options
This feature can be configured using Manager T or HiPath 3000 Manager E.
7-550
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Euro-ISDN Features (Not for U.S.)
Action
1.
Configure codes
2.
3.
Action
1.
Configure codes
Options
2.
Lines/networking
3.
ISDN parameter
4.
Action
1.
2.
3.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-551
Implementing Features
Euro-ISDN Features (Not for U.S.)
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
Feature available in
HW requirements
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
Configuration Options
This feature can be configured using Manager T or HiPath 3000 Manager E.
Configuring the Feature Using Manager T
Configure the Feature Using Manager T as follows:
Step
7-552
Action
1.
2.
3.
* Change
4.
3 ext. rings/call
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Euro-ISDN Features (Not for U.S.)
>
Some network providers do not guarantee that the called station will receive the information element for identifying a collect call in the ISDN-D channel protocol. In this
case, collect call barring is not possible.
Model-Specific Data
Subject
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
Feature available in
HW requirements
SW requirements
V3.0
or later
V3.0
or later
V3.0
or later
V3.0
or later
Configuration Options
This feature can be configured using Manager T or HiPath 3000 Manager E.
Configuring the Feature Using Manager T
Configure the feature using Manager T as follows:
Step
Action
1.
2.
Action
1.
2.
Set up station
3.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-553
Implementing Features
Euro-ISDN Features (Not for U.S.)
7-554
Action
1.
2.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
U.S. ISDN (for U.S. Only)
>
Both PRI and BRI with the HiPath 3550 and HiPath 3500
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-555
Implementing Features
U.S. ISDN (for U.S. Only)
7.17.1 PRI
Introduction
The HiPath 3750, HiPath 3550, HiPath 3700 and HiPath 3500 systems can be configured to support Primary Rate services from the public network. A primary rate interface (PRI) consists of 23 bearer (B) channels and 1 data (D) channel. Each channel supports 64 Kbps of bandwidth.
The HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 support a maximum of five T1 interfaces (TMST1)
that can be configured as primary rate interfaces. A Channel Service Unit (CSU) is
required for each interface connected to the public network. (Siemens ICN supports
certain models of CSU that have been tested with the HiPath 3000. Contact your Siemens ICN representative for the model numbers). The HiPath 3750 and HiPath
3700 support a maximum of four Call by Call (CBC) groups. Each group can be configured with a maximum of eight CBC trunk groups.
The HiPath 3550 and HiPath 3500 support one T1 interface (TST1 module) that can
be configured as a primary rate interface. A CSU is required for each interface connected to the public network. The HiPath 3550 and HiPath 3500 support a maximum
of one CBC group. The group can also be configured with a maximum of eight CBC
trunk groups. Typically, the entire T1 span is placed in a single trunk group, but depending on the application, the primary rate channels can be separated into discrete
route groups. This may be required for applications where a portion of the channels
can be separated out for non-system data applications.
A span or spans must be selected as the reference interface for the Central Office. A
hierarchical table is provided for assigning four reference-clock points. If the primary
clock source fails, the next clock source specified is used as the reference. When the
primary clock source returns, the system automatically resynchronizes to this clock.
A maximum of four reference clocks can be defined per system.
Model-Specific Data
Subject
HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
TMST1
TST1
Number of CBC
groups per system
Number of trunk
groups per CBC group
Feature available in
HW requirements
7-556
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
U.S. ISDN (for U.S. Only)
Subject
HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
SW requirements
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
V1.0 or later
Depending on the PRI providers requirements, users need to configure some or all
of the following for PRI setup:
Frame/line/encoding
Number of B channels
For networking with PRI, customers can use either tie trunks or the public-switched
telephone network.
Protocol type allows customers to select the interface between the HiPath 3750, HiPath 3550, HiPath 3700 or HiPath 3500 and the PRI provider. Protocols are different
for local exchange carriers (LECs) and for inter-exchange carriers (IECs). Customers
might prefer an IEC, for example, if they want to place calls on a tie trunk using station
numbers without going through the local exchange.
Customers can choose a different carrier and protocol for each PRI span. The HiPath
3000 systems support seven commonly used LEC protocols and seven commonly
used IEC protocols.Table 7-15 and Table 7-16 on page 7-558 show the protocols
available for each slot.
LEC Protocols
Table 7-15
LEC Carrier
Switch
Protocol
AT&T
5ESS
Custom
AT&T
5ESS
NI-2
Bell Canada
DMS100
Custom
GTE
GTT5
NI-2
Nortel
DMS100
Custom
Siemens
EWSD
Custom
Siemens
EWSD
NI-2
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-557
Implementing Features
U.S. ISDN (for U.S. Only)
IEC Protocols
Table 7-16
IEC Carrier
Protocol
AT&T
4ESS
Custom
MCI
DMS250
MCI
DEX600
Sprint
DMS250
Westinghouse
DMS250
GSA
DMS250
DMS250
5ESS
5ESS
Emulation type is determined by the protocol. Users need to select the emulation
type that matches the ISDN service they have ordered: Super Frame (SF) or Extended Super Frame (ESF).
The data format for SF emulation is inverted high-level data link control (HDLC); The
data format for ESF is normal HDLC.
Frame/line/encoding allows customers to select the type of encoding used on the D
channel. The choices are normal or inverted. Normal is the default. The type of frame
and line encoding depends on the protocol. HiPath 3550 and HiPath 3500 automatically set the correct type of frame and line encoding according to the protocol.
B channel allocation mode and identifier allows customers to select the system
method of finding an available B channel when needed. The choices are high and low.
High begins searching at the highest-numbered B channel of the highest-numbered
T1 span in the PRI trunk group and continues in descending order. Low begins
searching at the lowest-numbered B channel of the lowest-numbered T1 span in the
PRI trunk group and continues in ascending order.
Select the opposite mode from that used by the CO; this will avoid collisions when
both the CO and the HiPath 3000 are trying to seize a channel.
Number of B channels allows users to enter the number of B channels for the system, so that the system knows where to begin searching for channels to allocate. The
number entered here depends on the number of B channels that the customer has
ordered.
7-558
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
U.S. ISDN (for U.S. Only)
Trunk group calling service allows users to select the type of service for each trunk
group. The HiPath 3550, HiPath 3350, HiPath 3500 and HiPath 3300 support 36
types of trunk group service. Customers select the type of service according to the
service ordered from the ISDN provider.
>
If you are unsure the trunk group calling service, consult the ISDN provider for more
information.
The following tables outline the voice and data services available through the public
network providers in the North American market.
Table 7-17
MCI
DMS250/
MCI
DEX600
SPRINT
DMS250
Westing.
DMS250
In-WATS
(800)
Megacom
800-TFM
MCI 800
Out-WATS
Megacom
WICN-Out- N/A
WATS
In-WATS
(900)
Multiquest
MC!/900
N/A
N/A
N/A
MCI 800
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
Intl VPN
AT&T SDNGSDN
N/A
SPRINTVPN
N/A
N/A
SDS 56
Accu-SDS
NONE
Accu-SDS
Accu-SDS
N/A
SDS 94-c/r
Accu-SDS
NONE
Accu-SDS
Accu-SDS
N/A
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
FTS2000
DMS/5ESS
N/A
7-559
Implementing Features
U.S. ISDN (for U.S. Only)
Table 7-18
7-560
Nortel
DMS100
Bell Cnd
DMS100
Generic NI2
Siemens NI2
AT&T 5ESS NI2
In-WATS (800)
Megacom
DMS100 InWATS
NI2 InWATS
Out-WATS
Megacom
In WATS (900)
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
PVN
N/A
DMS100 PV
N/A
Multiband OutWATS
Megacom
None
None
None
None
None
Basic CO access
None
None
None
None
None
None
SDS-56
None
None
None
SDS-64 c/r
None
None
None
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
U.S. ISDN (for U.S. Only)
7.17.2 BRI
Introduction
To set up the HiPath 3000 for BRI ISDN, users must receive service profile identifier
designator (SPID) numbers from the telephone company (telco). SPID numbers identify the type of ISDN service and the variety of features that customers receive. In addition, to allow direct access to specific devices, some BRI interfaces can be set up
with CACH EKTS. Depending on the central office (CO) switch type, users have to
configure either call appearance identification (CAID) values (also known as CACH
values) or phantom direct inward dialing (PDID) numbers for all devices that make external calls.
Depending on the central office (CO) protocol selected, users need to configure some
or all of the following parameters for BRI setup:
CO protocol
SPID administration
CO Features (Transfer/Conference/Drop)
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-561
Implementing Features
U.S. ISDN (for U.S. Only)
CO protocol is the interface between the HiPath 3550, HiPath 3350, HiPath 3500
and HiPath 3300 and the CO of the BRI provider. Select the protocol that the BRI provider uses. support the following CO protocols:
AT&T NI1
AT&T Custom
Siemens NI1
Nortel NI1
Nortel NI1 requires PDID values instead of CAID values; for more information refer to
PDID administration on page 7-563.
>
>
7-562
Some COs do not assign CAID values to ISDN data terminals. If you do not know
the CAID numbers assigned to the system, consult the BRI provider.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
U.S. ISDN (for U.S. Only)
PDID administration allows customers to set phantom direct inward dialing identification numbers (PDIDs). PDID numbers take the place of CAID values in the Nortel
DMS100 NI1 CO only. Customers can assign PDID numbers to all voice and data terminals in the system. This allows incoming calls to be routed to the specified station
or ISDN terminal without attendant intervention.
The PDID number can be from 1 to 7 digits in length, corresponding to a traditional
seven-digit phone number.
PDIDs or directory numbers (DNs) are assigned by the ISDN provider.
FIN for message waiting allows users to set the feature identification number (FIN)
for the BRI message waiting feature provided by the LEC. The LEC assigns FIN values to associate the feature with specific HiPath 3550, HiPath 3350, HiPath 3500 or
HiPath 3300 stations; contact the LEC to obtain the FIN values for the stations.
The message waiting FIN value can only be assigned to stations with primary directory numbers.
With FIN for message waiting, customers must enter a FIN value for each station. Every station must have a FIN value assigned; however, each station can have the same
number.
CO features (Transfer/Conference/Drop) allows the customer to enable the CO
features Transfer, Conference, and Drop.
FIN for Transfer, Conference and Drop allows customers to set the feature identification numbers (FIN) for the BRI Transfer, Conference, and Drop features provided
by the LEC in the case of NI1 (AT&T NI1, Siemens NI1, or Nortel NI1). The FIN must
be the same for all the BRI interfaces; contact the LEC to obtain the FIN values for
these features.
CACH EKTS flag allows customers to indicate which of the BRI interfaces are configured within the LEC as CACH EKTS.
CACH is one of the methods used to have BRI emulate an analog hunt. Although
there is a CACH setting in the NT DMS, it does not react in the same manner; the
CACH setting in the DMS does not allow the sharing of DNs. Administration of CACH
values in the HiPath 3000 is referred to as CAID (Call Appearance IDentification) administration.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-563
Implementing Features
U.S. ISDN Features (for U.S. Only)
Model-Specific Data
Subject
Feature available in
HW requirements
SW requirements
HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
STMD8
or ISDN
adapter
STLS4
STLS4R
or ISDN
adapter
STLS4
STLS4R
or ISDN
adapter
V1.0 or later
7-564
Requirement or Condition
ISDN terminals
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
U.S. ISDN Features (for U.S. Only)
Configuration Options
This feature can be configured using Manager T or HiPath 3000 Manager E.
Programming Feature Using Manager T
Configure the feature using Manager T as follows:
Step
Action
1.
Configure S0 port
*9531994
2.
1.
2.
Action
1.
Configure S0 port
Options
2.
Lines/networking
3.
Trunks
4.
Flags
5.
ISDN flags
1.
2.
Set up station
3.
Station
Action
1.
2.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-565
Implementing Features
U.S. ISDN Features (for U.S. Only)
OUTWATS Facility
This feature allows customers to place calls to certain areas at special lower
rates.
INWATS Facility
This feature supports the 800 area code that provides callers toll-free access to
the terminating party. This is a terminating only service.
Model-Specific Data
Subject
HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
Feature available in
HW requirements
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
Requirements/Conditions
Subject
Simulated Facility
Groups (SFG)
7-566
Requirement/Condition
FX and Tie Trunk incoming and outgoing calls require an
SFG access code, which is assigned by the telephone
company at the time of subscription.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
U.S. ISDN Features (for U.S. Only)
HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
Feature available in
HW requirements
SW requirements
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
V1.0 or later
7-567
Implementing Features
U.S. ISDN Features (for U.S. Only)
7.18.4 Transfer
Definition
This feature allows calls to be transferred the same as non-ISDN calls.
Model-Specific Data
Subject
HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
Feature available in
HW requirements
SW requirements
7-568
V1.0 or later
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
U.S. ISDN Features (for U.S. Only)
7.18.5 Camp-On
Definition
This feature allows calls to be camped-on until the busy line is free. Once the line is
free, the user call is signaled through.
Model-Specific Data
Subject
HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
Feature available in
HW requirements
SW requirements
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
V1.0 or later
7-569
Implementing Features
U.S. ISDN Features (for U.S. Only)
HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
Feature available in
HW requirements
SW requirements
7-570
V1.0 or later
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
U.S. ISDN Features (for U.S. Only)
HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
Feature available in
HW requirements
SW requirements
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
V1.0 or later
7-571
Implementing Features
U.S. ISDN Features (for U.S. Only)
N11 Access
Most commonly used for 911 access, this feature routes PRI calls to the network
via an operator access code and N11, where N is any digit from 1 to 9.
Model-Specific Data
Subject
HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
Feature available in
HW requirements
SW requirements
7-572
V1.0 or later
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
U.S. ISDN Features (for U.S. Only)
HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
STMD8
STLS 4
STLS 4
V1.0 or later
Dependencies/Limitations
Subject
DID
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Dependency/Limitation
The extensions in the CS must at the very least be outward
restricted and direct inward dialing must be permitted.
7-573
Implementing Features
U.S. ISDN Features (for U.S. Only)
SW requirements
HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
STMD8 or
ISDN adapter
STLS4
STLS4R
or ISDN
adapter
STLS4
STLS4R
or ISDN
adapter
V1.0 or later
Dependencies/Limitations
Subject
7-574
Dependency/Limitation
MSN
MSNs are assigned in the DID number field for each ISDN
terminal. This number is used as the internal SPID for the
device.
Primary Directory
Number (PDN)
External SPIDs
The public network SPIDs for the ISDN links can be assigned to any station in the system.
B channels
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
U.S. ISDN Features (for U.S. Only)
Subject
Dependency/Limitation
Access
MSN
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-575
Implementing Features
U.S. ISDN Features (for U.S. Only)
7-576
HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HW requirements
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
U.S. ISDN Features (for U.S. Only)
All calls for the ISDN port are immediately forwarded to any port.
Call forwarding busy (CFB)
Same as CFU but only if the call is not answered within a specified period (15 s).
Model-Specific Data
Subject
HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
Feature available in
HW requirements
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
Dependencies/Limitations
Subject
Dependency/Limitation
CF
CF
Internal to S0
Only CFU is supported for internal station, otherwise, conflicts with call management would occur.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-577
Implementing Features
U.S. ISDN Features (for U.S. Only)
HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
Feature available in
HW requirements
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
Dependencies/Limitations
Subject
7-578
Dependency/Limitation
CH
CH
Non-ISDN stations do not receive an advisory announcement (except that the station is placed on hold in the CS).
CH
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
U.S. ISDN Features (for U.S. Only)
HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
Feature available in
HW requirements
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
Dependencies/Limitations
Subject
Dependency/Limitation
3PTY
3PTY internal to S0
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-579
Implementing Features
U.S. ISDN Features (for U.S. Only)
HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
Feature available in
HW requirements
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
Dependencies/Limitations
Subject
CW
7-580
Dependency/Limitation
At multi-device connections only. In the case of CSs, call
waiting is executed in the CS. The information element is
transmitted to the trunk.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
U.S. ISDN Features (for U.S. Only)
HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
Feature available in
HW requirements
SW requirements
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
V1.0 or later
7-581
Implementing Features
U.S. ISDN Features (for U.S. Only)
HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
Feature available in
HW requirements
SW requirements
7-582
V1.0 or later
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
U.S. ISDN Features (for U.S. Only)
HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
Feature available in
HW requirements
SW requirements
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
V1.0 or later
7-583
Implementing Features
U.S. ISDN Features (for U.S. Only)
HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
Feature available in
HW requirements
SW requirements
7-584
V1.0 or later
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
U.S. ISDN Features (for U.S. Only)
HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
Feature available in
HW requirements
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
Requirements/Conditions
Subject
No appropriate
B-channel
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Requirement/Condition
If the HiPath 3000 cannot accept the call on an appropriate
B channel, it rejects the call with cause value #34, channel
congestion, or cause value #44, requested channel not
available.
7-585
Implementing Features
U.S. ISDN Features (for U.S. Only)
HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
Feature available in
HW requirements
SW requirements
7-586
V1.0 or later
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
U.S. ISDN Features (for U.S. Only)
HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
Feature available in
HW requirements
SW requirements
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
V1.0 or later
7-587
Implementing Features
U.S. ISDN Features (for U.S. Only)
HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
Feature available in
HW requirements
SW requirements
7-588
V1.0 or later
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
U.S. ISDN Features (for U.S. Only)
HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
Feature available in
HW requirements
SW requirements
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
V1.0 or later
7-589
Implementing Features
U.S. ISDN Features (for U.S. Only)
7-590
HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
Feature available in
HW requirements
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
U.S. ISDN Features (for U.S. Only)
HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
Feature available in
HW requirements
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
Requirements/Conditions
Subject
Requirement/Condition
Call appearance iden- In a basic EKTS system CAID values are not supported.
tification (CAID) valThe AT&T 5E and Siemens EWSD central offices support
ues
the CAID format. The Northern Telcom central offices use
phantom DID numbers instead of CAID values.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-591
Implementing Features
U.S. ISDN Features (for U.S. Only)
Checks the calling number against any ANI or DNIS table entries
2.
Translates the digits into an account number, customer name, or company name
3.
4.
HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
Feature available in
HW requirements
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
Requirements/Conditions
Subject
7-592
Requirement/Condition
T1 Trunks
Protocols
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
U.S. ISDN Features (for U.S. Only)
HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
Feature available in
HW requirements
SW requirements
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
V1.0 or later
7-593
Implementing Features
U.S. ISDN Features (for U.S. Only)
Model-Specific Data
Subject
7-594
HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
Feature available in
HW requirements
SW requirements
V1.0 or later
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
U.S. ISDN Features (for U.S. Only)
Model-Specific Data
Subject
HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
Feature available in
HW requirements
SW requirements
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
V1.0 or later
7-595
Implementing Features
Host Link Interface
Customers must use a converter to support Plus Products that use ACL-H2.
The converter converts all messages and message procedures based on
the ACL-H2 protocol to the CSTA protocol and vice versa. The converter has
been implemented as a driver that runs under Microsoft Windows 95/98.
Plus Products that support the CSTA protocol standardized by ECMA can be
connected directly (for example, Hicom Agentline Office V1.1 CSTA).
>
7-596
Contact your local service center for up-to-date information about the applications
supported in the different countries.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Implementing Features
Host Link Interface
Application
ACL-H2
CSTA
Converter connection
CSTA
COM
Device
driver
Host (Plus product)
CSTA
Direct connection
CSTA
COM
Host (Plus product)
LAN interface:
CSTA over IP
CDRC over IP
Admin over IP
Data
COM
IP client
Host (Plus product)
CSTA over IP
CDRC over IP
Admin over IP
COM
IP client
VCAPI
PSTN interface
Data
COM
IP client
Host (Plus product)
Figure 7-17
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7-597
Implementing Features
Host Link Interface
7-598
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Configuration Guidelines
8 Configuration Guidelines
The Online Help for HiPath 3000 Manager E contains up-to-date configuration examples.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
8-1
Configuration Guidelines
8-2
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Workpoint Clients
Overview
9 Workpoint Clients
9.1 Overview
Chapter Contents
This chapter discusses the following topics:
Topic
optiPoint 500 (V3.0 SMR-3 or Later), page 9-3
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
9-1
Workpoint Clients
Overview
Topic
IP Telephony (Voice over IP (VoIP)), page 9-39
Gigaset 3000 Comfort Feature Handset (Not for U.S.), page 9-60
Gigaset 3000 Micro Feature Handset (Not for U.S.), page 9-61
Gigaset 4000 Comfort Feature Handset (Not for U.S.), page 9-62
9-2
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Workpoint Clients
optiPoint 500 (V3.0 SMR-3 or Later)
>
The optiPoint 500 telephones described in this section are compatible with the optiset E telephones. It is possible to operate both telephone families on one UP0/E
board. You can also use telephones from the two families in mixed host-client configurations (earlier called the master-slave or primary-secondary configuration).
You can find information on optiset E telephones, adapters, and add-on device in
the Hicom 150 H V1.0 and Hicom 150 E Office Rel.2.0-3.0 Service Manual (refer to
the list of related documents).
Introduction
optiPoint 500 telephones handle the digital communication of voice and data (voice
communication only for optiPoint 500 entry and optiPoint 500 economy). The three dialog keys and the display guarantee convenient and interactive operation. Furthermore, the key lamp principle visualizes the activated functions.
With the exception of optiPoint 500 entry and optiPoint 500 economy, the optiPoint
500 telephones have a USB 1.1 interface. This allows for PC-supported telephoning
and Internet access over the USB interface of a PC.
The add-on devices optiPoint key module and optiPoint BLF allow you to increase the
number of available function keys.
The different optiPoint 500 adapters provide a flexible extension to the telephone
workstation. Additional devices (such as personal computers, fax equipment, telephones, headsets) can be connected quickly because it is easy to build them on to
the bottom of the telephones (not optiPoint 500 entry and optiPoint 500 economy)
and because the adapters are plugnplay.
You can find information not contained in this chapter in the optiPoint 500 Service
Manual.
The market introduction of the optiPoint 500 telephones, adapters and add-on devices takes place in two steps:
Step 1, release 12/01: Contains all optiPoint 500 telephones, adapters and addon devices, described in this chapter and not included in step 2.
Step 2, release probably 03/02: Contains optiPoint 500 entry, optiPoint 500 economy, optiPoint acoustic adapter, optiPoint ISDN adapter, optiPoint recorder
adapter and optiPoint BLF.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
9-3
Workpoint Clients
optiPoint 500 (V3.0 SMR-3 or Later)
Key Programming
>
>
optiset E basic
>
>
>
>
Because optiPoint 500 advance has more function keys (4 + 15) than any optiset E
telephones (max. 4 + 8), the system generates an optiset E advance plus/comfort
with optiset E key module for the optiPoint 500 advance. HiPath 3000 Manager E also
recognizes this combination.
Use the 4 + 8 function keys of the optiset E advance plus/comfort and the first 7 keys
of the optiset E key module to program the 4 + 15 function keys of the optiPoint 500
advance.
You can label the keys in one of the following ways:
9-4
Using a PC:
with the Key Labeling Tool (requires MS Word) that is on the CD Electronic Operating Instructions (refer to the list of related documents).
with the Online Key Labeling Tool that can be downloaded from http://
www.siemens.com/hipath (> Downloads).
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Workpoint Clients
optiPoint 500 (V3.0 SMR-3 or Later)
8 function keys (can be modified with HiPath 3000 Manager E) with LEDs (see
page 9-4)
Open listening
Consultation hold
Redial
Message
Callback
Speed dialing
Microphone on/off
Speaker
Release
Figure 9-1
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
9-5
Workpoint Clients
optiPoint 500 (V3.0 SMR-3 or Later)
12 function keys (4 can be changed using HiPath 3000 Manager E, 8 freely programmable) with LEDs (see page 9-4)
3 dialog keys for interactive user prompts: Yes, Back and Next
Open listening
Service
Programmable
Redial
Programmable
Microphone on/off
Programmable
Speaker
Programmable
Programmable
Programmable
Programmable
Release
Figure 9-2
9-6
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Workpoint Clients
optiPoint 500 (V3.0 SMR-3 or Later)
12 function keys (4 can be changed using HiPath 3000 Manager E, 8 freely programmable) with LEDs (see page 9-4)
3 dialog keys for interactive user prompts: Yes, Back and Next
Open listening
1 option bay
Service
Programmable
Redial
Programmable
Microphone on/off
Programmable
Speaker
Programmable
Programmable
Programmable
Programmable
Release
Figure 9-3
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
9-7
Workpoint Clients
optiPoint 500 (V3.0 SMR-3 or Later)
12 function keys (4 can be changed using HiPath 3000 Manager E, 8 freely programmable) with LEDs (see page 9-4)
3 dialog keys for interactive user prompts: Yes, Back, and Next
Full duplex speakerphone mode with echo suppression for adapting to the room
2 setting keys (plus/minus) for volume, pitch, speaker quality and display contrast
Service
Programmable
Redial
Programmable
Microphone on/off
Programmable
Speaker
Programmable
Programmable
Programmable
Programmable
Release
Figure 9-4
9-8
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Workpoint Clients
optiPoint 500 (V3.0 SMR-3 or Later)
19 function keys (4 can be changed using HiPath 3000 Manager E, 15 freely programmable) with LEDs (see page 9-4)
3 dialog keys for interactive user prompts: Yes, Back, and Next
Full duplex speakerphone mode with echo suppression for adapting to the room
2 setting keys (plus/minus) for volume, pitch, speaker quality and display contrast
2 option bays
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
9-9
Workpoint Clients
optiPoint 500 (V3.0 SMR-3 or Later)
Service
Programmable
Redial
Programmable
Microphone on/off
Programmable
Speaker
Programmable
Programmable
Programmable
Programmable
Programmable
Programmable
Programmable
Programmable
Programmable
Programmable
Programmable
Release
Figure 9-5
9-10
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Workpoint Clients
optiPoint 500 (V3.0 SMR-3 or Later)
Hardware
requirements
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
free
UP0/E port
on
SLMO8 (not
for U.S.) or
SLMO24
free
UP0/E port
on
CBCC
CBRC
SLU8
SLU8R
SLMO24
free
UP0/E port
on
CBCC
CBRC
SLU8
SLU8R
free
UP0/E port
on
SBSCO
free
UP0/E port
on
SBSCS
Refer to Section 6.2 for information on upgrading peripheral boards for HiPath 3750
and HiPath 3700.
Connecting as a Client Telephone
>
It can also be connected to an existing optiPoint 500 telephone (except for optiPoint
500 entry and optiPoint 500 economy) as a client telephone (using an optiPoint
phone adapter).
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
9-11
Workpoint Clients
optiPoint 500 (V3.0 SMR-3 or Later)
>
Activity
1.
2.
Connect the cable from the main distribution frame to the wall outlet.
The maximum range for a standalone or host telephone without additional local
power supply is approximately 1000 m (3280 feet) (for J-Y (ST) 2x2x0.6, 0.6 mm).
Perform the telephone test in Section 12.6.7 to determine whether a local power
supply is needed for additional power (for example, in host-client configurations or
for larger ranges).
3.
Over a PC:
With the Key Labeling Tool (requires MS Word) that is on the
Electronic Operating Instructions CD.
With the Online Key Labeling Tool that can be downloaded from
http://www.siemens.com/hipath (> Downloads).
4.
Connect the handset cord to the telephone (marked with symbol) and
to the handset.
5.
All LEDs on the add-on devices (AODs), if connected, light up briefly (AOD LEDs
do not necessarily flash at the same time as the LEDs on the telephone.)
These indications show that the telephone is starting up and performing a self-test.
Downloading has finished and the telephone is ready for operation when you see the
date and time on the display.
9-12
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Workpoint Clients
optiPoint 500 (V3.0 SMR-3 or Later)
USB interface
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
9-13
Workpoint Clients
optiPoint 500 (V3.0 SMR-3 or Later)
Data transmission over CAPI (for example, direct Internet access, fax capability,
or e-mail). If the CAPI software is installed, PCs have direct Internet access over
the USB interface without any additional adapter. There is a charge for this software.
TAPI and CAPI can be used simultaneously (for example, receiving a large e-mail or
download while calls are being set up over a CTI application).
>
9-14
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Workpoint Clients
optiPoint 500 (V3.0 SMR-3 or Later)
Warning
Always disconnect the line cord before connecting add-on devices to the telephone.
Refer to Section 7.11.2 for model-dependent data for the optiPoint key module and
the optiPoint BLF.
Figure 9-7
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
9-15
Workpoint Clients
optiPoint 500 (V3.0 SMR-3 or Later)
Figure 9-8
9-16
optiPoint BLF
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Workpoint Clients
optiPoint 500 (V3.0 SMR-3 or Later)
Action
1.
Unplug the connecting cable between the optiPoint key module and the
telephone (or other optiPoint key module). Remove optiPoint key module.
2.
Remove optiPoint key module from the database, using HiPath 3000
Manager E.
3.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
9-17
Workpoint Clients
optiPoint 500 (V3.0 SMR-3 or Later)
optiPoint
BLF
optiPoint
key
module
optiPoint
BLF
optiPoint
BLF
optiPoint
key
module
optiPoint
BLF
optiPoint
key
module
optiPoint
key
module
9-18
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Workpoint Clients
optiPoint 500 (V3.0 SMR-3 or Later)
Warning
Always disconnect the line cord before connecting adapters to the telephone or removing them from the telephone.
Option bays
Option bays:
Figure 9-10
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
9-19
Workpoint Clients
optiPoint 500 (V3.0 SMR-3 or Later)
Figure 9-11
Pin
Signal
free
free
T (Tip)
R (Ring)
free
free
9-20
Supply current: 30 mA
Does not support: VoiceMail server with T/R interface, message waiting lamp,
dictating equipment, speaker, announcement device (such as start/stop).
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Workpoint Clients
optiPoint 500 (V3.0 SMR-3 or Later)
Figure 9-12
Pin
Signal
free
free
SR1
SX1
SX2
SR2
free
free
S0 interface properties
Cable lengths
Maximum 200 m (656 feet) with a cable impedance of 150 ohms (complies
with CCITT recommendation I.430)
The NT terminating resistors are integrated into the ISDN adapter. Additional terminating resistors are included in the accessory pack.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
9-21
Workpoint Clients
optiPoint 500 (V3.0 SMR-3 or Later)
Figure 9-13
9-22
Pin
Signal
free
AUX (T (Tip))
UP0/E
UP0/E +
AUX + (R (Ring))
free
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Workpoint Clients
optiPoint 500 (V3.0 SMR-3 or Later)
MW wall outlets
MW wall outlet
Host
Client
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
9-23
Workpoint Clients
optiPoint 500 (V3.0 SMR-3 or Later)
busy display/door opener and secondary bell/light paging, etc. (each with its own
power supply) via floating contacts
Assignment of the three connection sockets:
Acoustic transformer:
Impedance: 150 10%
EBD: 13 dB 2.5 dB
2 Connecting a loudspeaker and microphone using Y
cable (see Figure 9-16)
3 Floating contacts (see Table 9-1), load capacity of
max. 5 W at 24 VAC or 60 VDC
Figure 9-15
9-24
The internal components of the optiPoint terminal are deactivated in speakerphone mode if an internal microphone and an external loudspeaker are used
(sense lead).
optiPoint 500 basic does not support the connection of an external microphone
to the optiPoint acoustic adapter.
Workpoint Clients
optiPoint 500 (V3.0 SMR-3 or Later)
The internal microphone, the transmitter inset and any microphone connected to
the optiPoint acoustic adapter are muted in the "Mute" audio state.
Ring, alarm and key tones are transferred to the internal loudspeaker and not to
an external loudspeaker connected to the optiPoint acoustic adapter.
The volume keys on the optiPoint terminal are used to adjust the volume level of
the internal loudspeaker and any connected external loudspeaker. The volume
of the external loudspeaker can also be adjusted using the external amplifier.
Assignment of the MW2 connection sockets:
Y cable
Loudspeaker
Pin
Signal
sense lead
NF+
Free
GND
Internal resistance: 0 ; 10 F
Level (for PCM -20 dBm): -4.8 dBm (at volume level 8; 0.775
V = 0 dBm)
Sense lead to GND: int. loudspeaker deactivated; only active
for tone ringing.
Acoustic adapter
4
Microphone
Pin
Signal
+5V
GND
Free
sense lead
Figure 9-16
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
9-25
Workpoint Clients
optiPoint 500 (V3.0 SMR-3 or Later)
Table 9-1
Pin
Assignment
Notes
Free
Handset lifted
9-26
"Call" contact
Free
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Workpoint Clients
optiPoint 500 (V3.0 SMR-3 or Later)
Signal
Tx
Rx
Rx
Tx+
Signal
Free
NF
NF
NF
NF
Free
Figure 9-17
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
9-27
Workpoint Clients
optiPoint 500 (V3.0 SMR-3 or Later)
If one of these adapters is used in the optiPoint 500 advance, only a category 2 adapter can be operated in the second slot.
Category 2 optiPoint 500 adapters
The following adapters can be used on the host and client telephones. This is also
true if a category 1 optiPoint 500 adapter is already connected.
Configurations Restrictions
>
The voltage feed test can be used to check whether a local power supply is also necessary for an adapter configuration. To avoid any doubts, the test should always be
implemented when installing large configurations.
9-28
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Workpoint Clients
optiPoint 500 (V3.0 SMR-3 or Later)
optiPoint 500
analog adapter
analog adapter
phone adapter
phone adapter
data adapter
control adapter
ISDN adapter
ISDN adapter
acoustic adapter
acoustic adapter
contact adapter
headset adapter
headset plus adapter
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
recorder adapter
9-29
Workpoint Clients
optiPoint 500 (V3.0 SMR-3 or Later)
AC line frequency: 47 to 53 Hz
Table 9-3
9-30
Pin
Assignment
not used
a-wire (tip)
b-wire (ring)
not used
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Workpoint Clients
optiPoint 500 (V3.0 SMR-3 or Later)
Analog
telephone
or device
MW jack
HiPath 3750
optiPoint 500
telephone
Figure 9-18
9.2.4.2 Headsets
A headset replaces the telephone handset, which means that the users hands are
free when telephoning.
You can use the headsets listed in Table 9-4 on the optiPoint 500 advance or over an
optiPoint acoustic adapter.
Figure 9-19
Headset
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
9-31
Workpoint Clients
optiPoint 500 (V3.0 SMR-3 or Later)
Telephone/Accessories
optiPoint 500 entry
Part Number
arctic
S30817-S7101-A101-*
manganese
S30817-S7101-A107-*
arctic
S30817-S7108-A101-*
manganese
S30817-S7108-A107-*
arctic
S30817-S7102-A101-*
manganese
S30817-S7102-A107-*
arctic
S30817-S7103-A101-*
manganese
S30817-S7103-A107-*
arctic
S30817-S7104-A101-*
manganese
S30817-S7104-A107-*
arctic
S30817-S7105-A101-*
manganese
S30817-S7105-A107-*
arctic
S30817-S7107-A101-*
manganese
S30817-S7107-A107-*
arsenic
S30817-K7110-B108-*
arsenic
S30817-K7110-B208-*
arsenic
S30817-K7110-B308-*
arsenic
S30817-K7110-B408-*
arsenic
S30817-K7110-B508-*
arsenic
C39363-A328-C338
arsenic
C39363-A329-C338
9-32
Color
AUL:06D1284
(C39280-Z4-C71 =
number entered on the
unit)
AUL:06D1287
(C39280-Z4-C72 =
number entered on the
unit)
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Workpoint Clients
optiPoint 500 (V3.0 SMR-3 or Later)
Table 9-4
Telephone/Accessories
Color
Part Number
AUL:51A4827
(C39280-Z4-C73 =
number entered on the
unit)
L30460-X1282-X1
L30460-X1282-X2
Headset Tristar
L30460-X1282-X3
Headset Supra
L30460-X1282-X4
Headset DuoSet
L30460-X1282-X5
L30460-X1283-X1
L30460-X1283-X2
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
9-33
Workpoint Clients
optiPoint 600 office
>
optiPoint 600 office can be used in conjunction with special SMRs for V1.2 and V3.0.
Please refer to the respective sales release documentation for further details.
HiPath 3000 < V3.0 does not automatically detect optiPoint 600 office; it treats it as
if it was an optiset E memory + optiset E key module.
Because optiPoint 600 office has more function keys (4 + 15) than an optiset E
memory (4 + 8), the system generates an optiset E memory with optiset E key module for the optiPoint 600 office. HiPath 3000 Manager E also recognizes this combination.
Use the 4 + 8 function keys of the optiset E memory and the first 7 keys of the optiset
E key module to program the 4 + 15 function keys of the optiPoint 600 office.
Important features
9-34
19 function keys (4 changeable using HiPath 3000 Manager E, 15 user-programmable) with LEDs
3 dialog keys for interactive user prompts: Yes, Back, and Next
2 setting keys (plus/minus) for volume, pitch, speaker quality and display contrast
1 adapter slot
Workpoint Clients
optiPoint 600 office
Service
Programmable
Redial
Programmable
Microphone on/off
Programmable
Speaker
Programmable
Programmable
Programmable
Programmable
Programmable
Programmable
Programmable
Programmable
Programmable
Programmable
Programmable
Release
Figure 9-20
optiset E memory
optiPoint IP adapter needed for use in IP environments
Headset port
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
9-35
Workpoint Clients
optiPoint 600 office
Table 9-5
optiset E memory
9-36
Connection of the optiPoint 600 office over the UP0/E interface: Refer to page 912 for more information.
Connection of the optiPoint 600 office over the IP interface: You can obtain information in the installation and startup instructions (http://www.siemens.com/hipath (> Downloads)).
Use HiPath 3000 Manager E to configure a workpoint client for HiPath 3000.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Workpoint Clients
optiLog 4me
Figure 9-21
optiLog 4me
You can set the optiLog 4me to the following modes in both digital and analog telephones:
Start Recorder
Recording begins when you press the Start key.
Trader Recorder
Records and stores all calls.
Furthermore, you can use the recorder to record conference calls using an external
microphone.
The optiLog 4me can be connected between the optiPoint 500 telephone and the
handset. The local power supply is included in the delivery.
For additional information on this, please refer to the installation and administration
instructions included with the adapter.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
9-37
Workpoint Clients
optiset E Privacy Module
>
9-38
The optiset E privacy module may be subject to import and export regulations.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Workpoint Clients
IP Telephony (Voice over IP (VoIP))
HiPath 3000
Central Board
ISDN board
optiClient 130
with remote access
ISDN
Telecommunications network)
HG1500
ISDN
Internet
connection
Example: use as
home workstation
Client
LAN
optiClient 130
Figure 9-22
Features
optiClient 130, in combination with HiPath 3000, uses optiPoint 500 functionalities.
The client is also equipped with ACD functions.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
9-39
Workpoint Clients
IP Telephony (Voice over IP (VoIP))
Technical Features
H.323 protocol
Minimum PC Requirements
128 MB RAM
Configuration
Use HiPath 3000 Manager E to configure a workpoint client for HiPath 3000.
9-40
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Workpoint Clients
IP Telephony (Voice over IP (VoIP))
Service
Programmable
Redial
Programmable
Microphone on/off
Programmable
Speaker
Programmable
Programmable
Programmable
Programmable
Release
Figure 9-23
Quick and error-free dialing directly from the address book of a PC application
(for example, MS Outlook) using CTI (TAPI).
The use of the H.323 standard allows the telephone to communicate with other
H.323-compatible systems.
The two switching Ethernet interfaces and Internet protocol (IP) allow the user to
telephone on both the companys internal Intranet and the public Internet.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
9-41
Workpoint Clients
IP Telephony (Voice over IP (VoIP))
Main Features
3 dialog keys for interactive user prompts: Yes, Back, and Next
Full duplex speakerphone mode with echo suppression for adapting to the room
2 setting keys (plus/minus) for volume, pitch, speaker quality and display contrast
Interfaces:
Caution
You must connect optiPoint 400 standard to the LAN first. Only then should you connect to the power supply.
9-42
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Workpoint Clients
IP Telephony (Voice over IP (VoIP))
no speakerphone
Service
Programmable
Redial
Programmable
Microphone on/off
Programmable
Speaker
Programmable
Programmable
Programmable
Programmable
Release
Figure 9-24
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
9-43
Workpoint Clients
IP Telephony (Voice over IP (VoIP))
RJ11, UP0/E jack for one optiset E or optiPoint 500 telephone (including power
supply)
Figure 9-25
9-44
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Workpoint Clients
IP Telephony (Voice over IP (VoIP))
123
456
789
00
ABC
DEF
ABC
DEF
GHIJKL
MNO
GHI MNO
PQRS
TUV
WXYZ
PQRS
TUV
optiPoint IPadapter
MW jack
optiset E or optiPoint
500 telephone
RJ11
RJ45
HiPath 3000
LAN
HiPath HG1500board
or
LIM module
Figure 9-26
A LAN cable (3 m) with RJ45 plug is also included as part of the delivery. When connecting the optiPoint IPadapter to a LAN, do not use a cable longer that 100 m.
You can operate the optiPoint IPadapter using the optiset E or optiPoint 500 telephone with display (only for basic settings) that is connected to the UP0/E port. Or, you
can also use a LAN with a PC (HTTP client = web server, use any setting).
For more information on this, please refer to the installation and administration instructions included with the adapter.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
9-45
Workpoint Clients
IP Telephony (Voice over IP (VoIP))
9.6.5 HiPath HG1500 V2.0, V3.0: Determining the Number of HiPath HG1500
Boards Required
>
Introduction
HiPath HG1500 V2.0 and HiPath HG1500 V3.0 provide resources for the functions
listed in Table 9-6. Table 9-7 shows the expansion limits (maximum numbers) for
these functions, based on the system.
Table 9-6
HXGM
16
16
16
16
Gateway channels
A gateway channel is required, for example, for connection between an IP workpoint client and a TDM
workpoint client (such as optiPoint 500).
16
16
16
16
Fax channels
These are special hardware resources that allow fax
via vCAPI and data gateway functionality.
9-46
HXGM2 HXGS
HXGM3 HXGSR
HXGS2
HXGS3
HXGSR2
HXGR3
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Workpoint Clients
IP Telephony (Voice over IP (VoIP))
Table 9-6
HXGM
20
96
20
48
LAN ports
How many of these can be used as DSL ports
1
0
2
1
1
0
2
1
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
HXGM2 HXGS
HXGM3 HXGSR
HXGS2
HXGS3
HXGSR2
HXGR3
9-47
Workpoint Clients
IP Telephony (Voice over IP (VoIP))
Table 9-7
Routing partner
IP workpoint clients that can use ISDN routing
70
70
70
120
32
16
vCAPI clients
IP workpoint clients that can use vCAPI.
100
100
100
MOH channels
Number of MOH data streams for IP workpoint
clients (system clients)
10
10
10
H.323 clients
48
16
16
9-48
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Workpoint Clients
IP Telephony (Voice over IP (VoIP))
>
IP workpoint clients
optiClient 130
HiPath HG1500 boards with Digital Signal Processor DSP (voice and data)
Refer to the following tables for information on the different board models:
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
9-49
Workpoint Clients
IP Telephony (Voice over IP (VoIP))
Gateway Functionality
Gateway connections are needed for connections to TDM workpoint clients and lines.
You need one gateway channel on the HiPath HG1500 board for each gateway connection. The following are examples of TDM workpoint clients and lines:
CMI station
Analog station
ISDN station
Examples: a consultation call to an optiPoint 500 telephone is set up during an existing connection between two IP workpoint clients. A HiPath HG1500 gateway channel
is necessary for this consultation call.
An IP workpoint client seizes a trunk. A HiPath HG1500 gateway channel is required
for this trunk.
In the case of conferences, the number of gateway channels seized corresponds to
the number of stations and IP workpoint clients involved.
One DSP resource (no B channel) on each HiPath HG1500 board is permanently reserved for playing music-on-hold. A maximum of ten MOH data streams are possible
for each DSP resource, i.e. for each HiPath HG1500 board. This means that a maximum of ten IP workpoint clients can hear MOH at one time.
Example: two licenses were acquired for two gateway channels and six clients. Six
optiPoint 400 standard are logged on. The following scenario is possible in this case:
two stations can conduct an external call, while two stations are listening to MoH and
two stations are talking to each other.
ISDN Routing
HiPath HG1500 boards can also be used as ISDN routers. The ISDN router connects
two physically separate IP networks via an ISDN line.
If an IP workpoint client wants to call another IP workpoint client that is physically in
another network via ISDN, the ISDN router (HiPath HG1500) sets up the contact between the two networks.
Consequently, the router allows connection across different networks.
In addition, the ISDN router can provide Internet access and enables teleworkers to
access a company network.
9-50
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Workpoint Clients
IP Telephony (Voice over IP (VoIP))
9.6.5.2 Determining the Number of HiPath HG1500 V2.0 and V3.0 Boards Required
The intensity of the use of gateway connections and ISDN routing determines the
number of HiPath HG1500 boards required.
Channels for gateway connections
HXGM and HXGM2 and HXGM3 (V3.0 SMR-11 or Later) each feature up to 16 gateway channels (B channels). HXGS, HXGS2, HXGSR (Not for U.S.), HXGSR2 and
HXGS3 and HXGR3 (V3.0 SMR-11 or Later) each feature up to eight gateway channels per board.
The following table shows the number of gateway channels (HiPath HG1500 boards)
necessary based on the existing IP workpoint clients.
A prerequisite for value calculation is that a station must spend 10% of its working
time in call status. Provisions should be made for more gateway channels (HiPath
HG1500 boards) in high traffic volume environment (e.g. call centers).
Table 9-8
03
4 12
13 16
17 38
39 54
10
55 70
12
71 86
14
87 96
15
97 101
16
102 136
20
137 172
24
173 210
28
211 247
32
248 324
40
325 402
48
403 481
56
482 500
64
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
9-51
Workpoint Clients
IP Telephony (Voice over IP (VoIP))
V3.0
Table 9-9
Boards
Total output
per board
1000
1000
770
770
720
Resource Requirement
HiPath HG1500 V2.0 HiPath HG1500 V3.0
45
47
30
36
10
15
16
9-52
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Workpoint Clients
IP Telephony (Voice over IP (VoIP))
Table 9-9
Resource Requirement
HiPath HG1500 V2.0 HiPath HG1500 V3.0
ISDN routing
(voice), per routing channel
G.723 (packeting = 3)
40
57
G.723 (packeting = 1
= default)
110
100
G.729 (packeting = 3)
54
(packet size = 60 ms)
G.729 (packeting = 1)
150
(packet size = 20 ms)
45
34
230
650
66
DSL routing
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
9-53
Workpoint Clients
IP Telephony (Voice over IP (VoIP))
Example calculations:
Example 1 = HiPath HG1500 V2.0
Channels for gateway
connections (G.711)
=8
8 x 45
+ 20 x 5
+ 4 x 15
= 520
As the value of 1000 (= resource provision by one HiPath HG1500 V2.0 board) is not exceeded, the function of this configuration can be guaranteed with one board.
Example 2 = HiPath HG1500 V2.0
Channels for gateway
connections (G.711)
= 12
12 x 45
+ 60 x 5
+ 650
= 1490
The value of 1000 is exceeded. Two HiPath HG1500 V2.0 boards are required for this configuration.
Example 3 = HiPath HG1500 V3.0
Channels for gateway
connections (G.711)
= 10
10 x 47
+ 20 x 1
+ 5 x 16
= 570
This output value can be guaranteed with a single HXGM3 or HXGS3/HXGR3 board (without
PDM1).
9-54
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Workpoint Clients
Attendant Console Versions
Service
Night answer
Redial
Telephone directory
Microphone on/off
Call waiting
Speaker
Intrusion
Hold
External 1
External 2
Release
Figure 9-27
Refer to the optiPoint Attendant for HiPath 3000 Operating Manual which is on the
Electronic Operating Instructions CD (refer to the list of related documents).
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
9-55
Workpoint Clients
Attendant Console Versions
>
9-56
Dialing from an Access database is not supported with optiClient Attendant V6.0 or
later. Dialing with Outlook contacts has been implemented instead.
Connection with charges for single calls with automatic display in the notebook
(printable)
Workpoint Clients
Attendant Console Versions
WindowsNT
V4.0
Windows2000
WindowsXP
optiset E control
adapters
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
No
Yes
Yes
No
No
Yes
Yes
Connection variant
Microsoft-compatible mouse
For operation on USB: optiPoint 500 telephone or optiPoint 600 office with free
USB interface, USB cable (part number S30267-Z360-A30-1), USB driver (CallBridge TU) and a free USB port on the PC.
For operation using optiset E control adapters: optiset E telephone with free
adapter slot and a free interface on the PC (COM ports 1-4).
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
9-57
Workpoint Clients
Attendant Console Versions
Licensing
The optiClient Attendant V6.0 is subject to compulsory licensing. The final license
must be obtained within 30 days of installation.
The end customer is responsible for licensing. Because the registration includes details such as PC-relevant hardware information, both hardware replacement/upgrade
and operating system change/reinstallation operations necessitate reregistration.
Model-Specific Data
Topic
HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
Feature available in
Hardware requirements
Software requirements
9-58
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Workpoint Clients
HiPath Cordless Office Telephones
Dimensions: 160 x 55 x 25 mm (L x W x D)
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
9-59
Workpoint Clients
HiPath Cordless Office Telephones
Figure 9-28
9-60
3 function keys:
Speakerphone
Handset phone book for around 100 entries. Redial of the last five numbers.
Dimensions: 60 x 50 x 28 mm (L x W x D)
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Workpoint Clients
HiPath Cordless Office Telephones
Figure 9-29
3 function keys:
Handset phone book for approximately 100 entries. Redial of last five numbers.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
9-61
Workpoint Clients
HiPath Cordless Office Telephones
Figure 9-30
9-62
2 display keys
6 function keys:
Off-hook key
Speakerphone key
Caller list
Keylock (#)
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Workpoint Clients
HiPath Cordless Office Telephones
Internal handset directory for approx. 200 entries. Redial option for last five numbers dialled.
Figure 9-31
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
9-63
Workpoint Clients
HiPath Cordless Office Telephones
9-64
2 display keys
6 function keys:
Off-hook key
Speakerphone key
Caller list
Keylock (#)
Internal handset directory for approx. 200 entries. Redial option for last five numbers dialled.
Vibrating alarm
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Workpoint Clients
HiPath Cordless Office Telephones
Figure 9-32
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
9-65
Workpoint Clients
HiPath Cordless Office Telephones
4 function keys
3 guidance keys (for scrolling through function menus and confirming functions)
2-line display
Security and lock-mode selection (65,000 codes programmed into the handset
and the base for increased security)
Base Station
Charging Stand
Handset
Figure 9-33
9-66
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Workpoint Clients
HiPath Cordless Office Telephones
>
For initial installation of the HiPath Cordless Office, the HiPath Cordless Office system number must be ordered together with the SLC16 or SLC16N board. Later shipments of replacement boards do not come with HiPath Cordless Office system numbers.
Before logging on a mobile phone, you must open the login window from a system
telephone by entering the code and password. A maximum of 10 login windows can
be open at a time. Then type the station numbers of the mobile telephones you want
to log on.
Action
Open the login window
Display
Station no.:
124
Station no:
Type the station number of the
handset you want to log on (such as
124)
125
:
:
:
:
:
:
The login window remains open for ten minutes per station. The handset must log on
during this period (refer to Log On the Mobile Telephone (for Gigaset 3000 Comfort,
3000 Micro) on page 9-68).
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
9-67
Workpoint Clients
HiPath Cordless Office Telephones
9.8.7.2 Log On the Mobile Telephone (for Gigaset 3000 Comfort, 3000 Micro)
Example: Log the mobile telephone (station number 125) onto the DECT telephone
system 2, using mobile telephone PIN 11112345.
Step
Entry or Key
Handset Display
1.
The first time you log on, the message Register? appears on the
handset display. The second time
you log on, Base 1 or a similar
message is displayed.
2.
3.
Base 2
4.
5.
6.
7.
Base 2
After logging on and releasing a handset, always turn on the out-of-range warning
signal. For more information, refer to the operating instructions (see Related Documentation).
9-68
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Workpoint Clients
HiPath Cordless Office Telephones
9.8.7.3 Log On the Mobile Telephone (for Gigaset 4000 Comfort, 4000 Micro)
Example: Log the mobile telephone (station number 125) onto DECT telephone System 2, using mobile telephone PIN 11112345.
Step
Entry or Key
Handset Display
1.
The first time you log on, the message Register? appears on the
handset display. The second time
you log on, Base 1 or a similar
message is displayed.
2.
3.
Base 2
4.
5.
6.
7.
Base 2
After logging on and releasing a mobile telephone, always turn on the out-of-range
warning signal. For more information, refer to the operating instructions. (see Related
Documentation).
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
9-69
Workpoint Clients
HiPath Cordless Office Telephones
>
9-70
When you replace a mobile telephone, the station must be assigned a new mobile
telephone code (PIN) in the HiPath 3000 system. This automatically logs off the mobile telephone.
This also prevents a person who knows the old PIN to log on an invalid mobile telephone.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Workpoint Clients
Analog Telephones
Hardware
requirements
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
Hardware
requirements
Refer to Section 6.2 for information on upgrading peripheral boards in HiPath 3750
and HiPath 3700.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
9-71
Workpoint Clients
ISDN Terminals
>
It is also possible to connect an analog telephone to an existing optiPoint 500 telephone with the optiPoint analog adapter (except for optiPoint 500 entry and optiPoint
500 economy).
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
Free S0 port Free S0 port Free S0 port Free S0 port Free S0 port
on
on
on
on
on
STMD8
CBCC
CBCC
SBSCO
SBSCS
CBRC
CBRC
STLS2/4
STLS2/4
STLS4R
STLS4R
Refer to Section 6.2 for information on upgrading peripheral boards in HiPath 3750
and HiPath 3700.
Connecting With an optiPoint ISDN adapter
>
9-72
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Workpoint Clients
ISDN Terminals
HiPath 3000
3 ft. (0.91 m)
I1
I0
T
R
T0
In
30 ft. (9.14 m)
T1
Tn
Legend
T
TR
I
Figure 9-34
ISDN Terminal
Terminating Resistor, 100 ohms
(located at wall jack)
Wall jack location
Reference Wiring Configuration in the User Premises Location
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
9-73
Workpoint Clients
ISDN Terminals
Point-to-point
Several other wiring configurations are possible; however, the wiring is guaranteed to
work only if the configuration meets the electrical specifications described in ANSI
T1.605-1991.
Point-to-Point
In a point-to-point configuration, only one terminal device is connected to each S0
port on the system; therefore, the connection is a direct connection.
Configuration Restrictions
The following maximums apply to point-to-point S0 wiring:
Maximum distance between the system and the device is 3000 feet (914.40 m),
as shown in Figure 9-35
A 100-ohm termination is required at the ISDN terminal. If the terminal does not have
a built-in termination, you must install a separate 100-ohm ISDN terminating resistor
module (Model Number 256503) anywhere between the terminal and its wall jack.
L = 3000 ft. (914.40 m)
T
R
HiPath 3000
T0
Legend
T
TR
I
Figure 9-35
9-74
ISDN Terminal
Terminating Resistor, 100 ohms
(located at wall jack)
Wall jack location
S0 Point-to-Point Wiring
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Workpoint Clients
ISDN Terminals
Maximum cable distance between the system and the last terminal on the line is
405 feet (123.44 m), as shown in Figure 9-36
Maximum cable length is 30 feet (9.14 m) between each terminal and the wall
jack
The terminating resistor (Model Number 256503) must be located anywhere between
the last terminal and its wall jack.
L = 405 ft. (123.44 m)
HiPath 3000
3 ft. (0.91 m)
I1
I0
T
R
T0
In
30 ft. (9.14 m)
T1
Tn
Legend
T
TR
I
ISDN Terminal
Terminating Resistor, 100 ohms
(located at wall jack)
Wall jack location
Figure 9-36
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
9-75
Workpoint Clients
ISDN Terminals
Maximum cable distance between the system and the last device in the group is
1500 feet (457.20 m)
Maximum distance between the first ISDN terminal and the last ISDN terminal is
75 feet (22.86 m), as shown in Figure 9-37
The terminating resistor (Model Number 256503) must be located anywhere between
the last terminal and its wall jack.
9-76
I1
ISDN Terminal
Terminating Resistor, 100 ohms
(located at wall jack)
Wall jack location
I0
3 ft. (0.91 m)
T
R
T0
30 ft. (9.14 m)
Tn
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Special Equipment
Overview
10 Special Equipment
10.1 Overview
Chapter Contents
This chapter discusses the following topics:
Topic
Answering Machines, page 10-2
Recorded Announcements, page 10-4
Voice Mail, page 10-5
Entrance Telephones (Not for U.S.), page 10-10
Speakers (Not for U.S.), page 10-13
Connecting Data Equipment (Not for U.S.), page 10-15
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
10-1
Special Equipment
Answering Machines
Example
Using Manager T, this example configures station 19 to Answer machine.
10-2
Step
Entry
Action
Display
1.
*95
System administration
2.
14 11
3.
# 19
4.
*4
5.
F8 F7
Time, Date
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Special Equipment
Answering Machines
Example
Using Manager T, this example configures a programmable key for Message waiting.
Step
Entry
1.
* 91
2.
Any key
3.
...
4.
...
5.
Action
Display
11 [name] Change
key?
Select feature
Call waiting
Time, Date
T (a)
T (a)
Analog
subscriber
R (b) board
R (b)
Answering Machine
or
House Cable
Analog
trunk
board
Note: A maximum of four DTMF dial diction circuits can interface with the system. During maintenance of dial-controlled diction equipment, the associated analog subscriber board must be
taken out of service. Failing to take the board out of service will cause incoming calls to receive
a ringback tone instead of a busy tone or prevent the call from being diverted to an alternate device.
Figure 10-1
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
10-3
Special Equipment
Recorded Announcements
Intercept announcements inform incoming trunk callers that the number dialed is
invalid.
Sequential mode connects callers simultaneously to a continuously playing announcement when a start signal is detected.
Start on-ring mode connects a caller to an announcement when the announcement device detects rings.
Hardware Requirements
HW requirements
10-4
Barge-in
Mode
Sequential
mode
Sequential
on-demand
mode
Start on-ring
mode
Free port on
analog subscriber board
Free Port on
TIEL
Free Port on
TIEL
Free port on
analog subscriber board
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Special Equipment
Voice Mail
>
You can connect only one voice mail system to HiPath 3000.
Type of Call
Code
Type of Call
Express mailbox
Group mailbox
Recall - no answer
Calling party
Mandatory element
Maximum length depends on the type of station dialed: voice mail with 5-digit
station no." or "voice mail with 6-digit station no.".
Station number value range = 0-9.
The system has a record of the internal station numbers of internal calling parties. It encodes the numbers of external calling parties, using a fixed string (02)
followed by additional 2s up to the maximum length.
Called party
Mandatory element for call types 3, 4, 7, 8, and 9. The element remains blank for
all other types of calls.
Variable length.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
10-5
Special Equipment
Voice Mail
Information
Calling Party
Called Party
Information
***74
blank
*1
External call to voice mail: Party on an analog trunk calls voice mail system.
***2
02222
blank
*3
Internal CF - no answer to voice mail: Station 74 calls station 13, which has set
CF - no answer to voice mail.
***4
***74
13
*1
CF to voice mail: External party on an ISDN trunk calls station 13, which has set
CF to voice mail.
***3
10-6
02222
13
*4
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Special Equipment
Voice Mail
Under Station type (14 11), enter the ports as Voice mail (2).
2.
Set up a linear hunt group for the two ports (16 15 1/2).
3.
4.
5.
Enter the hunt group as destination 1 in a free call destination list (16 18 1).
6.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
10-7
Special Equipment
Voice Mail
Sample Configurations
Example 1: Voice mail will be connected to analog ports 25 and 26.
Step
Input
Action
Display
1.
*95
System
administration
2.
14 11
Station type
Stn 25: 2
Stn 26: 2
3.
16 15 1
Dest. 1: 25
Dest. 2: 26
4.
16 15 2
Grp 1: 2
5.
16 15 3
Group names
6.
14 12
Station names
7.
16 18 1
Dest. 1: Grp 1
8.
16 18 2
13
13
9.
F8 F7
Time, Date
The result of this programming is that call forwardingno answer is performed even
when the voice mail port is dialed directly. A callback is always executed via the initiators port after a display message is received (a voice mail port, not the group. Memo
for Hicom can only be configured by the stations (call internal group 1 and follow the
voice prompting).
After receiving a display message, a callback is always placed to the first voice mail
port.
In the case of call forwarding to internal group 1, the box is activated when the user
leaves the workstation. Call forwarding when busy or free can be configured for individual stations or all stations in call management.
10-8
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Special Equipment
Voice Mail
Example 2: During day service, the exchange and extensions 13 and14 are to be forwarded to Memo after 4 rings; during night service, call forwardingno answer is to
be performed immediately.
Step
Input
Action
Display
1.
*95
System
administration
2.
16 18 1
Dest. 1: Called
Dest. 2: Grp 1
3.
16 18 5
Call cycles: 4
4.
16 18 3
Dest. 11: 12
Dest. 13: 12
Dest. 14: 12
5.
16 18 1
Dest. 1: Called
Dest. 2: Grp 1
6.
16 18 5
Call cycles: 1
7.
16 18 4
Dest. 11: 11
Dest. 13: 11
Dest. 14: 11
8.
F8 F7
Time, Date
Remarks
Call forwardingno answer must always be directed to Memo. For example, if call
destination list 11 (option 16) refers immediately to the voice mail group, the box answers as in the case of a direct station call (display box).
Memo programming is described in the manual provided with Memo for Hicom.
Password list for Memo for Hicom:
Customer password
(VOICEMAIL/EXCHANGE)
1234
5991
>
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
10-9
Special Equipment
Entrance Telephones (Not for U.S.)
ET adapter
Amplifier
Door
Figure 10-2
ET/A
adapter
Door
You can also make a direct connection if needed. In this case, only voice connections
to the entrance telephone are possible, without the support of the opener and signal
functions.
if necessary, loop in a capacitor
1 F/250 V for each
T
to T/R analog port
Amplifier
R
Figure 10-3
10-10
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Special Equipment
Entrance Telephones (Not for U.S.)
Connecting
Power supply
NG 602-0
HiPath 3000
Siedle-Vario
TLM 612
analog
DoorCom Analog
DCA 612-0
Figure 10-4
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
10-11
Special Equipment
Entrance Telephones (Not for U.S.)
10-12
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Special Equipment
Speakers (Not for U.S.)
Connection to an analog station port (it may be necessary to adjust the amplifier
level)
HiPath 3000
SLA/SLAS
T/R
Amplifier
Starting contact
REAL/STRBR/STRBR
HiPath 3000
SLA/SLAS
T/R
ET
HiPath 3000
SLA/SLAS
T/R
ET
T/R
Amplifier
Starting contact
Figure 10-5
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
10-13
Special Equipment
Speakers (Not for U.S.)
Active
speakers only
HiPath 3000
a/b
TML/TLA
HiPath 3000
a/b
TML/TLA
REAL/STRB
Amplifier
Starting contact
The analog trunk port must be programmed with the pause before setting dialing
to 1 s or 3 s (14 11). Place the trunk in a separate trunk group without direct trunk
access.
Figure 10-6
10-14
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Special Equipment
Connecting Data Equipment (Not for U.S.)
a/b/E
System
Telekom
or PBX
Maximum
2400 baud
V.24/
V.28
ADo 8M/
TAE 6D
Modem
Terminal or PC
VDo 7
a2/b2/W/G/E
Analog phone
with data key
Figure 10-7
La
a2
1
2
3
4
E
G
Lb
8
7
6
5
E
a
b
Z
b2
3
E
E
b2
G
Z
rd
a2
bl gy ye gn br wt
VDo 7
G
Z
rd bl gy
a
b2
a2
ye gn br wt
Figure 10-8
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
10-15
Special Equipment
Connecting Data Equipment (Not for U.S.)
10-16
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
11.1 Overview
Chapter Contents
This chapter discusses the following topics:
Topic
Introduction, page 11-2
System Configuration, page 11-3
Technical Data for Base Stations, page 11-4
Power-Related Capacity Limits, page 11-6
Multi-SLC and System-Wide Networking, page 11-9
Notes on Planning Networked HiPath 3000 Systems With the Network-Wide Roaming Feature, page 11-11
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
11-1
11.2 Introduction
For Version 1.2 or later of HiPath 3000, HiPath Cordless Office can be used on all systems in the product line.
The newly developed BS3/1 (S30807-H5482-X) base station can be
directly connected to the UP0/E interfaces in the central control boards for HiPath
3550, HiPath 3350, HiPath 3250, HiPath 3500 and HiPath 3300.
connected to the UP0/E interfaces in the SLC16 and SLC16N board for HiPath
3750, HiPath 3550 and HiPath 3700.
To ensure the operation of a maximum of one base station on the central control
boards UP0/E interfaces of the HiPath 3550, HiPath 3350, HiPath 3250, HiPath 3150,
HiPath 3500, and HiPath 3300, a BS3/S (X30807-X5482-X100) single-cell base station can be used. In this case, it is not possible to expand with additional base stations.
A mix of both the BS2/2 (S30807-H5471-X200), BS3/1 (S30807-H5482-X),
and BS3/3 (S30807-H5485-X) base stations may be used on one SLC16 or SLC16N
board.
However, the BS3/1 base station cannot be simultaneously connected to the SLC16
or SLC16N board and the CBCC within one HiPath 3550 system.
Up to four SLC16 or SLC16N boards can be used within HiPath 3750 and HiPath
3700. These boards provide complete cordless functionality (roaming and seamless
connection handover) (refer to Section 11.6).
A mix of both the SLC16 and SLC16N boards within one system is supported.
At present, HiPath 3000 versions V1.2 and V3.0 do not support the network-wide
handover function.
11-2
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
V3.0
SLC16
SLC16N
BS3/1 to
1 x UP0/E
BS3/S to
1 x UP0/E
BS2/2 to
2/1 x UP0/E
BS3/3 to
3/2 x UP0/E
BS3/1
BS3/S
BS2/2
BS3/3
Maximum number
of MTs
Analog trunk
access for system
V1.2
Table 11-1
HiPath 3150
CMS
no
HiPath 3250
CMS
no
CMS
no
CMS
16
no
CMA
16
yes
CMA
16
yes
CMS
32
no
CMA
32
yes
CMA
32
yes
(X)1
CGMC
16
8/16
4/8
12
64
yes
CMS
16
8/16
4/8
12
64
yes
CGM
16
8/16
4/8
12
64
yes
250 (for 4
12
SLC16/
SLC16Ns)3
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
12
(X)1
42
System
SW
Max.
version number
CMS
64
32/64 21/32
Simultaneous
calls per BS
yes
Explanations:
BS3/1 (S30807-H5482-X) is a base station (Figure 11-1) that supports a maximum of 4 calls simultaneously.
BS3/3 (S30807-H5485-X) is a base station that can only be operated on SLC16 and SLC16N. Connection
via at least two UP0/E interfaces is necessary. It supports a maximum of 12 simultaneous calls when connected via three UP0/E interfaces.
BS3/S (X30807-X5482-X100)is a single-cell base station that guarantees the operation of a maximum of one
base station on the UP0/E interface of the central board. It is not possible to operate additional base stations.
HiPath 3550, HiPath 3350, HiPath 3500, HiPath 3300: It is possible to operate the BS3/1 on the UP0/E interfaces of the central board only in connection with the CMA clock module.
1 It is possible to use HiPath Cordless Office on older hardware (Version 1.2 or earlier) with V1.2 SMR-G or later.
2 SLC16N can be used in conjunction with special SMRs for V1.2 and V3.0. Please refer to the respective sales release documentation for further details.
3 A maximum of 128 MTs are possible on one SLC16 or SLC16N.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
11-3
Parameter
BS3/3
Outdoor cover
42 to 54 V
42 to 54 V
Power consumption
max. 1.70 W
max. 3.20 W
Housing dimensions
(W x D x H in mm)
181 x 139 x 69
202 x 172 x 43
296 x 256 x 90
Weight
approx. 0.3 kg
approx. 0.5 kg
approx. 1.0 kg
Temperature range
Relative humidity
up to 95 %
Figure 11-1
11-4
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Outdoor Cover
A base station must be installed in a weatherproof outdoor cover to guarantee radio
coverage outdoors, for example on factory premises. The outdoor cover is suitable for
mounting on walls of buildings, roofs, and masts.
The outdoor cover S30122-X7469-X already available for BS2/2 is also used for the
new base stations, BS3/1 (BS3/S) and BS3/3. The only difference is that you do not
need a heater for BS3/1 (BS3/S) and BS3/3.
Outdoor housing
with BS3/1 (BS3/S)
The supplied Styrofoam block [1]
should be used to affix the BS3/1
(BS3/S).
Outdoor housing
with BS3/3
[1]
Figure 11-2
For information on the various outdoor cover mounting options, refer to the HiPath
Cordless Office Service Manual.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
11-5
HiPath 3550 and HiPath 3500 - Maximum Number of Corded Telephones Depending on the Number of BS3/1 Connected to CBCC/
CBRC
Number of
BS3/1 base stations
connected to
CBCC/CBRC
1-10
11-20
21-30
31-40
41-50
11-6
66
61
57
53
48
44
63
59
54
50
46
41
60
56
52
47
43
39
58
53
49
45
40
36
55
51
47
42
38
33
53
48
44
40
35
31
50
46
41
37
33
28
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Table 11-4
Number of
BS3/1 base stations
connected to
SLC16 or SLC16N
1-10
11-20
21-30
31-40
41-50
66
61
57
53
48
44
63
59
54
50
46
41
60
56
52
47
43
39
58
53
49
45
40
36
55
51
47
42
38
33
53
48
44
40
35
31
50
46
41
37
33
28
47
43
39
34
30
26
45
40
36
32
27
23
10
42
38
33
29
25
20
11
40
35
31
27
22
18
12
37
33
28
24
20
15
13
34
30
26
21
17
13
14
32
27
23
19
14
10
13
29
25
20
16
12
16
27
22
18
13
Table 11-5
Number of
BS2/2 base stations
connected to
SLC16 or SLC16N
1-10
11-20
21-30
31-40
41-50
63
59
54
50
46
41
58
53
49
45
40
36
53
48
44
40
35
31
47
43
39
34
30
26
42
38
33
29
25
20
37
33
28
24
20
15
32
27
23
19
14
10
27
22
18
13
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
11-7
Table 11-6
Number of
BS3/3 base stations
connected to
SLC16 or SLC16N
analog telephones
0
1-10
11-20
21-30
31-40
41-50
>
64
60
56
51
47
42
60
56
52
47
43
39
57
52
48
43
39
35
53
48
44
40
35
31
49
44
40
36
31
27
45
40
36
32
27
23
41
37
32
28
23
19
37
33
28
24
20
15
11-8
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
11-9
HiPath 3750
Node ID = 1
Home SLC16
SLC16 no. = 1
Station no = 124
SLC16 no. = 2
Station no. = 141
SLC16
BS
HiPath 3550
Node ID = 2
CorNet-N
Extension
connection
SLC16
BS
BS
BS
BS = BS2/2, BS3/1 or
BS3/3
SLC16
BS
BS
Figure 11-3
Model-Specific Data
Feature
11-10
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
11.7 Notes on Planning Networked HiPath 3000 Systems With the NetworkWide Roaming Feature
For the cross-system extension connections described in Section 11.6, you may need
to consider additional B channels for permanent connection paths (CorNet-N).
If the Network-wide roaming feature is used, please ensure that there is no overlapping in the radio areas of individual systems with identical DECT IDs. Networked systems with identical DECT IDs are viewed as a single system by the handset.
If the radio fields of systems with identical DECT IDs overlap, mobile telephones inadvertently try to perform network-wide handover (result: communication breakdown).
If it is necessary to network systems where individual radio fields overlap (e.g. to increase configuration limits or through decentralized installation), different DECT IDs
should be configured in the individual systems. The network-wide roaming feature is
not supported in this case.
Following are three different scenarios showing networked HiPath 3000 systems.
Scenario 1: Unauthorized DECT configuration of networked HiPath 3000 systems
Because of identical DECT IDs and overlapping radio fields, there is an unauthorized
handover (result: communication breakdown).
PSTN
Networking (S0, S2M, IP)
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
11-11
PSTN
Networking (S0, S2M, IP)
11-12
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
PSTN
Networking
(S0, S2M, IP)
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
11-13
11-14
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Service
Overview
12 Service
12.1 Overview
Introduction
This chapter contains information on the options available to service technicians and
customers for
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
12-1
Service
Customer Database Backup (CDB Backup)
12-2
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Service
Customer Database Backup (CDB Backup)
Activity
2.
3.
4.
Loading the saved customer data from the MMC into the system
1.
2.
3.
4.
Procedure: After replacing board, load current CDB into the system
Step
Activity
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
Load the previous CDB that was saved on the MMC into the system RAM. The customer system is now configured:
All telephone options, such as volume and display, are determined per station.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
12-3
Service
Customer Database Backup (CDB Backup)
Procedure: After replacing board, load old CDB from the customer disk
into the system
Step
12-4
Activity
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
Reload.
8.
9.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Service
Relocate/Transfer Application Processor Software (APS)
>
APS replacement is only possible within a version and if a logical, compatible CDB
is available.
Procedure:
Step
Action
1.
Create a backup of the current CDB and save on a customer disk for
security reasons.
2.
3.
4.
5.
The activation of the new APS can be verified with APS Stamp.
The relevant query can be made with HiPath 3000 Manager E or
Manager T (menu item 29-1-2).
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
12-5
Service
Relocate/Transfer Application Processor Software (APS)
an APS transfer using remote service from a central service center using
Function
This feature transfers the new APS in its entirety and stores it in the available area of
the MMC. After the transfer has been completed, the system analyzes the checksum
and subsequently reports whether or not
Resetting the system initiates the changeover from the old APS to the new APS. If
problems occur during this process, the old APS is reactivated. Once the changeover
is successful, the old APS is deleted from the MMC.
In case of power outage, the SDRAM content that has no battery backup is completely lost. By reaccessing the current APS on the MMC, the system can be restored to
the state it was in prior to the power outage.
12-6
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Service
Relocate/Transfer Application Processor Software (APS)
Procedure
Step
Action
1.
2.
Select "Open CDB " from the HiPath 3000 Manager E file menu and
highlight "APS files (*.fst)."
Open the fst file using the new system software.
3.
4.
5.
6.
Once the APS transfer is completed, the HiPath 3000 Manager E reports that the APS transfer was successful. At the set changeover
time, the system resets and boots with the new version.
7.
Use the APS stamp to verify that the new APS has been activated.
Use HiPath 3000 Manager E or Manager T (menu item 29-1-2) to
make the necessary query.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
12-7
Service
Relocate/Transfer Application Processor Software (APS)
HE560S.10.428
Production number/Software binder
Feature package
Remark: Service Maintenance Releases SMR
are identified by production number and feature
package.
System:
Version/
Release:
Software: E = System
A = Manager/Assistant ...
HiPath/Hicom ...
>
12-8
Software modifications for the correction of faults and the addition of a moderate
number of new features are known as a software update or Service Maintenance
Release SMR. CDB conversion is not necessary.
A software upgrade must be performed if the case of extensive new features. Hardware modifications and patches can also be included in a software upgrade. A software upgrade changes the version number of the product in question, e.g. from V1.0
to V2.0. CDB conversion may be necessary.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Service
Upgrading HiPath 3000
If the connection is interrupted during the transfer (line failure, for example), use
HiPath 3000 Manager E to restart manually, then perform the complete APS
transfer again.
Since the software is written onto the MMC in a compressed format during APS
transfer, you have to unpack it after the transfer is complete (it takes about
5 minutes).
After the APS transfer, the checksum is analyzed. If the checksum finds errors,
delete the transferred APS. You then have to repeat the complete APS transfer.
Once the APS has been successfully transferred, the message APS transfer
was successful appears. You can then finish the session.
The system software uses a special system reset (none of the other resets initiates a changeover) to change over to the new APS. You cannot use the telephone while the system resets and boots up.
After a successful changeover to the new APS, an entry in the error memory is
also made and the old APS on the MMC is deactivated. This does not impede
switching traffic. The deactivated area is now available for a new APS transfer.
The positive or negative entry in the error memory is sent to the service center.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
12-9
Service
Effects of Hardware Changes on Customer Data
Caution
When using HiPath 3550, HiPath 3350, HiPath 3500 and HiPath 3300, disconnect
the system from the power supply before removing or inserting boards.
Only HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 peripheral boards can be removed or inserted
during operation.
If
Then
Inserting new
board in free slot
Replace board with The system activates the board and retains the surplus ports
underequipped
in the database.
board of same type
12-10
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Service
Effects of Hardware Changes on Customer Data
Table 12-1
If
Then
Replacing board The system activates the board with the same number of ports
with overequipped as on the old board.
board of same type After removing the old board, you can reinitialize the slot using
HiPath 3000 Manager E or Manager T.
After the new board is inserted, the system activates it as if it
had been inserted into a free slot. However, the CDB (customer database) area used by the old board is left as a gap.
In the case of subscriber lines modules, you can use HiPath
3000 Manager E to retain the old station data by copying it to
the new board, or you can delete it (reset to the default state).
Copying is not possible for trunk boards.
Replacing board The system does not automatically activate the board.
with different board After removing the old board, you can initialize the slot using
HiPath 3000 Manager E or Manager T.
After you have inserted the new board, the system activates it
as if it had been inserted into a free slot. However, the CDB
area used by the old board is left as a gap.
In the case of subscriber line modules, you can use HiPath
3000 Manager E to retain the old station data by copying it to
the new board, or you can delete it (reset to the default state).
Copying is not possible for trunk boards.
>
If you initiate a system reload on a system updated as described above, you must
reset the system after you import the adapted CDB. The reset synchronizes the port
placement sequence in the system with that of the CDB.
Procedure: Exchanging Boards (not with HiPath 3250 and HiPath 3150)
Step
Action
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
12-11
Service
Effects of Hardware Changes on Customer Data
Step
Action
8.
9.
12-12
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Service
Diagnosis Options
Run LED
Meaning
off
Power outage
on
off
Reset key pressed longer than 5 s (LED disappears as verification for initiating a reload.)
on
System boot
off
for 0.1 s
blinking
0.5 s on/0.5 s off
blinking
0.1 s on/0.1 s off
1 The blinking rhythm depends on the load. The higher the load, the slower the blinking rhythm.
Options Available?
You can call up the following options using the HiPath 3000 Manager E:
CMA
CMS
LIM
IMODC
MPPI, AM (only with HiPath 3250, HiPath 3150), UAM (only with HiPath 3550,
HiPath 3350) or UAMR (only with HiPath 3500, HiPath 3300)
The presence of one of these announcement and music modules is displayed as
Option 5. The ALUM4 module cannot be displayed.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
12-13
Service
Diagnosis Options
Board
Status Display
12-14
Board disabled
Board busy (at least one station or line from this board is disconnected, is being
called, or is busy).
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Service
Diagnosis Options
No reference clock
When viewing the status of the board using the HiPath 3000 Manager E, all peripheral
boards integrated into the system are presented in a table. The status display is updated every 3 seconds.
With the Manager T, you can only view the status of one board at a time. You can also
update the status display by pressing a key.
You cannot perform additional activities with the HiPath 3000 Manager E and Manager T while viewing the status of a board.
Table 12-4
Slot
STLS2
SLU8
SLA4
TLA8
Locked
out
Idle
Busy
Clock
source
X
X
5
6
7
TS2
SLA16
9
10
SLMO24
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
12-15
Service
Diagnosis Options
Content
Date
Time
Trunk number
Slot/Port
Status
12-16
Trunk status:
Inactive
Incoming call
Outgoing call
Trunk-to-trunk connection
Trunk disabled (using lockout switch or HiPath
3000 Manager E)
Trunk failure
Number of the connected station
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Service
Diagnosis Options
Content
Station name
Slot/Port
Telephone model
Telephone status
Active/inactive
DID number
Language
Connection status
Connected to
Forwarding status
Destination
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
12-17
Service
Diagnosis Options
Data
Content
Activated features
Do not disturb
Advisory text
Room monitor
Code lock
Group ringing
Ringer connection
Hunt group
Handsfree answerback
Connected station
V.24 Monitoring
The number of sent or received bytes within a time period to be selected can be
recorded and then displayed or saved using a text editor
(default = MS WordPad).
The failure and restart of a V.24 interface generates an entry in the error history and
releases a remote error signal (V.24 failure = Check printer error message, V.24 restart = Withdrawal of error message). The interface is not supported by the optiset E
control adapters (see Section 7.15.10, Printer Pipe Mode (V.24 [RS-232] Range Extension for Call Data), on page 7-518).
12-18
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Service
Diagnosis Options
>
You must have special user privileges to call up the trace settings in the Maintenance menu. Only the Development user group has these rights.
activated manually from a telephone (if the customer discovers an error such as
double connections).
If the trace session is over, you can start the ISDN Message Decoder (ISDN Tracer)
and use it to convert the trace file into a readable format (only English). You can also
read out the trace data using remote service.
The ISDN Message Decoder is a 32 bit application which converts the ISDN layer 3
messages and information elements into a readable format. Since you cannot find out
from the trace file whether it deals with an information element from a Euro ISDN or
a QSig configuration, you have to select the protocol. You may select the following
settings from the main menu:
Euro ISDN
QSig V1
With the Raw setting, the Hex values are only decoded, not interpreted. With the
other two settings, the Hex values are decoded and interpreted per feature
(CC, AOC, ...).
Tracing Call-related Activities
You can trace all activities from any telephone, trunk, etc., that is released by a call.
These include consultation calls, conference calls, hunt groups, for example.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
12-19
Service
Diagnosis Options
>
Telephone Test
Step
Entry
1.
*940
2.
Explanation
Code for telephone test
For approximately five seconds, all LEDs blink
quickly (except for the Service menu LED), all display pixels are activated, and you can hear a tone.
If the test does not react as described, an additional power supply (plug-in power
supply unit) for the relevant system telephone may be necessary.
If the time and date do not appear in the display after startup, either the system telephone or the cable path is defective. Either exchange the system telephone or check
the cable path.
12-20
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Service
Error Messages
Fan Failure (caused by failure of the fan in the 19 HiPath 3500 and HiPath
3300 housing)
Too Many Key Modules (caused by inserting more than the maximum possible number optiPoint key modules specified in Table 2-6)
For U.S. only: INVALID SPID (HiPath 3550, HiPath 3350, HiPath 3500 and
HiPath 3300) signals that the service profile identifier (SPID) for BRI ISDN is
incorrect.
Recovery Action
are actions for correcting errors that are automatically triggered by the system
software (board reload, for example).
Technician Action
are actions that have to be performed by a service technician if the error is not
corrected automatically. This may be the case with hardware malfunctions or
configuration errors.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
12-21
Service
Error Messages
Table 12-6
No.
Recovery
Action
Technician
Action
Hard restart
Hard restart
10
Hard restart
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
Reload board
Replace board
12-22
Microprocessor: Error
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Service
Error Messages
Table 12-6
No.
Recovery
Action
Technician
Action
Reload board
Replace board
29
Line interruption
Check line
30
Short circuit
Check line
31
Low voltage
Check voltage
32
Thermal overload
34
Check line
35
36
Check line
37
38
Check line
39
42
Check line
43
44
Check line
45
48
Check line
49
50
Check line
51
58
Replace board
59
61
Replace board
62
65
66
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
12-23
Service
Error Messages
Table 12-6
No.
Recovery
Action
Technician
Action
Hard restart
Hard restart
Hard restart
Hard restart
Hard restart
Hard restart
Hard restart
Hard restart
Security violation
Hard restart
Trace
Hard restart
10
Hard restart
11
Hard restart
12
Hard restart
13
Hard restart
14
Hard restart
15
Hard restart
APS transfer
12-24
Service
Error Messages
Table 12-6
No.
Recovery
Action
Technician
Action
10
Notify appropriate
service support
Hard restart
Hard restart
Hard restart
Hard restart
Hard restart
Hard restart
Hard restart
Watchdog error
10
11
Manual reload
12
13
Notify appropriate
service support
14
15
16
Pool error
Notify appropriate
service support
17
20
Hard restart
21
Allocation fails
Hard restart
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Hard restart
12-25
Service
Error Messages
Table 12-6
No.
Recovery
Action
Technician
Action
Hard restart
Notify appropriate
service support
Reduce stations
Check interface
11
13
Hard restart
Notify appropriate
service support
Reference clock on
11
12
13
Replace CBRC
14
15
an additional CR8N
board can be used
for HiPath 3750 and
HiPath 3700.
an upgrade to the
next highest system
may be necessary for
all other systems.
12-26
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Service
Error Messages
Table 12-6
No.
Recovery
Action
Technician
Action
Hard restart
Notify appropriate
service support
Replace board
Reload board
Replace board
Board is activated
Hard restart
Notify appropriate
service support
COSMOS error
Hard restart
20
Hard restart
Notify appropriate
service support
24
Board malfunction
Reload board
25
Reload board
35
No ELIC interrupts
Hard restart
36
Hard restart
Notify appropriate
service support
37
Hard restart
38
Reload board
Replace board
Hard restart
Replace MMC
MMC defective
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
12-27
Service
Error Messages
Table 12-6
No.
Recovery
Action
Technician
Action
For errors that appear
sporadically, no action is
necessary.
For errors that appear regularly, replace the LIM
module. If this does not
correct the error, check
the LAN configuration.
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
12-28
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Service
Correcting Errors
Hard restart
Reload board
Port lockout
None
initiates a Reset (Hard restart of the entire system with the current CDB) if the
button is pressed for less than 5 seconds. The Run LED lights up when the Reset
button is pressed.
initiates a Reload if the button is pressed longer than 5 seconds. The Run LED
disappears after approximately 5 seconds as verification that the reload has
been initiated. The entire content of the customer database is replaced by its default version. All country and customer-specific settings are lost.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
12-29
Service
Correcting Errors
12-30
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Service
Remote Service
Remote service facilitates the administration and maintenance of various communication systems from a central location.
An integrated digital modem (B channel), an integrated analog modem (IMODC), or
HiPath HG1500 can be used to connect to the system.
HiPath 3000
Central Board
PSTN
(analog or
digital
telecommunications network)
Modem
Service center
Service PC
with
HiPath 3000 Manager E
LIM
Customer
LAN
Plus Products
Figure 12-1
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
12-31
Service
Remote Service
Caution
Be sure to disconnect the system from the power supply before removing or inserting integrated analog modems (IMODC).
The IMODC is treated as a pseudo port. It receives a number in the system that can
be reached internally through direct internal dialing (DID). You can cancel the DID
number manually to prevent external access.
Access over ISDN trunk = enable procedure: customer must enter PIN code.
Access over another trunk = login without code: PIN code is not necessary.
If necessary, the system administration (only by using Manager T) can reset the PIN
code back to the default value.
12-32
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Service
Remote Service
HiPath HG1500
A LAN-LAN connection via the HiPath HG1500 board allows remote access to all HiPath 3000 systems except HiPath 3250 and HiPath 3150.
Configuration information can be found in the HiPath HG1500 V2.0 Administration
Manual and the HiPath HG1500 V3.0 Configuration Manual.
Callback
Any one of these options establishes a connection using the integrated digital modem
(B channel) or the integrated analog modem (IMODC).
Callback
HiPath 3000 can manage up to six different callback indices (callback passwords and
their relevant callback numbers), in which case the first callback connection is also
the destination of the automatic error signaling. For each callback connection, you
can select either the digital modem (B channel) or the analog modem (IMODC).
If you have chosen your settings and selected the connection setup option Callback
activated, the HiPath 3000 Manager E can dial in to the system. HiPath 3000 register
the callback destination and saves the callback index. After 10 s, the HiPath 3000 initiates the actual callback with the number which is linked using the callback index. As
soon as the connection is established, you can use HiPath 3000 Manager E to manage the system.
If no connection is established, HiPath 3000 will make a total of 20 attempts in intervals of 10 s after which the callback attempt ends. You then have to start it up again
with HiPath 3000 Manager E.
Service Call Using a Code
You can use any telephone to initiate a HiPath 3000 service call to the service center
by selecting the connection setup option Service call using a code and activating
the feature Remote access immediately after installation. In contrast to the usual
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
12-33
Service
Remote Service
callback procedure, this callback (service call) is not activated by HiPath 3000 Manager E itself, but by any telephone you choose. Callback initialization is essentially
skipped.
The service call destinations are the six callback indeces that also apply to callback.
You are not required to enter the relevant passwords.
The service center wait time for one service call is limited to 15 minutes, though you
can end it manually at any time.
Procedure: Activate the feature Remote access immediately after installation.
Step
Entry
Explanation
1.
*994
2.
3.
XXXXXXX
4.
or #
12-34
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Service
Remote Service
Caution
In case of a power outage, the not battery-buffered SDRAM content of the MMC is
completely lost. With it the possibly carried out individual setting of the time parameter "error signaling interval" is also put back on the default value 15 minutes.
With the restarting of the sytem the automatic recovery action " reload CDB backup"
starts and with it the reload of the customer-individual settings. Because this process lasts longer than 15 minutes, the first error message is always signaled at the
end of the 15-minutes default interval. Then the signaling of all other errors takes
place again with the individually set interval.
Example: The error signaling interval of a HiPath 3550 with activated error signaling
was put on 90 s. Through a power outage, the 90 s-interval is put back on the default
value 15 minutes. The first error message "no voltage" is signaled 15 minutes after
restarting operation of the system. After conclusion of the recovery action "reload
CDB backup" the original 90 s-setting of the error signaling interval is again active.
The signaling of other errors takes place after 90 s.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
12-35
Service
Remote Service
Hang up button
By pressing this button, you can disconnect the remote connection manually.
12-36
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Service
Access Security
fixed password
>
Step
Entry
Explanation
1.
*95
2.
31994
3.
31994
Default password
For optiset E memory and optiPoint 600 office telephones, only alphanumeric characters can be used. Therefore, when changing the user name or password with the
Manager T/Manager TC, you may enter additional characters as long as you never
use the optiset E memory and optiPoint 600 office.
Step
Entry
4.
XXXXX
5.
XXXXX
6.
29-5
7.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Explanation
Country initialization
Selection of password type is requested:
1 = Variable password
2 = Fixed password
12-37
Service
Access Security
Step
Entry
Explanation
8.
XX
Notes:
On step 4 and step 5: If a new password is issued, both steps are omitted when
calling the system again.
On step 6: No country adjustment is necessary for Germany because the system starts up with German codes.
On step 7: When selecting the fixed password, the default password (31994)
overwrites the new password entered under step 4.
Variable Password
Up to 16 users can be assigned their own user ID with individual name, password,
and a user group consisting of six pre-determined user groups (in Table 12-7). Only
the data authorized for the relevant user group can be read and administered.
During the first login, the system requests the identity of the user and asks for a new
password (max. 15 characters from the optiPoint 500 or optiset E character set). This
then overwrites the default user name (31994) and default password (31994). This
first user is then automatically assigned to the user group System Maintenance. The
system informs the user that no user is configured in the system and that the user has
been assigned with System Maintenance authorization. Using HiPath 3000 Manager E or Manager T, additional users and their passwords can be configured in the user
administration.
If a user forgets a password, it has to be deleted and reconfigured by a different authorized user. If all authorized users forget their passwords, the system must be regenerated.
Fixed Password
When using the fixed password, only fixed user groups with unchangeable default
user names and default passwords are used. Also, new users cannot be configured
in the user administration.
12-38
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Service
Access Security
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
12-39
Service
Access Security
1.
2.
X2
Access rights to all system data (not including development access rights) as long as no users are assigned
to other user groups.
4.
X3
X3, 4
X4
6.
7.
Accounting
Audit
X1
3.
5.
1
2
3
4
Development
User rights
User admin.
User groups
No.
Customer admin.
(Customer)
Table 12-7
X
X
12-40
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Service
Access Security
User groups
System maint. (Service)
Name/Password=
31994/31994
No.
User rights
1.
Development
Table 12-8
X
X
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
X
X
12-41
Service
Access Security
AMHOST
The AMHOST (Administration and Maintenance via HOST) feature allows Plus products to read certain system information and to change it, if necessary. To enable Plus
products to access the system, you have to set up a user without a user group in the
HiPath 3000 default user administration. Enter AMHOST as the user name and
77777 as the default user password.
You can only change this password if the system is configured using a variable password. In this case, delete the AMHOST user and reconfigure the system with the
same user name and a new password.
12-42
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Service
Access Security
>
You cannot switch to a fixed password if using a system from Deutsche Telekom AG.
This feature allows for additional security measures due to an identification and authentication procedure that ensures proper access to Deutsche Telekom AG communication systems and prevents unauthorized access.
You can activate this feature by using a chip card. The service PCs at Deutsche Telekom AG are equipped with chip card readers that allow the PCs to boot only if the chip
card recognizes the technicians individual chip card ID and if the password is entered
correctly. The chip card is also configured to recognize whether or not access to the
Octopus E system family exists.
To permit access to both user groups as well as individual technicians, you can decide, when logging on, whether you want to log on using the group ID in the chip card
or your individual ID. In both cases, the logon information is entered in a log file to
ensure that you, the chip card, user can be directly retraced.
Each Octopus system is provided with a default name and default password. When
you first log in, if
no chip card is recognized, you have to access the service PC using the default
name and password.
In both cases, when logging on for the first time, you are required to enter the following in the user administration:
User name
Password
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
12-43
Service
Access Security
>
12-44
When you generate a default customer database offline, a default user table is also
set up. If you generate a customer database like this, you can only load it into a default system.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Service
Automatic Logging of Administration Procedures
12.11.1 Logging
A log entry contains the following information:
Manager T (1)
All activities are logged, regardless of system access. The respective code with
the most important parameters is recorded as the command entry (for example,
station, number).
Manager TC (2)
Same as Manager T (1)
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
12-45
Service
Automatic Logging of Administration Procedures
12-46
Service
Automatic Logging of Administration Procedures
>
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
12-47
Service
Automatic Logging of Administration Procedures
12-48
If the memory area for logging data is not empty, logging continues.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Service
Automatic Logging of Administration Procedures
00-11-25 15:57:10
rev(R)
(6)D1-1
Archive
1051
00-11-25 15:58:22
rev(R)
(3)A0-2
Logout procedure
1052
00-11-26 09:20:15
serv(S)
(3)A0-1
Login procedure
1053
00-11-26 09:21:35
serv(S)
(4)A1-1
Database read
1054
00-11-26 09:21:52
serv(S)
(7)14-12-*(20)
Station name
1055
00-11-26 09:22:45
serv(S)
(4)A1-3
Write database
1056
00-11-26 09:23:25
serv(S)
(3)A0-2
Logout procedure
1057
00-11-26 10:10:15
pnkm(A) (3)A0-1
Login procedure
1058
00-11-26 10:11:15
pnkm(A) (2)14-12-30
Station name
1059
00-11-26 10:11:35
pnkm(A) (2)14-12-31
Station name
1060
00-11-26 10:12:15
pnkm(A) (3)A0-2
Logout procedure
1061
00-11-27 11:20:30
rev(R)
Login procedure
(3)A0-1
The sample printout (without consideration of headers and footers) refers to the following information concerning administration procedures:
The Revisor (rev user in R (Revision) user group) has generated an initial archive.
The Service (serv user in S (system maintenance) user group) has read out
the system database, changed 20 station names, and written them again to the
system.
The Customer (pnkm user in A (Administration) user group) has changed two
additional station names.
The Revisor has retrieved the most recent log entries and printed them out.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
12-49
Service
Automatic Logging of Administration Procedures
12-50
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
13-1
13.2 Introduction
HiPath 3000 V1.2 offer the following LAN functionalities (TCP/IP protocol family):
SNMP (UDP)
CDRC (TFTP server mode, TFTP client mode and TCP/IP client mode)
Telnet (TCP)
Monitoring and control of the LAN components are provided by the Simple Network
Management Protocol SNMP.
>
The main purpose of this chapter is to describe the options available by connecting
the LAN interface module LIM to HiPath 3000s central board.
Please refer to the products administration instructions and service manual for details relating HiPath HG 1500.
HiPath 3000
Service center
Central Board
Modem
LIM *
PSTN
interface
service PC with
HiPath 3000 Manager E
PSTN
(analog or
digital telecommunications
network)
Customer
LAN
Figure 13-1
13-2
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
implementing remote maintenance tasks (online port status, enabling and disabling ports, determining free ports)
standard MIB II (according to the RFC1213 Internet standard), which provides Internet and router functions;
parts of the RMON 1/2 standard MIBs (RFC 1757, RFC 2021), which support
Error history
Trap configuration
TFTP configuration
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
13-3
These components use the IP protocol according to OSI layer 3 and the UDP protocol
according to layer 4. The SNMP protocol stack uses port numbers. The system supports the SNMP protocol version 1.0.
SNMP Messages
The following commands control SNMP messages for communication between the
SNMP management agent (HiPath 3000) and external applications:
There is an integrated mechanism for generating SNMP traps in the event of class B
errors. The SNMP management agent evaluates the error messages. In the case of
defined errors, it generates specific traps and transmits them in the form of IP data
records to a configurable IP address (a total of five SNMP V1.0-compatible applications are supported, including HP Open View Network Node Manager).
13-4
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
HiPath 3000
Central Board
LIM *
Customer
LAN
PC with
HiPath 3000 Manager E
* A HiPath HG 1500 board can be used instead of the LIM board: HXGM, HXGM2, HXGM3 for HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700, HXGS, HXGS2, HXGS3 for HiPath 3550 and HiPath 3350 or HXGSR,
HXGSR2, HXGR3 for HiPath 3500 and HiPath 3300.
Figure 13-2
Model-Specific Data
Subject
Feature available in
HW requirements
SW requirements
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
LIM
or
HiPath HG1500 board
LIM
LIM
V1.2 or later
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
13-5
13-6
Step
Action
1.
Start the Telnet program with the IP address of the HiPath 3000 system.
2.
A mask appears where you can maximize the Telnet window (size of a telephone display with 24 lines and 8 characters per line).
Press any key.
3.
4.
Enter *95 to start the administration function just like you would under
Manager T.
Notes: If your Tenet program does not support function keys, you can use
the !, $, % and ? instead:
F2 > !
F7 > $
F8 > %
Speaker > ?
The font set in the Telnet program determines whether you can display
German umlauts. Use a font that displays the characters you need.
Configure Telnet as follows:
VT100/ANSI emulation
The arrow keys on the keypad have the following functions:
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
TFTP-PUT
hicom.fli
Explanation
CDB file
APS file
log.arc
LOG file
get.txt
gel.txt
gez.txt
ascii.txt
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
13-7
TCP/IP
server
LAN
External
applications
CSTA
client
CSTA
client
CSTA
client
CSTA
client
Figure 13-3
For an external application to address HiPath 3000, it must know the TCP port (7001)
of the TCP/IP server implemented in HiPath 3000 as well as the IP address.
Data packets sent from an application to HiPath 3000 -- that is, packets containing
the HiPath IP address, TCP port 7001, and protocol type TCP -- are accepted for further processing.
13-8
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Model-Specific Data
Subject
Feature available in
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
HW requirements
LIM
or
HiPath HG1500 board
SW requirements
V1.2 or later
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
13-9
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
Feature available in
HW requirements
LIM
or
HiPath HG1500 board
SW requirements
LIM
LIM
V1.2 or later
HiPath 3000
External
application
TFTP
client
TFTP protocol
TFTP
server
Alternative
server
Figure 13-4
Controlled by a programmable timer and a fixed threshold value determining the call
data buffer capacity (around 80 percent of the call data buffer full), the TFTP client
(HiPath 3000) sends call data to the TFTP server (external application). If the system
cannot set up a connection to the TFTP server, it addresses an alternative server. If
this server is also unavailable, it outputs an SNMP trap or error message (Unable to
output data). The system tries to set up another connection every 60 seconds. A call
data buffer overflow causes an error message to be entered in the error history file.
Use HiPath 3000 Manager E to configure the TFTP server and timer IP addresses.
13-10
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
HiPath 3000
TCP
client
Figure 13-5
External
application
TCP protocol
TCP
server
When call data records accumulate, the TCP client (HiPath 3000) sets up a TCP/IP
connection to an external TCP server (external application) and transmits the data.
The connection remains active continuously so that the system can send any further
accumulated data, transmitting each data record separately.
Use HiPath 3000 Manager E to configure the servers TCP/IP address (TCP port and
IP address).
HiPath 3000
External
application
TFTP
server
TFTP protocol
TFTP
client
TFTP
client
Figure 13-6
The external application (TFTP client) requests output of the call data records. To do
this, the application must set up a connection and indicate the service (GET gez.txt),
after which it receives all accumulated call data records. It releases the connection
after the transfer.
Note: The IP address of the TFTP client must be entered in the firewall and the call
charges application flag set.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
13-11
The applications request for call data can be controlled automatically or using an
SNMP trap (see Section 13.3). HiPath 3000 sends the SNMP trap (data available)
to the external application, generating the trap using a programmable threshold value
determining the call data buffer capacity (0 to 80 percent of the call data buffer full).
Use HiPath 3000 Manager E to configure the threshold value.
Configuring the Feature Using HiPath 3000 Manager E
The settings necessary for this feature are described in Section 13.11.
>
13-12
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
HiPath 3000
PSTN
(analog or
digital telecommunications
network)
Central board
Modem
Figure 13-7
PSTN
interface
Service center
service PC
with
HiPath 3000 Manager E
If the connection is established via callback, HiPath 3000 first of all denies a connection request from the service center (HiPath 3000 Manager E). A callback is then set
up to the service centers calling party number transferred via the PSTN connections
D channel.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
13-13
Model-Specific Data
Subject
Feature available in
HW requirements
SW requirements
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
CBCPR
CBCC or
CBRC
CBCC or
CBRC
SBSCO
SBSCS
V1.2 or later
13-14
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
HiPath 3000
PSTN
(analog or
digital telecommunications
network)
Central board
Modem
LIM *
PSTN
interface
Service center
service PC
with
HiPath 3000 Manager E
Customer
LAN
Plus Products
* A HiPath HG 1500 board can be used instead of the LIM board: HXGM, HXGM2, HXGM3 for HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700, HXGS, HXGS2, HXGS3 for HiPath 3550 and HiPath 3350 or HXGSR,
HXGSR2, HXGR3 for HiPath 3500 and HiPath 3300.
Figure 13-8
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
13-15
>
If a Plus Product supports SNMP traps, these can be transferred from the HiPath
3000 to the service center.
Access Mechanism
A list of up to twenty remote structures controls access from the service center to the
customer LAN and vice versa. Each remote structure contains the following information:
The IP address of the service center (= PSTN partner in the service center) for
setting up connections from the customer LAN to the service center and for the
automatic transmission of error messages (SNMP traps).
The DID number (part of the numbering plans) for direct identification of this remote structure.
Up to five PSTN remote numbers marked as incoming (for identifying the remote
structure - when dialing the router call number) and/or outgoing (for use as callback address).
If Short hold = no is selected, a PSTN connection remains permanently active until the end criterion is received.
Callbk yes/no
13-16
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
IP mapping yes/no
If a number of different customers have the same IP address, you can use address mapping to achieve unique IP address assignment in the various customer
LANs.
If IP mapping = yes is selected, you can map an IP address which is assigned to multiple customers to a unique virtual IP address. You can perform IP mapping for up to twenty address entries.
Examples:
IP data transfer from the customer LAN to the service center via the PSTN
interface: IP customer LAN is transformed by HiPath 3000 into an IP virtual
LAN.
IP data transfer from the service center to the customer LAN via the PSTN
interface: IP virtual LAN is transformed by HiPath 3000 into an IP customer
LAN.
the HiPath 3000 (host) must be authenticated at the Plus Product (client).
SW requirements
HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250 HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300 (not for U.S.) (not for U.S.)
LIM
or
HiPath HG1500 board
LIM
LIM
V1.2 or later
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
13-17
SNMP Functionality (SNMP in the LAN and SNMP traps for the service center)
Administering HiPath 3000 via the LAN Interface (SysAdmin via LAN)
(also includes settings for TFTP access, CSTA via IP, Telnet)
IP access
LIM: The LIM board is used for IP/LAN access to HiPath
3000.
HIP Forwarding: The HiPath HG 1500 board (HXGM,
HXGS, or HXGSR) is used for IP/LAN access. This board
works in bridging mode, which means that the HiPath HG
1500 board and the HiPath 3000 controller have separate
IP addresses that share a physical LAN interface.
Refer to the HiPath HG1500 V2.0 Administration Manual
and the HiPath HG1500 V3.0 Configuration Manual for
more information.
13-18
PPAdmin
SysAdmin
via PPP
1. Activate the Network dialog box in the Settings menu and open
the Basic settings tab.
Activity
(HiPath 3000 Manager E)
SNMP
SysAdmin
via LAN
CDRC via IP
Necessary for
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
PPAdmin
SysAdmin
via PPP
LAN interface
IP address: HiPath 3000s IP interface address to the LAN
(LIM board).
Subnet mask: Use the network mask for setting subnetworks in a corporate structure with only one official IP address. You can use a subnet mask to split the official IP address into different IP networks to provide a separate IP
network for each branch office. This new structure, however, is only valid in the internal corporate network.
MTU: Maximum packet length in bytes for the IP protocol
(value range = 500 to 1500). Do not change the default value.
SysAdmin
via LAN
CDRC via IP
Activity
(HiPath 3000 Manager E)
SNMP
Necessary for
PSTN interface
Router call no.: ISDN DID number used for contacting the
HiPath 3000 from outside the network.
Call no. test: If active, calls are only answered if a calling
party number is also transferred.
Check DID: Checks for duplicated station numbers in the
system.
Connection control
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
13-19
2. Open the SNMP data tab and make the following settings.
13-20
PPAdmin
SysAdmin
via PPP
SysAdmin
via LAN
SNMP
Activity
(HiPath 3000 Manager E)
CDRC via IP
Necessary for
SNMP Flags
Enable SNMP: This option activates the SNMP in the HiPath 3000.
CDR Notification Traps: This option activates traps for call
detail recording.
Port Status Notification Traps: This option activates traps
for interface status.
Trap Flags
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3. Open the SNMP partner tab and make the following settings.
PPAdmin
SysAdmin
via PPP
SysAdmin
via LAN
CDRC via IP
Activity
(HiPath 3000 Manager E)
SNMP
Necessary for
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
13-21
PPAdmin
SysAdmin
via PPP
SysAdmin
via LAN
CDRC via IP
Activity
(HiPath 3000 Manager E)
SNMP
Necessary for
4. Open PSTN partner tab and make the following settings (double-
click the table).
Security:
13-22
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
PPAdmin
SysAdmin
via PPP
SysAdmin
via LAN
PSTN partner
5. Open the Firewall tab and make the following settings (doubleclick the tables).
CDRC via IP
Activity
(HiPath 3000 Manager E)
SNMP
Necessary for
13-23
PPAdmin
SysAdmin
via PPP
SysAdmin
via LAN
SNMP
Activity
(HiPath 3000 Manager E)
CDRC via IP
Necessary for
6. Open the IP routing tab and make the following settings (double- ( ) ( ) ( ) ( ) ( )
click the table).
If the IP computer with the Plus Product is not in the LAN directly
connected to HiPath 3000, you can specify the gateway through
which the IP computer is reached.
13-24
IP routing
( ) ( ) ( ) ( ) ( )
IP address: IP address of the computer (Plus Product).
Net mask: Use the network mask for setting subnetworks
in a corporate structure with only one official IP address.
You can use a subnet mask to split the official IP address
into different IP networks to provide a separate IP network for each branch office.
Gateway: IP address of the gateway server.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
PPAdmin
SysAdmin
via PPP
SysAdmin
via LAN
CDRC via IP
Activity
(HiPath 3000 Manager E)
SNMP
Necessary for
7. Open the IP mapping tab and make the following settings (double- ( )
click the table).
If a number of customers have the same IP address, you can perform address mapping to uniquely assign the IP addresses in the
various customer LANs.
In the case of IP traffic, you can map a customer IP address to a
unique virtual IP address via HiPath 3000s PSTN interface.
You can perform IP mapping for up to twenty address entries.
Examples:
IP data transfer from the customer LAN to the service center via the
PSTN interface: IP customer LAN is transformed by HiPath 3000
into an IP virtual LAN.
IP data transfer from the service center to the customer LAN via the
PSTN interface: IP virtual LAN is transformed by HiPath 3000 into
an IP customer LAN.
( ) ( )
IP mapping
( )
IP cust. LAN: IP address or IP network address in the customer LAN.
IP virtual LAN: Specific associated IP address or IP network address at the PSTN.
Mapping mask: Defines the part of the IP address to be
mapped.
( ) ( )
Note:
Additional settings must be made in the AllServe parameter tab for systems in a HiPath
AllServe 150 network.
Server
IP address: Enter the IP address of the AllServe server.
Node
Node ID: A random 32-bit number which represents a unique node in an AllServe system
is generated during system startup.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
13-25
8. Activate the Call charges dialog box in the System status menu.
Open the Output format tab and make the following settings.
LAN-Settings
TFTP-Client
- IP-Addr. Server 1
- IP-Addr. Server 2 (alternative server)
- Cycle: Interval at which HiPath 3000 sends call charge
data to the external application.
TCP-Client
IP-Addr. and TCP port of the external server
TFTP-Server
Threshold as a percentage
Output format:
- File format: UNIX (LF) or DOS (CR/LF)
- Separator: ; (semicolon), | (pipe) or (space)
13-26
PPAdmin
SysAdmin
via PPP
SysAdmin
via LAN
SNMP
Activity
(HiPath 3000 Manager E)
CDRC via IP
Necessary for
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Action
1.
2.
3.
4.
TTL=251
TTL=251
TTL=251
TTL=251
If you issued the ping command from outside the gateway, the gateway IP address may be incorrect. Check the remote network segment
to ensure that the gateway IP address is correct.
Final Tests
Run the following additional tests:
SNMP functions
If configured correctly, reply packets, such as error classes and numbers, should
be visible.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
13-27
13-28
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Activate
Deactivate
Telephone
A = All telephones
D = TDM telephones (optiset E and optiPoint 500) with display)
E = TDM telephones (optiset E and optiPoint 500) without display
N = Analog telephones, analog TA, TA RS232
S = ISDN (S0) terminals, TA S0
C = Cordless
I = IP devices
Accept call waiting (camp-on)
* 55
*60
+ACCT
Advisory message
Appointment (automatic wake-up
system)
* 69
# 69
* 46
+Time
+Type
# 46
D, E, N, C
*67
+Stn.
+Stn. no.
Associated services
*83
+Stn.
+Stn. no.
* 62
D, E, N, C
Busy override
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
A-1
Table A-1
Activate
Deactivate
Telephone
A = All telephones
D = TDM telephones (optiset E and optiPoint 500) with display)
E = TDM telephones (optiset E and optiPoint 500) without display
N = Analog telephones, analog TA, TA RS232
S = ISDN (S0) terminals, TA S0
C = Cordless
I = IP devices
Callback, initiate/view, cancel
* 58
* 65
A
D
* 64
+Stn. no.
# 64
*1
+Type
+Stn. no.
Types:
1=All calls
2=Ext. calls only
3=Int. calls only
#1
* 501
# 501
* 59
+Stn. no.
* 57
* 93
+Old code
+New code
+New code
*3
*0
*7
+ISD no.
(000-999)
(000-299 for HiPath 3350, HiPath 3250, HiPath 3150,
HiPath 3300)
A-2
# 58
#3
D, E, N, C, I
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Table A-1
Activate
Deactivate
Telephone
A = All telephones
D = TDM telephones (optiset E and optiPoint 500) with display)
E = TDM telephones (optiset E and optiPoint 500) without display
N = Analog telephones, analog TA, TA RS232
S = ISDN (S0) terminals, TA S0
C = Cordless
I = IP devices
Do not disturb
* 97
# 97
* 89
+Stn. no..
+Code
# 89
+Stn. no.
+Code
* 61
+Stn. no.
DTMF transmission
* 53
D, E, N, C
* 508
Group ringing
Handsfree answerback
Hunt group, all on/off
Group call, all on/off
Hunt group on/off
Group call on/off
Internal DISA (direct inward system
access)
(can be activated only within a HiPath AllServe 150 V1.0 network)
* 81
+Stn. no.
# 81
* 96
# 96
* 85 *
# 85 #
* 85
+ Grp no.
# 85
+ Grp no.
* 47
+ DISA stn. no
+ DISA stn.
+ Service
+ Suffix dialing
D, E, N
* 91
* 942
+Code
(+ Stn. no.)
* 84
Microphone
* 52
# 52
D, E
Night answer
*44
+Stn. no.
or *44*
# 44
Key programming
Logon mode (for handset) (not for
U.S.)
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
A-3
Table A-1
Activate
Deactivate
Telephone
A = All telephones
D = TDM telephones (optiset E and optiPoint 500) with display)
E = TDM telephones (optiset E and optiPoint 500) without display
N = Analog telephones, analog TA, TA RS232
S = ISDN (S0) terminals, TA S0
C = Cordless
I = IP devices
Park
* 56
+Park slot (0-9)
# 56
+Park slot (09)
* 45
+Stn. no.
# 45
+Stn. no.
* 43
+Trunk
Relocate
* 9419
* 502
Room monitor
* 88
D, E
#0
A
A
# 502
A
D, E, N
# 68
* 68
+Stn. no.
+Text no.
A
A
* 98
# 98
* 87
# 87
Silent monitoring
*944
+Stn. no.
D, E, N, C
Speaker calls
* 80
+Stn. no.
* 41
+DID no.
A-4
# 9419
* 63
+Trunk
* 86
# 86
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Table A-1
Activate
Deactivate
Telephone
A = All telephones
D = TDM telephones (optiset E and optiPoint 500) with display)
E = TDM telephones (optiset E and optiPoint 500) without display
N = Analog telephones, analog TA, TA RS232
S = ISDN (S0) terminals, TA S0
C = Cordless
I = IP devices
Station speed-dialing number,
save/change
* 92
+ISD no.
(*0 - *9)
D, E, N, C
* 90
+Relay no.
System administration
* 95
System administration
Remote DTMF administration and
maintenance, enable (customer
system)
* 992
+Code
System administration
Remote DTMF remote administration and maintenance, activate
(service system)
* 991
* 993
* 943
+Stn
+*
# 943
+Stn
* 42
(0-9 or
#0-#9)
* 66
+Code
Telephone test
Toggle
* 943
+Stn
+#
# 66+Code
* 940
D, E
*2
D, E, N, C
Trace Stop
* 509
* 51
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
# 90
+Relay no.
D, E, N, C
A-5
Table A-1
Activate
Deactivate
Telephone
A = All telephones
D = TDM telephones (optiset E and optiPoint 500) with display)
E = TDM telephones (optiset E and optiPoint 500) without display
N = Analog telephones, analog TA, TA RS232
S = ISDN (S0) terminals, TA S0
C = Cordless
I = IP devices
UCD (uniform call distribution),
logon
* 401
+ID
# 401
D, E, N
UCD, available
* 402
# 402
D, E, N
* 404
+Stn. no.
# 404
D, E, N
A-6
UCD, queue
* 405
UCD, work
* 403
# 403
D, E, N
* 82
# 82
76
75
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Step
Input
1.
*95
2.
XXXXX
Explanation
Start system administration
Enter user name:
Fixed password concept: User name = 31994
3.
XXXXX
Enter password:
For an example of the first time system administration is called via Manager T after
the system is booted, refer to page 12-37.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
A-7
Table A-3
Code Group
Function
12
13
Account Code
14
Configure station
15
Toll restriction
16
Incoming calls
17
Networking
18
Traffic restriction
19
Displays
20
ISDN parameters
21
Analog CO interface
22
System settings
23
Codes
24
Entrance phone
25
Announcement/Music
26
Relays
27
28
Edit CDB
29
System details
30
Remote administration
31
32
33
Attendant console
34
DISA
35
36
37
Security
51-63
A-8
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Table A-4
Code
11
Function
Call detail recording
11
11
11
Print CDR/station
11
11
11
11
11
11
11
11
11
11
11
11
11
11
11
11
11
Calculation accuracy (0 to 3)
11
12
12
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
A-9
Table A-4
Code
12
13
13
13
13
13
14
A-10
Function
Configure station
14
10
14
11
Station type
14
11
Default
14
11
Fax
14
11
Voice mail 5
14
11
Speaker
14
11
Answering machine
14
11
14
11
Analog telephone MW
14
11
Voice mail 6
14
11
Door, pulse
14
11
Memo
14
12
Station name, alphanumeric entry of up to 16 characters (optiset E memory and optiPoint 600 office only)
14
13
14
14
14
15
14
16
14
17
Headset: 0 = Off, 1 = On
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Table A-4
Code
Function
14
18
14
19
14
20
14
21
14
22
14
23
14
24
Reserved
14
25
14
26
Select language:
11 = German
12 = US English
13 = French
14 = Spanish
15 = English
16 = Italian
17 = Dutch
18 = Portuguese
19 = Finnish
20 = Czech
21 = Danish
22 = Swedish
23 = Norwegian
24 = Turkish
25 = Telekom, German
26 = Polish
27 = Hungarian
28 = Russian
29 = Greek
30 = Slovenian
31 = Serbo-Croatian
32 = Estonian
33 = Latvian
34 = Lithuanian
35 = Chinese
36 = Slovakian
37 = Catalonian
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
A-11
Table A-4
Code
14
27
14
28
14
29
14
30
Busy lamp field (BLF; not for U.S): Display: No BLF, one BLF,
two BLFs
14
31
14
32
14
33
14
34
14
35
15
A-12
Function
Toll restriction
15
15
15
Allowed lists
15
15
Allowed 2, 10 entries
15
Allowed 3, 10 entries
15
Allowed 4, 10 entries
15
Allowed 5, 10 entries
15
Allowed 6, 10 entries
15
15
Denied lists
1
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Table A-4
Code
Function
15
Denied 2, 10 entries
15
Denied 3, 10 entries
15
Denied 4, 10 entries
15
Denied 5, 10 entries
15
Denied 6, 10 entries
15
15
Telephone lock
0 = No access except by system speed-dialing
1 = Incoming only
2 - 7 = Allowed lists 1-6 (AL 1 to AL 6)
8 - 13 = Denied lists 1-6 (DL 1 to DL 6)
14 = Full access (full)
15
15
15
16
Incoming calls
16
10
16
10
16
10
16
10
16
10
16
11
16
12
16
13
16
14
Intercept mode
16
14
16
14
On busy
16
14
16
14
16
14
Station
Groups
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
A-13
Table A-4
Code
A-14
Function
16
14
16
14
16
15
16
15
16
15
16
15
16
15
Select host (primary)/executive, group, and station (only stations that are not the host (primary) telephone in another
group)
16
16
16
17
16
18
16
18
Hunt/group call
V3.0 or later =
500 for HiPath 3750, HiPath 3700
376 for HiPath 3550, HiPath 3500
70 for all other systems
Select destination (1 4), possible entries:
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Table A-4
Code
Function
16
18
V3.0 or later =
1 500 for HiPath 3750, HiPath 3700
1 376 for HiPath 3550, HiPath 3500
1 70 for all other systems
16
18
V3.0 or later =
1 500 for HiPath 3750, HiPath 3700
1 376 for HiPath 3550, HiPath 3500
1 70 for all other systems
16
18
V3.0 or later =
1 500 for HiPath 3750, HiPath 3700
1 376 for HiPath 3550, HiPath 3500
1 70 for all other systems
16
18
16
18
16
18
16
18
16
19
16
20
16
21
17
Networking
17
11
17
12
17
13
17
14
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
A-15
Table A-4
Code
17
15
17
16
17
17
17
17
17
17
17
18
Central intercept
17
19
17
19
Destination system
17
19
17
19
17
19
Node number
17
20
17
21
17
22
17
22
17
22
17
23
17
23
17
23
17
23
18
A-16
Function
Traffic restriction
18
18
Hotline
18
Hotline destinations
HiPath 3750, HiPath 3550, HiPath 3700, HiPath 3500: Destination 1-6
HiPath 3350, HiPath 3300: Destination 1
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Table A-4
Code
Function
18
18
18
Hotline assignment
HiPath 3750, HiPath 3550, HiPath 3700, HiPath 3500: 1-6
HiPath 3350, HiPath 3300: 1
18
18
18
18
18
18
18
3-1
18
3-2
18
18
Connection groups
1
19
19
11
Text messages: select message no. 0 to 9 and enter alphanumeric text (up to 24 characters) (optiset E memory and optiPoint 600 office only)
19
12
Advisory messages: select message no. 0 to 9 and enter alphanumeric text (up to 24 characters) (optiset E memory and
optiPoint 600 office only)
19
13
19
14
19
15
19
16
19
17
19
18
20
ISDN parameters
20
20
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
A-17
Table A-4
Code
A-18
Function
20
20
20
20
20
20
20
20
20
20
20
S0 port configuration; select slot/port and determine connection type (not for U.S.):
1 = Automatic
2 = DSS1 trunk PP
3 = DSS1 trunk PMP
4 = Euro-bus
5 = CorNet 1
6 = CorNet 2
7 = ECMA-QSIG
8 = ISO-QSIG
20
S2M port configuration; select slot/port and determine connection type (not for U.S.):
1 = DSS1 trunk PP
2 = CorNet 1
3 = CorNet 2
4 = ECMA-QSIG (not for U.S.)
5 = ISO-QSIG (not for U.S.)
20
20
20
20
20
20
20
Reference clock
Table A-4
Code
Function
20
CO/protocol:
1 = AT&T/NI 1
2 = AT&T/Custom
3 = Siemens/NI 1
4 = NT/NI 1
20
20
20
20
20
20
20
Emulation type
20
Frame/line/encod
20
20
Remote payload
20
No. of B-chn
20
B-chn identifier
20
20
10
Facility
PRI parameters
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
A-19
Table A-4
Code
A-20
Function
20
11
Protocol type:
11 = AT&T/Custom
12 = AT&T/NI2
13 = AT&T/NI2 OSA
14 = AT&T/4ESS
15 = Siemens/Custom
16 = Siemens/Custom OSA
17 = Siemens/NI2
18 = Siemens/NI2 OSA
19 = MCI/DEX600
20 = MCI/DMS250
21 = BELL/DMS100
22 = BELL DMS100 TNS
23 = Nortel/DMS100
24 = Nortel DMS100 TNS
25 = SPRINT/DMS250
26 = Westinghouse
27 = FTS/DMS250
28 = FTS/5ESS
29 = GENERIC/NI2
30 = GENERIC/NI2 OSA
31 = QSIG
32 = IDA-P
20
12
20
13
Inwats parameter
20
20
13-2 DNIS
20
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Table A-4
Code
20
Function
14
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
A-21
Table A-4
Code
A-22
Function
20
15
CBC pool:
11 = AT&TSDN-GSDN
12 = AT&TSDDN
13 = MCI-VN-VS
14 = SPRINT-VPN
15 = WICN-PV
16 = MEG800-TFM
17 = MCI 800
18 = ULTRA-800
19 = WICN-INWATS
20 = MEG
21 = MCI-PRISIM-WATS
22 = SPR-ULTRA-WATS
23 = WICN-OUTWATS
24 = ACCU-SDS
25 = LDS-WC-TSAA
26 = INTER-800
27 = MULTIQUEST
28 = MCI-900
29 = SDS56
30 = SDS64C
31 = SDS64R
32 = DMS100-PV
33 = DMS100-INWATS
34 = DMS100-OUTWATS
35 = DMS100-FX
36 = 5ESS-INWATS
37 = WATS-MSB
38 = DMS100-TIE
39 = NI2-INWATS
40 = NI2-OUTWATS
41 = NI2-FX
42 = NI2-TIE
43 = NI2-HOTEL
44 = NI2-SCOCS
20
16
20
20
QSIG: S0 parameter
20
20
System number
20
Group number
QSIG parameter
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Table A-4
Code
Function
20
20
20
Port number
20
National number
20
International number
20
21
Analog CO interface
21
21
MFC-R2
21
21
21
21
21
21
21
22
System settings
22
11
22
12
Directory: 0 = Off, 1 = On
22
13
22
13
22
13
Port assignment
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
A-23
Table A-4
Code
A-24
Function
22
13
22
13
22
13
22
13
22
13
22
13
22
14
22
14
22
14
22
15
22
16
Applications
22
16
22
17
22
17
22
17
22
18
22
19
Class of service
22
19
22
19
22
20
22
21
22
22
22
23
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Table A-4
Code
Function
22
24
22
25
22
26
22
27
CO features (Transfer/Conference/Drop):
0 = disabled, 1 = enabled
22
28
22
29
22
30
22
31
22
32
22
33
22
34
MFC-R2 parameters
22
34
22
34
DID digits
22
35
22
35
By hanging up
22
35
Without hanging up
22
36
22
37
22
38
22
38
22
38
01
22
38
09
22
38
12
22
38
15
22
38
16
22
38
20
22
38
21
22
38
23
Common hold
Stop trace
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
A-25
Table A-4
Code
22
38
26
22
38
28
22
38
29
22
38
30
22
38
11
22
38
22
39
22
39
IP interface, mode:
0 = Inactive
1 = HIP Forwarding
2 = LIM
3 = SLIP Routing
22
39
23
Codes
23
23
23
Trunk access code; select slot and trunk and enter new code
23
Trunk group code; select trunk group followed by position 110 for code and enter new code
Trunk group 1-8 (HiPath 3350, HiPath 3250, HiPath 3150, HiPath 3300)
Trunk group 1-16 (HiPath 3750, HiPath 3550, HiPath 3700,
HiPath 3500)
23
Attendant code
23
23
23
23
24
A-26
Function
Entrance phone
24
24
24
Table A-4
Code
Function
24
24
25
Announcement/Music
25
25
Announcement type; select announcement device: 1 = Announcement/music, 2 = Music on hold, 3 = Internal music
25
25
External MOH
(Only enter analog line module stations.)
26
Relays
26
26
Switching time
Select relay 1 through 4 and enter up to 3 digits (0 to 255)
26
Assigned station
Select relay 1 through 4 and enter stations or groups (up to 5
digits)
26
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
A-27
Table A-4
Code
27
Sensors (HiPath 3550, HiPath 3350, HiPath 3500 and HiPath 3300 only)
27
27
27
27
27
27
27
27
27
28
Edit CDB
28
28
28
CDB to MMC
28
29
A-28
Function
System details
29
System
29
29
29
29
29
29
29
Status display
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Table A-4
Code
Function
29
29
29
Software version for each option (1 to 16) (for verification purposes only)
29
Reset options
29
29
Boards
1
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
A-29
Table A-4
Code
A-30
Function
29
29
xx
29
0-9
Board status
29
Disable/Enable board
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Table A-4
Code
29
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Function
Initialize country: select country code (00 to 99)
11 = Germany
12 = Netherlands
13 = France
14 = Finland
15 = United Kingdom
16 = Italy
17 = Spain
18 = Portugal
19 = Switzerland
20 = Austria
21 = International
22 = Ireland
23 = Belgium
24 = Brazil
25 = South Africa
26 = China
28 = India
29 = Czech Republic
30 = Denmark
31 = Australia
32 = Argentina
33 = Philippines
36 = Singapore
37 = Hungary
38 = Malaysia
40 = Indonesia
41 = Russia
42 = Thailand
46 = Poland
47 = Greece
49 = Sweden
50 = Norway
51 = Turkey
52 = U.S.A. and Canada
53 = Pakistan
54 = Hong Kong
55 = New Zealand
A-31
Table A-4
Code
30
Remote administration
30
30
30
30
Reset password
30
Integrated modem
30
30
DID number
30
30
30
30
DID number
30
CAID admin
30
30
30
30
30
30
30
Station number
30
DID number
Digital modem
Callback call
31
A-32
Function
31
31
Group parameters
31
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Table A-4
Code
Function
31
31
Call cycles
31
31
31
31
31
31
31
32
32
32
Radio paging type (HiPath 3750, HiPath 3700 only): 1 = Standard, 2 = Enhanced (not for U.S.)
32
32
32
32
32
32
32
32
32
32
32
32
32
32
32
32
32
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
A-33
Table A-4
Code
33
Attendant console
33
33
Reserved
33
33
34
DISA
34
34
DID number
34
34
35
A-34
Function
35
35
35
Outdial rule
35
35
35
35
35
LCR schedule
35
35
35
35
Routing tables
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Table A-4
Code
Function
35
35
35
35
35
35
35
35
35
35
Dialing plan
36
36
36
36
36
36
37
37
Security
1
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Change password
A-35
Table A-4
Code
Function
Customer administration (previously Manager TC)
51
51
Speed-dialing numbers
51
Speed-dialing names
52
Time, hour/minute
53
Date, mmddyy
54
54
54
Edit CDRS
54
Print CDRS
54
54
Edit CDRT
54
Print CDRT
54
54
ISDN factor
54
Currency designation
54
Call log
54
CDR at station
55
Station names
56
Text messages
57
Advisory messages
58
Language selection
59
Group names
60
Account codes
60
60
60
60
Number of digits
61
A-36
Hotline
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Table A-4
Code
Function
61
Hotline destinations
61
Hotline station
61
61
Hotline assignment
61
Hotline timeout
62
63
Codes, Cordless
99
Access
The bolded messages appear in optiset E memory and optiPoint 600 office telephones only.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
A-37
A-38
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
>
The following values are for orientation only, and can vary depending on the traffic
flow.
This supplement specifies the power requirement of the boards and components of
the HiPath 3000 systems. In addition, information is provided on the power requirement of the different workpoint clients, key modules and adapters.
With this information,
every system configuration can be checked to see whether the nominal output of
the power supply unit is sufficient or whether an additional power supply may be
needed.
Topic
HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 Boards Power Requirement, page B-2
HiPath 3550 Boards Power Requirement, page B-4
HiPath 3350 Boards Power Requirement, page B-6
HiPath 3500 Boards Power Requirement, page B-8
HiPath 3300 Boards Power Requirement, page B-10
Workpoint clients, Key Modules and Adapter Power Requirements, page B-12
Check Whether the Output of a Power Supply Unit is Sufficient, page B-14
Identifying the Primary System Power Requirement, page B-17
>
To ensure that a systems dynamic capacity limit is not exceeded, the configuration
can be tested using the project planning tool (Intranet: http://intranet.mch4.siemens.de/syseng/perfeng/tools/hpt/index_en.htm).
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
B-1
>
Nominal output of the HiPath 3750 power supply unit and HiPath
3700
Part Number
S30122-K5950-A76100
S30122-K5950-S76100
S30122-K5959-S121(for RSA
only)
48 V
60.0
166.0
You must check whether the total power requirement of the boards used and the
connected workpoint clients of a system box exceeds the maximum possible UPSM
output. Section B.7 contains a sample calculation.
Table B-2
Board or Component
48 V
BS3/1
S30807-H5482-X
2.0
BS3/3
S30807-H5485-X
3.0
8.5
GEE8
S30817-Q664-xxxx
1.0
HXGM2
S 30810-Q2940-X
S30810-Q2940-X10
S30810-Q2940-X100
S30810-Q2940-X110
3.0
HXGM3
S30810-Q2942-X
12.0
IVML8
S30122-X7380-X100
3.0
0.7
IVML24
S30122-X7380-X
5.0
1.0
PDM1
S30807-Q5692-X100
5.0
PEM
S30807-Q5679-X
4.0
REAL
S30807-Q5913-X
0.5
SLA8N
S30810-Q2929-X200
1.5
1.5
SLA16N
S30810-Q2929-X100
3.0
3.0
B-2
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Table B-2
Board or Component
Part Number
48 V
SLA24N
S30810-Q2929-X
4.5
4.5
SLC16
S30810-Q2922-X
8.0
SLC16N
S30810-Q2193-X100
5.0
SLMO8
S30810-Q2901-X100
0.7
SLMO24
S30810-Q2901-X
1.5
STMD2
S30810-Q2558-X400
2.0
STMD8
S30810-Q2558-X200
2.0
TIEL
S30810-Q2520-X
1.0
TMAMF
S30810-Q2587-A200
1.81
16.91
TMCAS
S30810-Q2938-X
TMDID8
S30810-Q2507-X
1.41
23.81
TMGL8
S30810-Q2703-X
1.61
2.11
TML8W
S30817-Q626-Axxx/Bxxx
1.0
TMST1
S30810-Q2920-X
3.0
TMS2
S30810-Q2915-X
3.0
Not Available
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
B-3
Part Number
48 V
UPSC-D
S30122-K5660-M300
40.0
53.0
S30122-K5660-M300 with
S30122-K7221-X2
40.0
140.0
>
You must check whether the total power requirement of the boards used and the
connected workpoint clients exceeds the maximum possible output of the UPSC-D
with or without EPSU2. Section B.7 contains an sample calculation.
Table B-4
Board or Component
Part Number
48 V
BS3/1
S30807-H5482-X
2.0
BS3/3
S30807-H5485-X
3.0
S30810-Q2935-A201
7.0
0.5
GEE12
S30817-Q951-Axxx
0.5
GEE16
S30817-Q951-Axxx
0.5
GEE50
S30817-Q951-Axxx
0.5
HXGS2
S30810-Q2939-X
S30810-Q2939-X10
S30810-Q2939-X100
S30810-Q2939-X110
4.5
1.5
10.0
2.8
S30810-Q2943-X
10.0
IVMS8
S30122-Q7379-X
2.6
0.3
PDM1
S30807-Q5692-X100
5.0
PEM
S30807-Q5679-X
4.0
SLA8N
S30810-Q2929-X200
0.2
0.5
B-4
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Table B-4
Board or Component
Part Number
48 V
SLA16N
S30810-Q2929-X100
3.0
3.0
SLA24N
S30810-Q2929-X
4.5
4.5
SLC16
S30810-Q2922-X
8.0
SLC16N
S30810-Q2193-X100
5.0
SLMO24
S30810-Q2901-X
1.5
SLU8
S30817-Q922-A301
0.8
STLS2
S30817-Q924-B313
0.6
STLS4
S30817-Q924-A313
1.0
STRB
S30817-Q932-A
0.5
TLA2
S30817-Q923-Bxxx
0.1
TLA4
S30817-Q923-Axxx
0.2
TLA8
S30817-Q926-Axxx
0.4
TMAMF
S30810-Q2587-A400
1.81
16.91
TMCAS
S30810-Q2938-X
TMGL4
S30810-Q2918-X
4.71
0.11
TMQ4
S30810-Q2917-X
3.8
TST1
S30810-Q2919-X
0.8
TS2
S30810-Q2913-X100
0.9
V24/1
S30807-Q6916-X100
0.3
4SLA
S30810-Q2923-X200
0.7
0.7
8SLA
S30810-Q2923-X100
1.3
1.3
16SLA
S30810-Q2923-X
2.5
2.5
Not Available
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
B-5
Part Number
48 V
S30122-K5658-M
15.0
19.2
UPSC-D
S30122-K5660-M300
20.01
53.0
S30122-K5660-M300 with
S30122-K7221-X2
40.0
140.0
PSUP
1 Nominal output = 40 W. Due to build-up of heat, not more than 20 W may be withdrawn.
>
You must check whether the total power requirement of the boards used and the
connected workpoint clients exceeds the maximum possible output of the PSUP or
the UPSC-D with or without EPSU2. Section B.7 contains an sample calculation.
Table B-6
Board or Component
Part Number
48 V
BS3/1
S30807-H5482-X
2.0
BS3/3
S30807-H5485-X
3.0
S30810-Q2935-A201
7.0
0.5
GEE12
S30817-Q951-Axxx
0.5
GEE16
S30817-Q951-Axxx
0.5
GEE50
S30817-Q951-Axxx
0.5
HXGS2
S30810-Q2939-X
S30810-Q2939-X10
S30810-Q2939-X100
S30810-Q2939-X110
4.5
1.5
10.0
2.8
IVMP8
S30122-Q7379-X100
2.6
0.3
PDM1
S30807-Q5692-X100
5.0
PEM
S30807-Q5679-X
4.0
SLU8
S30817-Q922-A301
0.8
B-6
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Table B-6
Board or Component
Part Number
48 V
STLS2
S30817-Q924-B313
0.6
STLS4
S30817-Q924-A313
1.0
STRB
S30817-Q932-A
0.5
TLA2
S30817-Q923-Bxxx
0.1
TLA4
S30817-Q923-Axxx
0.2
TLA8
S30817-Q926-Axxx
0.4
TMGL4
S30810-Q2918-X
4.71
0.11
TMQ4
S30810-Q2917-X
3.8
V24/1
S30807-Q6916-X100
0.3
4SLA
S30810-Q2923-X200
0.7
0.7
8SLA
S30810-Q2923-X100
1.3
1.3
16SLA
S30810-Q2923-X
2.5
2.5
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
B-7
Part Number
UPSC-DR
UPSC-DR with
EPSU2R1
48 V
S30122-K7373-M900
40.0
53.0
S30122-K7373-M900 with
S30122-K7221-X900
40.0
140.0
You must check whether the total power requirement of the boards used and the
connected workpoint clients exceeds the maximum possible output of the UPSCDR with or without EPSU2-R. Section B.7 contains an sample calculation.
>
Table B-8
Board or Component
Part Number
48 V
BS3/1
S30807-H5482-X
2.0
BS3/3
S30807-H5485-X
3.0
S30810-K2935-Z
7.0
0.5
HXGSR2
S30810-K2939-Z
S30810-K2939-Z10
S30810-K2939-Z100
S30810-K2939-Z110
4.5
1.5
HXGR3
S30810-K2943-Z
10.0
IVMS8R
S30122-K7379-Z
2.6
0.3
1.4
PDM1
S30807-Q5692-X100
5.0
PEM
S30807-Q5679-X
4.0
SLU8R
S30817-K922-Z301
0.8
STLS4R
S30817-K924-Z313
1.0
STRBR
S30817-Q932-Z
0.5
TLA4R
S30817-Q923-Zxxx
0.2
B-8
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Table B-8
Board or Component
Part Number
48 V
0.11
TMGL4R
S30810-K2918-Z
5.71
TST1
S30810-K2919-Z
0.8
TS2R
S30810-K2913-Z100
0.9
8SLAR
S30810-K2925-Z
1.3
1.3
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
B-9
Part Number
UPSC-DR
2
48 V
S30122-K7373-M900
20.01
53.0
S30122-K7373-M900 with
S30122-K7221-X900
40.0
140.0
1 Nominal output = 40 W. Due to build-up of heat, not more than 20 W may be withdrawn.
2 Installed in expansion box EBR S30777-U711-E901
You must check whether the total power requirement of the boards used and the
connected workpoint clients exceeds the maximum possible output of the UPSCDR with or without EPSU2-R. A sample calculation is shown in Section B.7.
>
Table B-10
Board or Component
Part Number
48 V
BS3/1
S30807-H5482-X
2.0
BS3/3
S30807-H5485-X
3.0
S30810-K2935-Z
7.0
0.5
HXGSR2
S30810-K2939-Z
S30810-K2939-Z10
S30810-K2939-Z100
S30810-K2939-Z110
4.5
1.5
HXGR3
S30810-K2943-Z
10.0
IVMP8R
S30122-K7379-Z100
2.6
0.3
1.4
PDM1
S30807-Q5692-X100
5.0
PEM
S30807-Q5679-X
4.0
SLU8R
S30817-K922-Z301
0.8
STLS4R
S30817-K924-Z313
1.0
STRBR
S30817-Q932-Z
0.5
TLA4R
S30817-Q923-Zxxx
0.2
B-10
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Table B-10
Board or Component
Part Number
48 V
0.11
1.3
TMGL4R
S30810-K2918-Z
5.71
8SLAR
S30810-K2925-Z
1.3
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
B-11
optiPoint 500
0.3
0.7
0.7
0.7
0.72
0.05
optiPoint BLF
01
02
0.7
0.18
0.25
0.3
B-12
01
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Table B-11
optiset E
optiset E entry
0.36
optiset E basic
0.36
optiset E standard
0.41
0.43
0.85
optiset E memory
0.56
0.06
01
0.02
02
0.7
0.34
0.76
0.03
0.23
0.05
0.06
0.3
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
B-13
Warning
To guarantee smooth system operation, the nominal output of the power supply unit
at the 5 V output and at the 48 V output must be greater than the respective secondary power requirement.
Procedure
Proceed as follows to identify the secondary power requirement of a system:
1.
B-14
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
7.00 W
1 x CBCC
4.50 W
1 x HXGS2
0.90 W
1 x TS2
2.40 W
3 x SLU8
1.30 W
1 x 8SLA
5.00 W
1 x SLC16N
0.00 W
12 x BS3/1
21.10 W
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
B-15
2.
0.50 W
1 x CBCC
1.50 W
1 x HXGS2
0.00 W
1 x TS2
0.00 W
3 x SLU8
1.30 W
1 x 8SLA
0.00 W
1 x SLC16N
24.00 W
12 x BS3/1
0.56 W
1 x optiset E memory
4.32 W
0.85 W
8.40 W
2.40 W
0.00 W
0.00 W
2 x optiPoint BLF
0.40 W
0.50 W
1.80 W
6 x analog telephones
46.53 W
B-16
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
the result should be multiplied by the factor 1.2 to allow for the degree of efficiency of
the power supply.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
B-17
7.50 W
1 x CBCC
6.00 W
1 x HXGS2
0.90 W
1 x TS2
2.40 W
3 x SLU8
2.60 W
1 x 8SLA
5.00 W
1 x SLC16N
24.00 W
12 x BS3/1
0.56 W
1 x optiset E memory
4.32 W
0.85 W
8.40 W
2.40 W
0.00 W
0.00 W
2 x optiPoint BLF
0.40 W
0.50 W
1.80 W
67.63 W
UPSC-D requirement =
12.00 W
79.63 W
x 1.2 = 95.6 W
The primary power requirement of HiPath 3550 with the expansion mentioned amounts to approximately 95.6 W.
B-18
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
U.S.-Specific Aspects
Overview
C U.S.-Specific Aspects
C.1 Overview
Chapter Contents
This appendix discusses the following U.S.-specific topics:
Subject
Configuring a Primary Rate Interface (PRI) ISDN, page C-2
Inband Integration Specifications, page C-17
Configuring the HiPath 3000 for the Octel Overture 250/350, Octel Overture 200/
300, and Audix INTUITY Systems, page C-25
Installing and Configuring the TraqNet 2002 Product, page C-29
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
C-1
U.S.-Specific Aspects
Configuring a Primary Rate Interface (PRI) ISDN
>
Besides the US market the T1-PRI protocol is also used for the country
HONGKONG. In Hongkong the PRI protocol has always to be set to IDA-P - HKTAProtocol.
Table C-1
Supported Protocols
Protocol
C-2
ATT 4ESS CO
ATT 5ESS CO
MCI DEX600 CO
Sprint DMS100 CO
Siemens EWSD CO
Generic NI-2 CO
Siemens NI-2 CO
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
U.S.-Specific Aspects
Configuring a Primary Rate Interface (PRI) ISDN
Planning Steps
Consider the following items when designing a primary rate interface.
Contact the local service provider to determine the central office type, the national ISDN standard used, and the voice and data services supported
Define your customers needs and the services they will require
Work with the network provider and the customer to determine any optional requirements for incoming and outgoing voice and data services
Table C-2 outlines the voice and data services provided by inter-exchange carriers
(IECs) in the North American market.
Table C-2
IEC
AT&T 4ESS MCI DMSSERVICES
250/MCI
DEX-600
SPRINT
DMS250
INWATS
(800)
MEG800TFM
MCI 800
ULTRA-800
WICN-INWATS
N/A
OUTWATS
MEG
MCIPRISMWATS
SPR-ULTRA-WATS
WICN-OUTWATS
N/A
INWATS
(900)
MULTIQUEST
MCI/900
N/A
N/A
N/A
Intl INWATS
(800)
INTER-800
MCI 800
N/A
N/A
N/A
PVN
AT&T
SDDN
MCI-VN-VS SPRINTVPN
WICN-PV
N/A
Intl VPN
SPRINTVPN
N/A
N/A
SDS-56
ACCU-SDS None
ACCU-SDS
ACCU-SDS
N/A
ACCU-SDS
ACCU-SDS
N/A
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
WH DMS250
FTS 2000
DMS and
FTS 2000
5ESS
C-3
U.S.-Specific Aspects
Configuring a Primary Rate Interface (PRI) ISDN
Table C-3 outlines the voice and data services provided by local exchange carriers
(LECs) in the North American market.
Table C-3
LEC SERVICES
NT DMS-100 or
BC DMS-100
GENERIC NI2 or
SIEMENS NI2 or
AT&T 5ESS NI2
INWATS (800)
MEG
DMS100 INWATS
NI2-INWATS
OUTWATS
MEG
DMS100
OUTWATS
NI2-OUTWATS
INWATS (900)
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
PVN
N/A
DMS100-PV
N/A
Multiband
OUTWATS
MEG
DMS100 OUTWATS
NI2-OUTWATS
Access to
LEC Operator
None
None
None
None
None
DMS100
OUTWATS
NI2-OUTWATS
None
None
Access to IEC
Operator
None
None
None
SDS-56
None
None
None
SDS 64-c/r
None
None
None
Equal Access to
IEC Long Distance Services
C-4
AT&T 5ESS or
SIEMENS EWSD
MEG
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
U.S.-Specific Aspects
Configuring a Primary Rate Interface (PRI) ISDN
Task
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
Optional Steps
Step
Task
1.
2.
Action
1.
Use the HiPath 3000 Manager E dialog box to select and place the T1 cards in the
desired card slots. For Primary Rate applications, you must select the TST1 Digital
or TMST1 Digital card type. The card data should be set for TMST1 Digital, which is
the default.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
C-5
U.S.-Specific Aspects
Configuring a Primary Rate Interface (PRI) ISDN
Action
System status ->System wide ->Switchover to -> Hardware expansion ->Card configuration ->Card data
The T1 Module data is preset for a digital T1 interface and will operate in most situations. Card data information can be revised and saved as a template if required. Table
C-4 lists the default configuration for the T1 digital interface.
Table C-4
X SF/ESF
In/Out Priority
X AMI/B8ZS
X Layer 2 active
Not supported
X Contact closure
Optical fiber
X CRC 6 - check
TEI verify
EOC
C-6
Action
Options ->Lines/networking ->Trunks ->Route
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
U.S.-Specific Aspects
Configuring a Primary Rate Interface (PRI) ISDN
Slot/Trunk
Code
Route
Route Name
TMST1 6-1-1
7801
rte. 1
PRI 4ESS
TMST1 6-1-2
7802
rte. 1
PRI 4ESS
TMST1 6-1-3
7803
rte. 1
PRI 4ESS
TMST1 6-1-4
7804
rte. 1
PRI 4ESS
TMST1 6-1-23
7823
rte. 2
PRI 4ESS
.
TMST1 7-1-1
7824
rte. 2
PRI 5ESS
TMST1 7-1-2
7825
rte. 2
PRI 5ESS
TMST1 7-1-3
7826
rte. 2
PRI 5ESS
TMST1 7-1-23
7846
rte. 2
PRI 5ESS
Action
Options ->Lines/networking -> Trunks ->Parameters (double-click)
->ISDN flags
C-7
U.S.-Specific Aspects
Configuring a Primary Rate Interface (PRI) ISDN
Call by Call services are optional and should be reviewed with the customer and the
public network provider.
Programming Using HiPath 3000 Manager E
Step
1.
Action
Options ->Lines/networking ->Trunks ->Routes
Name
Enter a display name for the PRI interface. The entry can be up to 10 characters in
length.
PABX Number
Typically the operating company assigns an 11-digit directory number to the PRI interface for incoming direct-inward-dialing and dialed-number Identification services.
Depending on the length of the DID-DNIS number being sent from the central office,
you should complete the following table entries.
For example, if the directory number received is 1-408-492-2000 and there are no
DID-DNIS numbers required, the fields should be filled in as follows:
Country Code: 1
Country Code: 1
Overflow Route
An optional route can be selected for handling outbound calls if the PRI interface
channels are busy.
C-8
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
U.S.-Specific Aspects
Configuring a Primary Rate Interface (PRI) ISDN
Calling Service
None: If None is selected, no optional voice or data services are required. The circuit
will be used for basic voice applications.
Call by Call Group: One of four call-by-call groups can be selected in the HiPath
3750 and HiPath 3700. One call-by-call group can be selected in the HiPath 3550 and
HiPath 3500. A call-by-call group can be assigned to the entire PRI span or to a specific route group associated with group of channels within a PRI span. Access codes
for the specific calling services are assigned on the PRI screen.
Specific Calling Service for Route Group: A specific calling service can be assigned to the entire PRI span or to specific channels in a configured route group. If a
service is assigned to a group of channels on a span, the seizure code for the route
group is used to access the outbound service.
C.2.2.6 Setting Additional Route Parameters
The Route type should be set to CO and the number and type outgoing should be set
to Local area code,
Programming Using HiPath 3000 Manager E
Step
1.
Action
Options ->Lines/networking -> Routing parameters
Route Type:
Country code: If selected, 14084922000 is sent to the network for our example.
Local area code: If selected, 4084922000 is sent to the network for our example.
PABX number: If selected, 4922000 is sent to the network for our example.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
C-9
U.S.-Specific Aspects
Configuring a Primary Rate Interface (PRI) ISDN
Action
Options ->Lines/networking ->Trunks ->Clock parameters
Example:
Position
TMST1 6
TMST1 7
C-10
Action
Options ->Lines/networking ->Trunks ->PRI
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
U.S.-Specific Aspects
Configuring a Primary Rate Interface (PRI) ISDN
Example:
INWATS DNIS
You can configure INWATS calling service for Trunk Group 2 and Trunk Group 3, depending on the carrier specification. The dialed number identification service (DNIS)
800-777-7222 on Trunk Group 2 leads to direct-inward-dialing (DID) Port 700 (dedicated service and CBC service). The empty DNIS field (response to no DNIS) on
Trunk Group 3 leads to DID Port 701. This is for dedicated service only.
Position 1-40
Route 1-16
8007777222
700
701
3
4
.
.
40
C.2.2.9 Configuring Call By Call Groups (Optional)
The HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 communications server support 4 call by call
groups. HiPath 3550 and HiPath 3500 support one call by call group. Each call by call
group supports from one to eight call services, which are accessed using a configurable code. Based on the parameters selected on the Trunks and Routes screen, an
entire PRI span can be associated with a CBC pool or selected channels can be configured for specific ISDN calling services.
Call by Call groups can be used to access public network services on specific PRI
channels provided by the central office. CBC trunk group 1 represents the #4ESS
span and CBC trunk group 2 represents the #5ESS span. The direct access codes
are placed in this dialog form.
A CBC Pool has been configured with the AT&T Megacom offering and the ACCUNET Data offering. The CBC trunk group codes are used to access the services identified in the CBC pool for each of the Primary Interface spans configured in the system.
Programming Using HiPath 3000 Manager E
Step
1.
Action
Options ->Lines/networking ->Trunks ->PRI
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
C-11
U.S.-Specific Aspects
Configuring a Primary Rate Interface (PRI) ISDN
Authorization code
LCR schedule
Extension access
Warnings
To use calling services, you must configure several trunk groups. One trunk group can
be used for a basic call, a dedicated service, or a CBC pool. Prime Line should always
be off.
PABX Number
Incoming Calls
The system interprets the type of number for Incoming calls via the PABX number
field on the Routes dialog table.
Station number: 49
International number: 1
For incoming calls, the right destination (address) is examined based on the received
type of number and the digit Information.
Outgoing Calls
For outgoing calls the calling address is built from the DID plus the configured station
number information.
C-12
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
U.S.-Specific Aspects
Configuring a Primary Rate Interface (PRI) ISDN
The type of number of the called address depend on the protocol and the dialed number (refer to the different numbering plans of the carrier specifications). To override
this behavior and send a leading 1 in front of a 10-digit code, for example, you must
configure the dialing rule as follows:
Note: In these cases, set the Type of Number to Unknown in the HiPath 3000 Manager E routing parameters: Options ->Lines/networking ->Routing parameters.
LCR Access Code
The first field of the dialing plan is also known as the LCR access code. After a reload
of the system, the trunk group access codes (80, 81, 82, 84, 851, 852,) can be used
for LCR access. Other LCR access codes can be configured using HiPath 3000 Manager E.
Basic Call
Example:
After dialing LCR access code 80, the user first hears the simulation of the dial tone.
The subsequent dialed digits are saved until the end of dialing (# or timeout). The
LCR digit interpretation finds that Line 1 of the dialing plan is valid and selects the
assigned routing table (Routing Table 1).
Routing Table: The first entry of the Routing Table 1 leads to Trunk Group 1 using Outdial Rule 1 if the extension has the minimum authorization. Time schedule and warnings are not configured.
1.
Outdial Rule: All digits are echoed except the first field (LCR access code).
User dials
80 4234567
User dials
80 4234567
C-13
U.S.-Specific Aspects
Configuring a Primary Rate Interface (PRI) ISDN
Dedicated Service
Example:
Dedicated Services
Dialing Plan: After dialing LCR access code 80, 81, or 82, the user first hears the
simulation of the dialing tone. The subsequent dialed digits are saved until the end of
dialing (# or timeout). LCR digit interpretation determines whether the following digits
match the entries in the dialing plan. If so, the dialing plan leads to one of the routing
tables (1 to 3).
Routing Table: The first entry of Routing Table 1 leads to Trunk Group 1 using Outdial Rule 1 if the extension has the minimum authorization. Time Schedule and Warnings are not configured. The first entry in Routing Table 2 leads to Trunk Group 2 using Outdial Rule 2 if the extension has the minimum authorization. Time schedule and
warnings are not configured. The first entry in Routing Table 3 leads to Trunk Group
3 using Outdial Rule 3 if the extension has the minimum authorization. Time schedule
and warnings are not configured.
Outdial Rule:
Rule 1 After CIC 222 is used, all digits are echoed except the first field.
Rule 2 means that after Band Number 1 is used for OUTWATS, all digits are echoed except the first field.
Rule 3 means that after Band Number 2 is used for OUTWATS, all digits are echoed except the first field.
Example:
Example:
Example:
C-14
80-423-4567
System dials
81-1-415-423-4567
System dials
82-1-707-423-4567
System dials
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
U.S.-Specific Aspects
Configuring a Primary Rate Interface (PRI) ISDN
CBC Pool
Example:
Dedicated Services
Dialing Plan: After dialing the LCR Access Code 80, 81, or 82, the user first hears
the simulation of the dialing tone. The subsequent dialed digits are saved until the end
of dialing (# or timeout). LCR Digit Interpretation determines whether the subsequent
digits match the entries in the Dialing Plan. If so, the Dialing Plan leads to one of the
Routing Tables (1 to 3).
Routing Table: The first entry in Routing Table 1 leads to Trunk Group 1 using Outdial
Rule 1 if the extension has the minimum authorization. Time schedule and warnings
are not configured. The first entry in Routing Table 2 leads to Trunk Group 2 using
Outdial Rule 2 if the extension has the minimum authorization. Time schedule and
warnings are not configured. The first entry in Routing Table 3 leads to Trunk Group
2 using Outdial Rule 3 if the extension has the minimum authorization. Time schedule
and warnings are not configured.
Outdial Rule:
Rule1 means that after CIC 222 is used, all digits are echoed except the first field.
Rule 2 means that after SFG 404 is used for NI-2 OUTWATS, all digits are echoed except the first field.
Rule 3 means that all digits are echoed except the first field.
Example:
Example:
Example:
80-423-4567
System dials
81-1-415-423-4567
System dials
82-423-4567
System dials
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
C-15
U.S.-Specific Aspects
Configuring a Primary Rate Interface (PRI) ISDN
In the case of the cut-through method, the switch may have to wait for a PROGRESS
containing PI #1 or PI #8. After it receives the PROGRESS, the switch sends the dialing information as DTMF digits.
Dialing Plan: After dialing the LCR access code 80, the user first hears the simulation of the dial tone. The subsequent dialed digits are saved until the end of dialing (#
or timeout). The subsequent digits lead to Routing Table 1.
Routing Table: The first entry in Routing Table 1 leads to Trunk Group 1 using Outdial Rule 1 if the extension has the minimum authorization. Time schedule and warnings are not configured.
Outdial Rule: Rule1 means that after the Cut Through Method is used for the installed calling service NI-2 TIE with the SFG 404, the remaining digits are sent as
DTMF if PROGRESS with PI #1 or PI #8 is received.
Example:
80-1-415-423-4567
System dials
INWATS Service
Depending on the trunk group, an INWATS dialed number identification service
(DNIS) port is assigned to a DID port. This DID port should be configured as a pseudo-port, meaning that it is locked for basic DID. The entries in the call management
destination tables are valid for the INWATS DNIS ports.
Example:
INWATS DNIS
INWATS calling service can be configured for Trunk Group 2 and Trunk Group 3 (depending on the carrier specification). The DNIS 800-777-7222 on Trunk Group 2
leads to DID Port 700 (for dedicated service and CBC service). The empty DNIS (response for no DNIS) on Trunk Group 3 leads to DID Port 701. This is for dedicated
service only.
C-16
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
U.S.-Specific Aspects
Inband Integration Specifications
The information is transmitted to the voice mail register when the call is answered by
the voice mail system.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
C-17
U.S.-Specific Aspects
Inband Integration Specifications
Several voice-mail ports can be grouped in a hunt group and can be accessed
by dialing a hunt-group access code.
For the message waiting callback feature to operate, the first PhoneMail Port (numeric logical port) must be routed to the PhoneMail hunt group using the Call
Management. A separate Pseudo port may also be configured and called using
a repertory-dialing key for callback purposes as well.
Suffix dialing with DTMF tones from an analog DTMF phone during a connection
to a voice mail port results in end to end signaling (DTMF tones generated by the
DTMF code sender). Rotary dial telephones cannot send suffix-dialed digits.
Digital phones use their own DTMF sender if applicable; otherwise the DTMF
sender of the HiPath 3000 is used.
C-18
DEV NA: Call deviated no answer. Voice mail is accessed after the calling party
has at least one ring-back situation.
U.S.-Specific Aspects
Inband Integration Specifications
RECALL NA: Voice mail is recalled because subscriber extended to does not answer.
Calling party
Called party
At the end of the voice message received from the incoming caller, the system sends
the message-waiting code to station B. When reading a message sent from a voice
mail system (by display message on UP0/E phones or by tone by analog phones), the
user can call the voice-mail system back.
The following information is sent for a direct call to the PhoneMail system
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
C-19
U.S.-Specific Aspects
Inband Integration Specifications
Upon detection of answering, the HiPath 3000 sends a message to the voicemail system. The message is transferred as DTMF codes. The message consists
of four elements (described in Section C.3.3.3).
The voice-mail system can release by opening the loop for nominally 1 second (in the
U.S.) or 200 ms (in Germany).
C.3.3.3 Message Elements Sent to the Voice-Mail System
This section describes the message elements that make up the DTMF inband packet
of information:
C-20
Calling party
Called party
Info
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
U.S.-Specific Aspects
Inband Integration Specifications
Type of Call
Mandatory element
DIRECT_INT
DIRECT_EXT
DEV_ALL
Call diversion all calls. The calling party is always deviated to voice mail
DEV_NA
Call diversion on no answer. Voice mail is accessed after the calling party has at least one ringback situation
EXPRESS
COMMON
DEV_BY
RECALL_NA
RECALL_BY
DEV_NR
Diversion not obtainable (intercept). Voice mail is accessed after a non existing number was dialed
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
C-21
U.S.-Specific Aspects
Inband Integration Specifications
Calling Party
Contains the source of the call.
Internal: Internal station number. The fill character is used if the number is shorter
than the fixed length.
Mandatory Elements
Phase 2 USA: You can use HiPath 3000 Manager E to define an analog voicemail port with one of the following extension types:
DEV_NA:
DEV_BY:
C-22
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
U.S.-Specific Aspects
Inband Integration Specifications
Info Field
Meaning
Calling Party
Called Party
Info
***74
Empty
*1
External Call to Voice Mail: External Party Calls Over Analog Trunk.
***2
02222
Empty
*3
***74
13
*1
CF Always to VM:
External Party Calls Extension 13 Over ISDN (13 CFWD Always to VM).
***3
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
02222
13
*4
C-23
U.S.-Specific Aspects
Inband Integration Specifications
C-24
Access codes and extension numbers can be customized to meet the customer's
dial-plan requirements.
The IBMN port must be an analog port with a member number less than the
voice-mail ports in the hunt group for proper operation.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
U.S.-Specific Aspects
Configuring the HiPath 3000 for the Octel Overture 250/350, Octel Overture 200/300, and Au-
C.4 Configuring the HiPath 3000 for the Octel Overture 250/350, Octel
Overture 200/300, and Audix INTUITY Systems
Introduction
You can configure the HiPath 3000 Communications Server for connection to the Lucent Octel and Audix INTUITY systems.
Requirements
Free analog port (SLA16, SLA16N, SLA24N, or 8SLA board)
Procedure Overview
The following sections describe this sequence in detail.
Step
Task
1.
2.
3.
Create a voice mail hunt group and add the voice-mail ports.
4.
5.
6.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
C-25
U.S.-Specific Aspects
Configuring the HiPath 3000 for the Octel Overture 250/350, Octel Overture 200/300, and Au-
HiPath 3750, HiPath 3550, HiPath 3700 and HiPath 3500: 100 to 700
Action
1.
2.
Options > Setup stations > Parameters -> Type -> Extension Type ->
PhoneMail (use a five-digit call number)
C-26
Action
1.
2.
Options -> Setup stations -> Parameters -> Type -> Extension type
-> PhoneMail (use a five-digit call number)
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
U.S.-Specific Aspects
Configuring the HiPath 3000 for the Octel Overture 250/350, Octel Overture 200/300, and Au-
Action
Options -> Incoming calls -> Hunt group -> Group
a) Define a display name for the group.
b) Select linear or cyclic as the group type.
c) Add the voice-mail ports to the voice-mail hunt group.
If desired, you can define a pilot number or DID pilot number for the group.
Action
Options -> Setup stations -> Key programming
Action
1.
2.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
C-27
U.S.-Specific Aspects
Configuring the HiPath 3000 for the Octel Overture 250/350, Octel Overture 200/300, and Au-
Action
1.
2.
3.
4.
Options -> Setup stations -> Parameters -> Type > Extension type ->
Answer machine
Assign call-destination tables to pseudo-stations for external day, external night, and
internal calls.
Programming Using HiPath 3000 Manager E
Step
1.
Action
Options -> Incoming calls -> Assignment internal external calls
C-28
Step
Action
1.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
U.S.-Specific Aspects
Installing and Configuring the TraqNet 2002 Product
HiPath 3750, HiPath 3550, HiPath 3350, HiPath 3700, HiPath 3500 or HiPath
3300 with IMOD Modem and TMGL4 or TMGL8 Module for loop-start (LS) analog CO access
Software Requirements
Reference Documentation
Action
1.
2.
Connect the CO loop-start trunk to the line port of the TraqNet unit.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
C-29
U.S.-Specific Aspects
Installing and Configuring the TraqNet 2002 Product
Modem
CO
TraqNet
TMGL4 or
TMGL8
LS trunk
Figure C-1
Task
1.
2.
C-30
Action
Options -> Lines and networking -> Trunks -> Route
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
U.S.-Specific Aspects
Installing and Configuring the TraqNet 2002 Product
Action
File -> Options -> Lines and networking -> Routes -> Route name
Configure the trunk as a loop-start trunk and enable the DTMF DID flag. This will allow the trunk to answer the call and allocate a register to analyze the DTMF tones
from TraqNet and the remote modem.
Using HiPath 3000 Manager E for Programming
Step
Action
1.
File -> Options -> Lines and networking -> Trunks -> Parameters ->
MSI flags
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
C-31
U.S.-Specific Aspects
Installing and Configuring the TraqNet 2002 Product
Procedure
Step
Action
1.
2.
Enter the CO telephone number, the access code, and the HiPath
3000 modem number (7710004,,12345678,,890).
3.
Select the Read/Write KDS and the Hicom-->PC button and make
sure that the modem call is in progress to read data from the HiPath
3000.
Result
The modem call is set up and the popup window for transferring data between the HiPath 3000 and the remote PC appears.
Example: InfoKey Access
This example uses an InfoKey access code.
Procedure
Step
Action
1.
2.
3.
Select Read/Write KDS and the Hicom-->PC button and make sure
that the modem call is in progress to read data from the HiPath 3000.
Result
The modem call is set up and the popup window for transferring data between the HiPath 3000 and the remote PC appears.
C-32
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
U.S.-Specific Aspects
Installing and Configuring the TraqNet 2002 Product
Action
1.
2.
3.
Select Read/Write KDS and the Hicom-->PC button and make sure
that the modem call is in progress to read data from the HiPath 3000.
Result
The modem call is set up and the popup window for transferring data between the HiPath 3000 and the remote PC appears.
Timeout
C.5.5 Using an External Telephone to Place the Call for the Modem
You can connect a 2500-type analog telephone to an external modem to perform the
dial-up setup from the PC with HiPath 3000 Manager E to the HiPath 3000.
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
C-33
U.S.-Specific Aspects
Installing and Configuring the TraqNet 2002 Product
C-34
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Figures
Figures
Figure 2-1
Figure 2-2
Figure 2-3
Figure 2-4
Figure 2-5
Figure 2-6
Figure 2-7
Figure 2-8
Figure 2-9
Figure 3-1
Figure 3-2
Figure 3-3
Figure 3-4
Figure 3-5
Figure 3-6
Figure 3-7
Figure 3-8
Figure 3-9
Figure 3-10
Figure 3-11
Figure 3-12
Figure 3-13
Figure 3-14
Figure 3-15
Figure 3-16
Figure 3-17
Figure 3-18
Figure 3-19
Figure 3-20
Figure 3-21
Figure 3-22
Figure 3-23
Figure 3-24
Figure 3-25
Figure 3-26
Figure 3-27
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
W-1
Figures
Figure 3-28
Figure 3-29
Figure 3-30
Figure 3-31
Figure 3-32
Figure 3-33
Figure 3-34
Figure 3-35
Figure 3-36
Figure 3-37
Figure 3-38
Figure 3-39
Figure 3-40
Figure 3-41
Figure 3-42
Figure 3-43
Figure 3-44
Figure 3-45
Figure 3-46
Figure 3-47
Figure 3-48
Figure 3-49
Figure 3-50
Figure 3-51
Figure 3-52
Figure 3-53
Figure 3-54
Figure 3-55
Figure 3-56
Figure 3-57
Figure 3-58
Figure 3-59
Figure 3-60
Figure 3-61
Figure 3-62
Figure 3-63
Figure 3-64
Figure 3-65
Figure 3-66
Figure 3-67
Figure 3-68
W-2
Figures
Figure 3-69
Figure 3-70
Figure 3-71
Figure 3-72
Figure 3-73
Figure 3-74
Figure 3-75
Figure 3-76
Figure 3-77
Figure 3-78
Figure 3-79
Figure 3-80
Figure 3-81
Figure 3-82
Figure 3-83
Figure 3-84
Figure 3-85
Figure 3-86
Figure 3-87
Figure 3-88
Figure 3-89
Figure 3-90
Figure 3-91
Figure 3-92
Figure 3-93
Figure 3-94
Figure 3-95
Figure 3-96
Figure 3-97
Figure 3-98
Figure 3-99
Figure 3-100
Figure 3-101
Figure 3-102
Figure 3-103
Figure 3-104
Figure 3-105
Figure 3-106
Figure 3-107
Figure 3-108
Figure 3-109
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-162
3-164
3-166
3-166
3-168
3-169
3-169
3-170
3-173
3-177
3-179
3-180
3-181
3-182
3-183
3-189
3-190
3-191
3-193
3-194
3-197
3-201
3-202
3-207
3-210
3-212
3-214
3-216
3-220
3-222
3-225
3-227
3-229
3-230
3-233
3-234
3-234
3-235
3-236
3-237
3-240
W-3
Figures
Figure 3-110
Figure 3-111
Figure 3-112
Figure 3-113
Figure 3-114
Figure 3-115
Figure 3-116
Figure 3-117
Figure 3-118
Figure 3-119
Figure 3-120
Figure 3-121
Figure 3-122
Figure 3-123
Figure 3-124
Figure 3-125
Figure 3-126
Figure 3-127
Figure 3-128
Figure 3-129
Figure 3-130
Figure 3-131
Figure 3-132
Figure 3-133
Figure 3-134
Figure 3-135
Figure 3-136
Figure 3-137
Figure 3-138
Figure 3-139
Figure 3-140
Figure 3-141
Figure 3-142
Figure 3-143
Figure 3-144
Figure 3-145
Figure 4-1
Figure 4-2
Figure 4-3
Figure 4-4
Figure 4-5
Figure 4-6
W-4
Figures
Figure 4-7
Figure 4-8
Figure 4-9
Figure 4-10
Figure 4-11
Figure 4-12
Figure 4-13
Figure 4-14
Figure 4-15
Figure 4-16
Figure 4-17
Figure 4-18
Figure 4-19
Figure 4-20
Figure 4-21
Figure 4-22
Figure 4-23
Figure 4-24
Figure 4-25
Figure 4-26
Figure 4-27
Figure 4-28
Figure 4-29
Figure 4-30
Figure 4-31
Figure 4-32
Figure 4-33
Figure 4-34
Figure 4-35
Figure 4-36
Figure 4-37
Figure 4-38
Figure 4-39
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
4-18
4-19
4-21
4-22
4-23
4-25
4-26
4-26
4-28
4-30
4-31
4-33
4-34
4-37
4-38
4-41
4-42
4-43
4-48
4-50
4-51
4-53
4-55
4-56
4-58
4-59
4-62
4-63
4-64
4-65
4-66
4-67
4-68
W-5
Figures
Figure 4-40
Figure 4-41
Figure 4-42
Figure 4-43
Figure 4-44
Figure 4-45
Figure 4-46
Figure 4-47
Figure 4-48
Figure 4-49
Figure 4-50
Figure 4-51
Figure 4-52
Figure 4-53
Figure 4-54
Figure 4-55
Figure 4-56
Figure 4-57
Figure 4-58
Figure 4-59
Figure 4-60
Figure 4-61
Figure 4-62
Figure 4-63
Figure 4-64
Figure 4-65
Figure 4-66
Figure 4-67
Figure 4-68
Figure 4-69
Figure 5-1
Figure 5-2
Figure 6-1
Figure 6-2
Figure 6-3
Figure 6-4
Figure 6-5
Figure 6-6
Figure 6-7
Figure 6-8
W-6
Slot Numbers and Widths in 8-Slot BC, EC1, and EC2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-71
HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 - Initialization of Subscriber Line
Circuits and Ports . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-73
PCM Segments for a One-Cabinet System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-75
PCM Segments for a Two-Cabinet System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-76
PCM Segments for a Three-Cabinet System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-76
Locking and Unlocking Boards . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-78
HiPath 3550 and HiPath 3350 Space Requirements (for U.S. Only) . . . . 4-84
MDFU Layout and Dimensions (367.0 x 328.8 x 125.4 mm)
(Not for U.S.) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-87
HiPath 3550 and HiPath 3350 - Wall Attachment. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-90
HiPath 3550 and HiPath 3350 - Mounting Holes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-90
HiPath 3550 and HiPath 3350 - Grounding an External Main
Distribution Frame . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-92
HiPath 3550 - Backplane Connection for a Peripheral Board in
HiPath 3750 Format . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-94
Layout of CABLU S30269-Z41-A30 (3 m long) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-95
Integrated Distribution Frame - Slip-on Connector Screw Connections . . 4-96
HiPath 3550 and HiPath 3350 - Power Cable with Ferrite Sleeve . . . . . . 4-98
HiPath 3550 - Wall Housing System Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-100
HiPath 3550 - Slots in the Wall Housing. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-101
HiPath 3550 - Options Adapter Long (OPAL). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-101
HiPath 3350 - Wall Housing System Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-102
HiPath 3350 - Slots in the Wall Housing. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-102
HiPath 3500 and HiPath 3300 - Wall Mounting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-108
HiPath 3500 or HiPath 3300 - Mounting the 19-Inch Cabinet . . . . . . . . 4-110
HiPath 3500 and HiPath 3300 - Grounding . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-112
HiPath 3500 and HiPath 3300 - Connecting cable to ECR . . . . . . . . . . 4-113
HiPath 3500 - Slot Levels in the 19-Inch Housing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-114
HiPath 3300 - Slot Levels in the 19-Inch Housing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-115
HiPath 3250 and HiPath 3150 - Wall Mounting, Minimum Clearance . . 4-121
HiPath 3250 and HiPath 3150 - Connection Overview. . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-122
Station Number Assignment in HiPath 3250 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-123
Station Number Assignment in HiPath 3150 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-123
Pin Assignment of MW Jacks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-21
Wiring and Ranges for S0 Bus Jacks (Not for U.S.). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-22
Example connection of a CDR printer to HiPath 3000 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-4
ECR front panel (155 x 440 x 380 mm) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-6
ECR Rear Panel With Connecting Elements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-7
HiPath 3700, HiPath 3500, HiPath 3300 - ECR With Batteries . . . . . . . . 6-10
ECR With Built-in Batteries. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-11
HiPath 3500, HiPath 3300 - ECR With Batteries and EPSU2-R . . . . . . . 6-15
ECR with Built-in EPSU2-R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-16
Connecting the Fan to the EPSU2-R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-18
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Figures
Figure 6-9
Figure 7-1
Figure 7-2
Figure 7-3
Figure 7-4
Figure 7-5
Figure 7-6
Figure 7-7
Figure 7-8
Figure 7-9
Figure 7-10
Figure 7-11
Figure 7-12
Figure 7-13
Figure 7-14
Figure 7-15
Figure 7-16
Figure 7-17
Figure 9-1
Figure 9-2
Figure 9-3
Figure 9-4
Figure 9-5
Figure 9-6
Figure 9-7
Figure 9-8
Figure 9-9
Figure 9-10
Figure 9-11
Figure 9-12
Figure 9-13
Figure 9-14
Figure 9-15
Figure 9-16
Figure 9-17
Figure 9-18
Figure 9-19
Figure 9-20
Figure 9-21
Figure 9-22
Figure 9-23
Figure 9-24
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
W-7
Figures
Figure 9-25
Figure 9-26
Figure 9-27
Figure 9-28
Figure 9-29
Figure 9-30
Figure 9-31
Figure 9-32
Figure 9-33
Figure 9-34
Figure 9-35
Figure 9-36
Figure 9-37
Figure 10-1
Figure 10-2
Figure 10-3
Figure 10-4
Figure 10-5
Figure 10-6
Figure 10-7
Figure 10-8
Figure 11-1
Figure 11-2
Figure 11-3
Figure 11-4
Figure 11-5
Figure 11-6
Figure 12-1
Figure 13-1
Figure 13-2
Figure 13-3
Figure 13-4
Figure 13-5
Figure 13-6
Figure 13-7
Figure 13-8
Figure C-1
W-8
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Tables
Tables
Table 1-1
Table 2-1
Table 2-2
Table 2-3
Table 2-4
Table 2-5
Table 2-6
Table 2-7
Table 2-8
Table 2-9
Table 2-10
Table 2-11
Table 3-1
Table 3-2
Table 3-3
Table 3-4
Table 3-5
Table 3-6
Table 3-7
Table 3-8
Table 3-9
Table 3-10
Table 3-11
Table 3-12
Table 3-13
Table 3-14
Table 3-15
Table 3-16
Table 3-17
Table 3-18
Table 3-19
Table 3-20
Table 3-21
Table 3-22
Table 3-23
Table 3-24
Table 3-25
0
List of Available Documentation for HiPath 3000 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-15
Boards for HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-11
Boards for HiPath 3550 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-12
Boards for HiPath 3350 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-13
Boards for HiPath 3500 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-17
Boards for HiPath 3300 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-18
HiPath 3000 V3.0 - System-Related Capacity Limits
(Maximum Numbers). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-19
Technical Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-21
Telephone Interface-to-Interface Ranges (with J-Y (ST) 2x2x0,6,
0.6 mm diameter) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-23
Cable Lengths for Direct Trunk and CorNet-N Wiring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-23
Default Station Numbers for HiPath 3000 V3.0. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-24
U.S. and Canadian Regulatory Compliance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-25
HiPath 3000 Functional Overview of All Boards and
Components Used. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-1
HiPath 3000 Model Overview of all Boards and Components Used . . . 3-9
CBCC - X1 to X4 Contact Assignments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-27
CBRC - X1 and X3 Contact Assignments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-27
CBCC and CBRC - X9 Contact Assignments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-28
CBCC and CBRC - V.24 Interface Assignment (SUB-D Plug) . . . . . . . . 3-29
CBCC and CBRC - LAN Connector Assignment (RJ45 Jack) . . . . . . . . 3-29
Numbering Plan for HiPath 3550 and HiPath 3500. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-30
CBCP - X1 to X4 Contact Assignments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-33
CBCP - X9 Contact Assignments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-33
CBCP - V.24 Interface Assignment (SUB-D Plug) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-34
CBCP - LAN Connector Assignment (RJ45 Jack). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-34
Numbering Plan for HiPath 3350. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-35
CBCPR - V.24 Interface Assignment (SUB-D Plug) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-38
CBCPR - LAN Connector Assignment (RJ45 Jack) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-38
Recommendations for Using CMA and CMS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-41
CR8N - LED Statuses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-45
LIM - RJ45 Jack Assignment. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-49
Multimedia Card Models and Applications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-52
SBSCO - X1 and X3 Contact Assignments. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-58
SBSCO - X9 Contact Assignments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-58
SBSCO - X19-X21 Contact Assignments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-59
SBSCO - V.24 Interface Assignment (SUB-D Plug) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-59
SBSCO - LAN Connector Assignment (RJ45 Jack) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-60
Numbering Plan for HiPath 3250. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-61
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
X-1
Tables
Table 3-26
Table 3-27
Table 3-28
Table 3-29
Table 3-30
Table 3-31
Table 3-32
Table 3-33
Table 3-34
Table 3-35
Table 3-36
Table 3-37
Table 3-38
Table 3-39
Table 3-40
Table 3-41
Table 3-42
Table 3-43
Table 3-44
Table 3-45
Table 3-46
Table 3-47
Table 3-48
Table 3-49
Table 3-50
Table 3-51
Table 3-52
Table 3-53
Table 3-54
Table 3-55
Table 3-56
Table 3-57
Table 3-58
Table 3-59
Table 3-60
Table 3-61
Table 3-62
X-2
Tables
Table 3-63
Table 3-64
Table 3-65
Table 3-66
Table 3-67
Table 3-68
Table 3-69
Table 3-70
Table 3-71
Table 3-72
Table 3-73
Table 3-74
Table 3-75
Table 3-76
Table 3-77
Table 3-78
Table 3-79
Table 3-80
Table 3-81
Table 3-82
Table 3-83
Table 3-84
Table 3-85
Table 3-86
Table 3-87
Table 3-88
Table 3-89
Table 3-90
Table 3-91
Table 3-92
Table 3-93
Table 3-94
Table 3-95
Table 3-96
Table 3-97
Table 3-98
Table 3-99
Table 3-100
Table 3-101
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
3-128
3-129
3-134
3-135
3-136
3-138
3-139
3-139
3-146
3-146
3-150
3-151
3-152
3-153
3-155
3-156
3-157
3-159
3-163
3-165
3-171
3-172
3-178
3-184
3-185
3-187
3-189
3-190
3-191
3-195
3-195
3-196
3-200
3-201
3-202
3-203
3-203
3-208
3-208
X-3
Tables
Table 3-102
Table 3-103
Table 3-104
Table 3-105
Table 3-106
Table 3-107
Table 3-108
Table 3-109
Table 3-110
Table 3-111
Table 3-112
Table 3-113
Table 3-114
Table 3-115
Table 3-116
Table 3-117
Table 3-118
Table 3-119
Table 3-120
Table 3-121
Table 3-122
Table 3-123
Table 3-124
Table 3-125
Table 3-126
Table 3-127
Table 3-128
Table 3-129
Table 3-130
Table 3-131
Table 3-132
Table 3-133
Table 3-134
Table 3-135
Table 3-136
Table 3-137
Table 3-138
Table 4-1
Table 4-2
Table 4-3
Table 4-4
Table 4-5
Table 4-6
X-4
Tables
Table 4-7
Table 4-8
Table 4-9
Table 4-10
Table 4-11
Table 4-12
Table 4-13
Table 4-14
Table 5-1
Table 5-2
Table 5-3
Table 5-4
Table 5-5
Table 5-6
Table 5-7
Table 5-8
Table 6-1
Table 6-2
Table 7-1
Table 7-2
Table 7-3
Table 7-4
Table 7-5
Table 7-6
Table 7-7
Table 7-8
Table 7-9
Table 7-10
Table 7-11
Table 7-12
Table 7-13
Table 7-14
Table 7-15
Table 7-16
Table 7-17
Table 7-18
Table 9-1
Table 9-2
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
X-5
Tables
Table 9-3
Table 9-4
Table 9-5
Table 9-6
Table 9-7
Table 9-8
Table 9-9
Table 11-1
Table 11-2
Table 11-3
Table 11-4
Table 11-5
Table 11-6
Table 12-1
Table 12-2
Table 12-3
Table 12-4
Table 12-5
Table 12-6
Table 12-7
Table 12-8
Table 13-1
Table A-1
Table A-2
Table A-3
Table A-4
Table B-1
Table B-2
Table B-3
Table B-4
Table B-5
Table B-6
Table B-7
Table B-8
X-6
Tables
Table B-9
Table B-10
Table B-11
Table C-1
Table C-2
Table C-3
Table C-4
Table C-5
Table C-6
Table C-7
Table C-8
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
X-7
Tables
X-8
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Abbreviations
Abbreviations
This list contains the abbreviations used in this manual.
A
ACL-H2
ADPCM
ALUM
AMHOST
ANI
AP
Exposed
APS
B
BC
BFSK
C
CABLU
Cabling Unit
CAS
CAS
CBCC
CBCP
CBCPR
CBRC
CDB
Customer Database
CDRC
CHAP
CLIP
CMA
CMS
CR
Code Receiver
CSTA
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Y-1
Abbreviations
CUC
CUCR
CUP
CUPR
D
DSP
E
EC1
EC2
ECG
Euro-ISDNCAS-Gateway
ECGM
Euro-ISDN-CAS-Gateway Maintenance
ECMA
ECR
EPSU
ESD
ESM
ET
Entrance Telephone
ETS
ETSI
F
FSK
G
GCM
GEE
H
HPCO
HXGM
HXGR
HXGS
Y-2
ICMP
IMOD
Abbreviations
IP
Internet Protocol
ISO
IVML
IVMP
IVMPR
IVMS
IVMSR
L
LAN Bridge
LED
Light-Emitting Diode
LIM
M
MDFU
MDFU-E
MFC-R2
MIB
MMC
Multimedia Card
MOH
Music on Hold
MSN
MULAP
MW
Mini Western
N
NT
Network Termination
O
OPAL
OPALR
P
PAP
PCM
PDM1
PDS
PEM
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Y-3
Abbreviations
PFT
PMP
Point-To-Multipoint Connection
PP
Point-To-Point Connection
PPP
Point-to-Point Protocol
PSE
PSTN
PSUP
R
RDT
REAL
RJ
Registered Jack
ROW
Rest Of World
S
SBSC
SELV
SLA
SLC
SLMO
SLU
SLUR
SMR
SNMP
STLS
STLSR
STMD
STRB
STRBR
Y-4
TC
Telecommunication
TCP
TIEL
TLA
Abbreviations
TLAR
TMAMF
TMCAS
TMGL8
TML8W
TMOM
TMS2
TMST1
TS2
TS2R
TW
Twin-Wire
U
UAE
UCD
UDP
UP
Concealed
UPSC-D
UPSC-DR
UPSM
UPSMres
USBS
V
VMIE
W
WAP
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Y-5
Abbreviations
Y-6
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Index
Index
Numerics
16SLA 3-244
connection conditions 3-247
contact assignments 3-246
interfaces 3-246
3PTY 7-544
4SLA 3-244
connection conditions 3-247
contact assignments 3-245
interfaces 3-244
7-slot cabinets 6-20
8SLA 3-244
connection conditions 3-247
contact assignments 3-245
interfaces 3-244
8SLAR
contact assignments 3-248
interfaces 3-248
module specifications 3-249
8-slot cabinets (HiPath 3700) 4-55
8-slot cabinets (HiPath 3750) 4-30
A
ac power outlet requirements
HiPath 3500/3300 4-106
HiPath 3550/3350 4-85
HiPath 3700 4-46
HiPath 3750 4-6
access security 12-37
accidents 1-20
accidents, reporting 1-12
account code 7-489
ACCT 7-489
ACD, see uniform call distribution 7-95
administration of Plus Products via PPP
13-15
administration via LAN 13-5
administration via PPP 13-13
administration via Telnet 13-6
advice of charge 7-533
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Z-1
Index
Index
Z-3
Index
Z-4
central board
HiPath 3150 3-62
HiPath 3250 3-56
HiPath 3300 3-23
HiPath 3350 3-23
HiPath 3350 (for DTAG only) 3-31
HiPath 3500 3-23
HiPath 3550 3-23
HiPath 3700 3-36
HiPath 3750 3-36
central boards 3-1
central busy signaling optiClient Attendant
7-459
central office protocol 7-562
central voice mail server, network 7-463
centralized attendant service CAS 7-226
certification number
CS-03 2-25
FCC registration number 2-25
Industry Canada CS-03 2-25
CF 7-534
CFNA 7-71
CH 7-543
change display 7-427
changeover
individual telephone lock 7-155
system telephone lock 7-158
changing the system configuration (HiPath
3750) 5-5
chip card, chip card reader (only for Deutsche
Telekom AG) 12-43
class of service 7-255
least cost routing (U.S. only) 7-302
clearance
HiPath 3550/HiPath 3350 4-84
HiPath 3750 4-5
CLIP 7-528
CLIP no screening 7-281
CLIR 7-529
closed numbering 7-437
CM, see call management 7-65
CMA 3-39
CMS 3-40
codes for outgoing calls 7-550
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Index
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
connecting
ISDN S0 terminals (HiPath 3750) 3-173
ISDN terminals (HiPath 3550 and HiPath
3350) 3-160
connecting cable to the expansion cabinet
ECR 4-113
connecting cable, BC-EC "8-Slot" 4-33, 4-58
consultation hold 7-41
controlled release of a remote connection
12-35
converter (CSTA interface) 7-596
cordless telephones 9-59
CorNet-N
access for least cost routing (U.S. only)
7-300
call waiting 7-448
consultation hold 7-445
extension number 7-444
incoming calls 7-444
name display 7-451
number display 7-451
pickup 7-445
station name 7-444
toll restriction 7-439, 7-444
transfer 7-445
CorNet-N ranges 2-23
correcting errors 12-29
COS 7-255
country initialization 5-13
country initialization (HiPath 3750 and HiPath
3700) 5-6
CR8N 3-44
illustration 3-45
LED states 3-45
credit card call access 7-572
CS-03 certification number 2-25
CSO, see carrier-select override 7-302
CSTA interface 7-596
CSTA via IP 13-8
CSTA/V.24 cable, pin out 3-289
CUC 3-46
CUCR 3-46
CUP 3-47
CUPR 3-47
Z-5
Index
currency
call charge display with 7-520
customer data
effects due to hardware changes 12-10
customer database backup 12-2
customer database conversion 6-22
customer-specific display 7-427
CW 7-545
D
data calls 7-589
data security 1-14
data terminals
connecting 10-15
ISDN
HiPath 3550 and HiPath 3350 3-160
HiPath 3750 3-173
date 7-359
date and time display 7-359
D-channel encoding type 7-558
dedicated service 7-567
dedicated services, LCR PRI C-14
deferring a call 7-146
defining
clock reference for the PRI span C-10
PRI Route Parameters C-7
protocol for PRI span C-7
delete all station numbers 7-392
denied list for undialed trunks 7-269
diagnosis options 12-13
dial plan
least cost routing (U.S. only) 7-301,
7-304
dialed number identification service 7-582
dial-in control server access for least cost
routing (U.S. only) 7-301
dialing plan, PRI C-13
DID 7-524
digital modem 12-32
Z-6
dimensions
HiPath 3150 2-7
HiPath 3250 2-7
HiPath 3300 2-10
HiPath 3350 2-6
HiPath 3500 2-9
HiPath 3550 2-5
HiPath 3700 2-8
HiPath 3750 2-4
direct inward dialing 7-198, 7-524
U.S. ISDN 7-573
direct inward system access
description 7-206
direct station selection 7-314
DISA 7-206
display
called party 7-592
connected party 7-592, 7-593
date and time 7-359
number of stations with direct trunk access (Austria only) 7-379
disposal, battery 1-11
distinctive ringing 7-59
DND 7-126
DNIS 7-582
do not disturb 7-126
ringer cutoff 7-126
door opener 7-323
door phone connection, see entrance telephones 10-10
DoorCom Analog 10-11
double key assignment 9-4
DSS 7-314
DTMF DID 7-214
DTMF or rotary pulse dialing
selecting in least cost routing (U.S. only)
7-303
DTMF tones
and least cost routing (U.S. only) 7-303
dual-tone multifrequency
converting for PRI 7-587
dual-tone multifrequency direct inward dialing
7-214
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Index
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
ESM
structure 1-2
Euro-ISDN features 7-523
Euro-ISDNCAS-Gateway ECG
3-197,
3-230, 3-239
exchanging boards 12-11
exchanging telephones 12-12
executive MULAP groups 7-410
executive/secretary configuration, see Top
configuration 7-401
EXM
contact assignments 3-263
slot for HiPath 3550 and HiPath 3350
3-261
EXMNA (for U.S. Only) 3-262
slot for HiPath 3550 and HiPath 3350
3-262
EXMR
connection to HiPath 3500 and HiPath
3300 3-261
expansion cabinet ECR
connecting cable 4-113
installing 6-5
expensive route identification (U.S. only)
7-302
expert mode codes
account code A-10
analog CO interface A-23
announcement/music A-27
attendant console A-34
call detail recording A-9
codes A-26
configure station A-10
DISA A-34
displays A-17
entrance phones A-26
incoming calls A-13
ISDN parameters A-17
least cost routing (LCR) A-34
networking A-15
print CDB data A-28
radio paging equipment A-33
relays A-27
remote administration A-32
Z-7
Index
sensors A-28
system characteristics A-28
system settings A-23
system speed dial A-9
toll restriction A-12
traffic restriction A-16
UCD A-32
explicit call transfer 7-548
extension connection 11-9
external call forwarding 7-536
external call forwarding with PMP 5-23
external calls
restricting 7-158
external power supply EPSU2 3-144
external power supply EPSU2-R 6-15
F
fan connection (in ECR) 6-17
fan kit for HXGS3 in HiPath 3550/HiPath
3350 3-107
fax waiting message/answering machine key
7-144
FCC and Industry Canada Compliance 1-23
FCC compliance 1-24
FCC registration number 2-25
FCC rules 1-24
feature access codes A-1
features
correlation with least cost routing (U.S.
only) 7-302
features in alphabetical order 7-2
feeding
NT (HiPath 3750/HiPath 3700) 3-233
ferrite for HiPath 3550/HiPath 3350 4-98
ferrite sleeve for HiPath 3550/HiPath 3350
4-98
field-replaceable units (for U.S. only)
all models 3-7
HiPath 3300 3-22
HiPath 3350 3-16
HiPath 3500 3-20
HiPath 3550 3-14
HiPath 3750/HiPath 3700 3-10
flex call 7-163
Z-8
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Index
help
for installation (HiPath 3700) 4-2
for installation (HiPath 3750) 4-2
Hicom Office PhoneMail Entry board 3-267
HiPath 3000 on a LAN 13-1
HiPath 3150
connection overview 4-122
construction data 2-7
installation 4-118
numbering plan 3-66
startup 5-11
station number assignment 4-123
system environment 2-16
visual inspection 4-123
HiPath 3250
connection overview 4-122
construction data 2-7
installation 4-118
numbering plan 3-61
startup 5-11
station number assignment 4-123
system environment 2-14
visual inspection 4-123
HiPath 3300
construction data 2-10
FRUs for U.S. 3-22
installation 4-81
startup 5-11
system environment 2-18
HiPath 3350
construction data 2-6
FRUs for U.S. 3-16
installation 4-81
numbering plan 3-35
startup 5-11
system environment 2-13
HiPath 3500
construction data 2-9
FRUs for U.S. 3-20
installation 4-81
numbering plan 3-30
startup 5-11
system environment 2-17
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
HiPath 3550
construction data 2-5
FRUs for U.S. 3-14
installation 4-81
numbering plan 3-30
startup 5-11
system environment 2-12
HiPath 3700
construction data 2-8
FRUs for U.S. 3-10
installation 4-2
startup 5-2
system environment 2-11
HiPath 3750
construction data 2-3
FRUs for U.S. 3-10
installation 4-2
startup 5-2
system environment 2-11
HiPath Cordless Office 3-132, 9-67, 11-1
base station power supply 3-140
base stations 11-2
capacity limits 11-6
configuring 9-67
EPSU2 external power supply 3-144
extension connection 11-9
monocell BS 3-136
multi-SLC 11-9
networking among systems 11-9
outdoor cover 11-5
single-cell base station 11-3
single-cell BS 11-2
system configuration 11-3
system numbers 9-67
tech. base station data 11-4
telephones 9-59
HiPath HG1500 V2.0
boards 3-85, 3-97
capacity limits 9-48
determining the required number of
boards 9-46
techn. data (resources) of the boards
9-46
Z-9
Index
Z-10
HXGR3 3-101
determining the required number 9-46
extension modules 3-102
figure 3-103
interfaces 3-104
LAN interfaces 3-105
techn. data (resources) 9-46
V.24 interface 3-106
versions 3-102
HXGS/HXGS2 3-97
determining the required number 9-46
interfaces 3-99
LAN interfaces 3-100
models 3-97
techn. data (resources) 9-46
V.24 interface 3-100
HXGS3 3-101
determining the required number 9-46
extension modules 3-102
fan kit for HiPath 3550/HiPath 3350
3-107
figure 3-103
interfaces 3-104
LAN interfaces 3-105
techn. data (resources) 9-46
V.24 interface 3-106
versions 3-102
HXGSR/HXGSR2 3-97
determining the required number 9-46
interfaces 3-99
LAN interfaces 3-100
models 3-97
techn. data (resources) 9-46
V.24 interface 3-100
I
IDA-P (HKTA-Protocol) C-2
IEC, see inter-exchange carriers C-3
IMODC 3-48, 12-32
important notices 1-17
inband integration specifications C-17
incoming calls
CorNet-N 7-444
night answer 7-194
incoming preference 7-413
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Index
procedure 4-3
removing the cabinet covers 4-47
stripping the open-end cable 4-66
unpacking the components 4-46
visual inspection 4-80
installation (HiPath 3750) 4-2, 4-4
checking the protective grounding 4-29
connecting cable between BC and EC
4-33
connecting the cable 4-30
earth ground 4-27
freestanding installation
base elements 4-18
secondary protection 4-44
wall mounting for two cabinets stacked
4-15
grounding 4-24
help, tools 4-2
installation site 4-5
jumpering 4-40
line network 4-40
loading the system software 4-69
MDFU/MDFU-E 4-7
procedure 4-3
protective grounding (for U.S. Only) 4-27
removing cabinet covers 4-9
seismic anchors 4-22
setting up system cabinets 4-8
single-cabinet 4-10
stripping the open-end cable for MDFU/
MDFU-E 4-38
three-cabinet stacked 4-20
two cabinets side by side 4-19
two cabinets stacked 4-13
unpacking the components 4-7
visual inspection 4-80
wall mounting for one cabinet 4-10
installing an expansion cabinet rack (ECR)
6-5
integrated modem 3-48, 12-32
intercept announcements 10-4
intercept conditions 7-210
intercept position
network 7-458
Z-11
Index
Z-12
ISDN S0 wiring
HiPath 3550 and HiPath 3350
general information 9-73
point-to-multipoint long 9-76
point-to-multipoint short 9-75
point-to-point 9-74
IVML8/IVML24 3-110
figure 3-111
LAN adapter 3-113
LED statuses 3-112
lockout switch 3-111
packing protection covering 3-110
IVMP8/IVMP8R 3-114
figure 3-115
LAN connector assignment 3-116
LED statuses 3-117
lockout switch 3-115
packing protection covering 3-114
IVMS8/IVMS8R 3-118
figure 3-119
LAN connector assignment 3-121
LED statuses 3-122
lockout switch 3-119
packing protection covering 3-118
J
jumper strips
assignment 4-41
K
key assignment 9-4
key programming 7-176, 7-180, 9-4, 9-34
keyed holes for mounting
HiPath 3750 4-10, 4-15
keypad
converting DTMF for PRI 7-587
keypad dialing 7-274
keys
DSS 7-314
message waiting 10-2
redial 7-229
repdial 7-314
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Index
L
LAN adapter cable for backplane HiPath
3750/HiPath 3700 (U.S. only) 3-90, 3-96
LAN adapter connector for backplane HiPath
3750/HiPath 3700 3-89, 3-95
LAN Bridge 3-123
contact assignment of 10Base-T interface 3-124
interfaces 3-123
LAN interface, PSTN interface 7-596
LAN/IP connection, settings 13-18
language settings 7-370
languages, loading 7-370
last number redial (LNR) 7-229
LCR, see least cost routing 7-284
least cost routing 7-284
access code, PRI C-13
alternate carriers (U.S. only) 7-300
and basic-rate trunks (U.S. only) 7-303
and call keys (U.S. only) 7-303
and DTMF tones (U.S. only) 7-303
and electronic notebook (U.S. only)
7-303
and forced account codes (U.S. only)
7-303
and MUSAP keys (U.S. only) 7-303
and repertory dial keys (U.S. only) 7-303
and station redial (U.S. only) 7-303
and system speed dialing (U.S. only)
7-303
and toll restriction (U.S. only) 7-303
carrier access methods (U.S. only)
7-300
carrier types 7-299
carrier-select override (U.S. only) 7-302,
7-307
CorNet-N (U.S. only) 7-300
correlation with other features (U.S. only)
7-302
dial plan (U.S. only) 7-301, 7-304
dial-in control server (U.S. only) 7-301
dialing plan, PRI C-13
expensive route identification (U.S. only)
7-302
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Z-13
Index
MIB 13-3
microphone mute 7-326
minimum clearances
HiPath 3550/HiPath 3350 4-84
HiPath 3750 4-5
MMC 3-52
replace 12-5
mobile PIN 7-163
mobile telephone
checking the login status 9-70
monocell base station 3-136
mounting
one cabinet on the wall (HiPath 3750)
4-10
two stacked cabinets on the wall (HiPath
3750) 4-15
mounting holes
HiPath 3750 4-10, 4-15
mounting space
HiPath 3550/HiPath 3350 4-84
HiPath 3750 4-5
MSN, see multiple subscriber numbers 7-525
MULAP 7-394, 7-410
multi-device connection 5-23, 7-168, 7-564
multilingual text output 7-370
multimedia card MMC 3-52
multiple subscriber numbers 7-525
configuring default station numbers instead 7-526
U.S. ISDN 7-574
multi-SLC 11-9
MUSAP keys
and least cost routing (U.S. only) 7-303
music on hold
internal/external source 7-35
modes 10-4
relays 7-362
MWI at the trunk interface 7-188
N
N11 access 7-572
name
PRI C-8
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Index
names
assigning to stations 7-317
called party display 7-592
calling party display 7-592
translating station numbers for speed dialing 7-186
national and international codes for outgoing
calls 7-550
network termination
cable set for Spain/Portugal (HiPath
3550 and HiPath 3500) 3-243
connecting
S0 3-166
S2M 3-233
feeding (S2M, HiPath 3750/HiPath 3700)
3-233
power feeding (S2M, HiPath 3550 and
HiPath 3500) 3-242
S2M connection (HiPath 3550 and HiPath 3500) 3-242
networking 7-429
call forwarding with rerouting 7-453
call waiting 7-448
callback on free/busy 7-450
CDR with networking 7-442
central attendant console 7-458
conference 7-456
consultation hold/transfer/pickup 7-445
distinctive ringing in the network 7-449
HiPath 4000 CorNet-N connection 5-20
incoming calls 7-442, 7-444
numbering 7-437
recall 7-447
satellite capability 7-433
sharing central voice mail server 7-463
sharing system speed dialing in a gateway system 7-462
station number/name display 7-451
supported features 7-430
toggle 7-455
toll restriction with CorNet N 7-439
network-wide busy signaling optiClient Attendant 7-459
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Index
Z-16
outdial rules
least cost routing
letters (U.S. only) 7-307
parameters (U.S. only) 7-307
least cost routing (U.S. only) 7-306,
7-307
outdial rules for least cost routing (U.S. only)
7-301
outdoor cover 11-5
outgoing calls
LNR 7-229
redial 7-229
outgoing preference 7-414
outlet requirements
HiPath 3500/3300 4-106
HiPath 3550/3350 4-85
HiPath 3700 4-46
HiPath 3750 4-6
OUTWATS facility 7-566
overflow
least cost routing (U.S. only) 7-302
overflow (UCD) 7-113
overflow route, PRI C-8
overload indication 7-55
overview of boards
HiPath 3150 3-17
HiPath 3250 3-17
HiPath 3300 3-21
HiPath 3350 3-15
HiPath 3500 3-19
HiPath 3550 3-12
HiPath 3700 3-9
HiPath 3750 3-9
P
PABX number
LCR PRI C-12
PRI C-8
paging 7-326
parameters
for LCR outdial rules (U.S. only) 7-307
park 7-23
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Index
part numbers
all boards 3-1, 3-9
all components 3-1, 3-9
backplanes (HiPath 3700) 4-58, 4-59
backplanes (HiPath 3750) 4-33, 4-34
cabinets (HiPath 3700) 4-58, 4-59
cabinets (HiPath 3750) 4-33, 4-34
CABLUs, open-end cable (HiPath 3700)
4-60
CABLUs, open-end cable (HiPath 3750)
4-35
connecting cables (HiPath 3700) 4-58,
4-59
connecting cables (HiPath 3750) 4-33,
4-34
password 12-37
password type 5-13
password type (HiPath 3750 and HiPath
3700) 5-6
patch panel 4-60, 4-62
path replacement 7-445
payload switching (HiPath HG1500 V2.0/
V3.0) 9-49
PCM segments for HiPath 3750 and HiPath
3700 4-74
peripheral boards 3-3
PFT1/PFT4 3-271
assignment 3-273
installation location 3-272
trunk failure transfer 3-271
phantom direct inward dialing 7-561
assigning numbers 7-563
pickup
call key 7-180
trunk key 7-177
pin assignments of V.24 sockets 3-287
pin out of CSTA/V.24 cable 3-289
point-to-point connection 7-549
potential hazards
sources 1-21
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
power
outlet requirements
HiPath 3500/3300 4-106
HiPath 3550/3350 4-85
HiPath 3700 4-46
HiPath 3750 4-6
power failure transfer
REAL 3-274
power feeding
external applications
3-274, 3-277,
3-279
NT (HiPath 3550 and HiPath 3500)
3-242
power requirement (boards, workpoint clients, adapter) B-1
power supply
HiPath 3250/3150 3-53
HiPath 3350 3-55
HiPath 3500/3300 3-72
HiPath 3550/3350 3-67
HiPath 3750/3700 3-78
PRI carrier access for least cost routing (U.S.
only) 7-301
primary rate interface 7-555
additional route parameters C-9
background information C-2
B-channel allocation 7-558
calling service C-9
CBC groups C-11
clock reference for the PRI span C-10
configuring C-2
configuring board data for PRI span C-6
configuring route group for PRI span C-6
configuring T1 boards C-5
D-channel encoding type 7-558
dedicated services C-14
emulation type 7-558
frame/line/encoding 7-558
IEC calling services C-3
INWATS service C-10
LCR C-12
LCR access code C-13
LCR routing tables dialing plan C-13
Z-17
Index
Z-18
Q
QSig 7-465
basic features 7-466
busy override 7-468
central attendant position 7-467
COS changeover 7-470
intercept by central attendant position
7-467
resetting the lock code 7-469
R
radio paging equipment 3-221, 7-331
PSE simple 7-331
TMOM
PSE interface 3-222
PSE signals 3-221
via ESPA 7-333
ranges
CorNet-N 2-23
interface to interface 2-23
trunk 2-23
REAL 3-274
cable and connector assignment 3-278
electrical relay data 3-275
installation location 3-275
power failure transfer 3-274
relay contacts 3-277
special connections 3-274
recall 7-44
recommended configuration (HiPath 3700)
4-73
recommended configuration (HiPath 3750)
4-73
recorded announcement/music on Hold
(UCD) 7-110
recorded announcements 10-4
registration number for FCC 2-25
reinitialization
for expansions (HiPath 3750 and HiPath
3700) 5-5
procedure (HiPath 3750 and HiPath
3700) 5-5
reject calls 7-150
related documents 1-15
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Index
related information
manuals and guides (for U.S. only) 1-23
relays 7-362
relocate 7-385
remote access immediately after installation
12-34
remote administration 12-33
remote connection, controlled release 12-35
remote service 12-31
REN 2-25
repairs 1-24
repdial, see repertory dial keys 7-314
repertory dial keys
and least cost routing (U.S. only) 7-303
programming 7-314
reply text 7-340
reporting accidents 1-12, 1-20
requirements for hospital use (HiPath 3750)
4-22
reset activated services 7-382
reset board 3-111, 3-115, 3-119
resetting services 7-382
ring generator
settings (UPSM, -A100) 3-82
settings (UPSM, -S100) 3-81
ringer cutoff 7-129
ringer equivalency number 2-25
room monitor 7-346
route parameters
additional PRI C-9
route table
least cost routing (U.S. only) 7-306
route table paths
least cost routing (U.S. only) 7-306
route table search order
least cost routing (U.S. only) 7-306
router call number 13-13
routing (HiPath HG1500 V2.0/V3.0) 9-50
routing tables (LCR) 7-289
routing tables (U.S. only) 7-304
routing tables, PRI C-13
RS-232
contact assignments 3-287
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
rules
FCC 1-24
S
S0 bus
from STLS4 or ISDN adapter 3-161
from STMD8 or ISDN adapter 3-173
HiPath 3550 and HiPath 3350
general information 9-73
point-to-point 9-74
point-to-multipoint long 9-76
point-to-multipoint short 9-75
safety information 1-5
caution 1-9
danger 1-6
general 1-18
high voltages 1-18
warning 1-8
with electricity 1-18
safety information for Australia 1-13
safety symbols 1-5, 1-21
SBSCO 3-56
contact assignments 3-58
figure 3-57
LAN connector assignment 3-60
numbering plan 3-61
V.24 assignment 3-59
SBSCS 3-62
contact assignments 3-64
figure 3-63
LAN connector assignment 3-66
numbering plan 3-66
V.24 assignment 3-65
screened transfer 7-30
search order
of LCR route table 7-306
secondary protection (HiPath 3750) 4-44
security 12-37
seismic anchoring (HiPath 3750) 4-22
selecting DTMF or rotary pulse dialing in LCR
(U.S. only) 7-303
selective seizure of a DID number via a MUSAP key 7-201
sending information text 7-335
sensors 7-367
Z-19
Index
Z-20
SLU8 3-155
contact assignments 3-155
interfaces 3-155
SLU8R 3-157
contact assignments 3-157
interfaces 3-157
SMR 12-8
SNMP 13-3
messages 13-4
traps 13-4
software update 12-8
software upgrade 12-8
space requirements
HiPath 3550/HiPath 3350 4-84
HiPath 3750 4-5
speaker call 7-326
speaker connection to an analog station port
10-13
speakers 10-13
connecting to analog trunk circuit 10-14
special access 7-572
speech recording device optiLog 4me 9-37
speed dialing
network 7-462
station 7-240
system 7-233
splitting strips
assignment 4-41
startup
HiPath 3550, HiPath 3350, HiPath
3250,HiPath 3150 5-11
HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 5-2
static traffic capacity
HiPath 3500/HiPath 3300 4-116
HiPath 3550/HiPath 3350 4-103
HiPath 3750/HiPath 3700 4-77
station and line number assignment 5-18
station diagnosis 12-17
station number assignment
HiPath 3150 4-123
HiPath 3250 4-123
station number configuration via Manager T
7-148
station numbers for S0 stations 5-23
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Index
subaddressing 7-539
subboards, inserting 4-69
subscriber groups 7-82
suppress station number 7-281
surge protector 3-140
surge protector (HiPath 3700) for patch panel
4-62
surge protector (HiPath 3750) for MDFU/
MDFU-E 4-40
switch (relay) 7-362
system administration
activating services in the talk state 7-381
system configuration, changing (HiPath
3750) 5-5
system number - incoming 7-281
system number - outgoing 7-281
system power requirement B-1
system software upgrade 12-5
system software, installing 4-69
system speed dialing
and least cost routing (U.S. only) 7-303
in tenant systems 7-237
network 7-462
outgoing external traffic 7-233
sharing in a gateway system 7-462
system telephone lock
changeover 7-158
class of service 7-160
system upgrade, HW and SW 6-20
system-related capacity limits 2-19
T
T1 boards
configuring
PRI C-5
targeted call pickup outside of a PU group
7-138
Team configuration 7-394
example with 2 members 7-394
example with 8 members 7-397
Team keys 7-398
Team/Top 7-394
technical base station data 11-4
technical specifications 2-21, 2-25
Z-21
Index
telephone lock
individual 7-155
system 7-158
telephone testing 12-20
telephones
interface to interface ranges 2-23
Telnet administration 13-6
temporary signaling method changeover
7-152
temporary station number display suppression 7-267
tenant services 7-351
configuring 7-352
terminal portability (TP) 7-546
terminals
ISDN data
HiPath 3550 and HiPath 3350 3-160
HiPath 3750 3-173
terminating B-channel selection 7-585
terminating resistors (HiPath 3700) 4-59
terminating resistors (HiPath 3750) 4-34
text messages 7-335
TFTP access 13-7
three-party conference 7-544, 7-579
three-party service 7-544
tie trunk circuits, analog 3-174
tie trunk non-ISDN facility 7-566
TIEL 3-174, 7-436
cable and connector assignment 3-185
cable and connector assignment (for
U.S. only) 3-187
data for the interface 3-176
DIP-FIX switch positions 3-178
figure 3-177
interface types 3-175
LED statuses 3-184
signal wire connection 3-179
signaling protocols 3-176
time 7-359
time of day evaluation for least cost routing
(U.S. only) 7-301
time table, LCR (U.S. only) 7-307
time-division multiplex channels for HiPath
3750 and HiPath 3700 4-74
Z-22
TLA2 3-189
contact assignments 3-189
interfaces 3-189
TLA4 3-189
contact assignments 3-189
interfaces 3-189
TLA4R 3-191
contact assignments 3-191
interfaces 3-191
TLA8 3-189
contact assignments 3-190
interfaces 3-190
TMAMF 3-193
cable and connector assignment
DSP diagnosis, trace 3-194
figure 3-193
LED states 3-195
TMCAS 3-197
in HiPath 3550 3-202
in HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700
switches, display 3-197
TMDID8 3-207
cable and connector assignment
switches and indicators 3-207
TMGL4 3-210
interfaces 3-210
TMGL4R 3-212
interface assignments 3-213
interfaces 3-212
TMGL8 3-214
cable and connector assignment
TML8W 3-216
cable and connector assignment
figure 3-216
jumpers for CDR 3-216
LED statuses 3-217
TMOM 3-219
cable and connector assignment
figure 3-220
LED states 3-223
PSE interfaces 3-222
PSE signals 3-221
switches 3-219
3-196
3-201
3-209
3-215
3-218
3-224
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Index
TMQ4 3-225
interfaces 3-225
TMS2 3-230
jumper 3-231
LED states 3-232
NT connection 3-233
S2M networking 3-236
S2M trunk connection 3-233
SU connector assignments (backplane)
3-231
switches, displays 3-230
TMST1 3-227
interfaces 3-227
toggle 7-25
trunk key 7-177
toll fraud monitoring 7-516
toll restriction 7-255
and least cost routing (U.S. only) 7-303
tools
for installation (HiPath 3700) 4-2
for installation (HiPath 3750) 4-2
Top configuration 7-401
example with 1 exec./1 secr. 7-401
example with 2 exec./2 secr. 7-403
Top keys 7-403
trace options 12-19
traffic capacity (in Erlangs)
HiPath 3500/HiPath 3300 4-116
HiPath 3550/HiPath 3350 4-103
HiPath 3750/HiPath 3700 4-77
traffic restriction groups 7-259
transfer
U.S. ISDN 7-568
UCD groups 7-122
transfer from announcement 7-329
transfer of APS 12-5
transit traffic 7-183
translate station numbers to names for system speed dialing 7-186
transmission data for HiPath 3750/HiPath
3700 2-22
traps 13-4
TraqNet C-29
trunk diagnosis 12-16
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual
Z-23
Index
Z-24
V
V.24
contact assignments 3-287
range extension for call data 7-518
V.24 adapter 3-288
V.24 cable, pin out 3-289
V.24 interface 3-286
V.24 interfaces (HiPath 3700) 4-56
V.24 interfaces (HiPath 3750) 4-31
V24/1 3-286
visual inspection
HiPath 3700 4-80
HiPath 3750 4-80
VMIE C-20
voice channel signaling security 7-357
voice mail
central network server 7-463
HOPE board 3-267
interface 10-5
special equipment 10-5
strings 10-5
voicemail 7-595
W
wall attachments
HiPath 3750 4-10, 4-15
wall mounting (HiPath 3750)
one cabinet 4-10
two stacked cabinets 4-15
wall-mount kit 4-10, 4-15
web-based management WBM 3-91, 3-101
wiring
ISDN S0
general information 9-73
point-to-multipoint long 9-76
point-to-multipoint short 9-75
point-to-point 9-74
work time (UCD) 7-108
workpoint client power requirement B-1
P31003-H1030-S403-6-7620, 12/03
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, Service Manual